Voice over data telecommunications network architecture

Information

  • Patent Grant
  • 6614781
  • Patent Number
    6,614,781
  • Date Filed
    Friday, November 20, 1998
    26 years ago
  • Date Issued
    Tuesday, September 2, 2003
    21 years ago
Abstract
The present invention describes a system and method for communicating voice and data over a packet-switched network that is adapted to coexist and communicate with a legacy PSTN. The system permits packet switching of voice calls and data calls through a data network from and to any of a LEC, a customer facility or a direct IP connection on the data network. The system includes soft switch sites, gateway sites, a data network, a provisioning component, a network event component and a network management component. The system interfaces with customer facilities (e.g., a PBX), carrier facilities (e.g., a LEC) and legacy signaling networks (e.g., SS7) to handle calls between any combination of on-network and off-network callers.The soft switch sites provide the core call processing for the voice network architecture. The soft switch sites manage the gateway sites in a preferred embodiment, using a protocol such as the Internet Protocol Device Control (IPDC) protocol to request the set-up and tear-down of calls. The gateway sites originate and terminate calls between calling parties and called parties through the data network. The gateway sites include network access devices to provide access to network resources. The data network connects one or more of the soft switch sites to one or more of the gateway sites. The provisioning and network event component collects call events recorded at the soft switch sites. The network management component includes a network operations center (NOC) for centralized network management.
Description




BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION




1. Field of the Invention




The present invention relates generally to telecommunications networks and, more particularly, to a system and method for providing transmission of voice and data traffic over a data network, including the signaling, routing and manipulation of such traffic.




2. Related Art




The present invention relates to telecommunications, and in particular to voice and data communication operating over a data network. The Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) is a collection of different telephone networks owned by different companies which have for many years provided telephone communication between users of the network. Different parts of the PSTN network use different transmission media and compression techniques.




Most long distance calls are digitally coded and transmitted along a transmission line such as a T


1


line or fiber optic cable, using circuit switching technology to transmit the calls. Such calls are time division multiplexed (TDM) into separate channels, which allow many calls to pass over the lines without interacting. The channels are directed independently through multiple circuit switches from an originating switch to a destination switch. Using conventional circuit switched communications, a channel on each of the T


1


lines along which a call is transmitted is dedicated for the duration of the call, whether or not any information is actually being transmitted over the channel. The set of channels being used by the call is referred to as a “circuit.”




Telecommunications networks were originally designed to connect one device, such as a telephone, to another device, such as a telephone, using switching services. As previously mentioned, circuit-switched networks provide a dedicated, fixed amount of capacity (a “circuit”) between the two devices for the entire duration of a transmission session. Originally, this was accomplished manually. A human operator would physically patch a wire between two sockets to form a direct connection from the calling party to the called party. More recently, a circuit is set up between an originating switch and a destination switch using a process known as signaling.




Signaling sets up, monitors, and releases connections in a circuit-switched system. Various signaling methods have been devised. Telephone systems formerly used in-band signaling to set up and tear down calls. Signals of an in-band signaling system are passed through the same channels as the information being transmitted. Early electromechanical switches used analog or multi-frequency (MF) in-band signaling. Thereafter, conventional residential telephones used in-band dual-tone multiple frequency (DTMF) signaling to connect to an end office switch. Here, the same wires (and frequencies on the wires) were used to dial a number (using pulses or tones), as are used to transmit voice information. However, in-band signaling permitted unscrupulous callers to use a device such as a whistle to mimic signaling sounds to commit fraud (e.g., to prematurely discontinue billing by an interexchange carrier (IXC), also known as a long distance telephone company).




More recently, to prevent such fraud, out-of-band signaling systems were introduced. Out-of-band signaling uses a signaling network that is separate from the circuit switched network used for carrying the actual call information. For example, integrated services digital network (ISDN) uses a separate channel, a data (D) channel, to pass signaling information out-of-band. Common Channel Interoffice Signaling (CCIS) is another network architecture for out-of-band signaling. A popular version of CCIS signaling is Signaling System 7 (SS7). SS7 is an internationally recognized system optimized for use in digital telecommunications networks.




SS7 out-of-band signaling provided additional benefits beyond fraud prevention. For example, out-of-band signaling eased quick adoption of advanced features (e.g., caller id) by permitting modifications to the separate signaling network. In addition, the SS7 network enabled long distance “Equal Access” (i.e., 1+ dialing for access to any long distance carrier) as required under the terms of the modified final judgment (MFJ) requiring divestiture of the Regional Bell Operating Companies (RBOCs) from their parent company, AT&T.




An SS7 network is a packet-switched signaling network formed from a variety of components, including Service Switching Points (SSPs), Signaling Transfer Points (STPs) and Service Control Points (SCPs). An SSP is a telephone switch which is directly connected to an SS7 network. All calls must originate in or be routed through an SSP. Calls are passed through connections between SSPs. An SCP is a special application computer which maintains information in a database required by users of the network. SCP databases may include, for example, a credit card database for verifying charge information or an “800” database for processing number translations for toll-free calls. STPs pass or route signals between SSPs, other STPs, and SCPs. An STP is a special application packet switch which operates to pass signaling information.




The components in the SS7 network are connected together by links. Links between SSPs and STPs can be, for example, A, B, C, D, E or F links. Typically, redundant links are also used for connecting an SSP to its adjacent STPs. Customer premises equipment (CPE), such as a telephone, are connected to an SSP or an end office (EO) switch.




To initiate a call in an SS7 telecommunications network, a calling party using a telephone connected to an originating EO switch, dials a telephone number of a called party. The telephone number is passed from the telephone to the SSP at the originating EO (referred to as the “ingress EO”) of the calling party's local exchange carrier (LEC). A LEC is commonly referred to as a local telephone company. First, the SSP will process triggers and internal route rules based on satisfaction of certain criteria. Second, the SSP will initiate further signaling messages to another EO or access tandem (AT), if necessary. The signaling information can be passed from the SSP to STPs, which route the signals between the ingress EO and the terminating end office, or egress EO. The egress EO has a port designated by the telephone number of the called party. The call is set up as a direct connection between the EOs through tandem switches if no direct trunking exists or if direct trunking is full. If the call is a long distance call, i.e., between a calling party and a called party located in different local access transport areas (LATAs), then the call is connected through an inter exchange carrier (IXC) switch of any of a number of long distance telephone companies. Such a long distance call is commonly referred to as an inter-LATA call. LECs and IXCs are collectively referred to as the previously mentioned public switched telephone network (PSTN).




Emergence of competitive LECs (CLECs) was facilitated by passage of the Telecommunications Act of 1996, which authorized competition in the local phone service market. Traditional LECs or RBOCs are now also known as incumbent LECs (ILECs). Thus, CLECs compete with ILECs in providing local exchange services. This competition, however, has still not provided the bandwidth necessary to handle the large volume of voice and data communications. This is due to the limitations of circuit switching technology which limits the bandwidth of the equipment being used by the LECs, and to the high costs of adding additional equipment.




Since circuit switching dedicates a channel to a call for the duration of the call, a large amount of switching bandwidth is required to handle the high volume of voice calls. This problem is exacerbated by the fact that the LECs must also handle data communications over the same equipment that handle voice communications.




If the PSTN were converted to a packet-switched network, many of the congestion and limited bandwidth problems would be solved. However, the LECs and IXCs have invested large amounts of capital in building, upgrading and maintaining their circuit switched networks (known as “legacy” networks) and are unable or unwilling to jettison their legacy networks in favor of the newer, more powerful technology of packet switching. Accordingly, a party wanting to build a packet-switched network to provide voice and data communications for customers must build a network that, not only provides the desired functionality, but also is fully compatible with the SS7 and other, e.g., ISDN and MF, switching networks of the legacy systems.




Currently, internets, intranets, and similar public or private data networks that interconnect computers generally use packet switching technology. Packet switching provides for more efficient use of a communication channel as compared to circuit switching. With packet switching, many different calls (e.g., voice, data, video, fax, Internet, etc.) can share a communication channel rather than the channel being dedicated to a single call. For example, during a voice call, digitized voice information might be transferred between the callers only 50% of the time, with the other 50% being silence. For a data call, information might be transferred between two computers 10% of the time. With a circuit switched connection, the voice call would tie-up a communications channel that may have 50% of its bandwidth being unused. Similarly, with the data call, 90% of the channel's bandwidth may go unused. In contrast, a packet-switched connection would permit the voice call, the data call and possibly other call information to all be sent over the same channel.




Packet switching breaks a media stream into pieces known as, for example, packets, cells or frames. Each packet is then encoded with address information for delivery to the proper destination and is sent through the network. The packets are received at the destination and the media stream is reassembled into its original form for delivery to the recipient. This process is made possible using an important family of communications protocols, commonly called the Internet Protocol (IP).




In a packet-switched network, there is no single, unbroken physical connection between sender and receiver. The packets from many different calls share network bandwidth with other transmissions. The packets are sent over many different routes at the same time toward the destination, and then are reassembled at the receiving end. The result is much more efficient use of a telecommunications network than could be achieved with circuit-switching.




Recognizing the inherent efficiency of packet-switched data networks such as the Internet, attention has focused on the transmission of voice information over packet-switched networks. However, such systems are not compatible with the legacy PSTN and therefore are not convenient to use.




One approach that implements voice communications over an IP network requires that a person dial a special access number to access an IP network. Once the IP network is accessed, the destination or called number can be dialed. This type of call is known as a gateway-type access call.




Another approach involves a user having a telephone that is dedicated to an IP network. This approach is inflexible since calls can only be made over the UP network without direct access to the PSTN.




What is needed is a system and method for implementing packet-switched communications for both voice calls and data calls that do not require special access numbers or dedicated phones and permit full integration with the legacy PSTN.




SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION




The present invention is a system and method for communicating both voice and data over a packet-switched network that is adapted to coexist and communicate with a PSTN. The system permits efficient packet switching of voice calls and data calls from a PSTN carrier such as, for example, a LEC, IXC, a customer facility or a direct IP connection on the data network to any other LEC, IXC, customer facility or direct IP connection. For calls from a PSTN carrier, e.g., LEC or IXC, the invention receives signaling from the legacy SS7 signaling network or the ISDN D-channel or from inband signaling trunks. For calls from a customer facility, data channel signaling or inband signaling is received. For calls from a direct IP connection on the data network, signaling messages can travel over the data network. On the call destination side, similar signaling schemes are used depending on whether the called party is on a PSTN carrier, a customer facility or a direct IP connection to the data network.




The system includes soft switch sites, gateway sites, a data network, a provisioning component a network event component and a network management component. The system of the invention interfaces with customer facilities (e.g., a PBX), carrier facilities (e.g., a PSTN carrier, a LEC (e.g., ILECs and CLECs), an independent telephone company (ITC), an IXC, an intelligent peripheral or an enhanced service provider (ESP)) and legacy signaling networks (e.g., SS7) to handle calls between any combination of on-network and off-network callers.




The soft switch sites provide the core call processing for the voice network architecture. Each soft switch site can process multiple types of calls including calls originating from or terminating at off-network customer facilities as well as calls originating from or terminating at on-network customer facilities. Each soft switch site receives signaling messages from and sends signaling messages to the signaling network. The signaling messages can include, for example, SS7, integrated services digital network (ISDN) primary rate interface (PRI) and in-band signaling messages. Each soft switch site processes these signaling messages for the purpose of establishing new calls through the data network and tearing down existing calls and in-progress call control functions. Signaling messages can be transmitted between any combination of on-network and off-network callers.




Signaling messages for a call which either originates off-network or terminates off-network can be carried over the out-of-band signaling network of the PSTN via the soft switch sites. Signaling messages for a call which both originates on-network and terminates on-network can be carried over the data network rather than through the signaling network.




The gateway sites originate and terminate calls between calling parties and called parties through the data network. The soft switch sites control or manage the gateway sites. In a preferred embodiment, the soft switch sites use a protocol such as, for example, the Internet Protocol Device Control (IPDC) protocol, to manage network access devices in the gateway sites to request the set-up and tear-down of calls. However, other protocols could be used, including, for example, network access server messaging interface (NMI) and the ITU media gateway control protocol (MGCP).




The gateway sites can also include network access devices to provide access to network resources (i.e., the communication channels or circuits that provide the bandwidth of the data network). The network access devices can be referred to generally as access servers or media gateways. Exemplary access servers or media gateways are trunking gateways (TGs), access gateways (AGs) and network access servers (NASs). The gateway sites provide for transmission of both voice and data traffic through the data network. The gateway sites also provide connectivity to other telecommunications carriers via trunk interfaces to carrier facilities for the handling of voice calls. The trunk interfaces can also be used for the termination of dial-up modem data calls. The gateway sites can also provide connectivity via private lines and dedicated access lines (DALs), such as T


1


or ISDN PRI facilities, to customer facilities.




The data network connects one or more of the soft switch sites to one or more of the gateway sites. The data network routes data packets through routing devices (e.g., routers) to destination sites (e.g., gateway sites and soft switch sites) on the data network. For example, the data network routes internet protocol (IP) packets for transmission of voice and data traffic from a first gateway site to a second gateway site. The data network represents any art-recognized data network including the global Internet, a private intranet or internet, a frame relay network, and an asynchronous transfer mode (ATM) network.




The network event component collects call events recorded at the soft switch sites. Call event records can be used, for example, for fraud detection and prevention, and billing.




The provisioning event component receives provisioning requests from upstream operational support services (OSS) systems such as, for example, for order-entry, customer service and customer profile changes. The provisioning component distributes provisioning data to appropriate network elements and maintains data synchronization, consistency, and integrity across multiple soft switch sites.




The network management component includes a network operations center (NOC) for centralized network management. Each network element(NE) (e.g., soft switch sites, gateway sites, provisioning, and network event components, etc.) generates simple network management protocol (SNMP) events or alerts. The NOC uses the events generated by each network element to determine the health of the network and to perform other network management functions.




In a preferred embodiment, the invention operates as follows to process, for example, a long distance call (also known as a 1+ call). First, a soft switch site receives an incoming call signaling message from the signaling network. The soft switch site determines the type of call by performing initial digit analysis on the dialed number. Based upon the information in the signaling message, the soft switch site analyzes the initial digit of the dialed number of the call and determines that it is a 1+ call. The soft switch site then queries a customer profile database to retrieve the originating trigger plan associated with the calling customer. The query can be made using, for example, the calling party number provided in the signaling message from the signaling network. This look-up in the customer profile database returns subscription information. For example, the customer profile may indicate that the calling party has subscribed to an account code verification feature that requires entry of an account code before completion of the call. In this case, the soft switch site will instruct the gateway site to collect the account code digits entered by the calling party. Assuming that the gateway site collects the correct number of digits, the soft switch site can use the customer profile to determine how to process the received digits. For account code verification, the soft switch site verifies the validity of the received digits.




Verification can result in the need to enforce a restriction, such as a class of service (COS) restriction (COSR). In this example, the soft switch site can verify that the account code is valid, but that it requires that an intrastate COSR should be enforced. This means that the call is required to be an intrastate call to be valid. The class of service restriction logic can be performed within the soft switch site using, for example, pre-loaded local access and transport areas (LATAs) and state tables. The soft switch would then allow the call to proceed if the class of service requested matches the authorized class of service. For example, if the LATA and state tables show that the LATA of the originating party and the LATA of the terminating party are in the same state, then the call can be allowed to proceed. The soft switch site then completes customer service processing and prepares to terminate the call. At this point, the soft switch site has finished executing all customer service logic and has a 10-digit dialed number that must be terminated. To accomplish the termination, the soft switch site determines the terminating gateway. The dialed number (i.e., the number of the called party dialed by the calling party) is used to select a termination on the data network. This termination may be selected based on various performance, availability or cost criteria. The soft switch site then communicates with a second soft switch site associated with the called party to request that the second soft switch site allocate a terminating circuit or trunk group in a gateway site associated with the called party. One of the two soft switch sites can then indicate to the other the connections that the second soft switch site must make to connect the call. The two soft switch sites then instruct the two gateway sites to make the appropriate connections to set up the call. The soft switch sites send messages to the gateway sites through the data network using, for example, IPDC protocol commands. Alternately, a single soft switch can set up both the origination and termination.




The present invention provides a number of important features and advantages. First, the invention uses application logic to identify and direct incoming data calls straight to a terminating device. This permits data calls to completely bypass the egress end office switch of a LEC. This results in significant cost savings for an entity such as an internet service provider (ISP), ILEC, or CLEC. This decrease in cost results partially from bypass of the egress ILEC end office switch for data traffic.




A further advantage for ISPs is that they are provided data in the digital form used by data networks (e.g., IP data packets), rather than the digital signals conventionally used by switched voice networks (e.g., PPP signals). Consequently, the ISPs need not perform costly modem conversion processes that would otherwise be necessary. The elimination of many telecommunications processes frees up the functions that ISPs, themselves, would have to perform to provide Internet access.




Another advantage of the present invention is that voice traffic can be transmitted transparently over a packet-switched data network to a destination on the PSTN.




Yet another advantage of the invention is that a very large number of modem calls can be passed over a single channel of the data network, including calls carrying media such as voice, bursty data, fax, audio, video, or any other data formats.











Further features and advantages of the invention, as well as the structure and operation of various embodiments of the invention, are described in detail below with reference to the accompanying figures.




BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES




The present invention will be described with reference to the accompanying figures, wherein:





FIG. 1

is a high level view of the Telecommunications Network of the present invention;





FIG. 2A

is an intermediate level view of the Telecommunications Network of the present invention;





FIG. 2B

is an intermediate level operational call flow of the present invention;





FIG. 3

is a specific example embodiment of the telecommunications network including three geographically diverse soft switch sites and multiple geographically diverse or collocated gateway sites;





FIG. 4A

depicts a block diagram illustrating the interfaces between a soft switch and the remaining components of a telecommunications network;





FIG. 4B

provides a Soft Switch Object Oriented Programming (OOP) Class Definition;





FIG. 4C

provides a Call OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 4D

provides a Signaling Messages OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 4E

provides an IPDC Messages OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 4F

depicts a block diagram of interprocess communication including the starting of a soft switch command and control functions by a network operations center;





FIG. 4G

depicts a block diagram of soft switch command and control startup by a network operations center sequencing diagram;





FIG. 4H

depicts a block diagram of soft switch command and control registration with configuration server sequencing diagram;





FIG. 4I

depicts a block diagram of soft switch accepting configuration information from configuration server sequencing diagram;





FIG. 5A

depicts a detailed block diagram of an exemplary soft switch site including two SS7 Gateways communicating with a plurality of soft switches which are in turn communicating with a plurality of Gateway sites;





FIG. 5B

provides a Gateway Messages OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 5C

depicts a block diagram of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with SS7 gateways;





FIG. 5D

depicts a block diagram of interprocess communication including an access server signaling a soft switch to register with SS7 gateways;





FIG. 5E

depicts a block diagram of a soft switch registering with SS7 gateways sequencing diagram;





FIG. 6A

depicts an Off-Switch Call Processing Abstraction Layer for interfacing with a plurality of on-network and off-network SCPs;





FIG. 6B

depicts an Intelligent Network Component (INC) Architecture;





FIG. 6C

depicts an INC architecture including On-net Services Control Points (SCPs);





FIG. 6D

depicts an INC architecture including On-net and Off-net SCPs and customer Automatic Call Distributors (ACDs);





FIG. 7A

provides a Configuration Server OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 7B

depicts a block diagram of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with configuration server;





FIG. 8A

depicts Route Server Support for a Soft Switch Site including a plurality of collocated or geographically diverse route servers, soft switches, and Trunking Gateway and Access gateway sites,





FIG. 8B

provides a Route Server OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 8C

provides a Route Objects OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 8D

provides a Pools OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 8E

provides a Circuit Objects OOP Class Definition;





FIG. 8F

depicts a block diagram of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with route server (RS);





FIG. 9

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary Regional Network Event Collection Point Architecture (RNECP) including a master data center having a plurality of master network event database servers;





FIG. 10A

depicts a detailed block diagram of an exemplary gateway site;





FIG. 10B

depicts a block diagram of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with access servers;





FIG. 11A

depicts a detailed block diagram of an exemplary Trunking Gateway High-Level Functional Architecture;





FIG. 11B

depicts a detailed flow diagram overviewing a Gateway Common Media Processing Component on the Ingress side of a trunking gateway;





FIG. 11C

depicts a detailed flow diagram overviewing a Gateway Common Media Processing Component on the Egress side of a trunking gateway;





FIG. 12

depicts a detailed block diagram of an exemplary Access Gateway High-Level Functional Architecture;





FIG. 13

depicts a detailed block diagram of an exemplary Network Access Server High-Level functional architecture;





FIG. 14

depicts an exemplary digital cross connect system (DACS);





FIG. 15

depicts an exemplary Announcement Server Component Interface Design;





FIG. 16A

depicts an exemplary data network interconnecting a plurality of gateway sites and a soft switch site;





FIG. 16B

depicts a exemplary logical view of an Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) network;





FIG. 17A

depicts an exemplary signaling network including a plurality of signal transfer points (STPs) and SS7 gateways;





FIG. 17B

depicts another exemplary embodiment showing connectivity to an SS7 signaling network;





FIG. 17C

depicts a block diagram of an SS7 signaling network architecture;





FIG. 18

depicts a block diagram of the provisioning and network event components;





FIG. 19A

depicts a block diagram of a data distributor in communication with a plurality of voice network elements;





FIG. 19B

depicts a more detailed description of a data distributor architecture including voice network elements and upstream operational support services applications;





FIG. 19C

depicts an exemplary embodiment of a data distributor and voice network elements;





FIG. 19D

depicts a block diagram of provisioning interfaces into the SCPs from the data distributor,





FIG. 19E

illustrates a data distributor including BEA M3, a CORBA-compliant interface server


1936


with an imbedded TUXEDO layer;





FIG. 19F

depicts a detailed example embodiment block diagram of the BEA M3 data distributor of the provisioning element,





FIG. 19G

depicts a block diagram illustrating a high level conceptual diagram of the BEA M3 CORBA-compliant interface;





FIG. 19H

depicts a block diagram illustrating additional components of the high level conceptual diagram of the BEA M3 CORBA-compliant interface;





FIG. 19I

depicts a block diagram illustrating a data distributor sending data to configuration server sequencing diagram;





FIG. 20

depicts a block diagram of a Master Network Event Database (MNEDB) interfacing to a plurality of database query applications;





FIG. 21A

depicts an exemplary network management architecture;





FIG. 21B

depicts an outage recovery scenario illustrating the occurrence of a fiber cut, latency or packet loss failure in the Data Network;





FIG. 21C

depicts an outage recovery scenario including a complete-gateway site outage;





FIG. 21D

further depicts an outage recovery scenario including a complete-gateway site outage;





FIG. 21E

depicts an outage recovery scenario including a complete soft switch site outage;





FIG. 21F

further depicts an outage recovery scenario including a complete soft switch site outage;





FIG. 21G

depicts a block diagram of interprocess communication including a NOC communicating with a soft switch;





FIG. 22A

depicts a high-level operational call flow;





FIG. 22B

depicts a more detailed call flow;





FIG. 22C

depicts an even more detailed call flow;





FIG. 23A

depicts an exemplary voice call originating and terminating via SS7 signaling on a Trunking Gateway;





FIG. 23B

depicts an exemplary data call originating on a SS7 trunk on a trunking gateway (TG);





FIG. 23C

depicts an exemplary voice call originating on a SS7 trunk on a trunking gateway and terminating via access server signaling on an access gateway (AG);





FIG. 23D

depicts an exemplary voice call originating on an SS7 trunk on a trunking gateway and terminating on an announcement server (ANS);





FIG. 24A

depicts an exemplary voice call originating on an SS7 trunk on a network access server and terminating on a trunking gateway;





FIG. 24B

Data Call originating on an SS7 trunk and terminating on a NAS;





FIG. 24C

depicts an exemplary voice call originating on an SS7 trunk on a NAS and terminating via access server signaling on an AG;





FIG. 24D

depicts an exemplary data call on a NAS with callback outbound reorigination;





FIG. 25A

depicts an exemplary voice call originating on access server trunks on an AG and terminating on access server trunks on an AG;





FIG. 25B

depicts an exemplary data call on an AG;





FIG. 25C

depicts an exemplary voice call originating on access server trunks on an AG and terminating on SS7 signaled trunks on a TG;





FIG. 25D

depicts an exemplary outbound data call from a NAS via access server signaling to an AG;





FIG. 26A

depicts a more detailed diagram of message flow for an exemplary voice call received over a TG;





FIG. 26B

depicts a more detailed diagram of message flow for an exemplary voice call received over a NAS;





FIG. 26C

depicts a more detailed diagram of message flow for an exemplary data call over a NAS;





FIGS. 27-57

depict detailed sequence diagrams demonstrating component intercommunication during a voice call received on a NAS or TG or a data call received on a NAS;





FIG. 27

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch accepting a signaling message from an SS7 gateway sequencing diagram;





FIG. 28

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch getting a call context message from an IAM signaling message sequencing diagram;





FIG. 29A

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an IAM signaling message including sending a request to a route server sequencing diagram;





FIG. 29B

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch starting processing of a route request sequencing diagram;





FIG. 30

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server determining a domestic route sequencing diagram;





FIG. 31

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server checking availability of potential terminations sequencing diagram;





FIG. 32

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server getting an originating route node sequencing diagram;





FIG. 33A

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server calculating a domestic route for a voice call sequencing diagram;





FIG. 33B

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server calculating a domestic route for a voice call sequencing diagram;





FIG. 34

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch getting a call context from a route response from a route server sequencing diagram;





FIG. 35

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an IAM message including sending an IAM to a terminating network sequencing diagram;





FIG. 36

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message including sending an ACM to an originating network sequencing diagram;





FIG. 37

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message including the setup of access devices sequencing diagram;





FIG. 38

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an example of how a soft switch can process an ACM sending an RTP connection message to the originating access server sequencing diagram;





FIG. 39

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ANM message sending the ANM to the originating SS7 gateway sequencing diagram;





FIG. 40

depicts a block diagram of a call teardown flow showing a soft switch processing an REL message with the terminating end initiateing teardownsequencing diagram;





FIG. 41

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an REL message tearing down all nodes sequencing diagram;





FIG. 42

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an RLC message with the terminating end initiating teardown sequencing diagram;





FIG. 43

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch sending an unallocate message to route server for call teardown sequencing diagram;





FIG. 44

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch unallocating route nodes sequencing diagram;





FIG. 45

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a a soft switch processing call teardown and deleting call context sequencing diagram;





FIG. 46

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server calculating a domestic route sequencing diagram for a voice call on a NAS;





FIG. 47

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch getting call context from route response sequencing diagram;





FIG. 48

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an IAM sending the IAM to the terminating network sequencing diagram;





FIG. 49

depicting a block diagram of a call flow showing calculation of a domestic route for a data call sequencing diagram;





FIG. 50

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch getting call context from route response sequencing diagram,





FIG. 51

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an IAM connnecting the data call sequencing diagram; soft switch receiving and acknowledging receipt of a signaling message from an SS7 GW sequencing diagram;





FIG. 52

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message including sending an ACM to an originating network sequencing diagram;





FIG. 53

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ANM message including sending an ANM to an originating network sequencing diagram;





FIG. 54

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an RCR message sequencing diagram;





FIG. 55

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an RLC message sequencing diagram;





FIG. 56

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message sending an ACM to the originating network sequencing diagram;





FIG. 57

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an IAM setting up access servers;





FIG. 58A

depicts a block diagram of the H.323 architecture for a network-based communications system defining four major components, including, terminals, gateways, gatekeepers, and multipoint control units;





FIG. 58B

depicts an exemplary H.323 terminal,





FIG. 59

shows an example H.323/PSTN Gateway;





FIG. 60

depicts an example collection of all terminals, gateways, and multipoint control units which can be managed by a single gatekeeper, collectively known as an H.323 Zone;





FIG. 61

depicts an exemplary MCU of the H.323 architecture;





FIG. 62

depicts a block diagram showing a soft switch in communication with an access server;





FIG. 63

depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Inbound Call Handling state diagram;





FIG. 64A

depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Exception Handling state diagram;





FIG. 64B

further depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Exception Handling state diagram;





FIG. 65

depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Release Request Handling state diagram;





FIG. 66

depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side TDM Connection Handling state diagram;





FIG. 67A

depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Continuity Test Handling state diagram;





FIG. 67B

further depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Continuity Test Handling state diagram;





FIG. 68A

depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Outbound Call Handling Initiated by Access Server state diagram;





FIG. 68B

further depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Side Outbound Call Handling Initiated by Access Server state diagram;





FIG. 69

depicts a flowchart of an Access Server Outbound Call Handling Initiated by Soft Switch state diagram;





FIG. 70A

depicts an exemplary diagram of an OOP Class Definition; and





FIG. 70B

depicts an exemplary computer system of the present invention.











In the figures, like reference numbers generally indicate identical, functionally similar, and/or structurally similar elements. The figure in which an element first appears is indicated by the leftmost digit(s) in the reference number.




DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS




Table of Contents




I. High level description




A. Structural description




1. Soft Switch Sites




2. Gateway Sites




3. Data Network




4. Signaling Network




5. Network Event Component




6. Provisioning Component




7. Network Management Component




B. Operational description




II. Intermediate Level Description




A. Structural Description




1. Soft Switch Site




a. Soft Switch




b. SS7 Gateway




c. Signal Transfer Points (STPs)




d. Services Control Points (SCPs)




e. Configuration Server (CS) or Configuration Database (CDB)




f. Route Server




g. Regional Network Event Collection Point (RNECP)




2. Gateway Site




a. Trunking Gateway (TG)




b. Access Gateway (AG)




c. Network Access Server (NAS)




d. Digital Cross-Connect System (DACS)




e. Announcement Server (ANS)




3. Data Network




a. Routers




b. Local Area Networks (LANs) and Wide Area Networks (WANs)




c. Network Protocols




4. Signaling Network




a. Signal Transfer Points (STPs)




b. Service Switching Points (SSPs)




c. Services Control Points (SCPs)




5. Provisioning Component and Network Event Component




a. Data Distributor




6. Provisioning Component and Network Event Component




a. Master Network Event Database




7. Network management component




B. Operational Description




III. Specific Implementation Example Embodiments




A. Structural description




1. Soft Switch Site




a. Soft Switch




(1) Soft Switch Interfaces




b. SS7 Gateway




(1) SS7 Gateway Example Embodiment




(2) SS7 Gateway-to-Soft Switch Interface




c. Signal Transfer Points (STPs)




(1) STP Example Embodiment




 (a) Global Title Translation




 (b) Gateway Screening Software




 (c) Local Number Portability (LNP)




 (d) STP to LAN Interface




 (e) ANSI to ITU Gateway




d. Services Control Points (SCPs)




(1) Additional Services Calls




(2) Project Account Codes




(3) Basic Toll-Free




e. Configuration Server (CS) or Configuration Database (CDB)




f. Route Server




(1) Route Server Routing Logic




(2) Route Server Circuit Management




g. Regional Network Event Collection Point (RNECP)




(1) Example Mandatory Event Blocks EBs




(2) Augmenting Event Blocks EBs.




h. Software Object Oriented Programming (OOPs) Class Definitions




(1) Introduction to Object Oriented Programming (OOP)




(2) Software Objects in an OOP Environment




(3) Class Definitions




 (a) Soft Switch Class




 (b) Call Context Class




 (c) Signaling Message Class




 (d) SS7 Gateway Class




 (e) IPDC Message Class




 (f) Call Event Identifier Class




 (g) Configuration Proxy Class




 (h) Route Server Class




 (i) Route Objects Class




 (j) Pool Class




 (k) Circuit Pool Class




2. Gateway Site




a. Trunking Gateway (TG)




(1) Trunking Gateway Interfaces




b. Access Gateway (AG)




(1) Access Gateway Interfaces




c. Network Access Server (NAS)




(1) Network Access Server Interfaces




d. Digital Cross-Connect System (DACS)




e. Announcement Server (ANS)




3. Data Network




a. Routers




b. Local Area Networks (LANs) and Wide Area Networks (WANs)




c. Network Protocols




(1) Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol (TCP/IP)




(2) Internet Protocol (IP)v4 and IPv6




(3) Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP)




(4) Real-time Transport Protocol (RTP)




(5) IP Multi-Casting Protocols




d. Virtual Private Networks (VPNs)




(1) VPN Protocols




 (a) Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP)




 (b) Layer 2 Forwarding (L2F) Protocol




 (c) Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol (L2TP)




e. Exemplary Data Networks




(1) Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM)




(2) Frame Relay




(3) Internet Protocol (IP)




4. Signaling Network




a. Signal Transfer Points (STPs)




b. Service Switching Points (SSPs)




c. Services Control Points (SCPs)




5. Provisioning Component and Network Event Component




a. Data Distributor




(1) Data Distributor Interfaces




6. Provisioning Component and Network Event Component




a. Master Network Event Database




(1) MNEDB Interfaces




(2) Event Block Definitions




 (a) Example Mandatory Event Blocks (EBs) Definitions




 (b) Example Augmenting Event Block (EBs) Definitions




(3) Example Element Definitions




(4) Element Definitions




7. Network management component




a. Network operations center (NOC)




b. Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP)




c. Network Outage Recovery Scenarios




(1) Complete Gateway Site Outage




(2) Soft Switch Fail-Over




(3) Complete Soft Switch Site Outage Scenario




8. Internet Protocol Device Control (IPDC) Protocol




a. IPDC Base Protocol




b. IPDC Control Protocol




c. IPDC Control Message Codes




d. A Detailed View of the IPDC Protocol Control Messages




(1) Startup Messages




(2) Protocol Error Messages




(3) System Configuration Messages




(4) Telephone Company Interface Configuration Messages




(5) Soft Switch Configuration Messages




(6) Maintenance-Status Messages




(7) Continuity Test Messages




(8) Keepalive Test Messages




(9) LAN Test Messages




(10) Tone Function Messages




(11) Example Source Port Types




(12) Example Internal Resource Types




(13) Example Destination Port Types




(14) Call Control Messages




(15) Example Port Definitions




(16) Call Clearing Messages




(17) Event Notification Messages




(18) Tunneled Signaling Messages




e. Control Message Parameters




f. A Detailed View of the Flow of Control Messages




(1) Startup Flow




(2) Module Status Notification Flow




(3) Line Status Notification Flow




(4) Blocking of Channels Flow




(5) Unblocking of Channels Flow




(6) Keepalive Test Flow




(7) Reset Request Flow




g. Call Flows




(1) Data Services




 (a) Inbound Data Call via SS7 Signaling Flow




 (b) Inbound Data Call via Access Server Signaling Flow




 (c) Inbound Data Call via SS7 Signaling (with call-back)




 (d) Inbound Data Call (with loopback continuity testing) Flow




 (e) Outbound Data Call Flow via SS7 Signaling




 (f) Outbound Data Call Flow via Access Server Signaling




 (g) Outbound Data Call Flow Initiated from the Access Server with continuity testing




(2) TDM Switching Setup Connection Flow




 (a) Basic TDM Interaction Sequence




 (b) Routing of calls to Appropriate Access Server using TDM connections Flow




(3) Voice Services




 (a) Voice over Packet Services Call Flow (Inbound SS7 signaling, Outbound access server signaling, Soft Switch managed RTP ports)




 (b) Voice over Packet Call Flow (Inbound access server signaling, Outbound access server signaling, Soft switch managed RTP ports)




 (c) Voice over Packet Call Flow (Inbound SS7 signaling, outbound SS7 signaling, IP network with access server managed RTP ports)




 (d) Unattended Call Transfers Call Flow




 (e) Attended Call Transfer Call Flow




 (f) Call termination with a message announcement Call Flow




 (g) Wiretap




B. Operational description




1. Voice Call originating and terminating via SS7 signaling on a Trunking Gateway




a. Voice Call on a TG Sequence Diagrams of Component Intercommunication




2. Data Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Trunking Gateway




3. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Trunking Gateway and terminating via access server signaling on an Access Gateway




4. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Trunking Gateway and terminating on an Announcement Server




5. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Network Access Server and terminating on a Trunking Gateway via SS7 signaling




a. Voice Call on a NAS Sequence Diagrams of Component Intercommunication




6. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a NAS and terminating via Access Server Signaling on an Access Gateway




7. Data Call originating on an SS7 trunk and terminating on a NAS




a. Data Call on a NAS Sequence Diagrams of Component intercommunication




8. Data Call on NAS with Callback outbound reorigination




9. Voice Call originating on Access Server dedicated line on an Access Gateway and terminating on an Access Server dedicated line on an Access Gateway




10. Voice Call originating on Access Server signaled private line on an Access Gateway and terminating on SS7 signaled trunks on a Trunking Gateway




11. Data Call on an Access Gateway




12. Outbound Data Call from a NAS via Access Server signaling from an Access Gateway




13. Voice Services




a. Private Voice Network (PVN) Service




b. 1+ Long Distance Service




(1) Project Account Codes (PAC)




 (a) PAC Variations




(2) Class of Service Restrictions (COSR)




(3) Origination and Termination




(4) Call Rating




(5) Multiple Service T-1




(6) Monthly Recurring Charges (MRCs)




(7) PVN Private Dialing Plan




(8) Three-Way Conferencing




(9) Network Hold with Message Delivery




c. 8XX Toll Free Services




(1) Enhanced Routing Features




(2) Info-Digit Blocking




(3) Toll-Free Number Portability (TFNP)




(4) Multiple-Server T-1




(5) Call Rating




(6) Project Accounting Codes




(7) Toll-Free Directory Listings




(8) Menu Routing




(9) Network ACD




(10) Network Transfer (TBX)




(11) Quota Routing




(12) Toll-Free Valet (Call Park)




d. Operator Services




(1) Domestic Operator Services




 (a) Operator Services Features




(2) International Operator Services




e. Calling Card Services




(1) Calling Card Features




(2) Call Rating




f. One-Number Services




(1) One Number Features




g. Debit Card/Credit Card Call Services




h. Local Services




(1) Local Voice/Dial Tone (LV/DT)




(2) Call Handling Features




 (a) Line Hunting




 (b) Call Forward Busy




 (c) Call Forwarding Don't Answer




 (d) Call Forward Variable




 (e) Call Hold




 (f) Three-Way Calling




 (g) Call Transfer




 (h) Call Waiting/Cancel Call Waiting




 (i) Extension or Station-to-Station Calling




 (j) Direct Connect Hotline/Ring Down Line




 (k) Message Waiting Indicator




 (l) Distinctive Ringing




 (m) Six-Way Conference Calling




 (n) Speed Calling




 (o) Selective Call Rejection




 (p) Remote Activation of Call Forward Variable




(3) Enhanced Services




 (a) Remote Call Forward (RCF)




 (b) Voice Messaging Services




 (c) Integrated Voice Messaging




 (d) Stand-alone Voice Messaging




(4) Class Services




(5) Class of Service Restrictions




(b) Local Voice/Local Calling (LV/LC)




i. Conferencing Services




(1) Audio Conferencing




 (a) Audio conferencing features




(2) Video Conferencing




14. Data Services




a. Internet Hosting




b. Managed Modem Services




c. Collocation Services




d. IP network Services




e. Legacy Protocol Services—Systems Network Architecture (SNA)




f. Permanent Virtual Circuits




15. Additional Products and Services




IV. Definitions




V. Conclusion




I. High Level Description




This section provides a high-level description of the voice over IP network architecture according to the present invention. In particular, a structural implementation of the voice over IP (VOIP) network architecture is described at a high-level. Also, a functional implementation for this structure is described at a high-level. This structural implementation is described herein for illustrative purposes, and is not limiting. In particular, the process described in this section can be achieved using any number of structural implementations, one of which is described in this section. The details of such structural implementations will be apparent to persons skilled in the relevant arts based on the teachings contained herein.




A. Structural Description





FIG. 1

is a block diagram


100


illustrating the components of the VOIP architecture at a high-level.

FIG. 1

includes soft switch sites


104


,


106


, gateway sites


108


,


110


, data network


112


, signaling network


114


, network event component


116


, provisioning component


117


and network management component


118


.




Included in

FIG. 1

are calling parties


102


,


122


and called parties


120


,


124


. Calling parties


102


,


122


are homed to gateway site


108


. Calling parties


102


,


122


are homed to gateway site


108


. Called parties


120


,


124


are homed to gateway site


110


. Calling party


102


can be connected to gateway site


108


via trunks from carrier facility


126


to gateway site


108


. Similarly, called party


120


can be connected to gateway site


110


via trunks from carrier facility


130


to gateway site


110


. Calling party


122


can be connected to gateway site


108


via a private line or dedicated access line (DAL) from customer facility


128


to gateway site


108


. Similarly, called party


124


can be connected to gateway site


110


via a private line or a DAL from customer facility


132


to gateway site


110


.




Calling party


102


and called party


120


are off-network, meaning that they are connected to gateway sites


108


,


110


via the Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) facilities. Calling party


122


and called party


124


are on-network, meaning that connect to gateway sites


108


,


110


as direct customers.




1. Soft Switch Sites




Soft switch sites


104


,


106


provide the core call processing for the voice network architecture. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can process multiple types of calls. First, soft switch sites


104


,


106


can process calls originating from or terminating at on-network customer facilities


128


,


132


. Second, soft switch sites


104


,


106


can process calls originating from or terminating at off-network customer facilities


126


,


130


.




Soft switch sites


104


,


106


receive signaling messages from and send signaling messages to signaling network


114


. For example, these signaling messages can include SS7, primary rate interface (PRI) and in-band signaling messages. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


process these signaling messages for the purpose of establishing new calls from calling parties


102


,


122


through data network


112


to called parties


120


,


124


. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


also process these signaling messages for the purpose of tearing down existing calls established between calling parties


102


,


122


and called parties


120


,


124


(through data network


112


).




Calls can be transmitted between any combination of on-network and off-network callers.




In one embodiment, signaling messages for a call which either originates from an off-network calling party


102


, or terminates to an off-network called party


120


, can be carried over out-of-band signaling network


114


from the PSTN to soft switches


104


,


106


.




In another embodiment, signaling messages for a call which either originates from an on-network calling party


122


, or terminates to on-network called party


124


, can be carried in-band over data network


112


or over a separate data network to soft switch sites


104


,


106


, rather than through signaling network


114


.




Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can be collocated or geographically diverse. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can also be connected by redundant connections to data network


112


to enable communication between soft switches


104


,


106


.




Soft switch sites


104


,


106


use other voice network components to assist with the processing of calls. For example, gateway sites


108


,


110


provide the means to originate and terminate calls on the PSTN. In a preferred embodiment, soft switch sites


104


,


106


use the Internet Protocol Device Control (IPDC) protocol to control network access devices known as media gateways in gateway sites


108


,


110


, and to request, for example, the set-up and tear-down of calls. The IPDC protocol is described below with reference to Tables 144-185. Alternatively, any protocol understood by those skilled in the art can be used to control gateway sites


108


,


110


. One example of an alternative protocol is the Network Access Server (NAS) Messaging Interface (NMI) Protocol, discussed in U.S. Patent Application entitled “System and Method for Bypassing Data from Egress Facilities”, filed concurrently herewith, Attorney Docket No. 1757.0060000, the contents of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety. Another example of a protocol is the Media Gateway Control Protocol (MGCP) from the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF).




Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can include other network components such as a soft switch, which more recently can also be known as a media gateway controller, or other network devices.




2. Gateway Sites




Gateway sites


108


,


110


provide the means to originate and terminate calls between calling parties


102


,


122


and called parties


120


,


124


through data network


112


. For example, calling party


122


can originate a call terminated to off-network called party


120


, which is homed to gateway site


110


via carrier facility


130


.




Gateway sites


108


,


110


can include network access devices to provide access to network resources. An example of a network access device is an access server which is more recently commonly known as a media gateway. These devices can include trunking gateways, access gateways and network access servers. Gateway sites


108


,


110


provide for transmission of, for example, both voice and data traffic through data network


112


.




Gateway sites


108


,


110


are controlled or managed by one or more soft switch sites


104


,


106


. As noted, soft switch sites


104


,


106


can communicate with gateway sites


108


,


110


via the IPDC, NMI, MGCP, or alternative protocols.




Gateway sites


108


,


110


can provide trunk interfaces to other telecommunication carriers via carrier facilities


126


,


130


for the handling of voice calls. The trunk interfaces can also be used for the termination of dial-up modem data calls. Gateway sites


108


,


110


can also provide private lines and dedicated access lines, such as T


1


or ISDN PRI facilities, to customer facilities


128


,


132


. Examples of customer facilities


128


,


132


are customer premises equipment (CPE) such as, for example, a private branch exchange (PBX).




Gateway sites


108


,


110


can be collocated or geographically diverse from one another or from other network elements (e.g. soft switch sites


104


,


106


).




Gateway sites


108


,


110


can also be connected by redundant connections to data network


112


to enable communication with and management by soft switches


104


,


106


.




3. Data Network




Data network


112


connects one or more soft switch sites


104


,


106


to one or more gateway sites


108


,


110


. Data Network


112


can provide for routing of data through routing devices to destination sites on data network


112


. For example, data network


112


can provide for routing of internet protocol (IP) packets for transmission of voice and data traffic from gateway site


108


to gateway site


110


. Data Network


112


represents any art-recognized data network. One well-known data network is the global Internet. Other examples include a private intranet, a packet-switched network, a frame relay network, and an asynchronous transfer mode (ATM) network.




4. Signaling Network




Signaling network


114


is an out-of-band signaling network providing for transmission of signaling messages between the PSTN and soft switch sites


104


,


106


. For example, signaling network


114


can use Common Channel Interoffice Signaling (CCIS), which is a network architecture for out-of-band signaling. A popular version of CCIS signaling is Signaling System 7 (SS7). SS7 is an internationally recognized system optimized for use in digital telecommunications networks.




5. Network Event Component




Network event component


116


provides for collection of call events recorded at soft switch sites


104


,


106


. Call event records can be used, for example, for fraud detection and prevention, traffic reporting and billing.




6. Provisioning Component




Provisioning component


117


provides several functions. First, provisioning component


117


receives provisioning requests from upstream operational support services (OSS) systems, for such items as order-entry, customer service, and customer profile changes. Second, provisioning component


117


distributes provisioning data to appropriate network elements. Third, provisioning component


117


maintains data synchronization, consistency, and integrity across multiple soft switch sites


104


,


106


.




7. Network Management Component




Network management component


118


can include a network operations center (NOC) for centralized network management. Each network element(NE) of block diagram


100


can generate simple network management protocol (SNMP) events or alerts. The NOC uses the events generated by a NE to determine the health of the network, and to perform other network management functions.




B. Operational Description




The following operational flows describe an exemplary high level call scenario for soft switch sites


104


,


106


and is intended to demonstrate at a high architectural level how soft switch sites


104


,


106


process calls. The operational flow of the present invention is not to be viewed as limited to this exemplary illustration.




As an illustration,

FIG. 22A

depicts a simple operational call flow chart describing how soft switch sites


104


,


106


can process a long distance call, also known as a 1+ call. The operational call flow of

FIG. 22A

begins with step


2202


, in which a soft switch site receives an incoming signaling message. The call starts by soft switch site


104


receiving an incoming signaling message from carrier facility


126


via signaling network


114


, indicating an incoming call from calling party


102


.




In step


2204


, the soft switch site determines the type of call by performing initial digit analysis. Based upon the information in the signaling message, the soft switch site


104


analyzes the initial digit of the dialed number of the call and determines that it is a 1+ call.




In step


2222


, soft switch site


104


can select a route termination based on the dialed number (i.e., the number of called party


120


dialed by calling party


102


) using least cost routing. This route termination can involve termination off data network


112


or off onto another data network. Soft switch site


104


can then communicate with soft switch site


106


to allocate a terminating circuit in gateway site


110


for this call.




In step


2224


, soft switch site


104


can indicate connections to be made to complete the call. Soft switch site


104


or soft switch site


106


can return a termination that indicates the connections that must be made to connect the call.




In step


2226


, soft switch sites


104


,


106


instruct the gateway sites to make connections to set up the call. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can send messages through data network


112


(e.g. using IPDC protocol commands) to gateway sites


108


,


110


, to instruct the gateway sites to make the necessary connections for setting up the call origination from calling party


102


, the call termination to called party


120


, and the connection between origination and termination.




In step


2228


, soft switch sites


104


,


106


generate and send network events to a repository. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can generate and send network events to network event component


116


that are used, for example, in detecting and preventing fraud, and in performing billing.




In step


2230


, network management component


118


monitors the telecommunications network


100


. All network elements create network management events such as SNMP protocol alerts or events. Network management component


118


can monitor SNMP events to enable management of network resources.





FIG. 22B

details a more complex operational call flow describing how soft switch sites


104


,


106


process a long distance call.

FIG. 22B

inserts steps


2206


,


2208


and


2220


between steps


2204


and


2222


of FIG.


22


A.




The operational call flow of

FIG. 22B

begins with step


2202


, in which a soft switch site receives an incoming signaling message. The call starts by soft switch site


104


receiving an incoming signaling message from carrier facility


126


via signaling network


114


, indicating an incoming call from calling party


102


.




In step


2204


, the soft switch site determines the type of call by performing initial digit analysis. Based upon the information in the signaling message, the soft switch site


104


analyzes the initial digit of the dialed number of the call and determines that it is a 1+ call.




In step


2206


, the soft switch site queries a customer profile database to retrieve the originating trigger plan associated with the calling customer. With a 1+ type of call, the logic within the soft switch knows to query the customer profile database within soft switch site


104


to retrieve the originating trigger plan for the calling party. The step


2206


query can be made using the calling party number. The customer profile lookup is performed using as the lookup key, the originating number, i.e., the number of calling party


102


, provided in the signaling message from signaling network


114


.




In step


2208


, the lookup returns subscription information. For example, the customer profile can require entry of an account code. In this example, the customer profile lookup can return an indication that the customer, i.e., calling party


102


, has subscribed to an account code verification feature. A class of service restriction can also be enforced, but this will not be known until account code verification identifies an associated account code.




In step


2220


, soft switch site


104


completes customer service processing and prepares to terminate the call. At this point, soft switch site


104


has finished executing all customer service logic and has a 10-digit dialed number that must be terminated.




In step


2222


, soft switch site


104


can select a route termination based on the dialed number (i.e., the number of called party


120


dialed by calling party


102


) using least cost routing. This route termination can involve termination off data network


112


or off onto another data network. Soft switch site


104


can then communicate with soft switch site


106


to allocate a terminating circuit in gateway site


110


for this call.




In step


2224


, soft switch site


104


can indicate connections to be made to complete the call. Soft switch site


104


or soft switch site


106


can return a termination that indicates the connections that must be made to connect the call.




In step


2226


, soft switch sites


104


,


106


instruct the gateway sites to make connections to set up the call. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can send messages through data network


112


(e.g. using IPDC protocol commands) to gateway sites


108


,


110


, to instruct the gateway sites to make the necessary connections for setting up the call origination from calling party


102


, the call termination to called party


120


, and the connection between origination and termination.




In step


2228


, soft switch sites


104


,


106


generate and send network events to a repository. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can generate and send network events to network event component


116


that are used, for example, in detecting and preventing fraud, and in performing billing.




In step


2230


, network management component


118


monitors the telecommunications network


100


. All network elements create network management events such as SNMP protocol alerts or events. Network management component


118


can monitor SNMP events to enable management of network resources.





FIG. 22C

details an even more complex operational call flow describing how soft switch sites


104


,


106


can be used to process a long distance call using project account codes and class of service restrictions.

FIG. 22C

inserts steps


2210


through


2218


between steps


2208


and


2220


of FIG.


22


B.




The operational call flow of

FIG. 22C

begins with step


2202


, in which a soft switch site receives an incoming signaling message. The call starts by soft switch site


104


receiving an incoming signaling message from carrier facility


126


via signaling network


114


, indicating an incoming call from calling party


102


.




In step


2204


, the soft switch site determines the type of call by performing initial digit analysis. Based upon the information in the signaling message, the soft switch site


104


analyzes the initial digit of the dialed number of the call and determines that it is a 1+ call.




In step


2206


, the soft switch site queries a customer profile database to retrieve the originating trigger plan associated with the calling customer. With a 1+ type of call, the logic within the soft switch knows to query the customer profile database within soft switch site


104


to retrieve the originating trigger plan for the calling party. The step


2206


query can be made using the calling party number. The customer profile lookup is performed using as the lookup key, the originating number, i.e., the number of calling party


102


, provided in the signaling message from signaling network


114


.




In step


2208


, the lookup returns subscription information. For example, the customer profile can require entry of an account code. In this example, the customer profile lookup can return an indication that the customer, i.e., calling party


102


, has subscribed to an account code verification feature. A class of service restriction can also be enforced, but this will not be known until account code verification identifies an associated account code.




In step


2210


, soft switch site


104


instructs gateway site


108


to collect account codes. Using the information in the customer profile, soft switch site


104


can use the IPDC protocol to instruct gateway site


108


to collect a specified number of digits from calling party


102


.




In step


2212


, soft switch site


104


determines how to process received digits. Assuming gateway site


108


collects the correct number of digits, soft switch site


104


can use the customer profile to determine how to process the received digits. For account code verification, the customer profile can specify whether the account code needs to be validated.




In step


2214


, soft switch site


104


verifies the validity of the received digits. If the account code settings in the customer profile specify that the account code must be verified and forced to meet certain criteria, soft switch site


104


performs two functions. Because “verify” was specified, soft switch site


104


queries a database to verify that the collected digits meet such criteria, i.e., that the collected digits are valid. Because “forced” was specified, soft switch site


104


also forces the calling customer to re-enter the digits if the digits were not valid.




In step


2216


, verification can result in the need to enforce a restriction, such as a class of service (COS) restriction (COSR). In this example, soft switch site


104


can verify that the code is valid, but that it requires, for example, that an intrastate COSR should be enforced. This means that the call is required to be an intrastate call to be valid. The class of service restriction logic can be performed within soft switch site


104


using, for example, pre-loaded local access and transport areas (LATAs) and state tables.




If project account codes (PACs) are not used, class of service (COS) restrictions can be applied based on originating ANI or ingress trunk group.




In step


2218


, soft switch


104


allows the call to proceed if the class of service requested is permitted. For example, if the LATA and state tables show that the LATAs of originating party (i.e., calling party


102


) and terminating party (i.e. called party


120


), must be, and are, in the same state, then the call can be allowed to proceed.




In step


2220


, soft switch site


104


completes customer service processing and prepares to terminate the call. At this point, soft switch site


104


has finished executing all customer service logic and has a 10-digit dialed number that must be terminated.




In step


2222


, soft switch site


104


can select a route termination based on the dialed number (i.e., the number of called party


120


dialed by calling party


102


) using least cost routing. This route termination can involve termination off data network


112


or off onto another data network. Soft switch site


104


can then communicate with soft switch site


106


to allocate a terminating circuit in gateway site


110


for this call.




In step


2224


, soft switch site


104


can indicate connections to be made to complete the call. Soft switch site


104


or soft switch site


106


can return a termination that indicates the connections that must be made to connect the call.




In step


2226


, soft switch sites


104


,


106


instruct the gateway sites to make connections to set up the call. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can send messages through data network


112


(e.g. using IPDC protocol commands) to gateway sites


108


,


110


; to instruct the gateway sites to make the necessary connections for setting up the call origination from calling party


102


, the call termination to called party


120


, and the connection between origination and termination.




In step


2228


, soft switch sites


104


,


106


generate and send network events to a repository. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


can generate and send network events to network event component


116


that are used, for example, in detecting and preventing fraud, and in performing billing.




In step


2230


, network management component


118


monitors the telecommunications network


100


. All network elements create network management events such as SNMP protocol alerts or events. Network management component


118


can monitor SNMP events to enable management of network resources.




The intermediate level description and specific implementation example embodiments sections, below, will describe additional details of operation of the invention. For example, how soft switch site


104


performs initial digit analysis to identify the type of call and how to process the call will be discussed further. The sections also provide details regarding how soft switch sites


104


,


106


interact with the other components of the voice network architecture.




II. Intermediate Level Description




This section provides an intermediate level description of the VOIP network architecture according to the present invention. A structural implementation of the VOIP network architecture is described at an intermediate level. Also, a functional implementation for this structure is described at an intermediate level. This structural implementation is described herein for illustrative purposes, and is not limiting. In particular, the process described in this section can be achieved using any number of structural implementations, one of which is described in this section. The details of such structural implementations will be apparent to persons skilled in the relevant arts based on the teachings contained herein.




A. Structural Description





FIG. 2A

is a block diagram further illustrating the components of VOIP architecture


100


at an intermediate level of detail.

FIG. 2A

depicts telecommunications system


200


. Telecommunications system


200


includes soft switch site


104


, gateway sites


108


,


110


, data network


112


, signaling network


114


, network event component


116


, provisioning component


117


and network management component


118


. Included in

FIG. 2A

are calling parties


102


,


122


and called parties


120


,


124


.




Soft switch site


104


includes soft switch


204


, SS7 gateways


208


,


210


, service control point (SCP)


214


, configuration server/configuration database (CDB)


206


, route server


212


, signal transfer points (STPs)


250


,


252


, and regional network event collection point (RNECP)


224


. Table 1 below describes the functions of these network elements in detail.













TABLE 1









Soft switch component




Description











soft switch (SS)




Soft switches are call control







components responsible for







processing of signaling messages,







execution of call logic and control







of gateway site access devices.






SS7 gateways (SS7 GW)




SS7 gateways provide an interface







between the SS7 signaling network







and the soft switch.






service switching




Service switching points are the






points (SSP)




portions of backbone switches







providing SS7 functions. For







example, any switch in the PSTN is







an SSP if it provides SS7 functions.







A soft switch is an SSP.






signal transfer




Signal transfer points route signaling






point (STP)




messages from originating service







switching points (SSPs) to







destination SSPs.






service control




Service control points provide






point (SCP)




number translations for toll free







services and validation of project







account codes for PAC services.






configuration server/




Configuration servers are servers






configuration




managing customer profiles, voice






database (CDB)




network topologies and







configuration data. The







configuration database is used for







storage and retrieval of such data.






route server (RS)




Route servers are responsible for







selection of least cost routes through







the network and allocation of







network ports.






regional network event




Route servers are responsible for






collection point




selection of least cost routes through the






(RNECP)




network and allocation of network ports.







regional network event collection points







are points in the network that collect call







event data.














Gateway site


108


includes trunking gateway (TG)


232


, access gateway (AG)


238


, network access server (NAS)


228


, digital cross-connect system (DACS)


242


and announcement server (ANS)


246


. TG


232


, AG


238


, and NAS


228


are collectively known as access server


254


. Similarly, gateway site


110


includes TG


234


, AG


240


, NAS


230


, DACS


244


and ANS


248


. TG


234


, AG


240


, and NAS


230


are collectively known as access server


256


. Gateway sites


108


,


110


provide trunk, private line and dedicated access line connectivity to the PSTN. Table 2 below describes the functions of these network elements in detail.













TABLE 2









Gateway site component




Description











trunking gateway (TG)




A trunking gateway provides full-







duplex PSTN to IP conversion for







co-carrier and feature group D (FG-







D) trunks.






access gateway (AG)




An access gateway provides full-







duplex PSTN to IP conversion for







ISDN-PRI and T1 digital dedicated







access lines (DALs).






network access




A network access server provides






server (NAS)




modem access to an IP network.






digital access and




A digital access and cross-connect






cross-connect




system is a digital switching system






system (DACS)




used for the routing and switching of







T-1 lines and DS-0 circuits of lines,







among multiple T-1 ports.






announcement server (ANS)




An announcement server provides a







network with PSTN terminating







announcements.














Data network


112


provides the network bandwidth over which calls can be connected through the telecommunications system. Data network


112


can be, for example, a packet switched data network including network routers for routing traffic through the network.




Signaling network


114


includes signal transfer points (STPs)


216


,


218


and signaling control points (SCPs) associated with each network node. Table 3 below describes the functions of these network elements in detail.













TABLE 3









Signaling network component




Description











signal transfer




Signal transfer points route signaling






points (STPs)




messages from originating service







switching points (SSPs) to







destination SSPs.






service control




Service control point provide






point (SCP)




number translations for Toll Free







services and validation of project







account codes (PAC) for PAC







services.






service switching




Service switching points are the






point (SSPs)




portions of backbone switches







providing SS7 functions. For







example, any switch in the PSTN is







an SSP if it provides SS7 functions.







A soft switch is an SSP.














Network management component


118


includes the means to manage a network. Network management component


118


gathers events and alarms related to network events. For example, event logs can be centrally managed from a network operations center (NOC). Alerts and events can be communicated to the NOC via the simple network management protocol (SNMP)). Table 4 below describes the functions of these network elements in detail.













TABLE 4









Network







management component




Description











network operations




Network operations center is a






center (NOC)




centralized location for gathering







network management events







and for managing various network







elements via the SNMP protocol.






simple network management




Simple network management






protocol (SNMP)




protocol provides site filtering







of element alarms and messages







before forwarding them to







the NOC.














Network event component


116


includes master network event database (MNEDB)


226


. Table 5A below describes the functions of this network element in detail.













TABLE 5A









Network event component




Description











master network event




Master network event database is a






database (MNEDB)




centralized server/database that







collects call event records from







regional network event collection







points (RNECPs). It serves as a







depository for the event records.














Provisioning component


117


includes data distributor (DD)


222


. Table 5B below describes the functions of this network element in detail.













TABLE 5B









Provisioning component




Description











data distributor (DD)




The data distributor distributes







service requests and data from







upstream Operational Support







Systems (OSS) to network elements.







It maintains synchronization of







redundant network resources.














B. Operational Description




The following operational flow describes an exemplary intermediate level call scenario intended to demonstrate at an intermediate architectural level how call processing is handled. The operational flow of the present invention is not to be viewed as limited to this exemplary illustration.





FIG. 2B

depicts an exemplary call flow


258


.

FIG. 2B

illustrates interaction between a trunking gateway, a soft switch, a configuration server and a route server in order to connect a call through telecommunications network


200


.

FIG. 2B

details a call flow from TG


232


of gateway site


108


, controlled by soft switch site


104


, to TG


234


of gateway site


110


, controlled by soft switch site


106


. (Soft switch site


106


is illustrated in

FIGS. 1 and 3

.) Soft switch site


106


, including soft switch


304


, route server


314


, and configuration server


312


, is further described below in the Specific Example Embodiments section, with reference to FIG.


3


.




Included in call flow


258


is a description of how soft switch


204


can process a 1+ long distance call that uses project account codes (PACs) with class of service (COS) restrictions. Call flow


258


also assumes that the origination and termination for the call uses SS7 signaling, i.e., that the call comes into network


200


via trunks from carrier facilities


126


,


130


, to trunking gateways


232


,


234


.




Exemplary call flow


258


begins with step


259


. In step


259


, soft switch


204


receives an incoming IAM signaling message from an SS7 GW


208


, signaling an incoming call from calling party


102


on carrier facility


126


of a co-carrier.




In step


260


, soft switch


204


sends IPDC commands to trunking gateway


232


to set up a connection (e.g. a DS


0


or DS


1


circuit) between carrier facility


126


and TG


232


described in the received IAM signaling message. In step


262


, trunking gateway


232


sends an acknowledgement message to soft switch


204


.




Based upon the information in the IAM message, soft switch


204


performs initial digit analysis on the dialed number, i.e., the number of called party


120


, and determines that the incoming call is a 1+ call.




In step


263


, application program logic within soft switch


204


determines that, with this type of call, i.e., a 1+ call, soft switch


204


should query a customer profile database within configuration server


206


, to retrieve the originating customer trigger plan


290


for calling party


102


.




The customer profile lookup is performed in configuration server


206


using the originating automatic number identification (ANI) of calling party


102


as the lookup key.




In step


264


the customer profile lookup returns to soft switch


204


an indication that the calling party


102


has subscribed to project account codes (PAC). Examples of PACs include billing codes. They provide a mechanism for a network customer, such as a law firm, to keep an accounting of which of their clients to bill. Example call flow


258


will also perform a class of service (COS) restriction, but this will not be known by soft switch


204


until account code verification identifies an associated account code requiring the COS restriction. Alternatively, the customer profile information can reside in route server


212


, enabling route server


212


to perform the functions of configuration server


206


, in addition to its own functions.




In step


267


, using the information in the customer profile (i.e., customer trigger plans


290


) of configuration server


206


, soft switch


204


uses the IPDC protocol to instruct trunking gateway


232


to collect the specified number of digits, representing the project account code, from calling party


102


.




In step


268


, the digits are sent from trunking gateway


232


to soft switch


204


. Assuming that trunking gateway


232


collected the correct number of digits, soft switch


204


uses the customer profile of configuration server


206


to determine how to process the received digits. For project account codes (PACs), the customer profile in configuration server


206


specifies whether the project account code needs to be validated.




If the project account code settings in the customer profile of configuration server


206


specify that the project account code is “verified and forced,” then soft switch


204


, in step


265


, can query SCP


214


with the collected digits to verify that they are valid. Table 129 below provides alternative PAC settings.




In step


266


, SCP


214


returns an indication that the project account code is valid, and it requires that an intrastate class of service (COS) restriction should be enforced. The class of service (COS) restriction logic can be performed within soft switch


204


, using pre-loaded LATA and state tables from configuration server


206


.




If a PAC is not used, the COS restriction can be applied based on ANI or ingress trunk group.




If the LATA and state tables from configuration server


206


show that the originating LATA (i.e., the LATA of calling party


102


) and the terminating LATA (i.e., the LATA of called party


120


) are in the same state, then the call is allowed to proceed.




At this point, soft switch


204


has finished executing all customer service logic and has a 10-digit DDD number (i.e., the phone number of called party


120


), that must be terminated.




In step


269


, soft switch


204


queries route server


212


to receive a call route and to allocate circuits to connect the call. Route server


212


is responsible for using the DDD number to select a least cost route through data network


112


, and allocating a terminating circuit for this call.




Additional information on how soft switch


204


interacts with route server


212


and terminating soft switch


304


is described in the Specific Implementation Example Embodiments Section below, in the section entitled Route Server.




In step


270


, route server


212


returns a route that indicates the connections that soft switch


204


must make to connect the call.




In step


274


, soft switch


204


communicates with soft switch


304


to allocate ports in trunking gateway


234


of gateway site


110


, for termination of the call. Soft switch


304


is located in a central soft switch site


106


. In step


276


, soft switch


304


queries port status


298


of route server


314


to identify available ports in trunking gateway


234


. In step


278


, route server


314


returns an available port to soft switch


304


. In steps


280


and


282


, soft switch


304


communicates with trunking gateway


234


to allocate a port for termination of the call to called party


120


.




In step


284


, soft switch


304


communicates with soft switch


204


to indicate terminating ports have been allocated.




In steps


286


and


288


, soft switch


204


communicates with trunking gateway


232


in order to notify trunking gateway


232


to set up an RTP session (i.e. an RTP over UDP over IP session) with trunking gateway


234


and to permit call traffic to be passed over data network


112


.




The Specific Implementation Example Embodiments Section, in the next section, describes additional information about, for example, how soft switch


204


performs initial digit analysis to identify the type of call, and how to process the call. The next section also describes how soft switch


204


interacts with other components of the voice network architecture


200


in transmitting the call.




III. Specific Implementation Example Embodiments




Various embodiments related to structures, and operations between these structures described above are presented in this section (and its subsections). These embodiments are described herein for purposes of illustration, and not limitation. The invention is not limited to these embodiments. Alternate embodiments (including equivalents, extensions, variations, deviations, etc., of the embodiments described herein) will be apparent to persons skilled in the relevant arts based on the teachings contained herein. The invention is intended and adapted to include such alternate embodiments.




Specifically, this section provides a detailed description of the VOIP network architecture according to the present invention. A structural implementation of the (VOIP) network architecture is described at a low-level. Also, a functional implementation for this structure is described at a low-level.




A. Structural Description




A more detailed structural description of telecommunications network


200


will now be described.




1. Soft Switch Site





FIG. 3

is a block diagram illustrating a more detailed implementation of telecommunications network


200


. Specifically,

FIG. 3

illustrates telecommunications network


300


containing three geographically diverse soft switch sites. These soft switch sites include western soft switch site


104


, central soft switch


106


, and eastern soft switch


302


.




Telecommunications network


300


also includes a plurality of gateway sites that may be collocated or geographically diverse. These gateway sites include gateway sites


108




a


,


108




b


,


110




a


and


110




b.






Data network


112


can route both signaling and transport traffic between the regional soft switch sites and regional gateway sites. For example, data network


112


can be used to route traffic between western soft switch site


104


and gateway site


110




a


. Signaling and transport traffic can also be segregated and sent over separate data networks. As those skilled in the art will recognize, data network


112


can be used to establish a data or voice connection among any of the aforementioned gateway sites


108




a


,


108




b


,


110




a


and


110




b


under the control of any of the aforementioned soft switch sites


104


,


106


and


302


.




Western soft switch site


104


includes soft switch


204




a


, soft switch


204




b


, and soft switch


204




c


. Soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


can be collocated or geographically diverse. Soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


provide the features of redundancy and high availability.




Failover mechanisms are enabled via this architecture, since the soft switches can act as one big switch. Soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


can intercommunicate via the inter soft switch communication protocol, permitting access servers to reconnect from one soft switch to another.




Western soft switch site


104


includes SS7 gateway (GW)


208


, configuration server/configuration database (CS/CDB)


206




a


and route server (RS)


212




a


. To provide high availability and redundancy, western soft switch site


104


includes a redundant SS7 GW, a redundant CS/CDB and a redundant RS. Specifically, western soft switch site


104


includes SS7 GW


210


, CS/CDB


206




b


and RS


212




b.






Soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


are connected to SS7 GWs


208


,


210


, CS/CDBs


206




a


,


206




b


and RSs


212




a


,


212




b


via redundant ethernet switches (ESs)


332


,


334


having multiple redundant paths. This architecture enables centralization of SS7 interconnection to gain economies of scale from use of a lesser number (than conventionally required) of links to signaling network


114


, to be shared by many access servers in gateway sites. ESs


332


,


334


also provide connectivity to routers (Rs)


320


,


322


. Routers


320


,


322


respectively provide redundant connectivity between redundant ESs


332


,


334


and data network


112


. As noted, included in telecommunications network


300


are central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


. Central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


respectively include identical configurations to the configuration of western soft switch site


104


. Central soft switch site


106


includes SS7 GWs


308


, CS/CDBs


312


, RSs


314


, soft switches


304




a


,


304




b


,


304




c


, ESs


336


,


338


, and Rs


324


,


326


. Similarly, eastern soft switch site


302


includes SS7 GWs


310


, CS/CDBs


316


, RSs


318


, soft switches


306




a


,


306




b


,


306




c


, ESs


340


,


342


, and Rs


328


and


330


.




Gateway site


108




a


includes TG


232




a


, NAS


228




a


, AG


238




a


and DACS


242




a


. Gateway sites


108




b


,


110




a


and


110




b


have similar configurations to gateway site


108




a


. Gateway site


108




b


includes TG


232




b


, NAS


228




b


, AG


238




b


and DACS


242




b


. Gateway site


110




a


includes TG


234




a


, NAS


230




a


, AG


240




a


and DACS


244




a


. Finally, gateway site


110




b


includes TG


234




b


, NAS


230




b


, AG


240




b


, and DACS


244




b


. The details of gateway site


108




a


,


108




b


,


110




a


and


110




b


will be further described below with reference to FIG.


10


A.




a. Soft Switch




Referring back to

FIG. 2A

, soft switch


204


provides the call processing function for telecommunications network


200


. Call processing refers to the handling of voice and data calls. There are a number of important call processing functions handled by soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


processes signaling messages used for call setup and call tear down. These signaling messages can be processed by in-band or out-of-band signaling. For an example of out-of-band signaling, SS7 signaling messages can be transmitted between signaling network


114


and soft switch


204


. (Soft switch


204


refers to soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


.)




Another call processing function performed by soft switch


204


is preliminary digit analysis. Preliminary digit analysis is performed to determine the type of call arriving at soft switch


204


. Examples of calls include toll free calls, 1+ calls, 0+ calls, 011+ calls, and other calls recognized by those skilled in the art.




One important feature of soft switch


204


is communicating with CS/CDB


206


to retrieve important customer information. Specifically, soft switch


204


queries CS/CDB


206


to retrieve a customer trigger plan. The customer trigger plan effectively identifies the service logic to be executed for a given customer. This trigger plan is similar to a decision tree pertaining to how a call is to be implemented. Subsequently, soft switch


204


executes the customer trigger plan. This includes the processing of special service calls requiring external call processing, i.e., call processing that is external to the functions of telecommunications network


200


.




Another important function soft switch


204


is communicating with RS


212


to provide network routing information for a customer call. For example, soft switch


204


can query RS


212


to retrieve the route having the least cost from an off-network calling party


102


(homed to gateway site


108


) to an off-network called party


120


(homed to gateway site


110


) over data network


112


. Upon finding the least cost route, soft switch


204


allocates ports on TGs


232


,


234


. As described in detail below, soft switch


204


can also be used to identify the least cost route termination and allocate gateway ports over AGs


238


,


240


between an on-network calling party


122


(homed to gateway site


108


) and an on-network called party


124


(homed to gateway site


110


).




Soft switch


204


also communicates with AGs


238


,


240


, TGs


232


,


234


, and NASs


228


,


230


over data network


112


. Although AGs


238


,


240


, TGs


232


,


234


and NASs


228


,


230


can communicate with a plurality of soft switches, as illustrated in

FIG. 3

, these network nodes (referred to collectively as access servers


254




a


,


254




b


,


256




a


, and


256




b


) are respectively assigned to a primary soft switch. This primary soft switch, e.g., soft switch


204


, assumes a primary responsibility or control of the access servers. In addition, the access servers can be as respectively assigned to secondary switches, which control the access servers in the event that the primary soft switch is unavailable.




Referring back to

FIG. 3

, western soft switch site


104


, central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


are geographically diverse. For example, western soft switch site


104


can be a soft switch site located in San Diego, Calif. Central soft switch site


106


can be a soft switch site located in Denver, Colo. Eastern soft switch site


302


can be a soft switch site located in Boston, Mass.




It is permissible that additional network nodes are provided at any of soft switch sites


104


,


106


and


302


. For example, additional elements, including, e.g., SS7 GW


208


, CDB


206




a


, and RS


212




a


can be collocated at western soft switch site


104


. Examples of other supporting elements of western soft switch site


104


are an announcement server (ANS), a network event collection point (NECP), an SCP, and on-network STPs. Referring to the more detailed implementation of

FIG. 2A

, telecommunications network


200


includes ANSs


246


,


248


, NECP


224


, SCP


214


, and STPs


250


,


252


.




(1) Soft Switch Interfaces





FIG. 4A

is a block diagram illustrating the interfaces between soft switch


204


and the remaining components of telecommunications network


200


. The soft switch interfaces of

FIG. 4A

are provided for exemplary purposes only, and are not to be considered limiting. Soft switch


204


interfaces with SS7 GWs


208


,


210


via soft switch-to-SS7 GW interface


402


. One example of interface


402


is an SS7 integrated services digital network (ISDN) user part (ISUP) over a transmission control protocol/internet protocol (TCP/IP). Soft switch


204


interfaces with configuration server


206


over interface


406


. In an example embodiment, interface


406


is a TCP/IP connection.




Soft switch


204


interfaces with RNECP


224


over interface


410


. In an example embodiment, interface


410


is a TCP/IP connection.




Soft switch


204


interfaces with route server


212


over interface


408


. In an example embodiment, interface


408


is a TCP/IP connection.




Soft switch


204


interfaces with SCP


214


over interface


404


. In an example embodiment, interface


404


is a TCP/IP connection.




Soft switch


204


interfaces with announcement servers


246


,


248


over interface


416


. In an example embodiment, interface


416


can include the IPDC protocol used over a TCP/IP connection.




Soft switch


204


interfaces with TGs


232


,


234


over interface


412


. In an example embodiment, interface


412


can include the IPDC protocol used over a TCP/IP connection.




Soft switch


204


interfaces with AGs


238


,


240


over interface


414


. In an example embodiment, interface


414


can include the IPDC protocol used over a TCP/IP connection.




In one embodiment, soft switch


204


is an application software program running on a computer. The structure of this exemplary soft switch is an object oriented programming model discussed below with reference to

FIGS. 4B-4E

.




Another interface to soft switch


204


(not shown) is a man-machine interface or maintenance and monitoring interface (MMI). MMI can be used as a direct controller for management and machine actions. It should be noted that this is not intended to be the main control interface, but is rather available to accommodate the need for on-site emergency maintenance activities.




Yet another interface permits communication between soft switches


204


,


304


. A soft switch-to-soft switch interface will be described further with reference to

FIG. 2B. A

soft switch


204


-to-soft switch


304


interface permits communication between the soft switches


204


,


304


that control the originating call-half and terminating call-half of call flow


258


. The soft switch


204


-to-soft switch


304


interface allows soft switches


204


,


304


to set up, tear down and manage voice and data calls. Soft switch


204


to soft switch


304


interface can allow for a plurality of inbound and outbound signaling types including, for example, SS7, ISDN, and in-band E&M signaling.




In telephony, E&M is a trunking arrangement generally used for two-way (i.e., either side may initiate actions) switch-to-switch or switch-to-network connections. E&M signaling refers to an arrangement that uses separate leads, called respectively the “E” lead and the “M” lead, for signaling and supervisory purposes. The near-end signals the far-end by applying −48 volts DC (“VDC”) to the “M” lead, which results in a ground being applied to the far end's “E” lead. When −48 VDC is applied to the far-end “M” lead, the near-end “E” lead is grounded. “E” lead originally stood for “ear,” i.e., when the near-end “E” lead was grounded, the far end was calling and “wanted your ear.” “M” originally stood for “mouth,” because when the near-end wanted to call (i.e., to speak to) the far end, −48 VDC was applied to that lead.




When a PBX wishes to connect to another PBX directly, or to a remote PBX, or to an extension telephone over a leased voice-grade line (e.g., a channel on a T-1), the PBX can use a special line interface. This special line interface is quite different from that which the PBX uses to interface to directly-attached phones. The basic reason for the difference between a normal extension interface and a long distance interface is that the respective signaling requirements differ. This is true even if the voice signal parameter, such as level and two-wire, four-wire remain the same. When dealing with tie lines or trunks, it is costly, inefficient, and too slow for a PBX to do what an extension telephone would do, i.e., to go off hook, wait for a dial tone, dial, wait for ringing to stop, etc. The E&M tie trunk interface device is a form of standard that exists in the PBX, T-1 multiplexer, voice-digitizer, telephone company world. E&M signaling can take on a plurality of forms. At least five different versions exist. E&M signaling is the most common interface signaling method used to interconnect switching signaling systems with transmission signaling systems.




The sample configuration depicted in

FIG. 2B

, can use a soft switch


204


-to-soft switch


304


protocol. In

FIG. 2B

, the access servers depicted are trunking gateways


232


,


234


. TGs


232


,


234


are connected to the switch circuit network (SCN), i.e., signaling network


114


, via SS7 trunks, ISDN trunks, and in-band trunks. The originating soft switch


204


can receive a call over any of these trunks. The signaling information from these SS7, ISDN, and in-band trunks is processed by soft switch


204


to establish the originating call-half The signaling information processed by soft switch


204


, can be used to determine the identity of terminating soft switch


304


. The identity of terminating soft switch


304


is required to complete the call.




Originating soft switch


204


can then communicate the necessary information to complete the call, via an inter-soft switch communication (ISSC) protocol. Terminating soft switch


304


can be required to be able to establish the terminating call-half on any of the supported trunk types. The ISSC protocol can use a message set that is structured similarly to the IPDC protocol message set. The messages can contain a header followed by a number of tag-length-value attributes. The incoming signaling message for the call being placed, can be carried in a general data block of one of the attribute value pairs (AVPs). The other AVPs, can contain additional information necessary to establish a voice-over-IP connection between the originating and terminating ends of the call.




b. SS7 Gateway




SS7 gateways (GWs)


208


,


210


will now be described further with reference to FIG.


2


A and FIG.


5


A. In

FIG. 2A

, SS7 GWs


208


,


210


receive signaling messages from signaling network


114


and communicate these messages to soft switch


204


. Specifically, for SS7 signaled trunks, SS7 GWs


208


,


210


can receive SS7 ISUP messages and transfer them to soft switch


204


. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


can also receive signaling messages from soft switch


204


and send SS7 ISUP messages out to signaling network


114


.




(1) SS7 Gateway Example Embodiment




In an example embodiment, SS7 GWs


208


,


210


can be deployed in a two (2) computing element (CE) cluster


207


, depicted in FIG.


5


A. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


, in two-CE-cluster


207


can fully load-share. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


can intercommunicate as represented by connection


530


to balance their loads. Load-sharing results in a completely fault resilient hardware and software system with no single point of failure. Each SS7 GW


208


,


210


can have, for example, six two-port cards for a total of twelve links to signaling network


114


.




In an example embodiment, SS7 GWs


208


,


210


are application programs running on a computer system. An exemplary application program providing SS7 GW


208


,


210


functionality is OMNI SIGNALWARE (OMNI), available from DGM&S, of Mount Laurel, N.J. OMNI is a telecommunications middleware product that runs on a UNIX operating system. An exemplary operating system is the SUN UNIX, available from SUN Microsystems, Inc. of Palo Alto, Calif. The core of OMNI resides logically below the service applications, providing a middleware layer upon which telecommunications applications can be efficiently deployed. Since the operating system is not encapsulated, service applications have direct access to the entire operating environment. Because of OMNI's unique SIGNALWARE architecture, OMNI has the ability to simultaneously support variants of SS7 signaling technology (ITU-T, ANSI, China and Japan).




The SIGNALWARE architecture core is composed of the Message Transfer Part (MTP) Layer 2 and Layer 3, and Service Connection Control Part (SCCP). These core protocols are supplemented with a higher layer of protocols to meet the needs of a target application or service. OMNI supports multiple protocol stacks simultaneously, each potentially with the point code format and protocol support of one of the major SS7 variants.




OMNI SIGNALWARE Application Programming Interfaces (APIs) are found on the higher layers of the SS7 protocol stack. OMNI APIs include: ISDN User Part (ISUP), Telephony User Part (TUP), Transaction Capabilities Application Part (TCAP), Global System for Mobile Communications Mobile Application Part (GSM MAP), EIA/TIA Interim Standard 41 (IS-41 MAP), Advanced Intelligent Network (AIN), and Intelligent Network Application Part (INAP).




(2) SS7 Gateway-to-Soft Switch Interface





FIG. 5A

depicts SS7 gateway to soft switch distribution


500


. Soft switches receive signaling messages from signaling gateways. Specifically, for SS7 signaled trunks, SS7 GWs


208


,


210


send and receive signals from signaling network


114


. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


communicate with soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


, via redundant connections from the soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


to distributions


508


,


510


, of SS7 GWs


208


,


210


respectively. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


together comprise a CE cluster


207


.




Based upon an SS7 network design, a pair of SS7 gateways receive all signaling traffic for the trunking gateway (TG) circuits serviced by the soft switches at a single soft switch site. Specifically, a pair of SS7 GWs


208


,


210


receive all signaling traffic for circuits serviced by soft switch site


104


. Signals serviced by soft switch site


104


enter telecommunications network


200


from gateway sites


108


,


502


,


110


.




In an example embodiment,


96


circuits are serviced by each gateway site


108


,


502


,


110


. Gateway site


108


includes TGs


232




a


,


232




b


. Gateway site


110


includes TGs


234




a


,


234




b


. Gateway site


502


includes TGs


504


,


506


.




A circuit is identified by a circuit identification code (CIC). TG


232




a


includes line card access to a plurality of circuits including CICs


1


-


48




512


of gateway site


108


. TG


232




b


provides line card access to CICs


49


-


96




514


of gateway site


108


. TG


504


provides line card access to CICs


1


-


48




516


. TG


506


provides line card access to CICs


49


-


96




518


of gateway site


502


. TG


234




a


provides line card access to CICs


1


-


48




520


. TG


234




b


provides line card access to CICs


49


-


96




522


of gateway site


110


. Thus, CICs


1


-


48




512


,


516


,


520


, and CICs


49


-


96




514


,


518


,


522


are the trunking gateway circuits serviced by soft switch site


104


.




In an example embodiment, soft switches are partitioned such that any single soft switch will only service a subset of circuits serviced at a given soft switch site. For example, soft switch


204




a


can service CICs


1


-


48




512


,


516


, while soft switch


204




b


services CICs


49


-


96




514


and CICs


1


-


48




520


, and soft switch


204




c


services CICs


49


-


96




518


,


522


. In order to assure that all signaling messages for a particular call get to the correct one of soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


, it is necessary to partition SS7 signaling across the available soft switches based upon the circuits that each soft switch services.




It is much more efficient to run SS7 links to soft switches than to each individual access server (compare to the conventional approach requiring an SS7 link to each SSP). Centralization of SS7 signaling traffic interconnection enables benefits from economies of scale, by requiring less SS7 interconnection links.




An exemplary technique for distributing circuits across soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


is based upon the originating point code (OPC), destination point code (DPC), and CIC. OPC represents the originating point code for a circuit group, i.e., the point code of a local exchange carrier (LEC) switch, or signal point(SP). For example, the LEC providing CICs


1


-


48




512


, and CICs


49


-


96




514


can have an OPC


524


of value


777


. The LEC providing CICs


1


-


48




516


, and CICs


49


-


96




518


can have an OPC


526


of value


888


. The LEC switch providing CICs


1


-


48




520


, and CICs


49


-


96




522


has an OPC


528


of value


999


. Similarly, DPC represents the destination point code for a circuit group, i.e., the point code of soft switch site


104


. Soft switch site


104


has a point code


529


of value


111


, and an alternate point code


531


of value


444


. Soft switch site


104


can act as one big switch using a flat network design of the present invention. This flat network design simplifies routing of calls.




To support distribution of circuits across soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


, SS7 GWs


208


,


210


can include a lookup table that allows each signaling message to be routed to the correct soft switch


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


. The lookup table can route signaling messages to the correct soft switch


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


based upon the OPC, DPC, and CIC fields. This lookup table is built on SS7 GWs


208


,


210


based upon registration messages coming from soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


.




In an example embodiment, each time a TG boots up, the TG finds a soft switch to service its circuits. For example, when TG


232




a


is powered up, TG


232




a


must find a soft switch


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


to service its circuits, i.e. CICs


1


-


48




512


. In an exemplary technique, TG


232




a


sends registration messages to soft switch


204




a


to register circuits CICs


1


-


48




512


. Upon receipt of these registration messages the soft switch


204




a


registers these circuits with SS7 GWs


208


,


210


, at soft switch site


104


. The circuit registration messages sent to the SS7 gateways are used to build the type of table shown in Table 6.















TABLE 6











OPC, DPC, CIC








registration request




Value













Message Type




SS7 gateway circuit registration







OPC




Originating point code for the circuit








group. Equals the LEC point code.







Primary DPC




Primary destination point code for








the circuit group. Equals the Soft








Switch site point code.







Alias DPC




Alias DPC for the Soft Switch site







Start CIC




Starting Circuit Identification Code








for the circuit group







End CIC




Ending Circuit Identification Code








for the circuit group







Servicing Soft




Unique Identifier for the Soft







Switch ID




Switch that will service requests








for the OPC, DPC, CIC values







Servicing Soft




IP address for the Soft Switch







Switch IP address




that will service requests








for the OPC, DPC, CIC values







Servicing Soft




Port number that the Soft Switch







Switch IP port




is listening on for incoming








signaling messages.







Primary/Secondary/




The Soft Switch identifies itself as







Tertiary




the primary, secondary or tertiary







identification




contact for signaling messages








for the specified OPC, DPC and CIC.















The format of a registration message is shown in Table 7. Table 7 includes the mapping of circuits to soft switches.




The messages used by soft


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


to register their circuits with SS7 GWs


208


,


210


contain information for the OPC, DPC and circuit range, i.e., the CICs that are being registered. Each message also contains information about the soft switch that will be servicing the signaling messages for the circuits being registered.




The soft switch information includes an indication of whether this soft switch is identified as the primary servicing point for calls to these circuits,the secondary servicing point or the tertiary servicing point. The gateway uses this indicator in failure conditions, when it cannot contact the Soft Switch that is currently servicing a set of circuits.

















TABLE 7











OPC




DPC




CIC range




Soft Switch













777




111




 1-48




204a







777




111




49-96




204b







888




111




 1-48




204a







888




111




49-96




204c







999




111




 1-48




204b







999




111




49-96




204c
















FIG. 5A

Illustrates, and Table 7 represents in tabular form, the associations between circuit trunk groups of TGs


232




a


,


232




b


,


516


,


518


,


520


,


522


and soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


distribute incoming SS7 signaling messages to the soft switch


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


listed as associated with the particular circuit in the circuit to soft switch mapping lookup table, (i.e., Table 7). For example, when the LEC switch, or signaling point, associated with OPC 524 (having point code 777) sends a call to TG


232




b


over CICs


55


(of CICs


49


-


96




514


), an IAM message can be created and routed. The IAM includes the following information:




(1) OPC 777 (originating LEC has a point code 777),




(2) DPC 111 (soft switch site


104


, the “switch” that the LEC believes it is trunking to, has point code 111), and




(3) CIC


55


(the circuit selected by the LEC has circuit identifier code


55


).




The IAM message can then be routed by signaling network


114


(i.e., the SS7 network) to SS7 GWs


208


,


210


at soft switch site


104


, having point code 111. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


can perform a lookup to Table 7, to identify which of soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


is handling the particular circuit described in the IAM message. In the example above, the IAM message having OPC 524 of value 777, DPC of value 111 and CIC


55


can be routed to soft switch


204




b.






SS7 GWs


208


,


210


will now be discussed further with reference to FIG.


17


A.

FIG. 17A

depicts an exemplary signaling network environment


1700


.

FIG. 17A

includes signaling network


114


Specifically, signaling network


114


can be an SS7 national signaling network.

FIG. 17A

depicts three soft switch sites interfacing via a plurality of STPs to SS7 network


114


.





FIG. 17A

includes soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


. Western soft switch site


104


includes three soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


redundantly connected to routers


320


,


322


and SS7 GWs


208


,


210


via ethernet switches


332


,


334


. SS7 GW


208


and SS7 GW


210


communicate via a TCP/IP connection


1702


and serial link


1704


.




Similarly, central soft switch site


106


includes soft switches


304




a


,


304




b


,


304




c


redundantly connected to routers


324


,


326


and SS7 GWs


308




a


,


308




b


via ethernet switches


336


,


338


. SS7 GW


308




a


and SS7 GW


308




b


communicate via TCP/IP connection


1706


and serial link


1708


.




Finally, eastern soft switch site


302


includes soft switches


306




a


,


306




b


,


306




c


redundantly connected to routers


328


,


330


and SS7 GWs


310




a


,


310




b


via ethernet switches


340


,


342


. SS7 GW


310




a


and SS7 GW


310




b


communicate via TCP/IP connection


1710


and serial link


1712


.





FIG. 17A

also includes data network


112


connected to soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


via routers


320


,


322


, routers


324


,


326


and routers


328


,


330


, respectively. Data network


112


can carry data including control message information and call traffic information. Data network


112


can also carry in-band type signaling information and ISDN signaling information, via IPDC messages.




Out-of-band signaling, such as, e.g., SS7 signaling, information is communicated to (i.e. exchanged with) soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


via SS7 GWs


208


,


210


, SS7 GWs


308




a


,


308




b


, and SS7 GWs


310




a


,


310




b


from signaling network


114


.




SS7 signaling messages are transferred through signaling network


114


from STP to STP until arriving at a final destination. Specifically, signaling messages intended for soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


, are routed via packet switched SS7 signaling network


114


to STPs


216


,


218


which are part of the SS7 national signaling network


114


. STP services (i.e., STPs and A-F links) can be provided by an SS7 signaling services provider, such as, e.g., Transaction Network Services (TNS).




Table 19 defines SS7 signaling links. Some of the SS7 links used are as follows. STPs


216


,


218


are linked together by a C-link. STPs


216


,


218


are linked by redundant D-links


1730


to STPs


250




a


,


252




a


,


1722


,


1724


,


250




b


,


252




b


. STPs


216


,


218


can also be linked by redundant D-links


1730


to STPs


1718


,


1720


,


1714


,


1716


, though this is not shown.




STP pairs


250




a


,


252




a


are linked together by one or more C-links


1728


. Likewise, STP pairs


1722


,


1724


, STP pairs


250




b


,


252




b


, STP pairs


1718


,


1720


, and STP pairs


1714


,


1716


can be linked together by C-links.




STPs


1714


,


1716


,


250




a


,


252




a


,


1722


,


1724


,


250




b


,


252




b


,


1718


, and


1720


can be linked by one or more A-links


1726


to SS7 GWs


208


,


210


,


308




a


,


308




b


,


310




a


, and


310




b


. Thus, signaling messages from anywhere in signaling network


114


may be routed by STPs


216


,


218


through STPs


1714


,


1716


,


250




a


,


252




a


,


1722


,


1724


,


250




b


,


252




b


,


1718


,


1720


, to SS7 GWs


208


,


210


,


308




a


,


308




b


,


310




a


, and


310




b


of soft switch sites


104


,


106


, and


302


. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


,


308




a


,


308




b


,


310




a


, and


310




b


thus route messages through packet switched STPs to signaling network


114


.




SS7 GWs


208


,


210


,


308




a


,


308




b


,


310




a


, and


310




b


use a separate physical interface for all simple network management protocol (SNMP) messages and additional functions that may be defined. Exemplary functions that may be defined include provisioning, updating, and passing special alarms, and performance parameters to the SS7 GW from the network operation center (NOC) of network management component


118


.




c. Signal Transfer Points (STPs)




Signal transfer points (STPs)


216


,


218


are the packet switches of signaling network


114


. More specifically, STPs are the packet switches of the SS7 network. STPs


250


,


252


are the STPs interfacing with SS7 GWs


208


,


210


of soft switch site


104


. STPs


216


,


218


receive and route incoming signaling messages toward the proper destination.




STPs


250


,


252


also perform specialized routing functions. STPs are customarily deployed in pairs. While elements of a pair are not generally collocated, they work redundantly to perform the same logical function.




STPs have several interfaces. STP interfaces are now described, with reference to

FIGS. 17A and 17B

. The interfaces can be described in terms of the links used. Table 19 shows links used in SS7 architectures.




The first interface comprises one or more D-links


1730


from off-network STPs


250


,


252


(as shown in

FIG. 2A

) to on-network STPs


216


,


218


. D-links connect mated STPs at different hierarchical levels to one another. On-network STPs


216


,


218


, as well as STPs


1714


,


1716


,


1722


,


1724


,


1718


and


1720


are part of the national SS7 signaling network


114


. Additional D-links


1730


can connect STPs


216


,


218


to STPs


250




a


,


252




a


, STPs


1722


,


1724


, STPs


250




b


,


252




b


, and STPs


1718


and


1720


.




The second interface comprises C-links. C-links connect mated STPs together. An example are C-links


1728


between STP


250




a


and


252




a


. C-links


1728


enable STPs


250




a


,


252




a


to be linked in such a manner that they need not be co-located. Similarly, STPs


250




b


,


252




b


, STPs


1718


,


1720


, STPs


1722


,


1724


, STPs


1714


,


1716


, and STPs


216


,


218


can also be respectively linked via C-links.




The third interfaces to STPs comprise A-links and E-links. A-links connect STPs to SSPs and SCPs. E-links are special links that connect SSPs to remote STPs, and are used in the event that A-links to home STPs are congested. The entire soft switch site is viewed as an SSP to a signaling network. A-links or E-links can be used to connect any of STPs


1714


,


1716


,


250




a


,


252




a


,


1722


,


1724


,


250




b


,


252




b


,


1718


and


1720


respectively to soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


at SS7 GWs


208


,


210


,


308




a


,


308




b


,


310




a


and


310




b


. In an example embodiment, each of SS7 GWs


208


,


210


,


308




a


,


308




b


,


310




a


,


310




b


can have, for example, twelve (12) A-links


1726


distributed among STPs


250




a


,


252




a


,


250




b


,


252




b


and STPs


1714


,


1716


,


1722


,


1724


,


1718


,


1720


. By using the plurality of A-links, the soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


have a fully redundant, fully meshed, fault tolerant signaling architecture.




STPs


250




a


,


252




a


,


250




b


,


252




b


use a separate physical interface for all SNMP messages and additional functions that can be defined. Additional functions that can be defined include provisioning, updating, and passing special alarms and performance parameters to and from STPs


250




a


,


252




a


,


250




b


,


252




b


and network operation center (NOC) of network management component


118


.




In another embodiment of the invention, as illustrated in

FIG. 17B

, soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


have additional soft switches and SS7 GWs. Additional soft switches and SS7 GWs can be used, for example, for handling additional traffic and for testing of alternative vendor soft switches and SS7 GWs.





FIG. 17B

includes SS7 gateway to SS7 signaling network alternative embodiment


1740


.

FIG. 17B

includes signaling network


114


interfacing to western soft switch site


104


, central soft switch site


106


, and eastern soft switch site


302


. Signaling network


114


includes STPs


216


,


218


connected via multiple D-Links


1730


to STPs


250




a


,


252




a


,


250




b


,


252




b


. In an example embodiment STP


250




a


and STP


252




a


are connected together by C-Links


1728


. In an alternative embodiment, STPs


250




a


,


252




a


and STPs


250




b


,


252




b


can be linked by quad B-Links. B-links connect mated STP pairs to other mated STP pairs. STPs


250




a


,


252




a


,


250




b


,


252




b


are connected by multiple redundants A-Links


1726


to SS7 GWs in soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


.




Western soft switch site


104


includes SS7 GWs


208


,


210


, which can communicate via a TCP/IP connection and a serial link. SS7 GWs


208


,


210


are connected to soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


, and


204




c


. In addition, western soft switch site


104


includes soft switch


1742


and SS7 GW


1744


connected to STPs


250




a


and


252




a


. Also western soft switch site


104


includes soft switch


1746


and SS7 GW


1748


connected to STPs


250




a


,


252




a.






Central soft switch site


106


includes SS7 GWs


308




a


,


308


B which can communicate via a TCP/IP connection or a serial link. SS7 GWs


308




a


,


308




b


connect soft switches


304




a


,


304




b


and


304




c


to STPs


250




a


and


252




a


. Central soft switch site


106


also includes soft switch


1750


and SS7 GWs


1752


connected to STPs


250




a


,


252




a


. Central soft switch site


106


also includes soft switch


1754


connected to SS7 GW


1756


, which is connected to STPs


250




a


,


252




a


.




Eastern soft switch site


302


includes SS7 GWs


310




a


, SS7 GW


310




b


, which can communicate over TCP/IP and over a serial link. SS7 GWs


310




a


,


310




b


connect soft switches


306




a


,


306




b


and


306




c


to STPs


250




b


and


252




b


. Eastern soft switch site


302


also includes soft switch


1758


connected to SS7 GW


1760


, which is connected to STPs


250




b


,


252




b


. Eastern soft switch site


302


also includes soft switch


1762


, which is connected to SS7 GW


1764


which is in turn connected to STPs


250




b


,


252




b.






Alternative embodiment


1740


, by including additional soft switches and SS7 gateways, permits additional redundancy and enables testing of alternate devices for connection to signaling network


114


via STPs


250




a


,


252




a


,


250




b


,


252




b


,


216


and


218


.




(1) STP Example Embodiment




STPs


250


,


252


, in an example embodiment, can be a TEKELEC Network Switching Division's EAGLE STP. An EAGLE STP, available from TEKELEC of Calabasas, Calif., is a high speed packet switch designed to support SS7 signaling. STPs


250


,


252


can be equipped with a plurality of links. In an example embodiment, STPs


250


,


252


can support up to, for example, 84 links. For example, in a preferred embodiment, 14 links can be used initially, and additional links can be added in the future. In a preferred embodiment, several additional features can be added to STPs


250


,


252


.




(a) Global Title Translation




In a preferred embodiment, STPs


250


,


252


can have global title translation capability. Global title translation uses global title information. Global title information is information unrelated to signaling network address, which can be used to determine the appropriate destination of a message. Global title translation can support translations from, for example, one to twenty-one digits. For example, translations can be assigned to translation types from 0 to 225. In a preferred embodiment, STPs


250


,


252


can support up to, for example, 1,000 global title translation requests per second, per application service module (ASM).




(b) Gateway Screening Software




In a preferred embodiment, STPs


250


,


252


include a gateway screening software feature. EAGLE STP can support user definitions of up to 64 screen sets In this embodiment, each screen set can accommodate up to 2,000 condition statements (or rules) with the gateway screening software. Gateway screening can be performed on all in-bound messages from another network. Gateway screening can also be performed on all outgoing network management messages. Since gateway screening can occur on the link interface modules (LIMs) and the application service modules (ASMs), the deployment of the gateway screening feature does not impact link throughput capacity, and can contribute to less than 5 milliseconds increase to cross-STP delays.




(c) Local Number Portability (LNP)




In a preferred embodiment, local number portability (LNP) can be integrated into the EAGLE architecture of STPs


250


,


252


. An advantage of the integration of LNP functionality is that it eliminates the need for costly external LNP databases, and associated transmission equipment. In one embodiment, LNP portability can support, complete scalabilty in configurations ranging from 500,000 translation entries and up to more than several million translation entries for very large metropolitan serving areas (MSAs).




(d) STP to LAN Interface




In a preferred embodiment, the STP-to-LAN interface of the EAGLE architecture can allow the user to connect external data collection or processing systems directly to STPs


250


,


252


via a TCP/IP protocol. In this embodiment, the STP-to-LAN interface could be used to carry SS7 signaling over IP packets.




(e) ANSI to ITU Gateway




In a preferred embodiment, STPs


250


,


252


can include a feature referred to as the ANSI-ITU gateway feature. In a preferred embodiment, the ANSI-ITU feature of STPs


250


,


252


allows STPs


250


,


252


to interconnect three types of signaling networks, i.e., ITU international, ITU national and ANSI, by means of three different message signaling unit (MSU) protocols. In a preferred embodiment of STPs


250


,


252


, the ANSI-ITU feature can allow a smooth transition from an all-ANSI network to a combined ANSI-ITU network.




d. Services Control Points (SCPs)





FIG. 6A

depicts off-switch called processing abstraction diagram


600


showing communication mechanisms between soft switch and STPs.

FIG. 6A

includes at the gateway-facing layer, soft switch processing


604


which can use the IPDC protocol


602


, or alternatively, the Network Access Server (NAS) Messaging Interface (NMI) protocol to interface with access servers, or the messaging gateway control protocol (MGCP). IPDC protocol


602


provides a protocol for communications between soft switches and respectively TGs, AGs, NASs and ANSs. Soft switch processing


604


uses IPDC for gateway communication and uses off-switch call processing


606


to access SCPs


608


,


614


,


618


,


620


.




SS7 TCAP


608


is connected to SCP


610


an off-network SCP, via STP


250


. IP TCAP


614


is connected to SCP


612


. SCP


616


is connected to custom IP


618


. SCP


214


is an on-network SCP and is connected via INAP/IP


620


.





FIG. 6A

represents how some interfaces to soft switch


204


sit on top of a-a common interface used by soft switch


204


to handle off-switch call processing. SCPs and other devices, such as route servers, can use this common interface. For example, SCP


610


is an off-network or off-switch SCP, meaning that it is not within soft switch site


104


.




Off-switch call processing abstraction layer


606


is intended to be a flexible interface, similar to TCAP in function, that allows interaction between any type of SCP (or other call processing logic) and soft switch


204


. The abstraction layer is so designed that interfaces to a set of call processors supporting a specific function (e.g., 800 service), contain the same types of data, and can all map arguments to data elements supported by off-switch call processing abstraction layer


606


. The field values for messages supplied by off-switch call processing abstraction layer


606


are identified in this section (i.e., describing SCPs) and also in the section describing route servers below.




The SCPs can be off-switch call processing servers, which support intelligent services within the telecommunications network SCPs


610


,


612


, and


616


can support such services as, for example, account code verification and toll free/800 services, local number portability (LNP), carrier ID identification, and card services.




Other services and capabilities of SCPs


610


,


612


, and


616


include basic toll-free services, project account code (PAC) services, local number portability (LNP) services,


800


carrier ID services, calling name (CNAM) services, advanced toll-free/network automatic call distribution (ACD) services, customer premise toll-free routing services, one number (or follow-me) services, and SCP gateway for customer premises equipment (CPE) route selection services. These services are recognized by those skilled in the art.




Additional services and capabilities can include intelligent peripherals. Intelligent peripherals can include calling card, debit card, voicemail, unified messaging, conference calling, and operator services. These peripherals are recognized by those skilled in the art.





FIG. 6B

illustrates intelligent network architecture


622


.

FIG. 6B

includes gateway site


110


, communicating via data network


112


, to soft switch


204


. The communication can be performed by the H.323 protocol or the IPDC protocol. Soft switch


204


gains signaling information from signaling network


114


via STP


250


, through SS7 gateway


208


.




Gateway site


110


, in intelligent network architecture


622


, is connected to multiple off-network service providers. Off network service providers include local exchange carrier (LEC)


624


, inter-exchange (IXC) carrier


626


and operator services service bureau


628


. Thus calls coming in from LEC


624


or from IXC


626


into gateway site


110


, if identified as an operator call, may be routed to off-network operator services


628


.




Soft switch


204


does not dictate any particular SCP interface, but it is assumed that this interface will support the following types of interactions: (1) route request; (2) route response; (3) call gapping; and (4) connect to resource.




A route request is a message sent from soft switch


204


to an external SCP


610


. The route request is sent to request a translation service from SCP


610


, for example, to translate disclosed digits to a destination number.




A route response is a message sent from SCP


610


to soft switch


204


in response to a route request. The route response includes a sequence of prioritized destinations for the call. SCPs that perform routing can return a list of prioritized destinations. These destinations can be, for example, any combination of destination numbers or circuit groups. If SCP


610


returns a destinations number, soft switch


204


can attempt to route to that destination number using the least cost routing logic included in route server


212


. If SCP


610


returns a circuit group, the soft switch


204


can use route server


212


to select an available circuit in that group. Soft switch


204


can try to terminate to the specified destinations in the prioritized order that the destinations are returned from SCP


610


.




The interface that can be used by soft switch


204


, in order to interact with SCPs


214


,


610


,


612


, and


616


, is called the off-switch call processing (OSCP) interface. This interface is also used for route server


212


and any other call processing engines. OSCP is represented in

FIG. 6A

as off-switch call processing abstraction layer


606


. Tables 8, 9, 10, and 11 identify the fields in the OSCP route request and route response messages, which are necessary for 800 and account code processing service calls.












TABLE 8











800 Route Request












SCP Route




800 SCP - Route






Request Parameter




Request Value









Message Type




800 Route Request






Call Reference




Unique call identifier






Requesting Soft-Switch




Soft Switch ID






Bearer Capability




Voice, Data or Fax






Destination type




DDD (an 8XX number was dialed)






Destination




Dialed 8XX number






Originating LATA




LATA from IAM or from DAL profile






Calling Number




ANI






Originating station type




II-digits from IAM or DAL profile






Collected Digits




Not Used for 800 processing






















TABLE 9











Account Code Route Request












OSCP Route




Account Code SCP - Route






Request Parameter




Request Value









Message Type




Account Code Route Request






Call Reference




Unique call identifier






Requesting Soft-Switch




Soft Switch ID






Bearer Capability




Not used for Account Code processing






Destination type




Not used for Account Code processing






Destination




Not used for Account Code processing






Originating LATA




LATA from IAM or from DAL profile






Calling Number




ANI






Originating station type




II-digits from IAM or DAL profile






Collected Digits




Not Used for Account Code processing






















TABLE 10











800 Route Response












OSCP Route




800 SCP - Route






Request Parameter




Response Value









Message Type




800 Route Response






Call Reference




Unique call identifier






Result Code




Success/fail






Number of responses




Number of responses sent







from the SCP






Destination circuit group - 1




Terminating circuit group for







the first route if the SCP







identifies circuit groups






Destination circuit - 1




Not used for 800 processing






Outpulse digits - 1




Outpulse digits for selected







termination






Destination number - 1




Destination number for the first route






Destination Soft Switch - 1




Not used for 800 processing






Destination circuit group - N




Terminating circuit group







for the Nth route, if







the SCP identifies circuit groups






Destination circuit - N




Not used for 800 processing






Outpulse digits - N




Outpulse digit format for selected







circuit on the Nth route






Destination number - N




Destination number for the Nth route






Destination Soft Switch - N




Not used for 800 processing






















TABLE 11











Account Code Route Response












OSCP Route




Account Code SCP - Route






Request Parameter




Response Value









Call Reference




Unique call identifier






Result Code




Success/fail






Number of responses




0 - this is a success/fail response






Destination circuit group - 1




Not used for account code processing






Destination circuit - 1




Not used for account code processing






Outpulse digits - 1




Not used for account code processing






Destination number - 1




Not used for account code processing






Destination Soft Switch - 1




Not used for account code processing






Destination circuit group - N




Not used for account code processing






Destination circuit - N




Not used for account code processing






Outpulse digits - N




Not used for account code processing






Destination number - N




Not used for account code processing






Destination Soft Switch - N




Not used for account code processing














A route response can also include an indication to initiate a call gapping for a congested call. Call gapping refers to a message sent from an SCP to a soft switch to control the number and frequency of requests sent to that SCP. The call gapping response can indicate a length of time for which gapping should be active, as well as a gap interval, at which the soft switch should space requests going to the SCP. Call gapping can be activated on the SCP for each individual service supported on the SCP. For example, if SCP


214


supports 800 and project account code queries, it may gap on 800, but not on project account codes. Alternatively, SCP


214


can gap on project codes but not on 800, or can gap on both or neither.




A connect-to resource is a response that is sent from the SCP to the soft switch in response to a route request for requests that require a call termination announcement to be played.





FIG. 6C

illustrates additional off-switch services


630


. For example, calling card interactive voice response (IVR)


632


services can be provided off-switch, similarly to operator services


628


.

FIG. 6C

also depicts on-switch SCP services. Specifically, project account codes (PAC) SCP


214




a


and basic toll-free SCP


214




b


communicate with soft switch


204


via an INAP/IP protocol


620


. Project account codes are discussed further below. Basic toll-free services are also discussed further below.





FIG. 6D

depicts additional services


634


. For example,

FIG. 6D

depicts service node/IP


656


, which can be a voice services platform with a voice over IP (VOIP) interface on data network


112


. In addition, network IVR


654


is depicted. Network IVR


654


is an IVR that connects to data network


112


. Network IVR


654


can communicate with soft switch


204


via the IPDC protocol. Network IVR


654


is also in communication with an advanced toll-free SCP


648


, via the SR-3511 protocol.




Advanced toll-free SCP


648


is in communication with soft switch


204


via INAP/IP protocol


620


. Advanced toll-free SCP


648


is also in communication with computer telephony integration (CTI) server


650


. CTI server


650


can communicate with an automatic call distributor (ACD)


652


.





FIG. 6D

also depicts an IP client connected via a customer network into data network


112


. Specifically, IP-Client


660


is connected to data network


112


via customer network


658


. Customer network


658


is connected to data network


112


and communicates via an H.323 protocol or via IPDC protocol


602


through data network


112


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


is in communication with SS7 gateway


208


via a TCAP/SS7


608


protocol. SS7 gateway


208


is in turn in communication with STP


208


via a TCAP/SS7


608


protocol. STP


208


in turn can communicate with SCPs in the SS7 network via the TCAP/SS7


608


protocol. Specifically, STP


208


can communicate with local number portability (LNP) SCP


636


and also 800 carrier SCP


610


. Soft switch


204


can still communicate with PAC SCP


214


A and basic toll-free SCP


214


B via an INAP/IP


620


protocol. Soft switch


204


can also communicate with an SCP gateway


638


via an INAP/IP


620


protocol. SCP gateway


638


can be used to communicate with customer premises toll-free


640


facilities. Customer premises toll-free


640


facilities can communicate with computer telephony integration (CTI) server


642


. CTI server


642


can be in communication with an automatic call distributer (ACD)


644


.




The H.323 Recommendation will now be briefly overviewed with reference to

FIGS. 71A-E

The H.323 standard provides a foundation for, for example, audio, video, and data communications across IP-based networks, including the Internet. By complying with the H.323 Recommendation, multimedia products and applications from multiple vendors can interoperate, allowing users to communicate without concern for compatibility. H.323 will be the foundation of future LAN-based products for consumer, business, entertainment, and professional applications.




H.323 is an umbrella recommendation from the International Telecommunications Union (ITU) that sets standards for multimedia communications over Local Area Networks (LANs) that do not provide a guaranteed Quality of Service (QoS). These networks dominate today's corporate desktops and include packet-switched TCP/IP and IPX over Ethernet, Fast Ethernet and Token Ring network technologies. Therefore, the H.323 standards are important building blocks for a broad new range of collaborative, LAN-based applications for multimedia communications.




The H.323 specification was approved in 1996 by the ITU's Study Group 16. Version 2 was approved in January 1998. The standard is broad in scope and includes both stand-alone devices and embedded personal computer technology as well as point-to-point and multipoint conferences. H.323 also addresses call control, multimedia management, and bandwidth management as well as interfaces between LANs and other networks.




H.323 is part of a larger series of communications standards that enable videoconferencing across a range of networks. Known as H.32X, this series includes H.320 and H.324, which address ISDN and PSTN communications, respectively.





FIG. 58A

depicts a block diagram of the H.323 architecture for a network-based communications system


5800


. H.323 defines four major components for network-based communications system


5800


, including: terminals


5802


,


5804


and


5810


, gateways


5806


, gatekeepers


5808


, and multipoint control units


5812


.




Terminals


5802


,


5804


,


5810


are the client endpoints on the LAN that provide real-time, two-way communications. All terminals must support voice communications; video and data are optional. H.323 specifies the modes of operation required for different audio, video, and/or data terminals to work together. It is the dominant standard of the next generation of Internet phones, audio conferencing terminals, and video conferencing technologies.




All H.323 terminals must also support H.245, which is used to negotiate channel usage and capabilities.

FIG. 58B

depicts an exemplary H.323 terminal


5802


. Three other components are required: Q.931 for call signaling and call setup, a component called Registration/Admission/Status (RAS), which is a protocol used to communicate with a gatekeeper


5808


; and support for RTP/RTCP for sequencing audio and video packets.




Optional components in an H.323 terminal are video codecs, T.120 data conferencing protocols, and MCU capabilities (described further below).




Gateway


5806


is an optional element in an H.323 conference.

FIG. 59

depicts an example H.323 gateway. Gateways


5806


provide many services, the most common being a translation function between H.323 conferencing endpoints and other terminal types. This function includes translation between transmission formats (i.e. H.225.0 to H.221) and between communications procedures (i.e. H.245 to H.242). In addition, gateway


5806


also translates between audio and video codecs and performs call setup and clearing on both the LAN side and the switched-circuit network side.

FIG. 59

shows an H.323/PSTN Gateway


5806


.




In general, the purpose of gateway


5806


is to reflect the characteristics of a LAN endpoint to an SCN endpoint and vice versa. The primary applications of gateways


5806


are likely to be:




Establishing links with analog PSTN terminals.




Establishing links with remote H.320-compliant terminals over ISDN-based switched-circuit networks.




Establishing links with remote H.324-compliant terminals over PSTN networks




Gateways


5806


are not required if connections to other networks are not needed, since endpoints may directly communicate with other endpoints on the same LAN. Terminals communicate with gateways


5806


using the H.245 and Q.931 protocols.




With the appropriate transcoders, H.323 gateways


5806


can support terminals that comply with H.310, H.321, H.322, and V.70.




Many gateway


5806


functions are left to the designer. For example, the actual number of H.323 terminals that can communicate through the gateway is not subject to standardization. Similarly, the number of SCN connections, the number of simultaneous independent conferences supported, the audio/video/data conversion functions, and inclusion of multipoint functions are left to the manufacturer. By incorporating gateway


5806


technology into the H.323 specification, the ITU has positioned H.323 as the glue that holds the world of standards-based conferencing endpoints together.




Gatekeeper


5808


is the most important component of an H.323 enabled network. It acts as the central point for all calls within its zone and provides call control services to registered endpoints. In many ways, an H.323 gatekeeper


5808


acts as a virtual switch.




Gatekeepers


5808


perform two important call control functions. The first is address translation from LAN aliases for terminals and gateways to IP or IPX addresses, as defined in the RAS specification. The second function is bandwidth management, which is also designated within RAS. For instance, if a network manager has specified a threshold for the number of simultaneous conferences on the LAN, the Gatekeeper


5808


can refuse to make any more connections once the threshold is reached. The effect is to limit the total conferencing bandwidth to some fraction of the total available; the remaining capacity is left for e-mail, file transfers, and other LAN protocols.

FIG. 60

depicts a collection of all terminals, gateways


5806


, and multipoint control units


5812


which can be managed by a single gatekeeper


5808


. This collection of elements is known as an H.323 Zone.




An optional, but valuable feature of a gatekeeper


5808


is its ability to route H.323 calls. By routing a call through a gatekeeper, it can be controlled more effectively. Service providers need this ability in order to bill for calls placed through their network. This service can also be used to re-route a call to another endpoint if a called endpoint is unavailable. In addition, a gatekeeper


5808


capable of routing H.323 calls can help make decisions involving balancing among multiple gateways. For instance, if a call is routed through a gatekeeper


5808


, that gatekeeper


5808


can then re-route the call to one of many gateways based on some proprietary routing logic.




While a gatekeeper


5808


is logically separate from H.323 endpoints, vendors can incorporate gatekeeper


5808


functionality into the physical implementation of gateways


5806


and MCUs


5812


.




Gatekeeper


5808


is not required in an H.323 system. However, if a gatekeeper


5808


is present, terminals must make use of the services offered by gatekeepers


5808


. RAS defines these as address translation, admissions control, bandwidth control, and zone management.




Gatekeepers


5808


can also play a role in multipoint connections. To support multipoint conferences, users would employ a Gatekeeper


5808


to receive H.245 Control Channels from two terminals in a point-to-point conference. When the conference switches to multipoint, the gatekeeper can redirect the H.245 Control Channel to a multipoint controller, the MC. Gatekeeper


5808


need not process the H.245 signaling; it only needs to pass it between the terminals


5802


,


5804


,


5808


or the terminals and the MC.




LANs which contain Gateways


5806


could also contain a gatekeeper


5808


to translate incoming E.


164


addresses into Transport Addresses. Because a Zone is defined by its gatekeeper


5808


, H.323 entities that contain an internal gatekeeper


5808


require a mechanism to disable the internal function so that when there are multiple H.323 entities that contain a gatekeeper


5808


on a LAN, the entities can be configured into the same Zone.




The Multipoint Control Unit (MCU)


5812


supports conferences between three or more endpoints. Under H.323, an MCU


5812


consists of a Multipoint Controller (MC), which is required, and zero or more Multipoint Processors (MP). The MC handles H.245 negotiations between all terminals to determine common capabilities for audio and video processing. The MC also controls conference resources by determining which, if any, of the audio and video streams will be multicast. MCU


2112


is depicted in FIG.


61


.




The MC does not deal directly with any of the media streams. This is left to the MP, which mixes, switches, and processes audio, video, and/or data bits. MC and MP capabilities can exist in a dedicated component or be part of other H.323 components. A soft switch includes some functions of an MP. An access server, also sometimes referred to as a media gateway controller, includes some of the functions of the MC. MCs and MPs are discussed further below with respect to the IPDC protocol.




Approved in January of 1998, version 2 of the H.323 standard addresses deficiencies in version 1 and introduces new functionality within existing protocols, such as Q.931, H.245 and H.225, as well as entirely new protocols. The most significant advances were in security, fast call setup, supplementary services and T.120/H.323 integration.




(1) Project Account Codes




Project Account Codes can be used for tracking calls for billing, invoicing, and Class of Service (COS) restrictions. Project account code (PAC) verifications can include, for example, types Unverified Unforced, Unverified Forced, Verified Forced, and Partially Verified Forced. A web interface can be provided for a business customer to manage its accounts. The business customer can use the web interface to make additions, deletions, changes, and modifications to PAC translations without involvement of a carrier's customer service department.




An example of call processing using PACs follows. PAC SCP


214




a


of

FIG. 6C

can receive validation requests from Soft-Switch


204


after Soft-Switch


204


has requested and received PAC digits. The PAC digits can be forwarded to SCP


214




a


for verification. When SCP


214




a


receives this request, SCP


214




a


can compare the entire PAC, if the PAC type is Verified Forced, against a customer PAC table. SCP


214




a


can compare only the verified portion of the PAC, if the PAC type is Partially Verified Forced, against the customer PAC table.




The PAC digits can be sent from Soft-Switch


204


to SCP


214




a


in the ‘Caller Entered Digits’ field. The indicated customer can be sent from Soft-Switch


204


to SCP


214




a


in the ‘Customer’ field.




(2) Basic Toll-Free




Basic Toll-Free Service SCP


214




b


can translate a toll free (e.g., 800 and 888) number to a final routing destination based on a flexible set of options selected by a subscriber. Basic toll-free service supports e.g., 800 and 8XX Service Access Codes. Subscriber options can include, for example: 1) routing based on NPA or NPA-NXX of calling party; 2) routing based on time of day and day of week; 3) routing based on percent distribution; 4) emergency override routing; and 5) blocking based on calling party's NPA or NPA-NXX or ii-digits.




An exemplary embodiment of basic toll-free SCP


214




b


is a GENESYS Network Interaction Router available from GENESYS of San Francisco, Calif.




The GENESYS Network Interaction Router product suite provides Basic Toll-Free service. Soft-Switch


204


can send route requests to SCP


214




b


for any Toll Free numbers that Soft-Switch


204


receives. SCP


214




b


can then attempt to route the call using a route plan or trigger plan that has been defined for that Toll Free (dialed) number. SCP


214




b


can have several possible responses to a soft switch routing request, see Table 10 above. Using the subscriber routing option (described in the previous paragraph) SCP


214




b


can return a number translation for the Toll Free number. For example, SCP


214




b


can receive a dialed number of 800-202-2020 and return a DDD such as 303-926-3000. Alternatively, SCP


214




b


can return a circuit identifier. SCP


214




b


usually returns a circuit identifier when the termination is a dedicated trunk to a customer premise equipment (CPE). Then if SCP


214




b


determines that it can not route the call or has determined to block the call (per the route plan), SCP


214




b


returns a ‘route to resource’ response to Soft-Switch


204


with an announcement identifier. In this case Soft-Switch


204


can connect the calling party with Announcement Server


246


for the playing of an announcement and then disconnect the caller.




SCP


214




b


can store call events in CDR database tables on SCP


214




b


. CDR database tables can then be replicated to Master Network Event Database


226


using a data distributor


222


, such as, for example, the Oracle Replication Server.




e. Configuration Server (CS) or Configuration Database (CDB)




The configuration server


206


will now be described in greater detail with reference to FIG.


2


. Configuration server


206


supports transaction requests to a database containing information needed by network components. Configuration server


206


supports queries by voice network components during initialization and call processing. The data contained within configuration server


206


databases can be divided into two types. The first type of data is that used to initialize connections between components. Examples of such data used to initialize connections between network components include the following: IP address and port numbers for all servers that soft switch


204


must communicate with, information indicating initial primary/secondary/tertiary configurations for server relationships; configuration information for access gateways


238


,


240


and trunking gateways


232


,


234


; number and configuration of bays, modules, lines and channels (BMLC); relationship of module, line and channels to originating point code (OPC), destination point code (DPC) and circuit identification code (CIC) values; relationship of module, line and channels to trunk groups; call processing decision trees for soft switch processing; mapping of OPC, DPC and CIC values soft switches


204


; mapping of access server


254


,


256


ports to dedicated access line (DAL) identifiers and customer IDs; tables necessary to support class of service (COS) restrictions; local access transport area (LATA) tables, state tables; and blocked country code tables.




The second set of data can be categorized as that data needed by soft switch


204


for use during call processing. This type of data includes customer and DAL profiles. These profiles define the services that a customer has associated with their ANIs or DALs. This information can include information describing class of service restrictions and account code settings.




The database of configuration server


206


contains voice network topology information as well as basic data tables necessary for soft switch


204


call processing logic. Configuration server


206


is queried by soft switches


204


at start-up and upon changes to this information in order to set up the initial connections between elements of telecommunications network


200


. Configuration server


206


is also queried by soft switches


204


in order to configure initial settings within soft switch


204


.




Configuration server


206


contains the following types of information: IP address and port numbers for all servers that soft switch


204


must communicate with; information indicating initial primary/secondary/tertiary configurations for server relationships; configuration information for AGs


238


,


240


and TGs


232


,


234


; call processing decision trees for soft switch


204


call processing; mapping of OPC, DPC and CIC values to soft switch


204


; mapping of access server


254


,


256


ports to DALs and customer IDs; and tables necessary to support COS restrictions.




Configuration information for AGs and TGs includes: number and configuration of bays, modules, lines and channels; relationship of modules, line and channels to OPC, DPC and CIC values; and relationship of module, line and channels to trunk groups.




Tables necessary to support class of service restrictions include: LATA tables, state tables; and blocked country code tables.




Configuration server


206


also contains information related to customer trigger plans and service options. Customer trigger plans provide call processing logic used in connecting a call. Configuration server


206


information is queried during call processing to identify the service logic to be executed for each call.




The information that soft switch


204


uses to look-up customer profile data is the ANI, trunk ID or destination number for the call. The information that will be returned defines the call processing logic that is associated with ANI, trunk ID or destination number or trunk group.




Table 12 includes an example of a customer profile query.












TABLE 12











Customer Profile Query












Customer Profile Query Field




Value









Customer identification type




DDD, DAL ID, Customer ID






Customer identification




The value for the DDD, Trunk ID














Table 13 includes an example of a customer profile query response provided by configuration server


206


.












TABLE 13











Customer Profile Query Response












Customer Profile Response Field




Value









Customer identification type




DDD, Trunk ID






Customer Identification




The value for the DDD, Trunk ID






Class of Service restriction Type




None







Intrastate







IntraLATA







Domestic







Domestic and selected international






Selected International




When the class of service restriction






List ID




type is domestic and selected







international destinations, this is







an index to the list of







allowed international destinations.






Account Code Type




None







Verified Forced







Unverified Forced







Unverified Unforced







Partially Verified Forced






Account code length




2-12 digits






Local Service Area,




For queries on numbers, these fields






State, LATA, and Country




are identify the geographic







information that is







necessary to process the call.














Configuration server


206


interfaces to components. Configuration server


206


receives provisioning and reference data updates from data distributor


222


of provisioning component


222


. Configuration server


206


also provides data to soft switch


204


for call processing. Configuration server


206


is used by soft switch


204


to retrieve information necessary for initialization and call processing. Information that soft switch


204


retrieves from configuration server


206


during a query is primarily oriented towards customer service provisioning and gateway site


108


,


110


port configuration. Configuration server


206


database tables accessible to soft switch


204


include the following: toll free number to SCP type translation; SCP type to SCP translation; CICs profiles; ANI profiles summary; ANI profiles; account code profiles; NPA/NXX; customer profiles; customer location profiles; equipment service profiles; trunk group service profile summaries; trunk group services; high risk countries; and selected international destinations.




Configuration server


206


uses a separate physical interface for all SNMP messages and additional functions that may be defined. Examples of additional functions that may be defined include provisioning, updating, and the passage of special alarms and performance parameters to configuration server


206


from the NOC.




In an alternative embodiment, the functionality of configuration server


206


can be combined with that of route server


212


in a single network component. In an additional embodiment of the invention, the functions of either or both of CS


206


and RS


212


can be performed by application logic residing on soft switch


204


.




f. Route Server (RS)





FIG. 8A

depicts route server support for an exemplary soft switch site 800.

FIG. 8A

includes route server


212




a


and route server


212




b


. Route servers


212




a


and


212




b


are connected via redundant connections to soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


. Soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


are in turn connected to gateway sites via data network


112


(not shown). For example, soft switch


204




a


is in communication with TG


232




a


and TG


232




b


. Similarly soft switch


204




b


is in communication with AG


238




a


and TG


234




a


. Soft switch


204




c


is in turn in communication with AG


238




b


and AG


240




a


. It would be apparent to a person skilled in the art that additional TGs and AGs, as well as other gateway site devices, (such as a NAS device) can also be in communication with soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c.






Route server


212


will now be described in further detail with reference to FIG.


2


. Route server


212


provides at least two functions. Route server


212


performs the function of supporting the logic for routing calls based upon a phone number. This routing, performed by route server


212


, results in the selection of one or more circuit groups for termination.




Another function of route server


212


is the tracking and allocation of network ports. As shown in

FIG. 8A

, route server


212


(collocated with other components at soft switch site


104


) services routing requests for all soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


at that site. Therefore, route server


212


tracks port resources for all TGs


232




a


,


232




b


and


234




a


and AGs


238




a


,


238




b


and


240




a


that are serviced by soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


at soft switch site


104


.




(1) Route Server Routing Logic




The routing logic accepts translated phone numbers and uses anywhere from full digit routing to NPA-based routing to identify a terminating circuit group. Routing logic selects the translation based upon the best match of digits in the routing tables. An exemplary routing table is illustrated as Table 14.












TABLE 14











Number Routing Table

















Terminating









Number




Circuit Group




Priority




Load











303-926-3000




 34




1




50%







303-926-3000




 56




1




50%







303-926-3000




 23




2







303-926




 76







303




236




1







44 1784 470 330




564




1







44




923




1















In Table 14, there are five entries that can match the dialed number “303-926-3000”. The first route choice is the one that has a full match of digits with priority one. Since there are two entries with full matching digits, and which are marked as priority one, the load should be distributed as shown in the load column, (i.e., 50% load share is distributed to the first, and 50% load share is distributed to the second). The second route choice is the entry with a full digit match, but marked with the lower priority of two. The third route match is the one that has a matching NPA-NXX. The last route choice is the one that has a matching NPA only.




In situations where there are multiple route choices for a DDD number (i.e., the number of called party


120


) route server


212


must take into consideration several factors when selecting a terminating circuit group. The factors to be considered in selecting a terminating circuit group include: (1) the percent loading of circuit groups as shown in the load column of Table 14; (2) the throttling use of trunk groups to avoid overloaded networks; (3) the fact that end office trunk groups should be selected before tandem office trunk groups; and (4) routing based upon negotiated off-network carrier agreements.




Agreements should be negotiated with off-network carriers to provide the flexibility to route calls based upon benefits of one agreement another. The following types of agreements can be accounted for: (1) commitments for the number of minutes given to a carrier per month or per year; (2) the agreement that for specific NPA or NPA-NXX sets, one carrier may be preferred over another; (3) the agreement that international calls to specific countries may have preferred carriers; (4) the agreement that intra-LATA or intra-state calls originating for certain areas may have a preferred carrier in that area; and (5) the agreement that extended area service calls may have a preferred carrier.




The logic for route server


212


can include routing for international calls. In the example shown in Table 14, it is possible to have fully specified international numbers, or simply specified routing, for calls going to a particular country. As with domestic numbers, the routing logic should select the table entry that matches the most digits within the dialed number, (i.e. the number of called party


120


).




(2) Route Server Circuit Management




Once a terminating circuit group has been identified, route server


212


needs to allocate a terminating circuit within the trunk group. The selection of a terminating circuit is made by querying the port status table. Table 15A shows an exemplary port status table. The results of a query to port status Table 15A yields the location of a circuit. Route server


212


can use algorithms to select circuits within the trunk group. Each circuit group can be tagged with the selected algorithm that should be used when selecting circuits within that group.




Example algorithms to select circuits within the group include: (1) the most recently used circuit within a circuit group; (2) the least recently used circuit within a circuit group; (3) a circular search, keeping track of the last used circuit and selecting the next available circuit; (4) the random selection of an available circuit within a circuit group; and (5) a sequential search of circuits within a circuit group, selecting the lowest numbered available circuit. Table 15A illustrates the association between a circuit group and the selection algorithm that should be used to allocate ports from that group.












TABLE 15A











Circuit Group Parameters














Circuit group




Selection (algorithm)







34




Random







35




Least recently used























TABLE 15B











Port Status













Circuit group




Port




Status









34




3-4-6-1




Avail






34




3-4-6-2




In-use






34




3-4-6-3




avail






34




3-4-6-4




avail














Table 15B includes the circuit group (that a port is a member of), a port identifier, and the current status of that port. The port identifier shown in Table 15B assumes the type of port identification currently used in the IPDC protocol, where the port is represented by a bay, module, line and channel (BMLC). It would be apparent to persons skilled in the art that other methods of identifying a port can be used.




The function of route server


212


is to provide least-cost routing information to soft switch


204


, in order to route a call from calling party


102


to called party


120


. In addition to providing routing information, route server


212


allocates ports for terminating calls on the least cost routes, e.g., allocating ports within TGs


232


,


234


. Route server pair


212


is located at each of soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


and services all soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


,


304




a


,


304




b


,


304




c


,


306




a


,


306




b


and


306




c


at that site. (Refer to

FIG. 3.

)




Route server


212


interacts with at least two other voice network components. Route server


212


interacts with configuration server


206


. Configuration server


206


is used to retrieve initial information on route server


212


start-up to set up the initial routing tables in preparation for receiving requests from soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


, for example.




Route server


212


also interfaces with soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


can send route requests to route server


212


that contain either a phone number or a circuit group. Route server


212


can perform its least cost routing logic to first select a terminating circuit group for the call. Using that circuit group, route server


212


can then select and allocate a terminating circuit.




A description of the messages and model of interaction between route server


212


and soft switch


204


follows. Route server


212


is used by soft switch


204


to identify the possible network terminations for a call. Soft switch


204


passes a DDD number, an international DDD (IDDD) number, or a circuit group to route server


212


in a “route request” message. Using this information from soft switch


204


, route server


212


can return the port on an AG


238


,


240


or TG


232


,


234


that should be used to terminate this call. Using this port information, soft switch


204


can then signal the originating and terminating TG or AG to connect the call through data network


112


.




The route server


212


will now be described further with reference to FIG.


2


B.

FIG. 2B

depicts a sample call flow


258


, illustrating how soft switch


204


interacts with route server


212


to identify a terminating port for a call.




In exemplary call flow


258


, the call originates and terminates at different sites, specifically, gateway sites


108


, and I


10


. Since exemplary call flow


258


originates and terminates at different sites, the cooperation of the originating soft switch


204


and terminating soft switch


304


and route servers


212


,


314


, respectively to identify the terminating circuit. Portions of the call flow will now be described in greater detail.




As depicted in step


259


, for calls arriving on SS7 signal trunks, soft switch


204


receives call arrival notifications in the form of IAM messages. Upon receipt of the IAM message from SS7 GW


208


, soft switch


204


performs some initial digit analysis to determine the type of the call.




In step


260


, for calls involving customer features, soft switch


204


can use the ANI of calling party


102


(i.e., the telephone number of calling party


102


) to query a customer profile database in configuration server


206


. This is done to identify the originating customer's feature set. Each customer's feature set is known as a “trigger plan” for origination of the call. A trigger plan can be thought of as a flowchart which branches based on certain triggering events dependent on the caller's identity. Customer trigger plans


290


reside in a customer profile on configuration server


206


.




In step


262


, the customer profile database of configuration server


206


returns the customer trigger plan


290


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


can perform any processing necessary to implement the customer's specified originating triggers.




Application logic in soft switch


204


can then generate a translated number or an identification of the terminating circuit group for this call. For example, in the case of an 800 call, a translation may be requested as in step


265


of an SCP


214


. SCP


214


converts the 800 number into a normal number for termination, and in step


266


returns the number to soft switch


204


.




In step


267


, in order to translate the translated number or circuit group into an egress port, soft switch


204


makes a route request to route server


212


. The routing logic uses the NPA-NXX-XXXX to identify the terminating circuit group. Upon identifying the terminating circuit group, the route logic queries a circuit group to soft switch mapping table in route logic


294


of route server


212


, to identify the target soft switch that handles the identified termination. For example, the target soft switch may be soft switch


304


. It is important to note that there can be multiple route choices, and therefore there can be multiple soft switches


204


,


304


supporting a single route request.




In step


268


, route server


212


responds to soft switch


204


with the terminating circuit group. In this example, the terminating circuit group is included in trunks connected to trunking gateway


234


, which is serviced by a different soft switch (namely soft switch


304


) than originating soft switch


204


. Therefore, route server


212


responds with the terminating circuit group and identifies soft switch


304


as the soft switch that handles that terminating circuit group.




In step


269


, originating soft switch


204


initiates the connection from the origination to the termination, by requesting a connection from the originating trunking gateway


232


. Trunking gateway


232


, upon receipt of the set-up request from soft switch


204


, allocates internal resources in trunking gateway


232


.




TG


232


manages its own ports. In an example embodiment, TG


232


uses real time protocol (RTP) over UDP, and RTP sessions, which are ports used to implement an RTP connection. In step


270


, TG


232


returns to soft switch


204


the IP address and listed RTP port.




In step


274


, originating soft switch


204


issues a call setup command to terminating soft switch


304


. This is the command identified by route server


212


.




In step


276


, soft switch


304


queries route server


314


to determine the termination port for the call. Specifically, soft switch


304


queries port status


298


of route server


314


. The query in step


276


, “passes in” as a parameter the terminating circuit group.




In step


278


, route server


314


allocates a termination port and returns the allocated termination port to terminating soft switch


304


.




In step


280


, terminating soft switch


304


instructs the identified end point (i.e., trunking gateway


234


) to reserve resources, and to connect the call. Terminating soft switch


304


passes in an IP address and an RTP port corresponding to the port that was allocated by originating TG


232


.




In step


282


, terminating TG


234


returns the allocated resources for the call to soft switch


304


. For voice over IP (VOIP) connections, this includes the listed port and IP address for the terminating TG


234


.




In step


284


, terminating soft switch


304


returns to originating soft switch


204


the TP address of TG


234


.




In step


286


, originating soft switch


204


communicates with originating TG


232


in order to inform originating TG


232


of the listed port that was allocated by terminating TG


234


. At this point, originating TG


232


and terminating TG


234


have enough information to exchange full duplex information.




In step


288


, originating TG


232


acknowledges the receipt of the communication from soft switch


304


to soft switch


204


.




Table 16A shows fields that can be included in a route request sent from soft switch


204


to route server


212


. The route request can contain either a DDD number or a circuit group that requires routing. The route request message can also contain information about the call, collected from the IAM message, that is necessary to perform routing of this call. The route request message can also contain information about the call, necessary to perform routing of the call, which is obtained from the processing of the call. For example, in the case of an


800


call, this information can be a translated number.












TABLE 16A











Values for Route Request sent to the Route Server












OSCP Route




Route Server - Route






Request Parameter




Request Value









Message Type




Route Server Route Request






Call Reference




Unique call identifier






Requesting Soft Switch




Soft Switch ID






Bearer Capability




Voice, Data or Fax






Destination type




DDD or circuit group






Destination




Fully translated DDD (or IDDD)







number or circuit group ID






Originating LATA




LATA from IAM or from DAL profile






Calling Number




ANI






Originating station type




II-digits from IAM or DAL profile






Collected Digits




Not Used for Route Server














Table 16B shows fields which can be included in a response corresponding to the route response, sent from route server


212


back to soft switch


204


.




Alternatively, each route response can include one route termination, and multiple consecutive route terminations can be determined with multiple route request/response transactions.












TABLE 16B











Values for Route Response sent from the Route Server












Customer Profile Query Field




Route Server - Route Response Value









Message Type




Route Server Route Response






Call Reference




Unique call identifier






Result code




Success/Fail






Number of responses




Number of responses sent from







the route server






Destination circuit group - 1




Terminating circuit group for







the first route






Destination circuit - 1




Terminating circuit allocated by







the route server for the first route






Outpulse digits - 1




Outpulse digit format for selected







circuit on the first route






Destination number - 1




Destination number for the first route






Destination Soft Switch - 1




Soft switch servicing the circuit







group for the first route






Destination circuit group - N




Terminating circuit group







for the Nth route






Destination circuit - N




Terminating circuit allocated by







the route server for the Nth route






Outpulse digits - N




Outpulse digit format for selected







circuit on the Nth route






Destination number - N




Destination number for the Nth route






Destination Soft Switch - N




Soft switch servicing the circuit group







for the Nth route














The route response message can contain a plurality of route terminations for the DDD or circuit group that was passed in as a parameter to route server


212


. For example, the route response message can include I to


5


route choices. Each of the route choices of the route response message can include various fields of information. For example, each route choice can include the following information: the circuit group, the circuit, the outpulse digits, the destination number and the destination soft switch


304


. Alternatively, each route response can include one route termination and multiple consecutive route terminations can be determined with multiple route request/route response transactions.




In situations where the selected circuit group is managed by the same route server


212


that serviced the route request, the response for that route can contain all the information about the destination. This is possible because route server


212


can identify and allocate the circuit within the circuit group.




In situations where another route server


314


services the selected circuit group, the response for that route only contains the circuit group and the destination soft switch


304


. Originating soft switch


204


can then make a request to terminating soft switch


304


to query the terminating route server


314


for a circuit within the identified circuit group. The terminating soft switch


304


can then control the termination of the call.




g. Regional Network Event Collection Point (RNECP)




Referring back to

FIG. 2A

, regional network event collection points (RNECPs)


224


serve as collection points for real-time recorded call events that can be used by other systems. Soft switch


204


generates call data. This call data can be collected during call processing. Call data can also be generated by capturing events from other network elements. These network elements include internal soft switch site


104


components and external components. External components include SCPs


214


, intelligent peripherals (IPs), AGs


238


,


240


, TGs


232


,


234


, and signaling components, such as STPs


250


,


252


, SSPs, and off switch SCPs.




Soft switch


204


provides call event data to RNECPs


224


. Call data can be collected by a primary and secondary server at each RNECP


224


, using high availability redundancy to minimize the possibility of potential data loss. Data from RNECPs


224


can then be transmitted in real-time to a centralized server, called the master network event database (MNEDB)


226


. The MNEDB is discussed further below, with reference to FIG.


20


.





FIG. 9

depicts a network event collection architecture


900


.

FIG. 9

includes western soft switch site


104


, central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


are illustrated as including RNE CPs for collecting events and routing events to a master database. Specifically, western soft switch site


104


has soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


communicating via a local area network to RNECPs


224




a


,


224




b


. RNECPs can include disks


914


,


916


. RNECPs


224




a


,


224




b


can be in direct communication with, as well as can take a primary and a secondary role in communicating with, soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c.






RNECPs


224




a


,


224




b


can route network events through management virtual private network (VPN)


910


to master network event data center


912


. Network events come through management VPN


910


and can be routed via redundant paths to MNEDB server


226




a


and/or MNEDB


226




b


. MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


can communicate with one another. MNEDB


226




a


uses disks


926




a


as primary storage for its database. MNEDB


226




a


also uses disks


926




b


for secondary storage. Similarly MNEDB


226




b


uses primary and secondary disks,


926




a


,


926




b.






MNEDB


226




a


and MNEDB


226




b


can be collocated or can be geographically diverse. Thus master data center


912


can be either in one geographical area or in multiple locations.




Management VPN


910


also collects events from the other soft switch sites, i.e., central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


. Central soft switch site


106


includes soft switches


304




a


,


304




b


,


304




c


redundantly connected via a LAN to RNECPs


902


and


904


. RNECP


902


has disks


918


and


920


.




Eastern soft switch site


302


includes soft switches


306




a


,


306




b


,


306




c


, redundantly connected via a LAN. RNECPs


906


and


908


RNECP


906


can have disks


922


and


924


.




RNECPs


902


and


904


of central soft switch site


106


and RNECPs


906


and


908


of eastern soft switch site


302


can route network events for storage in disks


926




a


,


926




b


of MNEDBs


226




a


,


226




b.






This is done by routing network events via management VPN


910


to master data center


912


. The soft switches generate event blocks and push event block data to the RNECPs. (Event blocks are recorded call events that are created during call processing.)




Each RNECP


224




a


,


224




b


,


902


,


904


,


906


and


908


forwards collected event blocks (EBs) to (MNEDBs)


226




a


,


226




b


, which are centralized databases. RNECPs


224




a


,


224




b


,


902


,


904


,


906


and


908


use separate physical interfaces for all SNMP messages and additional functions that may be defined. Additional functions that can be defined include provisioning, updating, and passing special alarm and/or performance parameters to RNECPs from the network operation center (NOC).




RNECPs


224




a


,


224




b


,


902


,


904


,


906


and


908


are used by soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


,


304




a


,


304




b


,


304




c


,


306




a


,


306




b


and


306




c


to collect generated call events for use in such services as preparation of billing and reporting. At specific points throughout the duration of a call, soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


,


304




a


,


304




b


,


304




c


,


306




a


,


306




b


and


306




c


take the information that the soft switches have collected during call processing and push that data to the RNECPs.




Multiple types of data are logged by the soft switches during call processing of a normal one plus (1+) long distance call using account codes. Examples of data logged by an exemplary soft switch


204


include: a call origination record on the originating side, call termination information on the terminating side, an account code record, egress routing information, answer information on the originating side, call disconnect information on the originating side, call disconnect information on the terminating side, and final event blocks with call statistics.




Exemplary soft switch


204


can record data during call processing. Soft switch


204


transfers call events from RNECP


224


to MNEDB


226


for storage. This call event data, stored in MNEDB


226


, can be used by various downstream systems for post-processing. These systems include, for example, mediation, end-user billing, carrier access billing services (CABS), fraud detection/prevention, capacity management and marketing.




There are at least two types of EBs. Example Mandatory and Augmenting event blocks can be explained as follows.




Mandatory EBs are created by soft switch


204


during the initial point-in-call analysis. Initial point-in-call analysis includes going off-hook, (picking up the telephone set) call <insert> setup, initial digit analysis (i.e., digit analysis prior to any external database transactions or route determinations).




Since other events such as, for example, session/call answer, and SCP transactions, can occur during call processing, soft switch


204


can create augmenting EBs. Augmenting EBs are EBs which can augment the information found in a mandatory EB. Events such as, for example, route determination, and answer indication, can be recorded in an augmenting EBs.




Examples of mandatory and augmenting EBs follow. For a complete illustration of these EBs, the reader is referred to Tables 20-143 and the corresponding discussions below. Specifically, Tables 20-48 provide mandatory EBs, Tables 49-60 provide augmenting EBs, and Tables 61-143 provide the call event elements that comprise the Ebs.




(1) Example Mandatory Event Blocks EBs




The following event blocks are examples of Mandatory Event Blocks:




EB


0001


—Domestic Toll (TG Origination);




EB


0002


—Domestic Toll (TG Termination);




EB


0003


—Domestic Toll (AG Origination);




EB


0004


—Domestic Toll (AG Termination);




EB


0005


—Local (TG Origination);




EB


0006


—Local (TG Termination);




EB


0007


—Local (AG Origination);




EB


0008


—Local (AG Termination);




EB


0009


—8XX/Toll-Free (TG Origination);




EB


0010


—8XX/Toll-Free (TG Termination);




EB


0010


—8XX/Toll-Free (AG Origination);




EB


0012


—8XX/Toll Free (AG Termination);




EB


0013


—Domestic Operator Services (TG Termination);




EB


0014


—Domestic Operator Services (AG Origination);




EB


0015


—Domestic Operator Services (OSP Termination);




EB


0016


—International Operator Services (TG Origination);




EB


0017


—International Operator Services (AG Origination);




EB


0018


—International Operator Services (OSP Termination);




EB


0019


—Directory Assistance/555-1212 (TG Origination);




EB


0020


—Directory Assistance/555-1212 (AG Origination);




EB


0021


—Directory Assistance/555-1212 (DASP Termination);




EB


0022


—OSP/DASP Extended Calls (Domestic);




EB


0023


—OSP/DASP Extended Calls (International);




EB


0024


—International Toll (TG Origination);




EB


0025


—International Toll (AG Origination);




EB


0026


—International Toll (TG Termination);




EB


0027


—International Toll (AG Termination);




EB


0040


—IP Origination; and




EB


0041


—IP Termination.




(2) Augmenting Event Blocks EBs




The following event blocks are examples of Augmenting Event Blocks:




EB


0050


—Final Event Block;




EB


0051


—Answer Indication;




EB


0052


—Ingress Trunking Disconnect Information;




EB


0053


—Egress Trunking Disconnect Information;




EB


0054


—Basic 8XX/Toll-Free SCP Transaction Information;




EB


0055


—Calling Party (Ported) Information;




EB


0056


—Called Party (Ported) Information;




EB


0057


—Egress Routing Information (TG Termination);




EB


0058


—Routing Congestion Information;




EB


0059


—Account Code Information;




EB


0060


—Egress Routing Information (AG Termination); and




EB


0061


—Long Duration Call Information.




h. Software Object Oriented Programming (OOPs) Class Definitions




(1) Introduction to Object Oriented Programming (OOP)




In an example embodiment, soft switch site


104


comprises a plurality of object oriented programs (OOPs) running on a computer. As apparent to those skilled in the art, soft switch site


104


can alternatively be written in any form of software.




(a) Object Oriented Programming (OOP) Tutorial




OOPs can be described at a high level by defining object oriented programming classes. For example, in an embodiment of the present invention, soft switch


204


comprise an OOP written in an OOP language. Example languages include C++ and JAVA. An-OOP model is enforced via fundamental mechanisms known as encapsulation, inheritance and polymorphism.




Encapsulation may be thought of as placing a wrapper around the software code and data of a program. The basis of encapsulation is a structure known as a class. An object is a single instance of a class. A class describes general attributes of that object. A class includes a set of data attributes plus a set of allowable operations (i.e., methods). The individual structure or data representation of a class is defined by a set of instance variables.




Inheritance is another feature of an OOP model. A class (called a subclass) may be derived from another class, (called a superclass) wherein the subclass inherits the data attributes and methods of the superclass. The subclass may specialize the superclass by adding code which overrides the data and/or methods of the superclass, or which adds new data attributes and methods.




Thus, inheritance represents a mechanism by which subclasses are more precisely specified. A new subclass includes all the behavior and specification of all of its ancestors. Inheritance is a major contributor to the increased programmer efficiency provided by the OOP. Inheritance makes it possible for developers to minimize the amount of new code they have to write to create applications. By providing the significant portion of the functionality needed for a particular task, classes on the inheritance hierarchy give the programmer a head start to program design and creation.




Polymorphism refers to having one object and many shapes. It allows a method to have multiple implementations selected based on the type of object passed into a method and location. Methods are passed information as parameters. These are parameters passed as both a method and an invocation of a method. Parameters represent the input values to a function that the method must perform. The parameters are a list of “typed” values which comprise the input data to a particular message. The OOP model may require that the types of the values be exactly matched in order for the message to be understood.




Object-oriented programming is comprised of software objects that interact and communicate with each other by sending one another messages. Software objects are often modeled from real-world objects.




Object-oriented programs of the present invention are hardware platform independent. Client computer


7008


in a preferred embodiment is a computer workstation, e.g., a Sun UltraSPARC Workstation, available from SUN Microsystems, Inc., of Palo Alto, Calif., running an operating system such as UNIX. Alternatively a system running on another operating system can be used, as would be apparent to those skilled in the art. Other exemplary operating systems include Windows/NT, Windows98, OS/2, Mac OS, and other UNIX-based operating systems. Exemplary UNIX-based operating systems include solaris, IRIX, LINUX, HPUX and OSF. However, the invention is not limited to these platforms, and can be implemented on any appropriate computer systems or operating systems.




An exemplary computer system is shown in FIG.


70


B. Other network components of telecommunications network


200


, such as, for example, route server


212


and configuration server


206


, can also be implemented using computer system


7008


shown in FIG.


70


B. Computer system


7008


includes one or more processors


7012


. Processor


7012


is connected to a communication bus


7014


.




Client computer


7006


also includes a main memory


7016


, preferably random access memory (RAM), and a secondary memory


7018


. Secondary memory


7018


includes hard disk drive


7020


and/or a removable storage drive


7022


. Removable storage drive


7022


reads from and/or writes to a removable storage unit


7024


in a well known manner. Removable storage unit


7024


can be a floppy diskette drive, a magnetic tape drive or a compact disk drive. Removable storage unit


7024


includes any computer usable storage medium having stored therein computer software and/or data, such as an object's methods and data.




Client computer


7008


has one or more input devices, including but not limited to a mouse


7026


(or other pointing device such as a digitizer), a keyboard


7028


, or any other data entry device.




Computer programs (also called computer control logic), including object oriented computer programs, are stored in main memory


7016


and/or the secondary memory


7018


and/or removable storage units


7024


. Computer programs can also be called computer program products. Such computer programs, when executed, enable computer system


7008


to perform the features of the present invention as discussed herein. In particular, the computer programs, when executed, enable the processor


7012


to perform the features of the present invention. Accordingly, such computer programs represent controllers of computer system


7008


.




In another embodiment, the invention is directed to a computer program product comprising a computer readable medium having control logic (computer software) stored therein. The control logic, when executed by processor


7012


, causes processor


7012


to perform the functions of the invention as described herein.




In yet another embodiment, the invention is implemented primarily in hardware using, for example, one or more state machines. Implementation of these state machines so as to perform the functions described herein will be apparent to persons skilled in the relevant arts.




(2) Software Objects in an OOP Environment




Prior to describing the class definitions in detail, a description of an exemplary software object in an OOP environment is described.





FIG. 70A

is a graphical representation of a software object


7002


. Software object


7002


is comprised of methods and variables. For example software object


7002


includes methods


1


-


8




7004


and variables V


1


-V


N




7006


. Methods


7004


are software procedures that, when executed, cause software objects variables


7006


to be manipulated (as needed) to reflect the effects of actions of software object


7002


. The performance of software object


7002


is expressed by its methods


7004


. The knowledge of software object


7002


is expressed by its variables


7006


.




In object oriented programming, software objects


7002


are outgrowths (or instances) of a particular class. A class defines methods


7004


and variables


7006


that are included in a particular type of software object


7002


. Software objects


7002


that belong to a class are called instances of the class. A software object


7002


belonging to a particular class will contain specific values for the variables contained in the class. For example, a software class of vehicles may contain objects that define a truck, a car, a trailer and a motorcycle.




In object oriented programming, classes are arranged in a hierarchical structure. Objects that are defined as special cases of a more general class automatically inherit the method and variable definitions of the general class. As noted, the general class is referred to as the superclass. The special case of the general class is referred to as the subclass of the general class. In the above example, vehicles is the general class and is, therefore, referred to as the superclass. The objects (i.e. truck, car, trailer, and motorcycle) are all special cases of the general class, and are therefore referred to as subclasses of the vehicle class.




(3) Class Definitions




Example OOP class definitions are now described. The functions performed by the methods included in the class definitions, and the type of information stored in and/or passed as parameters in the variables of the classes depicted, will be apparent to those skilled in the art.




(a) Soft Switch Class





FIG. 4B

depicts a soft switch OOP class


418


. Soft switch class


418


may be instantiated to create a soft switch application object. Related OOP classes will be described with reference to

FIGS. 4C

,


4


D and


4


E.




Soft switch class


418


includes variables


420


and methods


422


. Variables


420


include information about a soft switch


204


, including soft switch


204


's identifier (ID), error message information, RNECP information, alarm server information, and run time parameters. Variables


420


can be used to provide information to the methods


422


included in soft switch class


418


.




Methods


422


can include a method to start a soft switch to receive information, to receive a message, to receive a response to a message, and to perform updates. Methods


422


also include the means to read configuration data, to acknowledge messages, to get call context information from a signaling message, and to get call context information from an IPDC message. Methods


422


also include the means to get call context information from a route response, to get call context information from a route server message, and to forward messages.





FIG. 4B

includes SS7 gateway proxy


424


which can have inter-object communication with soft switch class


418


.

FIG. 4B

also includes route server proxy


426


and configuration server proxy


428


, which can also have inter-object communication. These proxies can also be instantiated by soft switch class


418


objects.





FIG. 4B

also includes route response


430


, signaling message


432


, and IPDC message


434


, which can be passed parameters from soft switch class


418


.





FIG. 4F

depicts a block diagram


401


of interprocess communication including the starting of a soft switch command and control functions by a network operations center. Diagram


401


illustrates intercommunications between network operations center (NOC)


2114


, soft switch


204


and configuration server (CS)


206


. NOC


2114


communicates


404


with soft switch


418


to startup soft switch command and control. Soft switch command and control startup registers


405


soft switch


204


with CS


206


by communicating


411


with CS proxy


702


, and accepts configuration information for soft switch


204


from CS


206


.





FIG. 4G

depicts a block diagram of soft switch command and control startup by a network operations center sequencing diagram


413


, including message flows


415


,


417


,


419


,


421


and


423


.





FIG. 4H

depicts a block diagram of soft switch command and control registration with configuration server sequencing diagram


425


, including message flows


427


,


429


,


431


and


433


.





FIG. 4I

depicts a block diagram, of soft switch accepting configuration information from configuration server sequencing diagram


435


, including message flows


437


,


439


,


441


,


443


,


445


and


447


.




(b) Call Context Class





FIG. 4C

illustrates a call context class


438


OOP class definition. Call context class


438


includes variables


440


and methods


442


.




Variables


440


can be used to store information about call context class objects


438


. For example, variables


440


can include signaling message information for an incoming message, signaling message information for an outgoing message, a time stamp, and the number of stored signaling messages.




Methods


442


include various functions which can be performed by call context class


438


. For example, methods


442


include a call context message which passes parameters identifying a call event and a signaling message. Other methods


442


include a function to get an IAM message, to get a call event identifier, to get an originating network ID, to get a terminating network ID, to get a signaling message, and to get a subroute. Methods


442


also include the means to add an ACM message, an ANM message, an REL message, an RLC message, a connect message, and a route response message. Methods


442


also permit call context class


438


to set various states as, for example, that an ACM was sent, an


1


AM was received, an RTP connect was sent, a CONI was received, a connect was sent, an answer was sent, an REL was sent, that the system is idle, that an ANM was sent, or that an RLC was sent. Methods


442


can also get a route.





FIG. 4C

also includes route response


430


, call context repository


444


, call event identifier


448


, and network ID


452


. Call context repository


444


includes methods


446


. Methods


446


include a register function, a function to get call context, and to find call context. Call event identifier


448


includes the function of identifying a call event


450


.




(c) Signaling Message Class





FIG. 4D

includes signaling message class


432


OOP class definition.




Signaling message class


432


includes variables


456


and methods


458


. Variables


456


include an originating message and a type of the message.




Classes


481


inherit from classes


432


, i.e. class


432


is the base class for SS7 signaling messages.




Methods


458


include various signaling message functions which can pass various parameters and receive various parameters. Parameters which can be sent by signaling message functions include the request/response header (Rhs), the signaling message, the network ID, the port, the route response, the IPDC message and the soft switch information. Methods


458


also include the function to set the originating ingress port, to set the network identifier, to get a message type, and to get a network identifier.





FIG. 4D

also includes network ID


452


and route response


430


. Network ID


452


can communicate with signal message class objects


432


. Route response


430


can receive parameters passed by signaling message class objects


432


.

FIG. 4D

also includes ACK message


460


, IAM message


464


, ACM message


468


, ANM message


472


, REL message


476


, and RLC message


480


, collectively referred to as SS7 signaling message class definitions


481


. Each message of SS7 message class definition


481


includes various functions. For example ACK message


460


includes methods


462


, i.e., the ACK message function. IAM message


464


includes methods


466


. Methods


466


include several functions, such as, for example the IAM message function, the get dialed digits function, the get NOA function and the get ANI function. ACM message


468


includes method


470


, which includes function ACM message. ANM message


472


includes methods


474


, which includes the ANM message function. REL message


476


includes methods


478


, which includes the REL message functions. RLC message


486


includes methods


482


, which includes the RLC message functions.




(d) SS7 Gateway Class





FIG. 5B

includes SS7 gateway OOP class definition


532


and SS7 gateway proxy class definition


424


. SS7 gateway class


532


includes variables


534


, including runtime parameters, STP information, point code, and alias point code for an SS7 gateway.





FIG. 5C

depicts a block diagram


536


of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with SS7 gateways. Diagram


536


illustrates intercommunications between SS7 gateways (SS7 GW)


208


and soft switch


204


. SS7 GW


208


communicates


538


,


540


with soft switch


418


. Soft switch


418


communicates


538


with SS7 GW proxy


424


accepting signaling messages from SS7 gateways


208


. Soft switch


418


communicates


540


with SS7 GW proxy


424


sending signaling messages to SS7 gateway


208


. In sending signaling messages, soft switch


204


uses


542


command and control registration of the soft switch


204


with SS7 gateway


208


.





FIG. 5D

depicts a block diagram


542


of interprocess communication including an access server signaling a soft switch to register with SS7 gateways. Diagram


542


illustrates intercommunications between access server


232




a


, soft switch


204


and SS7 gateway


208


. Access server


232




a


communicates


544


with soft switch


418


. Soft switch accepts IPDC messages from access servers from interaction with the servers. This communication extends


544


the soft switch command and control which registers soft switch


204


with SS7 gateways


232




a


. This registration uses


546


interaction between the soft switch and SS7 gateway


424


. SS7 gateway


424


communicates


548


with the soft switch


418


.





FIG. 5E

depicts a block diagram of a soft switch registering with SS7 gateways sequencing diagram


550


, including message flows


552


-


564


.




(e) IPDC Message Class





FIG. 4E

illustrates IPDC message OOP class definition


434


. IPDC message


434


includes variables


484


and methods


486


. Variables


484


include an IPDC identifier for an IPDC message. Methods


486


include IPDC message functions, which pass such parameters as the route node container, RHS, IPDC message, an IN port, an OUT port, and a bay module line channel (BMLC). Methods


486


include the get message type function, the get call event identifier function (i.e. passing the call event identifier variable), and the get IPDC identifier function (i.e., passing the.IPDC identifier variable).




(f) Call Event Identifier Class





FIG. 4E

includes call event identifier


448


in communication with IPDC message class


434


, and route node container class


488


also in communication with IPDC message class


434


for passing parameters.





FIG. 4E

also includes exemplary IPDC messages


495


, which inherit from IPDC base class


434


. IPDC messages


495


include ACR message


490


, ACSI message


492


, CONI connect message


494


, connect message


496


, RCR message


498


, RTP connect message


454


, and TDM cross connect message


497


. IPDC messages can include various methods. For example, ACR message


490


can include ACR message function


493


. Similarly connect message


496


, RCR message


498


, and RTP connect message


454


, can include connect message function


491


, RCR message function


489


, RTP connect function methods, respectively.




(g) Configuration Proxy Class





FIG. 7A

illustrates configuration server proxy OOP class definition


702


. Configuration server proxy


702


includes methods


704


. Methods


704


include multiple functions. For example, methods


704


include the register function, the get configuration data function, the update function, the update all function, and the get data function.





FIG. 7B

depicts a block diagram


706


of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with configuration server (CS)


206


. Diagram


706


illustrates intercommunications between CS


206


and soft switch


204


. CS


206


communicates


708


,


710


with soft switch


418


. Soft switch


418


communicates


708


with CS proxy


702


to register soft switch


204


with CS. Soft switch


418


communicates


710


with CS proxy


702


to permit soft switch


204


to accept configuration information from CS


206


.




(h) Route Server Class





FIG. 8B

depicts route server class diagram


802


. Class diagram


802


includes route server OOP class definition


804


. Route server class


804


includes variables


806


and methods


808


.




Variables


806


include, for a respective route server


212


, an identifier (ID), a ten digit table, a six digit table, a three digit table, a treatment table, a potential term table, an local serving area (LSA) table, a circuit group (CG) table, an destination AD table, a runtime parameters and an alarm server.




Methods


808


include several functions. For example methods


808


include a start function, a receive message function, a receive request function, an update function, a process function and a digit analysis function.





FIG. 8B

includes route server proxy class


426


.





FIG. 8B

also includes route request class


430


, from route objects superclass


803


, which is passed parameters from route server class


804


.





FIG. 8B

also includes route server message class


810


, also from route objects superclass


803


, similarly receiving parameters from route server class


804


.





FIG. 8B

also includes configuration server proxy class


428


, which is in communication with route server class


804


.





FIG. 8B

also includes RTP pool class


812


, chain pool class


814


and modem pool class


818


, all of which are from superclass pools


805


, and are in communication with route server class


804


. Circuit pool class


816


, which is also from a superclass


805


, is also in communication with route server class


804


.




(i) Route Objects Class.





FIG. 8C

illustrates superclass route objects


803


in greater detail.

FIG. 8C

includes route response OOP class definition


430


. Route response class


430


includes variables


820


and methods


822


.




Variables


820


include the type of a route response and a version of the route response. Methods


822


include several functions. For example, methods


822


include the route response function, the get type of route response function, the get call event identifier function, the get originating out BMLC function, the get originating IP function, the get terminating out BMLC function, the get terminating IP function, and the get terminating network ID function.





FIG. 8C

includes route calculator class


824


, including methods


826


, which include a calculate function.





FIG. 8C

includes route server message class


810


, including methods


828


. Methods


828


include several functions, including the route server message function, and the get BMLCs function.





FIG. 8C

includes call event identifier class


448


. Network call event identifier


448


is in communication with route response class


430


.





FIG. 8C

also depicts route request class


832


in communication with call event identifier class


448


. Route request class


832


includes variables


834


and methods


836


.




Variables


834


include the nature of address, the dialed digits, the ANI, version, and the jurisdiction information parameters, of route request class


832


.




Methods


836


include multiple functions. Methods


836


include the route request function, the get dialed digits function, the get nature of address function, and the get network ID function. Network ID class


452


is in communication with route request class


832


. Potential term container class


844


is in communication with route response class


430


.




Route class


840


is in communication with route response class


430


. Route class


840


includes methods


842


. Methods


842


include several functions. For example methods


842


can include a route function, a get next function, a begin function, an end function, a get current function, an add route node function, and an end function. Route node class


846


is in communication with route class


840


.




Route node


846


includes variables


848


and methods


850


. Variables


848


include a BMLC, an IP, a location, and a bay name for a particular route node. Methods


850


include several functions. For example methods


850


can include a get OPC function, a get DPC function, a get terminating CIC (TCIC) function, a get IP function, a reserve function, a route node function, a get type function, a match function, a get pool function and a get BMLC function.




Call event identifier class


448


is in communication with route node class


846


. Route node class


846


has additional route node subclasses


851


. Route node subclasses


851


include MLC route node class


852


, modem route node class


856


, RTP route node class


858


and treatment route node class


862


. MLC route node class


852


includes methods


854


. Methods


854


includes several functions. For example methods


854


can include a match function, an are you available function, a get BMLC function and an unreserve function.




RTP route node class


858


includes methods


860


. Methods


860


include several functions, e.g., a get address port pair function. Treatment route node class


862


includes variables


864


, e.g., an announcement to play variable. RTP route node class


858


has two subclasses, i.e. IP address class


866


and IP port class


868


.




Finally,

FIG. 8C

includes route node container class


488


. Route node container class


488


includes methods


853


. Methods


853


can include several functions, e.g., a begin function, a get current function, and a next function.





FIG. 8F

depicts a block diagram


894


of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with route server (RS)


212


. Diagram


894


illustrates intercommunications between RS


212


and soft switch


204


. RS


804


accepts


896


route requests from soft switch


418


and sends


898


route responses from RS


804


to soft switch


418


. Soft switch manages ports by using RS


804


to process


899


unallocate messages from soft switch


418


.




(j) Pool Class





FIG. 8D

depicts superclass pool class


870


. Pool class


870


includes methods


872


, including a get route node function and a find route node function. Pool class


870


has a plurality of subpool classes


871


.




Subpool classes


871


include modem pool class


818


, real-time transport protocol (RTP) pool class


812


, and chain pool class


814


. RTP pool class


812


includes methods


876


.




Methods


876


include several functions, including a get originating route node function, a get terminating out route node function and a get route node function. Chain pool class


814


includes methods


878


, including a get function, a get route node function, a get chain pair function and a get route node function. In communication with modem pool class


818


is modem route node class


856


, which is a subclass from route objects


803


. In communication with chain pool class


814


is chain pair class


874


. Chain pair class


874


includes methods


880


, including a match MLC route node function, a match function and an are you available function. Chain pair class


874


is in communication with MLC route node class


852


, i.e., a subclass of route objects class


803


.




(k) Circuit Pool Class





FIG. 8E

illustrates circuit pool class


816


having methods


886


, including a get circuit function. In communication with circuit pool class


816


is a circuit class


882


having methods


888


, including a get route node function. In communication with circuit class


882


is circuit group class


884


having variables


890


and methods


892


. Variables


890


include a trunk group reference and a type for circuit groups of circuit group class


884


. Methods


892


include an any available function. Method ID class


452


is in communication with circuit class


882


.

FIG. 8E

also includes module line channel (MLC) route node class


852


from the route objects superclass.




2. Gateway Site





FIG. 10A

depicts a more detailed drawing


1000


of gateway site


108


.

FIG. 10A

includes gateway site


108


comprising TG


232


, NAS


228


, AG


238


, DACS


242


and announcement server ANS


246


. TG


232


, NAS


228


and AG


238


collectively are referred to as access server


254


. DACs


242


could also be considered an access server


254


if it can be controlled by soft switch


204


.




TG


232


, NAS


228


and AG


238


are connected via an IP interface connection to data network


112


. TG


232


, NAS


228


, AG


238


are connected via separate interface to network management component


118


. Specifically, TG


232


is connected to network management component


118


via interface


1002


. NAS


228


is connected to network management component


118


via interface


1004


. Also, AG


238


is connected to network management component


118


via interface


1006


.




In addition,

FIG. 10A

includes ANS


246


, which as pictured is connected directly via the IP connection to data network


112


. Alternatively, the ANS can functionally exist in other areas of the telecommunications network. For example, ANS


246


can functionality exist in TG


232


, as depicted by ANS


1008


, TG


232


having ANS functionality


1008


. Similarly, ANS functionality (shown as ANS


1010


) can be provided by AG


238


.





FIG. 10A

includes customer facility


128


, providing access for calling party


122


to AG


238


via a direct access line or dedicated access line (e.g., a PRI or T


1


). In a preferred embodiment, signaling for calling party


122


is carried inband between customer facility


128


and AG


238


via a signaling channel, e.g., an integrated services digital network (ISDN) data channel (D-channel). Calling party


102


, on the other hand, is connected via carrier facility


126


to DACS


242


, in order to provide connectivity to TG


232


and NAS


228


. In a preferred embodiment, signaling for calling party


102


is carried out-of-band over signaling network


114


, as shown in FIG.


10


A.





FIG. 10B

depicts a block diagram


1012


of interprocess communication including soft switch interaction with access servers such as trunking gateway


232




a


. Diagram


1012


illustrates intercommunications between access server


232




a


and soft switch


204


. Soft switch


418


accepts


1014


IPDC messages from access server


232




a


. Soft switch


418


sends


1016


IPDC messages to access server


232




a.






a. Trunking Gateway (TG)




A TG is a gateway enabling termination of PSTN co-carrier trunks and feature group-D (FG-D) circuits.

FIG. 11A

illustrates an exemplary TG


232


. Gateway common media processing is illustrated in

FIGS. 11B and 11C

below. Gateway common media processing on the ingress side will be described with reference to FIG.


11


B. Gateway common media processing on the egress side will be described with reference to FIG.


11


C.




Specifically,

FIG. 11A

depicts a trunking gateway high level functional architecture


1100


for TG


232


.

FIG. 11A

includes calling party


102


, connected via carrier facility


126


to DS


3


trunks, which in turn provide connection to TG


232


. Signaling for a call from calling party


102


is carried via out-of-band signaling network


114


, through SS7 gateway


208


, to soft switch


204


. This is shown with signaling


1118


.




TG


232


is controlled by soft switch


204


, via the IPDC protocol


1116


through data network


112


. TG


232


includes PSTN interface card


1102


connecting TG


232


to the incoming DS


3


trunks from the PSTN. PSTN interface card


1102


is connected to a time division multiplexed (TDM) bus


1104


.




TDM bus


1104


takes the incoming DS


3


trunks and separates the trunks, using time division multiplexing, into separate DS


1


signals


1106


. DS


1




1106


can be encoded/decoded via, for example, DSP-based encoder/decoder


1108


. Encoder/decoder


1108


typically performs a voice compression, such as G.723.1, G.729, or simply breaks out G.711 64 kbps DS


0


channels. Encoder/decoder


1108


is connected to packet bus


1110


, for packetizing the incoming digital signals. Packet bus


1110


, in turn, is connected to IP Interface cards


1112


-


1114


. IP Interface cards


1112


-


1114


provide connectivity to data network


112


for transmission of VOIP packets to distant gateways and control messages to soft switch


204


.




TG


232


also includes network management IP interface


1002


for receiving and sending network management alarms and events via the simple network management protocol (SNMP) to network management component


118


.




Trunks can handle switched voice traffic and data traffic. For example, trunks can include digital signals DS


1


-DS


4


transmitted over T


1


-T


4


carriers. Table 17 provides typical carriers, along with their respective digital signals, number of channels, and bandwidth capacities.

















TABLE 17












Number




Designation




Bandwidth in







Digital




of




of




Megabits per







signal




channels




carrier




second (Mbps)





























DS0




  1




None




0.064







DS1




 24




T1




1.544







DS2




 96




T2




6.312







DS3




 672




T3




44.736







DS4




4032




T4




274.176















Alternatively, trunks can include optical carriers (OCs), such as OC-1, OC-3, etc. Table 18 provides typical optical carriers, along with their respective synchronous transport signals (STSs), ITU designations, and bandwidth capacities.















TABLE 18










Electrical




International








signal, or




Telecommuni-






Optical




synchronous




cations Union




Bandwidth in






carrier




transport signal




(ITU)




Megabits per






(OC) signal




(STS)




terminology




second (Mbps)


























OC-1 




STS-1 





51.84






OC-3 




STS-3 




STM-1 




155.52






OC-9 




STS-9 




STM-3 




466.56






OC-12




STS-12




STM-4 




622.08






OC-18




STS-18




STM-6 




933.12






OC-24




STS-24




STM-8 




1244.16






OC-36




STS-36




STM-12




1866.24






OC-48




STS-48




STM-16




2488.32














With reference to

FIGS. 2A and 11A

, TGs


232


and


234


can receive call control messages from and send messages to soft switch


204


, via the IPDC protocol. Soft switch site


104


implements a signaling stack, e.g., an SS7 signaling network stack, for communications with legacy PSTN devices. On the ingress side of the telecommunications network, ingress trunking gateway


232


seizes a circuit as a call is initiated (i.e. assuming calling party


102


is placing a call to called party


120


).




As the circuit is seized at call initiation, SS7 signaling network


114


begins the process of setting up a call, by sending messages via SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


. As the call progresses, ingress TG


232


can receive commands from soft switch


204


to complete the call through ingress TG


232


and out through the virtual voice network via the IP interface


1114


to a destination gateway.




On the egress side of the network, this process is reversed to complete the call through the interconnected network to egress trunking gateway


234


and ultimately to called party


120


.





FIG. 11B

depicts gateway common media processing components on the ingress side


1140


.

FIG. 11B

begins with incoming media stream


1142


. From incoming media stream


1142


, tone detection


1144


can occur and then data detection


1146


can occur or tone detection


1144


can be bypassed (see path


1148


), as disabled/enabled by soft switch


204


via IPDC. From data detection


1146


, silence detection/suppression


1150


can be performed. Next, a coder


1152


can be processed and then the packet stream can be transferred, as shown in


11




54


.





FIG. 11B

is now described with respect to ingress trunking gateway


232


. Incoming media stream


1142


must be processed as it passes through ingress gateway


232


to complete the call via the IP core data network


112


.




The first process that takes place is data detection process


1146


. Data detection process


1146


attempts to detect the media type of the call traffic. The media type of the call traffic can include voice, data and modem. The media type information can be passed via IPDC protocol to soft switch


204


for process determination.




In one embodiment, no additional processing is required. In another embodiment, a compression/decompression software component (CODEC) that is used in performing media processing, can be selected based on data detection process


1146


. Specifically, if the data is determined to be modem traffic and if a suitable CODEC exists for the data rate, soft switch


204


can choose to incorporate this CODEC on the stream. Alternatively, if the call is a voice call, soft switch


204


can select the CODEC optimized for voice processing and current network conditions. In an embodiment of the invention, data calls can always be processed with the default bit rate CODEC.




In silence detection and suppression process


1150


, silence in a voice call can be detected and suppressed, yielding potential decreases in the volume of transmission of packets carrying no digitized voice, due to silence.




In encoding process


1152


, once a CODEC has been chosen by soft switch


204


or the decision is made to use the default CODEC, the media stream passes through a digital signal processor (DSP)


1108


to apply an appropriate compression algorithm. This compression processing algorithm can take the media stream as a traditional stream from the traditional voice world and transform it into a stream suitable for digital packetization. Once these packets have been formed, ingress TG


232


can process the packets into IP packets and prepare the packets for transport through the IP backbone


112


to egress TG


234


.




On the egress side of the network, packetized media is converted back to a digital stream. Specifically, egress TG


234


can take the packets from data network


112


and decompress them and decode them with the same DSP process and algorithm used on the ingress side of the network.





FIG. 11C

depicts exemplary gateway common media processing components on the egress side


1120


.

FIG. 11C

begins with egress TG


234


receiving packets


1122


. Next, packets are buffered to compensate for jitter


1124


, and comfort noise


1126


can be inserted into the call. Comfort background noise process


1126


can provide reassurance to the party on the other end of the call that the call has not been interrupted, but instead that the other party is merely being silent. Next, decoding process


1128


can be performed by DSP


1108


and echo processing


1130


can detect and cancel echo. Finally, digital bit stream media, (e.g., a DS


0


), is transferred to a telephony interface (e.g., a DS


3


port).




Additional media stream processing functions internal to TGs


232


,


234


can include, for example, the ancillary processes of silence detection and suppression


1150


, voice activation, and comfort noise insertion


1126


. The media stream processing functions include, for example, the major core functionality needed for TGs


232


,


234


.




Other functional components needed in trunking gateways


232


,


234


can also be included. Other functional components can include the provisioning and maintenance of trunking gateways


232


,


234


.




(1) Trunking Gateway Interfaces




TGs


232


,


234


provide voice network connectivity to the traditional public switched telephone network (PSTN). TGs


232


,


234


can accept co-carrier and feature group-D (FG-D) trunks. It would be apparent to those skilled in the art that TGs


232


,


234


can accept other telecommunications trunks. TGs


232


,


234


allow for termination of SS7 signaled calls to and from telecommunications network


200


.




TGs


232


,


234


can convert the media stream into packets for transmission over data network


112


. TGs


232


,


234


also provide a management interface for remote management, control and configuration changes. TGs


232


,


234


can interface to multiple components of telecommunications network


200


. For example, TGs


232


,


234


can interface with, for example, the PSTN for carrying media, soft switch


204


for communication of control messages from soft switch


204


, the voice network interface of data network


112


for carrying packetized voice media, and network management component


118


for sending SNMP alerts to the network operation center (NOC).




TGs


232


,


234


interface to the PSTN via co-carrier or FG-D trunks. These trunks are groomed via DACS


242


,


244


, to allow multiple two-way 64 kilobits per second (KPS) circuits to pass the media stream into and out of TGs


232


,


234


. The PSTN interface to TGs


232


,


234


provides all low level hardware control for the individual circuits and allows the interface to look like another switch connection to the PSTN network.




TGs


232


,


234


also interface with soft switch


204


. Referring to

FIG. 4A

, the TG to soft switch interface


412


is used to pass information needed to control the multiple media streams. Soft switch


204


controls all available circuit channels that connect through TGs


232


,


234


. TG to soft switch interface


412


uses the physical IP network interface cards (NICs)


1112


-


1114


to send and receive control information to and from soft switch


204


using the IPDC protocol. The IPDC protocol will be described in greater detail below.




Referring to

FIG. 11A

, TGs


232


,


234


interface with a voice virtual private network (VPN) that is overlaid on an IP data network


112


. The TG to voice VPN interface sends or receives voice packets on the IP side of the network from TGs


232


,


234


to other network components, e.g., to another of TGs


232


,


234


. TG to voice VPN interface, in a preferred embodiment, can physically be a


100


BaseT Ethernet interface, but can be logically divided into virtual ports that can be addressable via soft switch


204


. The media stream can be connected through this interface, i.e., the TG to voice VPN interface, to a distant connection with a real-time transport protocol (RTP) connection.




TGs


232


,


234


can also interface with network management component (NMC)


118


for the purposes of communicating network management SNMP alerts. The TGs


232


,


234


to SNMP interface is a management interface that can be connected to NMC


118


of the network management network through a dedicated connection on TGs


232


,


234


. SNMP messages that are generated at TGs


232


,


234


can be passed to the network operations center (NOC) through the TG to SNMP interface. In addition, messages and commands from the NOC can be passed to TGs


232


,


234


through this interface for several purposes including, for example, network management, configuration and control.




b. Access Gateway (AG)




An AG is a gateway that enables customers to connect via a Direct Access Line (DAL) from their customer premise equipment (CPE), such as, for example, a private branch exchange (PBX), to the telecommunications network. The AG terminates outgoing and incoming calls between the CPE, the telecommunications network and the PSTN.





FIG. 12

depicts an AG high level functional architecture


1200


.

FIG. 12

includes calling party


122


, connected via customer facility


128


to DAL (e.g., either an ISDN PRI or a T


1


DAL). A PRI DAL is connected from the PSTN-to-PSTN interface card


1202




a


. PSTN interface card


1202




a


includes ISDN signaling and media, meaning it includes both bearer channels (B-channels) for carrying media and data channels (D-channels) for carrying ISDN signaling information.




A T


1


DAL can be connected from the PSTN to a PSTN interface card


1202




b


, supporting T


1


in-band channel associated signaling (CAS). PSTN interface cards


1202




a


,


1202




b


are connected to TDM bus


1204


. Using TDM bus


1204


, incoming T


1


and PRI signals are broken into separate DS


1


signals


1206


.




DS


1




1206


is then encoded via DSP-based encode/decode


1208


. After encoding via DSP-based encode/decode


1208


, the signal is packetized via packet bus


1210


, to be transmitted via IP interface cards


1212


-


1214


, over data network


112


. IP packets containing signaling information (e.g., D-channel) are routed to soft switch


204


. IP packets containing media are transmitted to other media gateways, i.e. access servers such as an AG or TG




IP interface card


1214


includes both control and signaling information in its packets. This is illustrated showing IPDC protocol control information


1216


and signaling information


1218


.




AG


238


delivers signaling information inband over data network


112


to soft switch


204


. Accordingly, calling party


122


need not have its customer facility


128


have connectivity with SS7 signaling network


114


.




AG


238


is functionally equivalent to TG


232


. AG


238


differs from TG


232


only in the circuit types and scale of the terminated circuits supported. The circuit types and scale of terminated circuits supported drives the line side cards and signaling that AG


238


provides to a PBX or other customer facility


128


. The circuit associated and in-band signaling provided by the PBX or customer facility


128


must be passed from AG


238


to soft switch


204


via the IPDC protocol. AG


238


receives call-processing information from soft switch


204


.




(1) Access Gateway Interfaces




AGs


238


,


240


interface to several components of telecommunications network


200


. The interfaces of AGs


238


,


240


include interfaces facing the network, i.e., data network


112


, and network management component


118


, as described for TGs


232


,


234


above. AGs


238


,


240


also interface on the line side, through line side card interfaces, which can be needed to support in-band T


1


and ISDN primary rate interface (ISDN PRI) circuits.




In-band T


1


and ISDN PRI interfaces can be provisioned on an as-needed basis on AGs


238


,


240


, to support the equipment that can terminate the circuit on the far end. The ISDN PRI can support standard ISDN circuit associated D-channel signaling in the 23B+1D, NB+1D and NB+2D (bearer (B-) and data (D-) channel) configurations. For the in-band signaling T


1


configuration, the circuit can support wink start or loop start signaling.




The next six paragraphs briefly introduce wink start, loop start, and ground start signaling as would be apparent to a person having ordinary skill in the relevant communications signaling art.




Wink start refers to seizing a circuit by using a short duration signal. The signal is typically of a 140 millisecond duration. The wink indicates the availability of an incoming register for receiving digital information from a calling switch. Wink starts are used in telephone systems which use address signaling.




Loop start refers to seizing a circuit using a supervisory signal. A loop start signal is typically generated by taking the phone off hook. With a loop start, a line is seized by bridging a tip and ring (i.e., the wires of the telephone line) through a resistance. A loop start trunk is the most common type of trunk found in residential installations. The ring lead is connected to −48 V and the tip lead is connected to 0 V (i.e., connected to ground). To initiate a call, a “loop” ring can be formed through the telephone to the tip. A central office (CO) can ring a telephone by sending an AC voltage to the ringer within the telephone. When the telephone goes off-hook, the DC loop is formed. The CO detects the loop and the fact that it is drawing a DC current, and stops sending the ringing voltage.




Ground starting refers to seizing a trunk, where one side of a two-wire trunk (the ring conductor of the tip and ring) is temporarily grounded to get a dial tone. Ground starts are typically used for CO to PBX connections. Ground starting is effectively a handshaking routine that is performed by the CO and PBX. The CO and PBX agree to dedicate a path so that incoming and outgoing calls cannot conflict, so that “glare” cannot occur.




The PBX can check to see if a CO ground start trunk has been dedicated. In order to see if the trunk has been dedicated, the PBX checks to see if the tip lead is grounded. An undedicated ground start trunk has an open relay between 0 V (ground) and the tip lead connected to the PBX. If the trunk has been dedicated, the CO will close the relay and ground the tip lead.




In a ground start, the PBX can also indicate to the CO that it requires a trunk. The PBX has a PBX CO caller circuit. The PBX CO caller circuit can call a CO ground start trunk. The PBX CO caller circuit briefly grounds the ring lead causing DC current to flow. The CO detects the current flow and interprets it as a request for service from the PBX.




“Glare” occurs when both ends of a telephone line or trunk are seized at the same time for different purposes or by different users. Glare resolution refers to the ability of a system to ensure that if a trunk is seized by both ends simultaneously, then one caller is given priority, and the other is switched to another trunk.




AGs


238


and


240


interface to the PSTN via T


1


CAS signaling and ISDN PRI trunks. ISDN PRI trunks are groomed via the DACS


242


and


244


to allow multiple two-way 64 kps circuits to pass signaling information circuits to pass signaling information and the media stream into and out of AGs


238


and


240


. The AG to PSTN interface provides all low level hardware control for the individual circuits. The AG to PSTN interfaces, specifically, PSTN interface cards


1202




a


and


1202


, also allow the interface to look like a switch connection to the PSTN network.




AG to soft switch interface


414


can be used to pass information needed to control multiple media streams. Soft switch


204


can control all available circuit channels that connect through AGs


238


,


240


. AG to soft switch interface


414


can use the physical voice network interface card to send and receive control information to and from soft switch


204


using the IPDC protocol.




AGs


238


,


240


can have a separate physical interface to network management component (NMC)


118


. AG


238


has network management IP interface


1006


, which sends network management alarms and events in the SNMP protocol format to NMC


118


. The AG to NMC interface can be used for delivery of SNMP messages and additional functions. Examples of additional functions that can be defined include, for example, functions for provisioning, updating, and passing special alarms and performance parameters to AGs


238


,


240


from the network operation center (NOC) of NMC


118


.




c. Network Access Server (NAS)




NASs


228


,


230


accept control information from soft switch


204


and process the media stream accordingly. Modem traffic is routed to the internal processes within NASs


228


,


230


to terminate the call and route the data traffic out to data network


112


. The reader is directed to U.S. Patent Application entitled “System and Method for Bypassing Data from Egress Facilities”, filed concurrently herewith, Attorney Docket No. 1757.0060000, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, describing with greater details the interaction between NASs


228


,


230


and control server soft switch


204


.





FIG. 13

depicts a NAS high-level architecture


1300


.

FIG. 13

includes calling party


102


calling into carrier facility


126


. Its signaling information is routed via out-of-band signaling network


114


to SS7 GW


208


. The signaling information


1318


is sent to soft switch


204


.




NAS


228


receives trunk interfaces from the PSTN at PSTN interface card


1302


. PSTN interface card


1302


is connected to TDM bus


1304


.




TDM bus


1304


, in turn, can break out separate DS


1


signals


1306


. These DS


1


signals


1306


can be terminated to modems


1308


. Modem


1308


can convert the incoming data stream from a first format to a second format over packet bus


1310


to IP interface card


1312


or


1314


. It is important to note that IP interfaces


1312


and


1314


are the same.




Interface card


1312


carries media (e.g., data, voice traffic, etc.) over data network


112


. The media can be sent over multiple routers in data network


112


to the media's final destination. IP interface card


1314


transmits packets of information through data network


112


to soft switch


204


, including control information


1316


in the IPDC protocol format. Interface cards


1312


and


1314


can also perform additional functions




NAS


228


includes network management interface card (NMIC)


1004


, for providing network management alarms and events in an SNMP protocol format to network management component


118


.




(1) Network Access Server Interfaces




Telecommunications network


200


supports interaction with NASs via communication of control information from soft switch


204


. The interfaces between NASs


228


,


230


and the other network components of telecommunications network


200


, can be identical to those found on TGs


232


,


234


, with the exception of the FG-D interface.




NASs


228


,


230


can interface to the PSTN via co-carrier trunks. The co-carrier trunks can be groomed via the DACS


242


,


244


, to allow multiple two-way 64 kps circuits to pass the media stream into and out of NASs


228


,


230


. The NASs to PSTN interface provides all low level hardware control for the individual circuits. The NASs to PSTN interface looks like another switch connection to the PSTN network.




NASs


228


,


230


interface with soft switch


204


in order to pass information required to control the multiple media streams. Soft switch


204


, via the NASs to soft switch interface, can control all available circuit channels that connect through NASs


228


,


230


. The interface between NASs


228


,


230


and soft switch


204


uses the physical voice network interface card (NIC) to send and receive control information to and from soft switch


204


and NASs


228


,


230


via the IPDC protocol.




NASs


228


,


230


can interface with the backbone network of data network


112


. The NASs to backbone interface of data network


112


can allow the media stream to access the data network


112


and to terminate to any termination with an IP address including public Internet and world wide web sites, and other Internet service providers (ISP). This modem traffic media stream can be separate from any voice data media stream that is carried over the backbone. Modem traffic can enter NASs


228


,


230


in the form of serial line interface protocol (SLIP) or a point to point protocol (PPP) protocol and can be terminated to modems and can then be converted into another protocol, such as, for example, an IPX, an Apple Talk, a DECNET protocol, an RTP protocol, an Internet protocol (IP) protocol, a transmission control protocol/user datagram protocol (UDP), or any other appropriate protocol for routing to, for example, another private network destination.




NASs


228


,


230


can use a separate physical interface for communication of SNMP alerts and messages to NMC


118


. The NAS to NMC interface can be used for additional functions. Examples of additional functions that can be defined include, for example, provisioning, updating, and passing special alarms, and performance parameters to NASs


228


,


230


from the network operations center (NOC).




d. Digital Cross-Connect System (DACS)





FIG. 14

illustrates exemplary DACS


242


in detail. DACS


242


is a time division multiplexer providing switching capability for incoming trunks.




Referring to

FIG. 14

, voice and data traffic comes into DACS


242


from carrier facility


126


on incoming trunks. DACS


242


receives a signal from soft switch


204


(over data network


112


) indicating how DACS


242


is to switch the traffic. Depending on the signal provided by soft switch


204


, DACS


242


can switch the incoming traffic onto either circuits directed to TG


232


, or circuits directed to NAS


228


.




More generally, a DACS


242


is a digital switching machine, employed to manage or “groom” traffic at a variety of different traffic speeds. Grooming functions of DACS


242


include the consolidation of traffic from partly filled incoming lines with a common destination and segregation of incoming traffic of differing types and destinations. A traditional DACS


242


can have one of several available architectures. Example architectures, which accommodate different data rates and total port counts, include narrowband (or 1/0), wideband (or 3/1), and broadband (or 3/3).




As backbone traffic has grown, with increased data traffic, there is an emerging need for even higher capacity DACS


242


, having interface speeds of OC-48 and beyond, as well as cell and packet-switching capabilities to accommodate the increasing data traffic.




As data traffic continues to grow, increasing the demands of telecommunications networks, and as through-put speeds increase, DACS (e.g., DACS


242


) are migrating to include higher-speed switching matrices capable of terabit throughput. DACS


242


can also include high-speed optical interfaces.




Telecommunications network


200


can also make use of virtual DACS (VDACS). VDACS are conceptually the use of a computer software controlled circuit switch. For example, a DACS can be built which is capable of intercommunicating with a soft switch via, a protocol such as, for example, internet protocol device control (IPDC), to perform the functionality of a DACS.




In one embodiment of the invention, a NAS is used to terminate co-carrier, or local trunks, and a TG is used to terminate long distance trunks. In such a system, if a voice call were to come in over a NAS, then the voice call could be transmitted to the TG for termination. One approach that can be used to terminate this voice call includes occupying an outgoing channel to transmit the call out of the NAS and into the TG. Another approach uses a commandable DACS, a VDACS. The VDACS can cross-connect on command, so as to act as a commandable circuit switch. In practice, the soft switch can send a command down to the VDACS via IPDC, for example. A VDACS can be built by using a traditional DACS with the addition of application program logic supporting control and communication with a soft switch.




e. Announcement Server (ANS)




Referring back to

FIGS. 2A and 10A

, ANSs


246


,


248


store pre-recorded announcements on disk in an encoded format. ANSs


246


,


248


provide telecommunications network


200


with the ability to play pre-recorded messages and announcements, at the termination of a call. For example, ANSs


246


,


248


can play a message stating that “all circuits are busy.”




In one embodiment, the functionality of ANSs


246


,


248


can be included in TG


232


and/or AG


238


. The features of this embodiment are dependent on the amount of resources in TG


232


and AG


238


. This internal announcement server capability is shown in

FIG. 10A

, including, for example, ANS


1008


in TG


232


and ANS


1010


in AG


238


. It would be apparent to those skilled in the art that ANS functionality can be placed in other systems, such as, for example, soft switch


204


and NAS


1004


.




In another embodiment, ANSs


246


,


248


are applications running on one or more separate servers, as shown in FIG.


15


.

FIG. 15

depicts an announcement server (ANS) component interface design


1500


.

FIG. 15

includes ANS


246


, which is in communication with TG


232


, AG


238


and soft switch


204


over data network


112


. ANS


246


can be controlled by soft switch


204


via the IPDC protocol. ANS


246


can send network management alerts and events to network management component (NMC)


118


. Data distributor


222


can send announcement files to ANS


246


.




A benefit of providing separate ANSs


246


,


248


is that a more robust database of announcements can be stored and made available for use by the soft switch than is supported in conventional networks. Another benefit of a separate ANS


246


,


248


is that less storage is required in TGs and AGs since the announcement functionality is supported by the server of ANSs


246


,


248


server. ANSs


246


,


248


can be controlled by one or more soft switches to play the voice messages, via the IPDC protocol.




After determining that an announcement should be played, Soft switch


204


chooses an ANS


246


or


248


that is closest to the point of origination for the call, if available. The ANS and gateway site establish a real-time transport protocol (RTP) session for the transmission of the voice announcement. Then ANS


246


or


248


streams the file over RTP to the terminating gateway. When the message is complete, ANSs


246


,


248


can replay the message or disconnect the call.




ANSs


246


,


248


can store the message files in each of the media coder/decoders (CODECs) that the network supports. ANSs


246


,


248


can send announcements stored in the format of the G.711, G.726, and G.728, and other standard CODECs. The soft switch can direct ANS


246


,


248


to play announcements using other CODECS if the network enters a state of congestion. Soft switch


204


can also direct ANS


246


,


248


to play announcements using other CODECs if the gateway or end client is an IP client that only supports a given CODEC. In another embodiment, the CODEC of an announcement can be modified while the announcement is playing.




ANS


246


will now be described with greater detail with reference to FIG.


15


. ANS


246


has several interfaces. ANS interfaces include the provisioning, control, alarming, and voice path interfaces. ANS


246


also has several data paths. The path from ANS


246


to TG


232


or to AG


238


, have a common voice path interface (i.e., which is the same for TG


232


and AG


238


). The voice path interface can use RTP and RTCP.




In a preferred embodiment, ANS


246


to soft switch


204


interface provides for a data path using the internet protocol device control (IPDC) protocol to control announcement server


246


.




The ANS


246


to SNMP agent in network management component


118


data path is used to send alarm and event information from ANS


246


to SNMP agent via SNMP protocol.




Data distributor


222


to announcement server


246


data path carries announcement files between announcement server


246


and data distributor


222


. The provisioning interface downloads, via a file transfer protocol (FTP), encoded voice announcement files to announcement server


246


.




Announcement server


246


uses a separate physical interface for all SNMP messages and additional functions that can be defined. Examples of additional functions that can be defined include provisioning, updating, and passing of special alarms and performance parameters to announcement servers


246


from NOC


2114


.




In another embodiment, announcement server


246


is located in soft switch site


104


. It would be apparent to those skilled in the art that announcement server


246


could be placed in other parts of telecommunications network


200


.




3. Data Network




In an example embodiment, data network


112


can be a packet-switched network. A packet-switched network such as, for example, an ATM network, unlike a circuit switch network, does not require dedicated circuits between originating and terminating locations within the packet switch network. The packet-switched network instead breaks a message into pieces known as packets of information. Such packets are then encapsulated with a header which designates a destination address to which the packet must be routed. The packet-switched network then takes the packets and routes them to the destination designated by the destination address contained in the header of the packet.





FIG. 16A

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary soft switch/gateway network architecture


1600


.

FIG. 16A

illustrates a more detailed version of an exemplary data network


112


. In an exemplary embodiment, data network


112


is a packet-switched network, such as, for example, an asynchronous transfer mode (ATM) network.

FIG. 16

includes western soft switch site


104


and gateway sites


108


,


110


connected to one another via data network


112


. Data is routed from western soft switch


104


to gateway sites


108


,


110


through data network


112


, via a plurality of routers located in western soft switch site


104


and gateway sites


108


,


110


.




Western soft switch site


104


of

FIG. 16A

includes soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


,


204




c


, SS7 GWs


208


,


210


, CSs


206




a


,


206




b


, RSs


212




a


,


212




b


and RNECPs


224




a


,


224




b


, all interconnected by redundant connections to ethernet switches (ESs)


332


,


334


. ESs


332


,


334


are used to interconnect the host computers attached to them, to create an ethernet-switched local area network (LAN). ESs


332


,


334


are redundantly connected to routers


320


,


322


. The host computers in the local area network included in western soft switch site


104


can communicate with host computers in other local area networks, e.g., at gateway sites


108


,


110


, via routers


320


,


322


.




Gateway site


108


of

FIG. 16A

includes TGs


232




a


,


232




b


, AGs


238




a


,


238




b


and NASs


228




a


,


228




b


,


228




c


, interconnected via redundant connections to ESs


1602


,


1604


. ESs


1602


,


1604


interconnect the multiple network devices to create a LAN. Information can be intercommunicated to and from host computers on other LANs via routers


1606


,


1608


at gateway site


108


. Routers


1606


,


1608


are connected by redundant connections to ESs


1602


,


1604


.




Gateway site


110


of

FIG. 16A

includes TGs


234




a


,


234




b


, AGs


240




a


,


240




b


, and NASs


230




a


,


230




b


,


230




c


, connected via redundant connections to ESs


1610


,


1612


to form a local area network. Ethernet switches (ESs)


1610


,


1612


can in turn intercommunicate information between the LAN in gateway site


110


and LANs at other sites, e.g., at western soft switch site


104


and gateway site


108


via routers


1614


,


1616


. Routers


1614


,


1616


are connected to ESs


1610


,


1612


via redundant connections.




Routers


320


,


322


of western soft switch site


104


, routers


1606


,


1608


of gateway site


108


, and routers


1614


,


1616


of gateway site


110


can be connected via NICs, such as, for example, asynchronous transfer mode (ATM) interface cards in routers


320


,


322


,


1606


,


1608


,


1614


,


1616


and physical media such as, for example, optical fiber link connections, and/or copper wire connections. Routers


320


,


322


,


1606


,


1608


,


1614


,


1616


transfer information between one another and intercommunicate according to routing protocols.




a. Routers




Data network


112


can include a plurality of network routers. Network routers are used to route information between multiple networks. Routers act as an interface between two or more networks. Routers can find the best path between any two networks, even if there are several different networks between the two networks.




Network routers can include tables describing various network domains. A domain can be thought of as a local area network (LAN) or wide area network (WAN). Information can be transferred between a plurality of LANs and/or WANs via network devices known as routers. Routers look at a packet and determine from the destination address in the header of the packet the destination domain of the packet. If the router is not directly connected to the destination domain, then the router can route the packet to the router's default router, i.e. a router higher in a hierarchy of routers. Since each router has a default router to which it is attached, a packet can be transmitted through a series of routers to the destination domain and to the destination host bearing the packet's final destination address.




b. Local Area Networks (LANs) and Wide Area Networks (WANs)




A local area network (LAN) can be thought of as a plurality of host computers interconnected via network interface cards (NICs) in the host computers. The NICs are connected via, for example, copper wires so as to permit communication between the host computers. Examples of LANs include an ethernet bus network, an ethernet switch network, a token ring network, a fiber digital data interconnect (FDDI) network, and an ATM network.




A wide area network (WAN) is a network connecting host computers over a wide area. In order for host computers on a particular LAN to communicate with a host computer on another LAN or on a WAN, network interfaces interconnecting the LANs and WANs must exist. An example of a network interface is a router discussed above.




A network designed to interconnect multiple LANs and/or WANs is known as an internet. An internet can transfer data between any of a plurality of networks including both LANs and WANs. Communication occurs between host computers on one LAN and host computers on another LAN via, for example, an internet protocol (IP) protocol. The UP protocol requires each host computer of a network to have a unique IP address enabling packets to be transferred over the internet to other host computers on other LANs and/or WANs that are connected to the internet. An internet can comprise a router interconnecting two or more networks.




The “Internet” (with a capital “I”) is a global internet interconnecting networks all over the world. The Internet includes a global network of computers which intercommunicate via the internet protocol (IP) family of protocols.




An “intranet” is an internet which is a private network that uses internet software and internet standards, such as the internet protocol (IP). An intranet can be reserved for use by parties who have been given the authority necessary to use that network.




c. Network Protocols




Data network


112


includes a plurality of wires, and routes making up its physical hardware infrastructure. Network protocols provide the software infrastructure of data network


112


.




Early network protocols and architectures were designed to work with specific proprietary types of equipment. Early examples included IBM systems network architecture (SNA) and Digital Equipment Corporation's DECnet.




Telecommunications vendors have moved away from proprietary network protocols and technologies to multi-vendor protocols. However, it can be difficult for all necessary vendors to agree on how to add new features and services to a multi-vendor protocol. This can be true because vendor-specific protocols can in some cases offer a greater level of sophistication. For example, initial versions of asynchronous transfer mode (ATM) completed by the ATM Forum did not have built-in quality of service (QoS) capabilities. Recent releases of the specification added those features, including parameters for cell-transfer delay and cell-loss ratio. However, interoperability among equipment of different vendors and device performance still need improvement.




The IETF is working on defining certain Internet protocols (IP) “classes of service”. IP classes of service could provide a rough equivalent to ATMs QoS. IP classes of service is included as part of the IETF's integrated services architecture (ISA). ISA's proposed elements include the resource reservation protocol (RSVP), a defined packet scheduler, a call admission control module, an admission control manager, and a set of policies for implementing these features (many of the same concepts already outlined in ATM QoS).




(1) Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol (TCP/IP)




The Internet protocol (IP) has become the primary networking protocol used today. This success is largely a part of the Internet, which is based on the transmission control protocol/internet protocol (TCP/IP) family of protocols. TCP/IP is the most common method of connecting PCs, workstations, and servers. TCP/IP is included as part of many software products, including desktop operating systems (e.g., Microsoft's Windows 95 or Windows NT) and LAN operating systems. To date, however, TCP/IP has lacked some of the desired features needed for mission-critical applications.




The most pervasive LAN protocol to date, has been IPX/SPX from Novell's NetWare network operating system (NOS). However, IPX/SPX is losing ground to TCP/IP. Novell has announced that it will incorporate native IP support into NetWare, ending NetWare's need to encapsulate IPX packets when carrying them over TCP/IP connections. Both UNIX and Windows NT servers can use TCP/IP. Banyan's VINES, IBM's OS/2 and other LAN server operating systems can also use TCP/IP.




(2) Internet Protocol (IP)v4 and IPv6




IPv6 (previously called next-generation IP or IPng) is a backward-compatible extension of the current version of the Internet protocol, IPv4. IPv6 is designed to solve problems brought on by the success of the Internet (such as running out of address space and router tables). IPv6 also adds needed features, including circuiting security, auto-configuration, and real-time services similar to QoS. Increased Internet usage and the allocation of many of the available IP addresses has created an urgent need for increased addressing capacity. IPv4 uses a 32-byte number to form an address, which can offer about 4 billion distinct network addresses. In comparison, IPv6 uses 128-bytes per address, which provides for a much larger number of available addresses.




(3) Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP)




Originally developed to enhance IPv4 with QoS features, RSVP lets network managers allocate bandwidth based on the bandwidth requirements of an application. Basically, RSVP is an emerging communications protocol that signals a router to reserve bandwidth for real-time transmission of data, video, and audio traffic.




Resource reservation protocols that operate on a per-connection basis can be used in a network to elevate the priority of a given user temporarily. RSVP runs end to end to communicate application requirements for special handling. RSVP identifies a session between a client and a server and asks the routers handling the session to give its communications a priority in accessing resources. When the session is completed, the resources reserved for the session are freed for the use of others.




RSVP offers only two levels of priority in its signaling scheme. Packets are identified at each router hop as either low or high priority. However, in crowded networks, two-level classification may not be sufficient. In addition, packets prioritized at one router hop might be rejected at the next.




Accepted as an IETF standard in 1997, RSVP does not attempt to govern who should receive bandwidth, and questions remain about what will happen when several users all demand a large block of bandwidth at the same time. Currently, the technology outlines a first-come, first-served response to this situation. The IETF has formed a task force to address the issue.




Because RSVP provides a special level of service, many people equate QoS with the protocol. For example, Cisco currently uses RSVP in its IPv4-based internetwork router operating system to deliver IPv6-type QoS features. However, RSVP is only a small part of the QoS picture because it is effective only as far as it is supported within a given client/server connection. Although RSVP allows an application to request latency and bandwidth, RSVP does not provide for congestion control or network-wide priority with the traffic flow management needed to integrate QoS across an enterprise.




(4) Real-time Transport Protocol (RTP)




RTP is an emerging protocol for the Internet championed by the audio/video transport workgroup of the IETF. RTP supports real-time transmission of interactive voice and video over packet-switched networks. RTP is a thin protocol that provides content identification, packet sequencing, timing reconstruction, loss detection, and security. With RTP, data can be delivered to one or more destinations, with a limit on delay.




RTP and other Internet real-time protocols, such as the Internet stream protocol version 2 (ST2), focus on the efficiency of data transport. RTP and other Internet real-time protocols are designed for communications sessions that are persistent and that exchange large amounts of data. RTP does not handle resource reservation or QoS control. Instead, RTP relies on resource reservation protocols such as RSVP, communicating dynamically to allocate appropriate bandwidth.




RTP adds a time stamp and a header that distinguishes whether an IP packet is data or voice, allowing prioritization of voice packets, while RSVP allows networking devices to reserve bandwidth for carrying unbroken multimedia data streams.




Real-time Control Protocol (RTCP) is a companion protocol to RTP that analyzes network conditions. RTCP operates in a multi-cast fashion to provide feedback to RTP data sources as well as all session participants. RTCP can be adopted to circumvent datagram transport of voice-over-IP in private IP networks. With RTCP, software can adjust to changing network loads by notifying applications of spikes, or variations, in network transmissions. Using RTCP network feedback, telephony software can switch compression algorithms in response to degraded connections.




(5) IP Multi-Casting Protocols




Digital voice and video comprise of large quantities of data that, when broken up into packets, must be delivered in a timely fashion and in the right order to preserve the qualities of the original content. Protocol developments have been focused on providing efficient ways to send content to multiple recipients, transmission referred to as multi-casting. Multi-casting involves the broadcasting of a message from one host to many hosts in a one-to-many relationship. A network device broadcasts a message to a select group of other devices such as PCS or workstations on a LAN, WAN, or the Internet. For example, a router might send information about a routing table update to other routers in a network.




Several protocols are being implemented for IP multi-casting, including upgrades to the Internet protocol itself For example, some of the changes in the newest version of IP, IPv6, will support different forms of addressing for uni-cast (point-to-point communications), any cast (communications with the closest member of a device group), and multi-cast. Support for IP multi-casting comes from several protocols, including the Internet group management protocol (IGMP), protocol-independent multi-cast (PIM) and distance vector multi-cast routing protocol (DVMRP). Queuing algorithms can also be used to ensure that video or other multi-cast data types arrive when they are supposed to without visible or audible distortion.




Real-time transport protocol (RTP) is currently an IETF draft, designed for end-to-end, real-time delivery of data such as video and voice. RTP works over the user datagram protocol (UDP), providing no guarantee of in-time delivery, quality of service (QoS), delivery, or order of delivery. RTP works in conjunction with a mixer and translator and supports encryption and security. The real-time control protocol (RTCP) is a part of the RTP definition that analyzes network conditions. RTCP provides mandatory monitoring of services and collects information on participants. RTP communicates with RSVP dynamically to allocate appropriate bandwidth.




Internet packets typically move on a first-come, first-serve basis. When the network becomes congested, Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP) can enable certain types of traffic, such as video conferences, to be delivered before less time-sensitive traffic such as E-mail for potentially a premium price. RSVP could change the Internet's pricing structure by offering different QoS at different prices.




The RSVP protocol is used by a host, on behalf of an application, to request a specific QoS from the network for particular data streams or flows. Routers can use the RSVP protocol to deliver QoS control requests to all necessary network nodes to establish and maintain the state necessary to provide the requested service. RSVP requests can generally, although not necessarily, result in resources being reserved in each node along the data path.




RSVP is not itself a routing protocol. RSVP is designed to operate with current and future uni-cast and multi-cast routing protocols. An RSVP process consults the local routing database to obtain routes. In the multi-cast case for example, the host sends IGMP messages to join a multi-cast group and then sends RSVP messages to reserve resources along the delivery paths of that group. Routing protocols determines where packets are forwarded. RSVP is concerned with only the QoS of those packets as they are forwarded in accordance with that routing.




d. Virtual Private Networks (VPNs)




A virtual private network (VPN) is a wide area communications network operated by a telecommunications carrier that provides what appears to be dedicated lines when used, but that actually includes trunks shared among all customers as in a public network. A VPN allows a private network to be configured within a public network.




VPNs can be provided by telecommunications carriers to customers to provide secure, guaranteed, long-distance bandwidth for their WANs. These VPNs generally use frame relay or switched multi-megabyte data service (SMDS) as a protocol of choice because those protocols define groups of users logically on the network without regard to physical location. ATM has gained favor as a VPN protocol as companies require higher reliability and greater bandwidth to handle more complex applications. VPNs using ATM offer networks of companies with the same virtual security and QoS as WANs designed with dedicated circuits.




The Internet has created an alternative to VPNs, at a much lower cost, i.e. the virtual private Internet. The virtual private Internet (VPI) lets companies connect disparate LANs via the Internet. A user installs either a software-only or a hardware-software combination that creates a shared, secure intranet with VPN-style network authorizations and encryption capabilities. A VPI normally uses browser-based administration interfaces.




(1) VPN Protocols




A plurality of protocol standards exist today for VPNs. For example, IP security (IPsec), point-to-point tunneling protocol (PPTP), layer 2 forwarding protocol (L2F) and layer 2 tunneling protocol (L2TP). The IETF has proposed a security architecture for the Internet protocol (IP) that can be used for securing Internet-based VPNs. IPsec facilitates secure private sessions across the Internet between organizational firewalls by encrypting traffic as it enters the Internet and decrypting it at the other end, while allowing vendors to use many encryption algorithms, key lengths and key escrow techniques. The goal of IPsec is to let companies mix-and-match the best firewall, encryption, and TCP/IP protocol products.




(a) Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP)




Point-to-point tunneling protocol (PPTP) provides an alternate approach to VPN security than the use of IPsec. Unlike IPsec, which is designed to link two LANs together via an encrypted data stream across the Internet, PPTP allows users to connect to a network of an organization via the Internet by a PPTP server or by an ISP that supports PPTP. PPTP was proposed as a standard to the IETF in early 1996. Firewall vendors are expected to support PPTP.




PPTP was developed by Microsoft along with 3Com, Ascend and US Robotics and is currently implemented in WINDOWS NT SERVER 4.0, WINDOWS NT WORKSTATION 4.0, WINDOWS 95 via an upgrade and WINDOWS 98, available from Microsoft Corporation of Redmond, Wash.




The “tunneling” in PPTP refers to encapsulating a message so that the message can be encrypted and then transmitted over the Internet. PPTP, by creating a tunnel between the server and the client, can tie up processing resources.




(b) Layer 2 Forwarding (L2F) Protocol




Developed by Cisco, layer 2 forwarding protocol (L2F) resembles PPTP in that it also encapsulates other protocols inside a TCP/IP packet for transport across the Internet, or any other TCP/IP network, such as data network


112


. Unlike PPTP, L2F requires a special L2F-compliant router (which can require changes to a LAN or WAN infrastructure), runs at a lower level of the network protocol stack and does not require TCP/IP routing to function. L2F also provides additional security for user names and passwords beyond that found in PPTP.




(c) Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol (L2TP)




The layer 2 tunneling protocol (L2TP) combines specifications from L2F with PPTP. In November 1997, the IETF approved the L2TP standard. Cisco is putting L2TP into its Internet operating system software and Microsoft is incorporating it into WINDOWS NT 5.0. A key advantage of L2TP over IPsec, which covers only TCP/IP communications, is that L2TP can carry multiple protocols. L2TP also offers transmission capability over non-IP networks. L2TP however ignores data encryption, an important security feature for network administrators to employ VPNs with confidence.




Data network


112


will now be described in greater detail relating to example packet-switched networks. It will be apparent to persons having skill in the art that multiple network types could be used to implement data network


112


, including, for example, ATM networks, frame relay networks, IP networks FDDI WAN networks SMDS networks, X-25 networks, and other kinds of LANs and WANs.




It would be apparent to those skilled in the art that other data networks could be used interchangeably for data network


112


such as, for example, an ATM, X.25, Frame relay, FDDI, Fast Ethernet, or an SMDS packet switched network. Frame relay and ATM are connection-oriented services. Switched multi-megabyte data service (SMDS) is a connection-oriented mass packet service that offers speeds up to 45 Mbps. Originally, SMDS was intended to fill the gap for broadband services until broadband ISDN (BISDN) could be developed. Because the infrastructure for BISDN is not fully in place, some users have chosen SMDS.




e. Exemplary Data Networks




(1) Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM)




ATM is a high-bandwidth, low-delay, packet-switching, and multiplexing network technology. ATM packets are known as “cells.” Bandwidth capacity is segmented into 53-byte fixed-sized cells, having a header and payload fields. ATM is an evolution of earlier packet-switching network methods such as X.25 and frame relay, which used frames or cells that varied in size. Fixed-length packets can be switched more easily in hardware than variable size packets and thus result in faster transmissions.




Each ATM cell contains a 48-byte payload field and a 5-byte header that identifies the so-called “virtual circuit” of the cell. ATM can allocate bandwidth on demand, making it suitable for high-speed combinations of voice, data, and video services. Currently, ATM access can perform at speeds as high as


622


Mbps or higher. ATM has recently been doubling its maximum speed every year.




In an example embodiment, data network


112


is an asynchronous transfer mode (ATM) network. An ATM cell of data network


112


includes a header (having addressing information and header error checking information), and a payload (having the data being carried by the cell).




ATM is a technology, defined by a protocol standardized by the International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T), American National Standards Institute (ANSI), ETSI, and the ATM Forum. ATM comprises a number of building blocks, including transmission paths, virtual paths, and virtual channels.




Asynchronous transfer mode (ATM) is a cell based switching and multiplexing technology designed to be a general purpose connection-oriented transfer mode for a wide range of telecommunications services. ATM can also be applied to LAN and private network technologies as specified by the ATM Forum.




ATM handles both connection-oriented traffic directly or through adaptation layers, or connectionless traffic through the use of adaptation layers. ATM virtual connections may operate at either a constant bit rate (CBR) or a variable bit rate (VBR). Each ATM cell sent into an ATM network contains addressing information that establishes a virtual connection from origination to destination. All cells are transferred, in sequence, over this virtual connection. ATM provides either permanent or switched virtual connections (PVCs or SVCs). ATM is asynchronous because the transmitted cells need not be periodic as time slots of data are required to be in synchronous transfer mode (STM).




ATM uses an approach by which a header field prefixes each fixed-length payload. The ATM header identifies the virtual channel (VC). Therefore, time slots are available to any host which has data ready for transmission. If no hosts are ready to transmit, then an empty, or idle, cell is sent.




ATM permits standardization on one network architecture defining a multiplexing and a switching method. Synchronous optical network (SONET) provides the basis for physical transmission at very high-speed rates. ATM also supports multiple quality of service (QoS) classes for differing application requirements, depending on delay and loss performance. ATM can also support LAN-like access to available bandwidth.




The primary unit in ATM, the cell, defines a fixed-size cell with a length of 53 octets (or bytes) comprised of a five-octet header and 48-octet payload. Bits in the cells are transmitted over a transmission path in a continuous stream. Cells are mapped into a physical transmission path, such as the North American DS


1


, DS


3


, and SONET; European, E1, E3, and E4; ITU-T STM standards; and various local fiber and electrical transmission payloads. All information is multiplexed and switched in an ATM network via these fixed-length cells.




The ATM cell header field identifies the destination, cell type, and priority., and includes six portions. An ATM cell header includes a generic flow control (GFC), a virtual path identifier (VPI), a virtual channel identifier (VCI), a payload type (PT), a call loss priority (CLP), and a header error check (HEC). VPI and VCI hold local significance only, and identify the destination. GFC allows a multiplexer to control the rate of an ATM terminal. PT indicates whether the cell contains user data, signaling data, or maintenance information. CLP indicates the relative priority of the cell, i.e., lower priority cells are discarded before higher priority cells during congested intervals. HEC detects and corrects errors in the header.




The ATM cell payload field is passed through the network intact, with no error checking or correction. ATM relies on higher-layer protocols to perform error checking and correction on the payload. For example, a transmission control protocol (TCP) can be used to perform error correction functions. The fixed cell size simplifies the implementation of ATM switches and multiplexers and enables implementations at high speeds.




When using ATM, longer packets cannot delay shorter packets as in other packet-switched networks, because long packets are separated into many fixed length cells. This feature enables ATM to carry CBR traffic, such as voice and video, in conjunction with VBR data traffic, potentially having very long packets, within the same network.




ATM switches take traffic and segment it into the fixed-length cells, and multiplex the cells into a single bit stream for transmission across a physical medium. As an example, different kinds of traffic can be transmitted over an ATM network including voice, video, and data traffic. Video and voice traffic are very time-sensitive, so delay cannot have significant variations. Data, on the other hand, can be sent in either connection-oriented or connectionless mode. In either case, data is not nearly as delay-sensitive as voice or video traffic, conventionally. Conventional, however, data traffic is very sensitive to loss. Therefore, ATM conventionally must discriminate between voice, video, and data traffic. Voice and video traffic requires priority and guaranteed delivery with bounded delay, while data traffic requires, simultaneously, assurance of low loss. According to the present invention, data traffic can also carry voice traffic, making it also time-dependent. Using ATM, in one embodiment, multiple types of traffic can be combined over a single ATM virtual path (VP), with virtual circuits (VCs) being assigned to separate data, voice, and video traffic.





FIG. 16B

depicts graphically the relationship


1618


between a physical transmission path


1620


, virtual paths (VPs)


1622


,


1624


and


1626


, and virtual channels(VCs)


1628


,


1630


,


1632


,


1634


,


1636


,


1638


,


1640


,


1642


,


1644


,


1646


,


1648


and


1650


. A transmission path


1620


includes one or more VPs


1622


,


1624


and


1626


. Each VP


1622


,


1624


and


1626


includes one or more VCs


1628


,


1630


,


1632


,


1634


,


1636


,


1638


,


1640


,


1642


,


1644


,


1646


,


1648


and


1650


. Thus, multiple VCs


1628


-


1650


can be trunked over a single VP and


1622


. Switching can be performed on either a transmission path


1620


, VPs


1622


-


1626


, or at the level of VCs


1628


-


1650


.




The capability of ATM to switch to a virtual channel level is similar to the operation of a private or public branch exchange (PBX) or telephone switch in the telephone world. In a PBX switch, each channel within a trunk group can be switched. Devices which perform VC connections are commonly called VC switches because of the analogy to telephone switches. ATM devices which connect VPs are commonly referred to as VP cross-connects, by analogy with the transmission network. The analogies are intended for explanatory reasons, but should not be taken literally. An ATM cell-switching machine need not be restricted to switching only VCs and cross-connection to only VPs.




At the ATM layer, users are provided a choice of either a virtual path connection (VPC) or a virtual channel connection (VCC). Virtual path connections (VPCs) are switched based upon the virtual path identifier (VPI) value only. Users of a VPC can assign VCCs within a VPI transparently, since they follow the same route. Virtual channel connections (VCCs) are switched upon a combined VPI and virtual channel identifier (VCI) value.




Both VPIs and VCIs are used to route calls through a network. Note that VPI and VCI values must be unique on a specific transmission path (TP).




It is important to note that data network


112


can be any of a number of other data-type networks, including various packet-switched data-type networks, in addition to an ATM network.




(2) Frame Relay




Alternatively, data network


112


can be a frame relay network. It would be apparent to persons having ordinary skill in the art, that a frame relay network could be used as data network


112


. Rather than transporting data in ATM cells, data could be transported in frames.




Frame relay is a packet-switching protocol used in WANs that has become popular for LAN-to-LAN connections between remote locations. Formerly frame relay access would top out at about 1.5 Mbps. Today, so-called “high-speed” frame relay offers around 45 Mbps. This speed is still relatively slow as compared with other technology such as ATM.




Frame relay services employ a form of packet-switching analogous to a streamlined version of X.25 networks. The packets are in the form of frames, which are variable in length. The key advantage to this approach it that a frame relay network can accommodate data packets of various sizes associated with virtually any native data protocol. A frame relay network is completely protocol independent. A frame relay network embodiment of data network


112


does not undertake a lengthy protocol conversion process, and therefore offers faster and less-expensive switching than some alternative networks. Frame relay also is faster than traditional X.25 networks because it was designed for the reliable circuits available today and performs less-rigorous error detection.




(3) Internet Protocol (IP)




In an embodiment, data network


112


can be an internet protocol (IP) network over an ATM network. It would be apparent to persons having ordinary skill in the art, that an internet protocol (IP) network (with any underlying data link network) could be used as data network


112


. Rather than transporting data in ATM cells, data could be transported in IP datagram packets. The IP data network can lie above any of a number of physical networks such as, for example, a SONET optical network.




4. Signaling Network





FIG. 17C

illustrates signaling network


114


in greater detail. In an embodiment of the invention, signaling network


114


is an SS7 signaling network. The SS7 signaling network


114


is a separate packet-switched network used to handle the set up, tear down, and supervision of calls between calling party


102


and called party


120


. SS7 signaling network


114


includes service switching points (SSPs)


104


,


106


,


126


and


130


, signal transfer points (STPs)


216


,


218


,


250




a


,


250




b


,


252




a


and


252




b


, and service control point (SCP)


610


.




In SS7 signaling network


114


, SSPs


104


,


106


,


126


and


130


are the portions of the backbone switches providing SS7 functions. The SSPs


104


,


106


,


126


and


130


can be, for example, a combination of a voice switch and an SS7 switch, or a computer connected to a voice switch. SSPs


104


,


106


,


126


and


130


communicate with the switches using primitives, and create packets for transmission over SS7 signaling network


114


.




Carrier facilities


126


,


130


can be respectively represented in SS7 network


114


as SSPs


126


,


130


. Accordingly, the connections between carrier facilities


126


and


130


and signaling network


114


(presented as dashed lines in

FIG. 2A

) can be represented by connections


1726




b


and


1726




d


. The types of these links are described below.




STPs


216


,


218


;


250




a


,


250




b


,


252




a


and


252




b


act as routers in the SS7 network, typically being provided as adjuncts to in-place switches. STPs


216


,


218


,


250




a


,


250




b


,


252




a


and


252




b


route messages from originating SSPs


104


and


126


to destination SSPs


106


and


130


. Architecturally, STPs


216


,


218


,


250




a


,


250




b


,


252




a


and


252




b


can be and are typically provided in “mated pairs” to provide redundancy in the event of congestion or failure and to share resources (i.e. load sharing is done automatically). As illustrated in

FIGS. 17A

,


17


B and


17


C, STPs


216


,


218


,


250




a


,


250




b


,


252




a


and


252




b


can be arranged in hierarchical levels, to provide hierarchical routing of signaling messages. For example, mated STPs


250




a


,


252




a


and mated STPs


250




b


,


252




b


are at a first hierarchical level, while mated STPs


216


,


218


are at a second hierarchical level.




SCP


610


can provide database functions. SCP


610


can be used to provide advanced features in SS7 signaling network


114


, including routing of special service numbers (e.g., 800 and 900 numbers), storing information regarding subscriber services, providing calling card validation and fraud protection, and offering advanced intelligent network (AIN) services. SCP


610


is connected to mated STPs


216


and


218


.




In SS7 signaling network


114


, there are unique links between the different network elements. Table 19 provides definitions for common SS7 links.




Mated STP pairs are connected together by C links. For example, STPs


216


and


218


, mated STPs


250




a


and


252




a


, and mated STPs


250




b


and


252




b


are connected together by C links


1728




a


,


1728




b


,


1728




c


,


1728




d


,


1728




e


and


1728




f


, respectively. SSPs


104


and


126


and SSPs


106


and


130


are connected together by F links


1734


and


1736


, respectively.




Mated STPs


250




a


and


252




a


and mated STPs


250




b


and


252




b


, which are at the same hierarchical level, are connected by B links


1732




a


,


1732




b


,


1732




c


and


1732




d


. Mated STPs


250




a


and


252




a


and mated STPs


216


and


218


, which are at different hierarchical levels, are connected by D links


1730




a


,


1730




b


,


1730




e


and


1730




f


. Similarly, mated STPs


250




b


and


252




b


and mated STPs


216


and


218


, which are at different hierarchical levels, are connected by D links


1730




c


,


1730




d


,


1730




g


and


1730




h.






SSPs


104


and


126


and mated STPs


250




a


and


252




a


are connected by A links


1726




a


and


1726




b


. SSPs


106


and


130


and mated STPs


250




b


and


252




b


are connected by A links


1726




c


and


1726




d.






SSPs


104


and


126


can also be connected to mated STPs


216


and


218


by E links (not shown). Finally, mated STPs


216


and


218


are connected to SCP


610


by A links


608




a


and


608




b.






For a more elaborate description of SS7 network topology, the reader is referred to Russell, Travis, Signaling System #7, McGraw-Hill, New York, N.Y. 10020, ISBN 0-07-054991-5, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.












TABLE 19











Port Status












SS7 link







terminology




Definitions









Access




A links connect SSPs to STPs, or SCPs to STPs,






(A)




providing network access and database access through






links




the STPs.






Bridge (B)




B links connect mated STPs to other mated STPs.






links






Cross (C)




C links connect the STPs in a mated pair to one another.






links




During normal conditions, only network management







messages are sent over C links.






Diagonal (D)




D links connect the mated STPs at a primary hierarchical






links




level to mated STPs at a secondary hierarchical level.






Extended




E links connect SSPs to remote mated STPs, and are






(E)




used in the event that the A links to home mated STPs






links




are congested






Fully




F links provide direct connections between local SSPs






associated




(bypassing STPs) in the event there is much traffic






(F)




between SSPs, or if a direct connection to an STP is not






links




available. F links are used only for call setup and call







teardown.














a. Signal Transfer Points (STPs)




Signal transfer points (STPs) are tandem switches which route SS7 signaling messages long the packet switched SS7 signaling network


114


. See the description of STPs with reference to

FIG. 17A

, in the soft switch site section, and with reference to

FIG. 17C

above.




b. Service Switching Points (SSPs)




Service switching points (SSPs) create the packets which carry SS7 signaling messages through the SS7 signaling network


114


. See the description of SSPs with reference to

FIG. 17C

, above.




c. Services Control Points (SCPs)




Services control points (SCPs) can provide database features and advanced network features in the SS7 signaling network


114


. See the description of SCPs with reference to

FIG. 17B

in the soft switch site section, and with reference to

FIG. 17C

above.




5. Provisioning Component





FIG. 18

depicts a provisioning component and network event component architecture


1800


.

FIG. 18

includes a spool-shaped component (including provisioning component


117


and network event component


116


), and three soft switch sites, i.e. western soft switch site


104


, central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


.




The top elliptical portion of the spool-shaped component, illustrates an embodiment of provisioning component


117


, including operational support services (OSS) order entry (O/E) component


1802


, alternate order entry component


1804


and data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


. In an example embodiment, data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


comprise application programs.




In a preferred embodiment, data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


include ORACLE


8


.


0


relational databases from Oracle Corporation of Redwood Shores, Calif., Tuxedo clients and a BEA M3 OBJECT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM, CORBA-compliant interface, available from BEA Systems, Inc. of San Francisco, Calif., with offices in Golden, Colo. BEA M3 is based on the CORBA distributed objects standard. BEA M3 is a combination of BEA OBJECTBROKER CORBA ORB (including management, monitoring, and transactional features underlying BEA TUXEDO), and an object-oriented transaction and state management system, messaging and legacy access connectivity. BEA M3 is scalable, high performance, designed for high availability and reliability, supports transactions, includes CORBA/IIOP ORB, security, MIB-based managment, supports fault management, dynamic load balancing, gateways and adapters, client support, multi-platform porting, data integrity, management, reporting and TUXEDO Services.




In another embodiment, data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


include an application program by the name of automated service activation process (ASAP) available from Architel Systems Corporation of Toronto, Ontario.




Customer service request calls can be placed to a customer service office. Customer service operators can perform order entry of customer service requests via OSS


1802


order entry (O/E)


1803


system. In the event of the unavailability of OSS O/E


1802


, customer service requests may be entered via alternate O/E


1804


. Customer service requests are inputted into data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


for distribution and replication to configuration servers


312




a


,


312




b


,


206




a


,


206




b


,


316




a


and


316




b


which contain customer profile database entries. In addition, provisioning requests can be performed. Replication facilities in data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


enable maintaining synchronization between the distributed network elements of telecommunications network


200


.




a. Data Distributor




Referring to

FIG. 18

data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


receive service requests from upstream provisioning components such as, e.g., OSS systems. Data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


then translate the service requests and decompose the requests into updates to network component databases. Data distributors


222




a


and


222




b


then distribute the updates to voice network components in soft switch sites and gateway sites.

FIG. 19A

depicts examples of both the upstream and downstream network components interfacing to data distributors


222


and


222




b.







FIG. 19A

depicts data distributor architecture


1900


.

FIG. 19A

includes a data distributor


222


interfacing to a plurality of voice network elements. Voice network elements illustrated in

FIG. 19A

include SCPs


214




a


and


214




b


, configuration servers


206




a


,


312




a


and


316




a


route servers


212




a


,


212




b


,


314




a


,


314




b


,


316




a


and


316




b


TGs


232


and


234


, AGs


238


and


240


, and SS7 GWSI


208


and


210


. In addition, data distributor


222


interfaces to a plurality of services. Services include provisioning services


1902


, customer profiles/order entry services


1803


, OSS


1802


, route administration services


1904


, service activation services


1906


, network administration services


1908


, network inventory services


1910


and alternate data entry (APDE) services


1804


.




Data distributor


222


has a plurality of functions. Data distributor


222


receives provisioning requests from upstream OSS systems, distributes provisioning data to appropriate network elements and maintains data synchronization, consistency and integrity across data centers, i.e., soft switch sites


104


,


106


,


302


.




A more detailed architectural representation of one embodiment of data distributor


222


is provided in FIG.


19


B. Data distributor


222


accepts various requests from multiple upstream OSS systems


1922


,


1924


,


1926


,


1928


and APDE


1804


.




Services request processes (SRPs)


1938


manage the upstream interface between data distributor


222


and OSS systems


1922


-


1928


. SRPs


1938


are developed to support communication between individual OSS systems


1802


,


1922


-


1928


, APDE


1804


and data distributor


222


.




A common service description layer


1936


acts as an encapsulation layer for upstream applications. Common service description layer


1936


translates service requests from upstream OSS systems


1922


-


1928


and APDE


1804


to a common format. Common service description layer


1936


buffers the distribution logic from any specific formats or representations of OSS


1922


-


1928


and APDE


1804


.




Distribution layer


1930


includes the actual distribution application logic resident within data distributor


222


. Distribution layer


1930


manages incoming requests, performs database replications, maintains logical work units, manages application revisions, performs roll-backs when required, maintains synchronization, handles incoming priority schemes and priority queues, and other data distribution functions. Distribution layer


1930


includes access to multiple redundant high-availability database disks


1940


,


1942


, which can include a database of record.




Updates are distributed downstream through a network element description layer


1932


. Network element description layer


1932


is an encapsulation layer that insulates data distributor


222


from the individual data formats required by specific network element types. A network element processor (NEP)


1934


performs a role analogous to SRP


1938


, but instead for downstream elements rather than upstream elements. NEPs


1934


manage the physical interface between data distributor


222


and heterogeneous network elements


1943


, i.e. the down stream voice network elements to which data distributor


222


distributes updates. Heterogeneous network elements


1943


include SCPs


214




a


and


214




b


, configuration servers


206




a


,


212




a


and


216




a


, route servers


212




a


,


212




b


,


314




a


,


314




b


,


316




a


and


316




b


, TGs


232


and


234


, AGs


238


and


240


, and SS7 GWs


208


and


210


. Each NEP


1934


handles a particular type of heterogeneous network elements, e.g., route servers.




In addition to upstream feeds to OSS systems


1922


-


1928


and downstream feeds to heterogeneous network elements


1943


, data distributor


222


allows updates directly to distribution layer


1930


via APDE


1804


. APDE


1804


enables update of distribution layer


1930


and allows updates to the network in the unlikely event that an emergency update is required when interfacing OSS systems


1992


-


1928


upstream application are out of service or down for maintenance activity. APDE


1804


the alternate provisioning order entry system, can comprise a small local area network including several PCs and connectivity peripherals. APDE


1804


provides a backup for OSSs


1922


-


1928


.




In a preferred example embodiment of data distributor


222


, data distributor


222


is an application program BEA M3 available from BEA Systems, Inc. of San Francisco, Calif. In another example embodiment, data distributor


222


could be another application program capable of distributing/replication/rollback of software such as, for example, AUTOMATED SERVICE ACTIVATION PROCESS (ASAP) available from Architel of Toronto, Canada. Example upstream operational support services (OSS) components include application programs which perform multiple functions.

FIG. 19C

illustrates some example OSS applications


1802


including provisioning application


1902


, customer profiles/order entry application


1803


, route administration application


1904


, service activation triggers


1906


, network administration application


1908


, network inventory application


1910


, alternate provisioning data entry application (APDE)


1804


, and trouble ticketing application (not shown). Browsing tools can also be used, such as, for example, a browsing or query application programs.





FIG. 19C

illustrates a more detailed view of an example embodiment of data distributor


222


. Data distributor


222


includes distribution layer


1930


interfacing to database disks


1940


and


1942


. Distribution layer


1930


of

FIG. 19

interfaces to common service description layer


1936


. In an example embodiment, common service description layer


1936


is a common object request broker architecture (CORBA) compliant server such as, for example, BEA M3 from BEA Systems, Inc. of San Francisco, Calif. Alternate provisioning data entry (APDE)


1804


interfaces to CORBA server


1936


. Upstream voice provisioning components, i.e., operational support services (OSS)


1922


-


1928


, include application components


1802


and


1902


-


1910


. Provisioning component


1902


has a CORBA client in communication with CORBA server common service description layer


1936


. Customer profiles/order entry


1802


includes a CORBA client interface into CORBA server common service description layer


1936


. Similarly, routing administration


1904


, network inventory


1910


, network administration


1908


and service triggers


1906


all interface via CORBA clients to CORBA server common service description layer


1936


. Distribution layer


1930


also interfaces to downstream voice network elements via an application program, i.e., network element description layer


1932


. In an exemplary embodiment, network element description layer


1932


is an application program running on a work station, such as, for example BEA TUXEDO, available from BEA Systems, Inc. Voice network element configuration servers


206


,


312




a


and


314




a


interface via a TUXEDO client to TUXEDO server network element description layer


1932


. Routing servers


212




a


,


212




b


,


314




a


,


314




b


,


316




a


and


316




b


interface via a TUXEDO client to TUXEDO server network element description layer


1932


, as well. Similarly, SS7 GWs


208


and


210


, SCPs


214




a


and


214




b


, AGs


238


and


240


, and TGs


232


and


234


, interface to TUXEDO server network element description layer


1932


via TUXEDO clients. Preferred embodiment BEA TUXEDO available from BEA Systems, Inc. of San Francisco, Calif. (Colorado Springs and Denver/Golden, Colo. office) supports among other functions, rollback and data integrity features.

FIG. 19C

also includes database of record (DOR)


1940


,


1942


.





FIG. 19E

includes a more detailed illustration of a specific example embodiment of the data distributor and provisioning element


116


.

FIG. 19E

includes DOR


1940


and


1942


, which can be in a primary/secondary relationship for high availability purposes. DORs


1940


,


1942


can have stored on their media, images of the Route Server and Configuration Server databases. In one embodiment, the functions of route server


314




a


and configuration server


312




a


are performed by the same physical workstation element, a routing and configuration database (RCDB). DOR


1940


can be used for referential integrity. ORACLE relational database management (RDBMS) databases, e.g., ORACLE 8.0 RDBMS can support the use of a foreign key between a database and an index. DOR


1940


can be used to maintain integrity of the database. DOR


1940


sets constraints on the RCDB databases. DOR


1940


is used to maintain integrity of RCDB data and can be used to query data without affecting call processing. DOR


1940


supports parity calculations to check for replication errors.





FIG. 19E

includes distribution layer


1930


which can be used to distribute service level updates of telecommunications network system software to network elements using database replication features of, e.g., ORACLE 8.0. Other business processes demand updating the software on network elements. For example, other business processes requiring updates include, NPA splits. N-PA splits, occur when one area code becomes two or more area codes. An NPA split can require that thousands of rows of numbers must be updated.

FIG. 19E

includes an automated tool to distribute changes, i.e. a routing administration tool (RAT)


1904


.





FIG. 19E

also includes data distributor common interface (DDCI)


1999


, which can be thought of as an advanced programming interface (API) functional calls that OSS developers can invoke in writing application programs. OSS applications include programs such as, e.g., provisioning, order management and billing, (each of which can require the means to provision the RCDB, i.e., RS and CS, or can provide updates to the database of record (DOR).





FIG. 19E

illustrates a data distributor including BEA M3, a CORBA-compliant interface server


1936


with an imbedded TUXEDO layer. BEA M3 communicates through the CORBA server interface


1936


to CORBA-compliant clients. Other examples of CORBA compliant distributed object connectivity software includes, for example, VISIGENICS VISIBROKER, available from Inprise Corporation, of Scotts Valley, Calif.




DOR


1940


includes a plurality of relational database tables including each EO, NPA, NXX, LATA, and state. Each EO can home to 150,000 NPA/NXXs. Multiple inputs must be replicated into DOR


1040


. For example, Lockheed Martin Local Exchange and Routing Guide (LERG)


1941


includes twelve (12) tables maintained by the industry including flat files which are sent to a carrier each month.

FIG. 19E

demonstrates an exemplary monthly reference data update process


1957


. Monthly, a LERG


1941


compact disk (CD) is received by the carrier including changes to all of the 12 tables. Process


1957


includes merging an image snapshot of DOR


1940


with the LERG CD and storing the results in a temporary routing database (shown) to create a discrepancy report. This process can be used to yield a subset of the NPA/NXXs which have changed, which can then be audited and used to update the production DOR


1940


if found to be necessary. Once an updated version of the database is prepared, the database update can be sent to data distributor


1930


for distribution to all the relevant network elements.





FIG. 19F

depicts an even more detailed example embodiment block diagram


1958


of BEA M3 data distributor of provisioning element


116


. Diagram


1958


shows the flow of a provisioning request from OSS


1802


or APDE


1804


through BEA M3 CORBA interface


1936


through queues to data distributor


1930


for distribution/replication through queue servers


1995




a


,


1995




b


,


1995




c


, and queues


1996




a


,


1996




b


,


1996




c


for dispatch to geographically diverse RCDBs


212




a


,


206


(RSs and CSs at remote soft switch sites) through dispatch servers


1997




a


,


1997




b


,


1997




c


and DBProxyServers


1998




a


,


1998




b


,


1998




c


,


1998




d


,


1998




e


and


1998




f.






Operationally, when a provisioning request comes in from OSS


1802


, the request enters a queue. Priority queuing is enabled by BEA TUXEDO. Tuxedo creates a plurality of queues in order to protect database integrity, e.g., a high, medium and low priority queue. An example of the use of queues might be to place a higher priority on customer updates that to LERG updates, which are less time sensitive. Requests can be categorized in queues based on dates such as, for example, the effective date of the request, the effective deactivation date. Once categorized by date, the updates can be stored with a timestamp placed on them, and can then be placed in a TUXEDO queue.




TUXEDO permits the use of down word transaction in its multi-level queuing architecture. This permits pulling back transactions, also known as “rolling back” a replication/update, so updates will occur to all of or none of the databases. In some instances one network element can be removed from the network, but this is done rarely. For an example, in the event of RCDB crashing, the NOC can remove the crashing RCDB from the network configuration and thus it might not be capable of being updated. However, for normal situations of the network, updates are either performed on all elements or no updates are performed.





FIG. 19G

depicts a block diagram illustrating a high level conceptual diagram of the CORBA interface


1960


. CORBA IDL Interface


1936


includes routing provisioning


1966


, common configuration provisioning (configuration server provisioning)


1803


, provisioning factory


1902


, routing factory


1968


, common configuration factory


1970


, routing services


1908


,


1910


, common configuration services


1960


and SQL translator


1972


. SQL translator


1972


takes the application API calls and translates them into structured query language queries for queuing for eventual invocation against database of record


1940


.





FIG. 19H

depicts a block diagram


1962


illustrating additional components of the high level conceptual diagram of the CORBA interface


1960


. CORBA IDL Interface


1936


includes routing administration


1904


, routing validation


1974


, routing administration factory


1980


, composite updates


1976


, batch updates


1982


, and projects


1978


. SQL translator


1972


can take the application API calls and translate them into structured query language queries for queuing for eventual invocation against project database


1984


.





FIG. 19I

depicts a block diagram illustrating a data distributor sending data to configuration server sequencing diagram


1964


including message flows


1986


-


1994


.




(1) Data Distributor Interfaces




Data distributor


222


receives service requests from upstream OSS systems


1922


,


1924


,


1926


and


1928


. OSS service requests appear in the form of provisioning updates and administrative reference updates.




Provisioning updates include high-level attributes required to provision a customer's telecommunications service. Example high-level attributes required for provisioning include, for example, customer automatic number identification (ANM), and trunk profiles; class of service restrictions (COSR) and project account codes (PAC) profiles; AG and TG assignments; and toll-free number to SCP translation assignments.




Administrative reference updates include high-level attributes required to support call processing. Example high-level attributes required to perform administrative updates include, for example, 3/6/10 digit translation tables, international translation tables and blocked-country codes.




Alternate provisioning data entry (APDE)


1804


replicates OSS functionality supported at the interface with data distributor


222


. APDE


1804


can provide an alternative mechanism to provide provisioning and reference data to data distributor


222


in the event that an OSS


1922


-


1928


is unavailable.





FIG. 19D

illustrates data distributor


222


passing provisioning information from upstream OSSs


1922


-


1928


to downstream SCPs


214


. A plurality of tables are distributed from data distributor


222


to each SCP


214


. Exemplary data tables distributed include a PAC table, an ANI table, blocking list tables, numbering plan area (NPA)/NXX tables, state code tables, and LATA tables. Each of these tables is maintained at the customer level to ensure customer security.





FIG. 19D

illustrates block diagram


1946


depicting provisioning interfaces into SCPs. SCP


214


can receive customer and routing provisioning from data distributor


222


. Data distributor


222


distributes customer database tables to SCP


214


. Data distributor


222


also distributes route plan updates of configurations to SCP


214


. Customer tables are updated through a database replication server. An exemplary database replication server is an ORACLE database replication server, available from ORACLE of Redwood Shores, Calif. ORACLE replication server performs replication functions including data replication from data distributor to SCP


1952


and route plan distribution from data distributor to SCP


1954


. These functions are illustrated in

FIG. 19D

originating from ORACLE databases


1940


and


1942


of data distributor


222


and replicating to an ORACLE database in SCP


214


. ORACLE databases


1940


and


1942


in data distributor


222


are updated via toll-free routing provisioning


1950


from SCP


1902


. ORACLE databases


1940


and


1942


of data distributor


222


can also be updated via order entry application


1802


including customer tables


1948


of OSS systems


1922


-


1928


. Routing plans are updated via an SCP vendor's proprietary interfaces. Specifically, toll-free routing provisioning


1950


may be updated via a computer


1902


which interfaces to data distributor


222


.




Referring to

FIG. 19C

, data distributor


222


passes provisioning and configuration information from upstream OSS systems


1922


-


1928


(primarily the provisioning system) to configuration servers


206




a


,


312




a


and


314




a


. A plurality of tables are distributed from data distributor


222


to each configuration server. Exemplary tables distributed include, for example, toll-free numbers to SCP-type tables, SCP-type to SCP tables, carrier identification code (CIC) profile tables, ANI profile summary tables, ANI profile tables, account code profile tables, NPA/NXX tables, customer profile tables, customer location profile tables, equipment service profile tables, trunk group service profile summary tables, trunk group service tables, high risk country tables, and selected international destinations tables.




Data distributor


222


passes administrative and reference information from upstream OSS systems


1922


-


1928


to route server


212


. A plurality of tables are distributed from data distributor


222


to route servers


212




a


,


212




b


,


314




a


,


314




b


,


316




a


and


316




b


. Exemplary tables distributed include country code routing tables, NPA routing tables, NPA/NXX routing tables, ten-digit routing tables, route group tables, circuit group tables, and circuit group status tables.




Data distributor


222


passes administrative configuration information to TGs


232


and


234


.




Data distributor


222


passes administration configuration information to AGs


238


and


240


.




Data distributor passes administrative configuration information to SS7 gateways


208


and


210


. The administrative configuration information sent can be used in the routing of SS7 signaling messages throughout signaling network


114


.




Data distributor


222


uses a separate physical interface for all SNMP messages and additional functions that can be defined. Additional functions that can be defined include, for example, provisioning, and passing special alarm and performance parameters to data distributor


222


from the network operation center (NOC).






6


. Network Event Component





FIG. 18

depicts the provisioning component and network event component architecture


1800


.

FIG. 18

includes a spool-shaped component (comprising provisioning component


117


and network event component


116


), and three soft switch sites, i.e. western soft switch site


104


, central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


.




The spindle portion of the spool-shaped component includes western soft switch site


104


. Western soft switch site


104


includes configuration servers


206




a


and


206




b


, route servers


212




a


and


212




b


, soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


, and network event collection points, i.e., RNECPs


224




a


and


224




b


.

FIG. 18

also includes central soft switch site


106


including configuration servers


312




a


and


312




b


, route servers


314




a


and


314




b


, soft switches


304




a


,


304




b


and


304




c


, and RNECPs


902


and


904


.





FIG. 18

also includes eastern soft switch site


302


including configuration servers


316




a


and


316




b


, route servers


318




a


and


318




b


, soft switches


306




a


,


306




b


and


4306




c


and RNECPs


906


and


908


.




As depicted in

FIG. 18

, network call events are collected at regional network event collection points via RNECPs


902


,


904


,


224




a


,


224




b


,


906


and


908


, at the regional soft switch sites


104


,


106


and


302


, which are like FIFO buffers. A call record can be created by the ingress soft switch. The ingress soft switch can generate a unique identifier (UID) for the call based, for example, on the time of origination of the call. Ingress related call event blocks can be generated


10


throughout the call and are forwarded on to the RNECPs for inclusion in a call event record identified by the UID. The call event records can be sent from the RNECPs to master network event data base NEDB


226




a


and


226




b


for storage in database disks


926




a


,


926




b


and


926




c


for further processing using application programs such as, for example, fraud DB client


1806


, browser


1808


, statistics DB client


1810


and mediation DB client


1812


. In one embodiment, a version of the call record including all call event blocks as of that time, can be forwarded from the RNECPs to the NEDB on a periodic basis, to permit real-time, mid-call call event statistics to be analyzed. The call records can be indexed by the UID associated with the call. In one embodiment, a copy of a call event record for a call, including ingress call event blocks, remains in the RNECP until completion of the phone call. In completing a phone call, the ingress soft switch and egress soft switch can communicate using inter soft switch communication, identifying the call by means of the UID. A load balancing scheme can be used to balance storage and capacity requirements of the RNECPs. For example, in one embodiment, calls can be assigned, based on origination time, i.e., a UID can be assigned to a specific RNECP(based, e.g., on time of origination of the call) for buffered storage. The egress soft switch can similarly generate and forward call event blocks to the same or another RNECP for inclusion in the call event record. In one embodiment, all the call event blocks for the call record for a given call are sent to one RNECP which maintains a copy throughout the call (i.e. even if interim copies are transmitted for storage). In one embodiment, the call event record is removed from the RNECP upon completion of the call to free up space for additional calls.




The bottom elliptical portion of spool-shaped component, illustrates an embodiment of network event component


116


including master NEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


having database disks


926




a


,


926




b


and


926




c


. MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


can be in communication with a plurality of applications which process network call event blocks. For example, a fraud DB client


1806


, a browser


1808


, a statistics DB client


1810


, and a mediation DB client


1812


can process call event blocks (EBs).MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


can be in set up in a primary and secondary mode.




a. Master Network Event Database (MNEDB)




The master network event database (MNEDB)


226


is a centralized server which acts as a repository for storing call event records. MNEDB


226


collects data from each of RNECPs


224


which transmit information real-time to MNEDB


226


. MNEDB


226


can also be implemented in a primary and secondary server strategy, wherein RNECPs


224


are connected to a primary and a secondary MNEDB


226


for high availability redundancy. MNEDB


226


can store call event blocks (EBs) received from RNECPs


224


organized based on a unique call/event identifier as the primary key and a directional flag element as the secondary key. MNEDB


226


can serve as the “database of record” for downstream systems to be the database of record. Downstream systems include, for example, an accounting/billing system, a network management system, a cost analysis system, a call performance statistics system, a carrier access billing system (CABS), fraud analysis system, margin analysis system, and others. MNEDB


226


, in a preferred embodiment, has enough disk space to store up to 60 days of call event records locally.




MNEDBs


226


can create and feed real-time call event data to downstream systems. Real-time call event data provides significant advantages over call event data available in conventional circuit-switched networks. Conentional circuit-switched networks can only provide call records for completed calls to downstream systems. The advantages of real-time call event data include, for example, fraud identification and prevention, and enablement of real-time customized customer reporting and billing (e.g., billing based on packets sent).




(1) MNEDB Interfaces




MNEDBs


226


collect recorded call event blocks (EBs) from RNECPs


224


. NEDB


226


correlates the EBs and forwards the data to various downstream systems.





FIG. 20

illustrates master data center architecture


2000


.

FIG. 20

includes master data center


2004


having MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


. MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


have multiple redundant high availability disks


926




a


and


926




b


which can be arranged in a primary and secondary fashion for high availability redundancy. MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


intercommunicate as shown via communication line


2006


.




MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


are in communication via multiple redundant connections with a plurality of downstream application systems. Downstream application systems include, for example, browser system


1808


, fraud DB client system


1806


, carrier access billing system (CABS) DB client


2002


, statistics DB client


1810


and mediation DB client


1812


.




MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


provide recorded call event record data to fraud database client


1806


in real-time. Real-time call event data allows fraud DB client


1806


to detect fraudulent activities at the time of their occurrence, rather than after the fact. Traditional circuit-switched networks can only identify fraud after completion of a call, since event records are “cut” at that time. Real-time fraud detection permits operations personnel to take immediate action against fraudulent perpetrators. MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


provide recorded call event data to CABS DB client


2002


. CABS DB client


2002


uses the recorded call event data to bill other LECs and IXCs for their usage of telecommunications network


200


, using reciprocal billing.




MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


provide recorded call data to statistics DB client


1810


. Statistics DB client


1810


uses the recorded call event data to assist in traffic engineering and capacity forecasting.




MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


can provide recorded call event data to mediation DB client


1812


, in one embodiment. Mediation DB client


212


normalizes the recorded call data it receives from MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


and provides a data feed to a billing system at approximately real-time.




MNEDBs


226




a


and


226




b


use a separate physical interface for all SNMP messages and additional functions that can be defined to communicate with network management component


118


. Additional functions can include, for example, provisioning, updating and passing special alarm and performance parameters to MNEDBs


326




a


and


326




b


from the network operation center (NOC) of network management component


118


.




(2) Event Block Definitions




Definitions of the Event Blocks (EBs) that can be recorded during call processing are detailed in this section.




(a) Example Mandatory Event Blocks (EBs) Definitions




Table 20 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0001


. EB


0001


defines a Domestic Toll (TG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Long Distance calls, originating via a Trunking Gateway, i.e., from facilities of the PSTN. Typically, these calls can be PIC-calls, originating over featuring group-D (FGD) facilities.












TABLE 20











EB 0001 - Domestic Toll (TG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Overseas Indicator




 8




1







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Carrier Selection Information




51




2







Carrier Identification Code




12




4







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3







Ingress Originating Point Code




17




9







Ingress Destination Point Code




18




9







Jurisdiction Information




30




6















Table 21 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0002


. EB


0002


defines Domestic Toll (TG termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Long Distance calls terminating via a Trunking Gateway to the PSTN.












TABLE 21











EB 0002 - Domestic Toll (TG termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Overseas Indicator




 8




1







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Carrier Identification Code




12




4







Jurisdiction Information




30




6















Table 22 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0003


. EB


0003


defines Domestic Toll (AG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Long Distance calls, originating via an Access Gateway, i.e., entering via a DAL or ISDN PRI line.












TABLE 22











EB 0003 - Domestic Toll (AG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Overseas Indicator




 8




1







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Carrier Selection Information




51




2







Carrier Identification Code




12




4







Ingress Access Gateway




36




7







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 23 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0004


. EB


0004


defines Domestic Toll (AG termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Long Distance calls, terminating via an Access Gateway to a DAL or PRI












TABLE 23











EB 0004 - Domestic Toll (AG termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Overseas Indicator




 8




1







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Carrier Identification Code




12




4















Table 24 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0005


. EB


0005


defines Local (TG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all local calls, originating via a Trunking Gateway from a facility on the PSTN.












TABLE 24











EB 0005 - Local (TG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3







Ingress Originating Point Code




17




9







Ingress Destination Point Code




18




9







Jurisdiction Information




30




6















Table 25 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0006


. EB


0006


defines Local (TG termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all local calls terminating via a Trunking Gateway to facilities of the PSTN.












TABLE 25











EB 0006 - Local (TG termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3















Table 26 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0007


. EB


0007


defines Local (AG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all local calls originating via an Access Gateway.












TABLE 26











EB 0007 - Local (AG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Access Gateway




36




7







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 27 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0008


. EB


0008


defines Local (AG termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all local calls, terminating via an Access Gateway.












TABLE 27











EB 0008 - Local (AG termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




2







Originating Number




 7




10 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3















Table 28 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0009


. EB


0009


defines 8XX/Toll-Free (TG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for Toll-Free (8XX) calls, originating via a Trunking Gateway from












TABLE 28











EB 0009 - 8XX/Toll-Free (TG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Dialed NPA




25




3







Dialed Number




26




7







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3







Ingress Originating Point Code




17




9







Ingress Destination Point Code




18




9















Table 29 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0010


. EB


0010


defines 8XX/Toll-Free (TG termination), which can be the logical data set generated for Toll-Free (8XX)s calls, terminating via a Trunking Gateway to the facilities of the PSTN.












TABLE 29











EB 0010 - 8XX/Toll-Free (TG termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Dialed NPA




25




3







Dialed Number




26




7







Destination NPA/CC




27




5







Destination Number




28




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3















Table 30 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0011


. EB


0011


defines 8XX/Toll-Free (AG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for Toll-Free (8XX) calls, originating via an Access Gateway.












TABLE 30











EB 0011 - 8XX/Toll-Free (AG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Dialed NPA




25




3







Dialed Number




26




7







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Access Gateway




36




7







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 31 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0012


. EB


0012


defines 8XX/Toll-Free (AG termination), which can be the logical data set generated for Toll-Free (8XX)s calls, terminating via an Access Gateway.












TABLE 31











EB 0012 - 8XX/Toll-Free (AG termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Dialed NPA




25




3







Dialed Number




26




7







Destination Number




28




10 







Destination NPA/CC




27




5







Call Type Identification




79




3















Table 32 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0013


. EB


0013


defines Domestic Operator Services (TG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Operator Assisted calls, originating via a TG. The actual billing information (which can include the services utilized on the operator services platform (OSP): 3rd party billing, collect, etc.) can be derived from the OSP.












TABLE 32











EB 0013 - Domestic Operator Services (TG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3







Ingress Originating Point Code




17




9







Ingress Destination Point Code




18




9















Table 33 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0014


. EB


0014


defines Domestic Operator Services (AG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Operator Assisted calls, originating via an AG. The actual billing information (which can include the services utilized on the OSP) can be derived from the OSP.












TABLE 33











EB 0014 - Domestic Operator Services (AG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Access Gateway




36




6







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




6







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 34 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0015


. EB


0015


defines Domestic Operator Services (OSP termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Operator Assisted calls, terminating to the OSP. The actual billing information(which can include the services utilized on the OSP) can be derived from the OSP.












TABLE 34











EB 0015 - Domestic Operator Services (OSP termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Operator Trunk Group Number




69




4







Operator Circuit Identification Code




70




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 35 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0016


. EB


0016


defines International Operator Services (TG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Operator Assisted calls, originated via a TG. The actual billing information(which can include the services utilized on the OSP) can be derived from the OSP.












TABLE 35











EB 0016 - International Operator Services (TG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (International)




74




14 







Customer Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3







Ingress Originating Point Code




17




9







Ingress Destination Point Code




18




9















Table 36 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0017


. EB


0017


defines International Operator Services (AG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Operator Assisted calls, originated via an AG. The actual billing information(which will include the services utilized on the OSP) can be derived from the OSP.












TABLE 36











EB 0017 - International Operator Services (AG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (International)




74




14 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Access Gateway




36




6







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 37 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0018


. EB


0018


defines International Operator Services (OSP termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Operator Assisted calls, terminating to the OSP. The actual billing information(which will include the services utilized on the OSP) can be derived from the OSP.












TABLE 37











EB 0018 - International Operator Services (OSP termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (International)




74




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Operator Trunk Group Number




69




4







Operator Circuit Identification Code




70




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 38 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0019


. EB


0019


defines Directory Assistance/555-1212 (TG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for 555-1212 calls, originating via a TG from the PSTN.












TABLE 38











EB 0019 - Directory Assistance/555-1212 (TG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3







Ingress Originating Point Code




17




9







Ingress Destination Point Code




18




9















Table 39 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0020


. EB


0020


defines Directory Assistance/555-1212 (AG origination), which can be the logical data set generated for 555-1212 calls, originating via an AG on a DAL.












TABLE 39











EB 0020 - Directory Assistance/555-1212 (AG origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Access Gateway




36




6







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 40 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0021


. EB


0021


defines Directory Assistance/555-1212 (Directory Assistance Services Platform (DASP) termination), which can be the logical data set generated for 555-1212 calls, terminating to the DASP.












TABLE 40











EB 0021 - Directory Assistance/555-1212 (DASP termination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Access Gateway




36




6







DA Trunk Group Number




75




4







DA Circuit Identification Code




76




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 41 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0022


. EB


0022


defines OSP/DASP Extended Calls (Domestic), which can be the logical data set generated for all Domestic Operator and Directory Assisted calls that are extended back to telecommunications network


200


for termination.












TABLE 41











EB 0022 - OSP/DASP Extended Calls (Domestic)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Overseas Indicator




 8




2







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 42 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0023


. EB


0023


defines OSP/DASP Extended Calls (International), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Operator and Directory Assisted calls that are extended back to the telecommunications network


200


for termination.












TABLE 42











EB 0023 - OSP/DASP Extended Calls (International)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Overseas Indicator




 8




2







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (International)




74




14 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Date




72




8







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 43 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0024


. EB


0024


defines International Toll (TG Origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Long Distance calls, originating via a Trunking Gateway from facilities of the PSTN. Typically, these calls can be PIC-calls, originating over FGD facilities.












TABLE 43











EB 0024 - International Toll (TG Origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Overseas Indicator




 8




2







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (Intl.)




74




14 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Carrier Selection Information




51




2







Carrier Identification Code




12




4







Ingress Trunking Gateway




52




6







Ingress Carrier Connect Time




13




9







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Ingress Originating Point Code




17




9







Ingress Destination Point Code




18




9







Jurisdiction Information




30




6







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 44 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0025


. EB


0025


defines International Toll (AG Origination), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Long Distance calls, originating via an Access Gateway.












TABLE 44











EB 0025 - International Toll (AG Origination)
















Element




Number of







Element




Number




Characters











Event Block Code




 0




6







Unique Call/Event Identifier




 1




26 







Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2







Soft-Switch ID




 2




6







Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4







Directional Flag




77




1







Connect Date




 3




8







Connect Time




 4




9







Calling Party Category




 6




3







Originating Number




 7




10 







Customer Identification




80




12 







Customer Location Identification




81




12 







Overseas Indicator




 8




1







Terminating NPA/CC




 9




5







Terminating Number (Intl.)




74




14 







Call Type Identification




79




3







Carrier Selection Information




51




2







Carrier Identification Code




12




4







Ingress Access Gateway




36




6







Ingress Trunk Group Number




15




4







Ingress Circuit Identification Code




16




4







Trunk Group Type




78




3















Table 45 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0026


. EB


0026


defines International Toll (TG Termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Long Distance calls terminating via a Trunking Gateway to facilities of the PSTN.












TABLE 45











EB 0026-International Toll (TG Termination)















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Connect Date




3




8






Connect Time




4




9






Calling Party Category




6




3






Originating Number




7




10






Overseas Indicator




8




1






Terminating NPA/CC




9




5






Terminating Number (Intl.)




74




14






Call Type Identification




79




3






Carrier Identification Code




12




4






Jurisdiction Information




30




6






Trunk Group Type




78




3














Table 46 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0027


. EB


0027


defines International Toll (AG Termination), which can be the logical data set generated for all International Long Distance calls, terminating via an Access Gateway to a DPL or PRI.












TABLE 46











EB 0027-International Toll (AG Termination)















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Connect Date




3




8






Connect Time




4




9






Calling Party Category




6




3






Originating Number




7




10






Overseas Indicator




8




1






Terminating NPA/CC




9




5






Terminating Number (Intl.)




74




14






Call Type Identification




79




3






Carrier Identification Code




12




4






Trunk Group Type




78




3














Table 47 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0040


. EB


0040


defines IP Origination, which can be the logical data set generated for ALL IP originations.












TABLE 47











EB 0040-IP Origination















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Connect Date




3




8






Connect Time




4




9






Originating Number




7




10






Customer Identification




80




12






Customer Location Identification




81




12






Terminating NPA/CC




9




5






Terminating Number




10




10






Call Type Identification




79




3






Originating IP Address




63




12






Ingr. Security Gateway IP Address




65




12






Ingress Firewall IP Address




67




12














Table 48 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0041


. EB


0041


defines IP Termination, which can be the logical data set generated for ALL IP terminations.












TABLE 48











EB 0041-IP Termination















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Connect Date




3




8






Connect Time




4




9






Originating Number




7




10






Terminating NPA/CC




9




5






Terminating Number (NANP)




10




10






Call Type Identification




79




3






Terminating IP Address




64




12






Egr. Security Gateway IP Address




66




12






Egress Firewall IP Address




68




12














(b) Example Augmenting Event Block (EBs) Definitions




Table 49 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0050


. EB


0050


defines a Final Event Block, which can be used as the FINAL Event Block for ALL calls/events. It signifies the closure of a call/event.












TABLE 49











EB 0050-Final Event Block















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






End Date




40




8






End Time




39




9






Elapsed Time




11




10






Audio Packets Sent




59




9






Audio Packets Received




60




9






Audio Packets Lost




61




9






Audio Bytes Transferred




62




9














Table 50 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0051


. EB


0051


defines Answer Indication, which can be used as to indicate whether or not a call/session was answered or unanswered. If the call was unanswered, the Answer Indicator element will indicate that the call was not answered and the Answer Time element will contain the time that the originating party went on-hook.












TABLE 50











EB 0051-Answer Indication















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Answer Indicator




5




1






Answer Date




41




8






Answer Time




42




9














Table 51 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0052


. EB


0052


defines Ingress Trunking Disconnect Information which can contain Ingress Trunking Disconnect information. The release date and time of the ingress circuit used in the call can be recorded. This EB can be extremely important to downstream systems (i.e. cost analysis/CABS analysis) that may need to audit the bills coming from LECs/CLECs/Carriers.












TABLE 51











ER 0052-Ingress Trunking Disconnect Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Ingress Carrier Disconnect Date




44




8






Ingress Carrier Disconnect Time




43




9














Table 52 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0053


. EB


0053


defines Egress Trunking Disconnect Information, which can contain Egress Trunking Disconnect information. The release date and time of the egress circuit used in the call can be recorded. This EB can be extremely important to downstream systems (i.e. cost analysis/CABS analysis) that can need to audit the bills coming from LECs/CLECs/Carriers.












TABLE 52











EB 0053-Egress Trunking Disconnect Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Egress Carrier Disconnect Date




46




8






Egress Carrier Disconnect Time




45




9














Table 53 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0054


. EB


0054


defines Basic 8XX/Toll-Free SCP Transaction Information, which can be used for all basic toll-free (8XX) SCP transactions.












TABLE 53











EB 0054-Basic 8XX/Toll-Free SCP Transaction Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Transaction Identification




31




9






Database Identification




34




3






Transaction Start Time




32




9






Transaction End Time




33




9






Carrier Selection Information




51




2






Carrier Identification Code




12




4






Overseas Indicator




8




1






Destination NPA/CC




27




5






Destination Number




28




10






Customer Identification




80




12






Customer Location Identification




81




12






Alternate Billing Number




29




10














Table 54 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0055


. EB


0055


defines Calling Party (Ported) Information, which can be used to record information in regards to a Calling Party Number that has been ported.












TABLE 54











EB 0055-Calling Party (Ported) Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Location Routing Number




48




11






LRN Supporting Information




49




1














Table 55 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0056


. EB


0056


defines Called Party (Ported) Information, which can be used to record information in regards to a Called Party Number that has been ported.












TABLE 55











EB 0056-Called Party (Ported) Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Location Routing Number




48




11






LRN Supporting Information




49




1














Table 56 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0057


. EB


0057


defines Egress Routing Information (TG termination), which can be used to record the egress routing information (i.e., terminating via the PSTN).












TABLE 56











EB 0057-Egress Routing Information (TG termination)















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Egress Routing Selection




54




2






Egress Trunking Gateway




53




6






Egress Carrier Connect Date




73




8






Egress Carrier Connect Time




19




9






Egress Trunk Group Number




21




4






Egress Circuit Identification Code




22




4






Trunk Group Type




78




3






Egress Originating Point Code




23




9






Egress Destination Point Code




24




9














Table 57 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0058


. EB


0058


defines Routing Congestion Information, which can be used to record routes/trunks that were unavailable (e.g., due to congestion, failure, etc.) during the route selection process in soft switch


204


. EB


0057


(for TG termination) and EB


0060


(for AG termination) can be used to record the ACTUAL route/trunk used to terminate the call. This information can be extremely valuable to, for example, traffic engineering, network management, cost analysis.












TABLE 57











EB 0058-Routing Congestion Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Routing Attempt Time




57




9






Routing Attempt Date




58




8






Egress Routing Selection




54




2






Egress Trunking Gateway




53




6






Egress Trunk Group Number




21




4






Congestion Code




55




2














Table 58 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0059


. EB


0059


defines Account Code Information, which can be used for all calls requiring account codes.












TABLE 58











EB 0059-Account Code Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Account Code Type




71




1






Account Code




38




14






Account Code Validation Flag




56




1














Table 59 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0060


. EB


0060


defines Egress Routing Information (for AG termination), which can be used to record the egress routing information (i.e., terminating via an AG).












TABLE 59











EB 0060-Egress Routing Information (AG termination)















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Egress Routing Selection




54




2






Egress Access Gateway




37




6






Egress Carrier Connect Date




73




8






Egress Carrier Connect Time




19




9






Egress Trunk Group Number




21




4






Egress Circuit Identification Code




22




4






Trunk Group Type




78




3














Table 60 below provides a definition of event block (EB)


0061


. EB


0061


defines Long Duration Call Information, which can be used to record a timestamp of long duration calls. Soft switch


204


can generate this block when a call has been up for a duration that spans over two midnights. Subsequent LDCI EBs can be generated after each additional traverse of a single midnight. As an example, if a call has been up from 11:52 pm on Monday, through 4:17 pm on Thursday (of the same week), then TWO EB


0061


s can be generated for the call. One can be generated at midnight on Tuesday, the other can be generated at midnight on Wednesday.












TABLE 60











EB 0061-Long Duration Call Information















Number of






Element




Element Number




Characters
















Event Block Code




0




6






Unique Call/Event Identifier




1




26






Call Event Block Sequence Number




82




2






Soft-Switch ID




2




6






Soft Switch Version ID.




50




4






Directional Flag




77




1






Long Duration Sequence Number




83




2






Long Duration Event Time




84




9






Long Duration Event Date




85




8














(3) Example Element Definitions




Elements are the building blocks of Event Blocks (EBs). Event Blocks are logical groupings of elements. Each element can contain information that is collected during call/event processing, whether from, for example, signaling messages, external databases (SCPs and intelligent peripherals (IPs)), Access GTGs, customer attributes, or derived by a soft switch. All of the elements contain information that is used by various downstream systems. Downstream systems include, for example, billing/mediation, traffic engineering, carrier access billing, statistical engines, cost analysis engines, and marketing tools.




Example Call Elements include the following:




Element


0


—Event Block Code;




Element


1


—Unique Call/Event Identifier;




Element


2


—Soft-Switch ID;




Element


3


—Connect Date;




Element


4


—Connect Time;




Elements—Answer Indicator;




Element


6


—Calling Party Category;




Element


7


—Originating Number;




Element


8


—Overseas Indicator;




Element


9


—Terminating NPA/CC;




Element


10


—Terminating Number;




Element


11


—Elapsed Time;




Element


12


—Carrier Identification Code;




Element


13


—Ingress Carrier Connect Time;




Element


14


—Ingress Carrier Elapsed Time;




Element


15


—Ingress Trunk Group Number;




Element


16


—Ingress Circuit Identification Code;




Element


17


—Ingress Originating Point Code;




Element


18


—Ingress Destination Point Code;




Element


19


—Egress Carrier Connect Time;




Element


20


—Egress Carrier Elapsed Time;




Element


21


—Egress Trunk Group Number;




Element


22


—Egress Circuit Identification Code;




Element


23


—Egress Originating Point Code;




Element


24


—Egress Destination Point Code;




Element


25


—Dialed NPA;




Element


26


—Dialed Number;




Element


27


—Destination NPA/CC;




Element


28


—Destination Number;




Element


29


—Alternate Billing Number;




Element


30


—Jurisdiction Information;




Element


31


—Transaction Identification;




Element


32


—Transaction Start Time;




Element


33


—Transaction End Time;




Element


34


—Database Identification;




Element


36


—Ingress Access Gateway;




Element


37


—Egress Access Gateway;




Element


38


—Account Code;




Element


39


—End Time;




Element


40


—End Date;




Element


41


—Answer Date;




Element


42


—Answer Time;




Element


43


—Ingress Carrier Disconnect Time;




Element


44


—Ingress Carrier Disconnect Date;




Element


45


—Egress Carrier Disconnect Time;




Element


46


—Egress Carrier Disconnect Date;




Element


47


—Announcement Identification;




Element


48


—Location Routing Number;




Element


49


—LRN Supporting Information;




Element


50


—Soft Switch Version;




Element


51


—Carrier Selection Information;




Element


52


—Ingress Trunking Gateway;




Element


53


—Egress Trunking Gateway;




Element


54


—Egress Routing Selection;




Element


55


—Egress Route Congestion Code;




Element


56


—Account Code Validation Flag;




Element


57


—Routing Attempt Time;




Element


58


—Routing Attempt Date;




Element


59


—Audio Packets Sent;




Element


60


—Audio Packets Received;




Element


61


—Audio Packets Lost;




Element


62


—Audio Bytes Transferred;




Element


63


—Originating IP Address;




Element


64


—Terminating IP Address;




Element


65


—Ingress Security Gateway IP Address;




Element


66


—Egress Security Gateway IP Address;




Element


67


—Ingress Firewall IP Address;




Element


68


—Egress Firewall IP Address;




Element


69


—Operator Trunk Group Number;




Element


70


—Operator Circuit Identification Code;




Element


71


—Account Code Type;




Element


72


—Ingress Carrier Connect Date;




Element


73


—Egress Carrier Connect Date;




Element


74


—Terminating Number (International);




Element


75


—DA Trunk Group Number;




Element


76


—DA Circuit Identification Code;




Element


77


—Directional Flag;




Element


78


—Trunk Group Type;




Element


79


—Call Type Identification;




Element


80


—Customer Identification;




Element


81


—Customer Location Identification;




Element


82


—Call Event Block Sequence Number;




Element


83


—Long Duration Sequence Number;




Element


84


—Long Duration Event Time; and




Element


85


—Long Duration Event Date.




(4) Element Definitions




Element definitions recorded during call processing are defined in this section.




Table 61 below provides a definition of element


0


. Element


0


defines an Event Block Code element, which contains a code that can be mapped/correlated to a type of call/event. The EB code can be used for parsing and data definition for downstream systems.




An example of this element follows: EB


0012


.












TABLE 61











Element 0-Event Block Code














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




EB (constant)







3-6




Event Block Code















Table 62 below provides a definition of element


1


. Element


1


defines an Unique Call/Event Identifier (UCEI), which can be used to correlate all events (EBs) for a particular call/session. The correlation can be done in the MNEDB.




An example of this element follows: BOS00219980523123716372001.












TABLE 62











Element 1-Unique Call/Event Identifier (UCEI)












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-3




Site Identification






3-6




Node Identification






 7-14




Date






15-23




Connect Time






24-26




Sequence Number*











*A sequential number (per millisecond (ms)) from 0-999 can be incremented, then appended to each UCEI. This will allow differentiation of calls/events that are processed at the same Site, on the same Node (soft switch), on the same date, at exactly the same time(down to the ms).













Table 63 below provides a definition of element


2


. Element


2


defines a Soft-Switch ID element, which contains the soft switch identification number. This can indicate which soft switch recorded the call event data.




An example of this element follows: BOS003.












TABLE 63











Element 2-Soft-Switch ID














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Three Letter City ID







4-6




Soft Switch Number















Table 64 below provides a definition of element


3


. Element


3


defines a Connect Date element, which contains the date when the call was originated.




An example of this element follows: 19980430.












TABLE 64











Element 3-Connect Date














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-4




Year







5-6




Month







7-8




Day















Table 65 below provides a definition of element


4


. Element


4


defines a Connect Time element, which contains the time when the soft switch received an IAM.




An example of this element follows: 125433192.












TABLE 65











Element 4-Connect Time














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Hours







3-4




Minutes







5-6




Seconds







7-9




Milliseconds















Table 66 below provides a definition of element


5


. Element


5


defines an Answer Indicator element, which states whether or not a call/session was answered/unanswered.




An example of this element follows: 1.












TABLE 66











Element 5-Answer Indicator














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1




0 = Answered








1 = Unanswered















Table 67 below provides a definition of element


6


. Element


6


defines a Calling Party Category element, which contains whether a call was originated from, for example, a Hotel, a Prison, a Cell Phone, a pay phone, a PVIPS, and an inward wide area telephone service (INWATS), based on the Calling Party Category received in the Initial Address Message (IAM), derived from a soft switch, or received from a database external from the soft switch.




An example of this element follows: 1.












TABLE 67











Element 6-Calling Party Category














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




000 = PVIPS








001 = Prepay Coin








002 = Hotel/Motel








003 = IP Phone








008 = INWATS Terminating








018 = Prison















Table 68 below provides a definition of element


7


. Element


7


defines an Originating Number element, which contains the NPA NXX-XXXX (DN) that originated the call.




An example of this element follows: 3039263223.












TABLE 68











Element 7-Originating Number














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-10




Originating Number















Table 69A below provides a definition of element


8


. Element


8


defines an Overseas Indicator element, which provides the digit length of an overseas call, as well as whether or not an NPA was dialed or implied/derived from the soft switch. This element is crucial to downstream systems (i.e., billing/mediation) which need to differentiate between NPAs and CCs.




An example of this element follows: 01D.












TABLE 69A











Element 8-Overseas Indicator












ASCII







Characters




Meaning









1-2




00 = NPA Dialed By the Customer (not an overseas call)







01 = NPA Implied/Derived By Soft Switch







02 = Non-North American Numbering Plan Termination







03 = 7 Digit Overseas Number







04 = 8 Digit Overseas Number







05 = 9 Digit Overseas Number







06 = 10 Digit Overseas Number







07 = 11 Digit Overseas Number







08 = 12 Digit Overseas Number







09 = 13 Digit Overseas Number







10 = 14 Digit Overseas Number







11 = 15 Digit Overseas Number














Table 69B below provides a definition of element


9


. Element


9


defines a Terminating Numbering Plan Area/Country Code (NPA/CC) element, which contains either the NPA of the dialed number for domestic calls, or up to five characters of the overseas number dialed. Today, country codes (CCs) can be up to 3 digits and the national significant number can be up to 14 digits (since Dec. 31, 1996), for a total of no more than 15 digits. If the call is domestic, the first two characters can be 00(padding), the next three characters can be the NPA, and the last character can be the delimiter.




An example of this element follows: 00303D.












TABLE 69B











Element 9-Terminating Numbering Plan Area/Country Code NPA/CC














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Overseas Expander Positions







3-5




NPA















Table 69C below provides a definition of element


10


. Element


10


defines a Terminating Number North American Numbering Plan (NANP) element, which contains the NXX-LINE of the dialed number for domestic calls. The terminating number element should be populated for ALL calls that require a terminating number for billing.




An example of this element follows: 9263223.












TABLE 69C











Element 10-Terminating Number North American Numbering Plan






(NANP)














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




NXX







4-7




Four Digit Line Number















Table 70 below provides a definition of element


11


. Element


11


defines an Elapsed Time element, which contains the elapsed time (duration) of a completed call/session. The time can be GMT.




An example of this element follows: 123716372












TABLE 70











Element 11-Elapsed Time














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Hours







4-5




Minutes







6-7




Seconds







8-10




Milliseconds















Table 71 below provides a definition of element


12


. Element


12


defines a Carrier Identification Code element, which contains the toll carrier's identification code. This can be an extremely useful element for downstream systems (i.e. billing), that need to parse records for wholesale customers!




An example of this element follows: 0645












TABLE 71











Element 12-Carrier Identification Code














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-4




Carrier Identification Code















Table 72 below provides a definition of element


13


. Element


13


defines an Ingress Carrier Connect Time element, which contains the time that the ingress trunk/circuit was seized for a call, that is, when an ACM was sent towards the PSTN. This element can be important to downstream systems (i.e. cost analysis/CABS analysis) that may need to audit the bills coming from LECs/CLECs/Carriers.




An example of this element follows: 123716372












TABLE 72











Element 13-Ingress Carrier Connect Time














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Hours







3-4




Minutes







5-6




Seconds







7-9




Milliseconds















Table 73 below provides a definition of element


14


. Element


14


defines an Ingress Carrier Elapsed Time element, which contains the elapsed time(duration) that the ingress trunk/circuit was in use(from seizure to release) for both answered and unanswered calls/sessions. This element can be important to downstream systems (i.e. cost analysis/CABS analysis) that may need to audit the bills coming from LECs/CLECs/Carriers.




An example of this element follows: 123716372.












TABLE 73











Element 14-Ingress Carrier Elapsed Time














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Hours







3-4




Minutes







5-6




Seconds







7-9




Milliseconds















Table 74 below provides a definition of element


15


. Element


15


defines an Ingress Trunk Group Number element, which contains the Trunk Number on the originating/ingress side of a call. The information can be derived from either TG or AG, or from a correlation table, using Element


16


—Ingress Circuit Identification Code, Element


17


—Ingress Originating Point Code, and Element


18


—Ingress Destination Point Code, to correlate to a specific trunk group. This element can be important to downstream systems (i.e. cost analysis/CABS analysis) that may need to audit the bills coming from LECs/CLECs/Carriers. This can also assist traffic engineers in trunk sizing.




An example of this element follows: 1234.












TABLE 74











Element 15-Ingress Trunk Group Number














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-4




Trunk Group Number















Table 75 below provides a definition of element


16


. Element


16


defines an Ingress Circuit Identification Code element, which contains the circuit number/id of the circuit used on the originating/ingress side of a call. The information can be derived from either TG or AG, or from the Circuit Identification Code (CIC) field in the IAM.




An example of this element follows: 0312












TABLE 75











Element 16-Ingress Circuit Identification Code














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-4




Identification Code/Trunk Member Number















Table 76 below provides a definition of element


17


. Element


17


defines an Ingress Originating Point Code (IOPC) element, which contains the ingress OPC.




An example of this element follows: 212001001.












TABLE 76











Element 17-Ingress Originating Point Code














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Network (0-255)







4-6




Cluster (0-255)







7-9




Member (0-255)















Table 77 below provides a definition of element


18


. Element


18


defines an Ingress Destination Point (IDC) Code.




An example of this element follows: 213002002.












TABLE 77











Element 18-Ingress Destination Point Code














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Network (0-255)







4-6




Cluster (0-255)







7-9




Member (0-255)















Table 78 below provides a definition of element


19


. Element


19


defines an Egress Carrier Connect Time element, which contains the time that the egress trunk/circuit was seized for a call. The time can be derived from the Access or Trunking Gateways, or from the Initial Address Message. This element can be important to downstream systems (i.e. CABS) that need this information to BILL other LECs/CLECs/Carriers.




An example of this element follows: 123716372.












TABLE 78











Element 19-Egress Carrier Connect Time














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Hours







3-4




Minutes







5-6




Seconds







7-9




Milliseconds















Table 79 below provides a definition of element


20


. Element


20


defines an Egress Carrier Elapsed Time element, which contains the elapsed time (duration) that the egress trunk/circuit was in use (from seizure to release) for both answered and unanswered calls/sessions. This element can be important to downstream systems (i.e. CABS) that need this information to BILL other LECs/CLECs/Carriers.




An example of this element follows: 123716372.












TABLE 79











Element 20-Egress Carrier Elapsed Time














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Hours







3-4




Minutes







5-6




Seconds







7-9




Milliseconds















Table 80 below provides a definition of element


21


. Element


21


defines an Egress Trunk Group Number element, which contains the Trunk Number on the terminating/egress side of a call. The information can be derived from either TG or AG, or from a correlation table, using Element


22


—Egress Circuit Identification Code, Element


23


—Egress Originating Point Code, and Element


24


—Egress Destination Point Code, to correlate to a specific trunk group. This element can be important to downstream systems (i.e. cost analysis/CABS analysis) that may need to audit the bills coming from LECs/CLECs/Carriers.




An example of this element follows: 4321.












TABLE 80











Element 21-Egress Trunk Group Number














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-4




Trunk Group Number















Table 81 below provides a definition of element


22


. Element


22


defines an Egress Circuit Identification Code element, which contains the circuit number/id of the circuit used on the terminating/egress side of a call. The information can be derived from either TG or AG, or from the Circuit Identification Code (CIC) field in the IAM message.




An example of this element follows: 0645.












TABLE 81











Element 22-Egress Circuit Identification Code












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Circuit Identification Code/Trunk Member Number














Table 82 below provides a definition of element


23


. Element


23


defines an Egress Originating Point (EOP) Code.




An example of this element follows: 212001001.












TABLE 82











Element 23-Egress Originating Point Code














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Network (0-255)







4-6




Cluster (0-255)







7-9




Member (0-255)















Table 83 below provides a definition of element


24


. Element


24


defines an Egress Destination Point (EDP) Code.




An example of this element follows: 213002002.












TABLE 83











Element 24-Egress Destination Point Code














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Network (0-255)







4-6




Cluster (0-255)







7-9




Member (0-255)















Table 84 below provides a definition of element


25


. Element


25


defines a Dialed NPA element, which contains the 8XX code for a toll-free call.




An example of this element follows: 888.












TABLE 84











Element 25-Dialed NPA














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




NPA















Table 85 below provides a definition of element


26


. Element


26


defines a Dialed Number element, which contains the NXX-LINE of the dialed number for domestic toll-free calls. The terminating number element has seven significant characters and a sign (delimiter) character.




An example of this element follows: 4532609.












TABLE 85











Element 26-Dialed Number














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




NXX







4-7




Four Digit Line Number















Table 86 below provides a definition of element


27


. Element


27


defines a Destination NPA/CC element, which contains the Numbering Plan Area (NPA) for domestic calls and the Country Code (CC) for international calls. This information is SCP derived for 8XX calls. The element is right justified and padded (with


0


s) if necessary.




An example of this element follows: 00303D.












TABLE 86











Element 27-Destination NPA/CC














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-2




Overseas Expander Positions







3-5




NPA/CC















Table 87 below provides a definition of element


28


. Element


28


defines a Destination Number element, which contains the NXX-LINE of the destination number for domestic toll-free calls. This number is the routing number returned from a SCP


800


query. The terminating number element has seven significant characters and a sign (delimiter) character. The terminating number element should be populated for ALL calls that require a terminating number for billing.




An example of this element follows: 9263223D.












TABLE 87











Element 28-Destination Number














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




NXX







4-7




Four Digit Line Number















Table 88 below provides a definition of element


29


. Element


29


defines an Alternate Billing Number field element, which contains the billing number obtained from the optional billing number data received from SCP.




An example of this element follows: 3039263223D.












TABLE 88











Element 29-Alternate Billing Number














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-10




Alternate Billing Number















Table 89 below provides a definition of element


30


. Element


30


defines a Jurisdiction Information element, which contains the NPA-NXX of the originating Switch. This information can be contained in the Initial Address Message.




An example of this element follows: 303926D.












TABLE 89











Element 30-Jurisdiction Information














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




NPA







4-6




NXX







7




Delimiter















Table 90 below provides a definition of element


31


. Element


31


defines a Transaction Identification element, which contains a unique identification number for each external request to a SCP, an Intelligent Peripheral (IP), or some other database.




An example of this element follows: 0000012673.












TABLE 90











Element 31-Transaction Identification














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-9




Transaction ID















Table 91 below provides a definition of element


32


. Element


32


defines a Transaction Start Time element, which contains the time that the Soft Switch sent an external request to an SCP, an Intelligent Peripheral (IP), or some other database.




An example of this element follows: 124312507.












TABLE 91











Element 32-Transaction Start Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 92 below provides a definition of element


33


. Element


33


defines a Transaction End Time element, which contains the time that the Soft Switch received a response from an external request to a SCP, an Intelligent Peripheral (IP), or some other database.




An example of this element follows: 102943005.












TABLE 92











Element 33-Transaction End Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 93 below provides a definition of element


34


. Element


34


defines a Database Identification element, which contains the SCP, Intelligent Peripheral (IP), or some other database's identification number, that a transaction was performed.




An example of this element follows: 005.












TABLE 93











Element 34-Database Identification














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Database ID number















Table 94 below provides a definition of element


36


. Element


36


defines an Ingress Access Gateway element, which contains the AG identification number.




An example of this element follows: BOS003.












TABLE 94











Element 36-Ingress Access Gateway












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-3




Three Letter City ID






4-6




Trunking Gateway Number














Table 95 below provides a definition of element


37


. Element


37


defines an Egress Access Gateway element, which contains the AG identification number. An example of this element follows: BOS003.












TABLE 95











Element 37-Egress Access Gateway












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-3




Three Letter City ID






4-6




Trunking Gateway Number














Table 96 below provides a definition of element


38


. Element


38


defines an Account Code element, which contains the length of the account code, as well as the actual account code digits that were entered.




An example of this element follows: 06000043652678.












TABLE 96











Element 38-Account Code












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Account Code Length







00 = 2 Digit Account Code







01 = 3 Digit Account Code







02 = 4 Digit Account Code







03 = 5 Digit Account Code







04 = 6 Digit Account Code







05 = 7 Digit Account Code







06 = 8 Digit Account Code







07 = 9 Digit Account Code







08 = 10 Digit Account Code







09 = 11 Digit Account Code







11 = 12 Digit Account Code






3-14




Account Code Digits











*The Account Code digits can be right justified and padded with Os.













Table 97 below provides a definition of element


39


. Element


39


defines an End Time element, which contains the time when the call completed. The time should be recorded after both parties, originating and terminating, go on-hook.




An example of this element follows: 032245039.












TABLE 97











Element 39-End Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 98 below provides a definition of element


40


. Element


40


defines an End Date element, which contains the date when the call was completed.




An example of this element follows: 19980218.












TABLE 98











Element 40-End Date












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day














Table 99 below provides a definition of element


41


. Element


41


defines an Answer Date element, which contains the date when the call was answered.




An example of this element follows: 19980513.












TABLE 99











Element 41-Answer Date












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day














Table 100 below provides a definition of element


42


. Element


42


defines an Answer Time element, which contains the time when the terminating station went off-hook. The timer could start when the Soft Switch receives an answer message, If the call was unanswered, the Answer Time will contain the time that the originating party went on-hook.




An example of this element follows: 023412003.












TABLE 100











Element 42-Answer Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 101 below provides a definition of element


43


. Element


43


defines an Ingress Carrier Disconnect Time element, which contains the time that the ingress trunk/circuit was released for a call. The time will either be derived from the Access or Trunking Gateways, or from the Release Message. This element can be important to downstream systems (i.e. cost analysis/CABS analysis) that may need to audit the bills coming from LECs/CLECs/Carriers.




An example of this element follows: 041152092.












TABLE 101











Element 43-Ingress Carrier Disconnect Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 102 below provides a definition of element


44


. Element


44


defines an Ingress Carrier Disconnect Date Disconnect Date element, which contains the date when the ingress trunk/circuit was released for a call.




An example of this element follows: 19980523.












TABLE 102











Element 44-Ingress Carrier Disconnect Date Disconnect Date












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day














Table 103 below provides a definition of element


45


. Element


45


defines an Egress Carrier Disconnect Time element, which contains the time that the egress trunk/circuit was released for a call. The time will either be derived from the Access or Trunking Gateways, or from the Release Message. This element can be extremely important to downstream systems (i.e. CABS) that need this information to BILL other LECs/CLECs/Carriers.




An example of this element follows: 041152092.












TABLE 103











Element 45-Egress Carrier Disconnect Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 104 below provides a definition of element


46


. Element


46


defines an Egress Carrier Disconnect Date element, which contains the date when the egress trunk/circuit was released for a call.




An example of this element follows: 19981025D.












TABLE 104











Element 46-Egress Carrier Disconnect Date












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day














Table 105 below provides a definition of element


47


. Element


47


defines an Announcement Identification element, which contains the announcement number (correlating to an announcement) that was invoked during call processing.




An example of this element follows: 0056D.












TABLE 105











Element 47-Announcement Identification












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Announcement ID














Table 106 below provides a definition of element


48


. Element


48


defines a Location Routing Number (LRN) element, which contains the Location Routing Number. Depending on the EB being created (EB


0055


or EB


0056


), this field contains the LRN for the Calling Party Number (if ported) or the LRN for the Called Party Number (if ported).




An example of this element follows: 13039263223D.












TABLE 106











Element 48-Location Routing Number














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1




Party Identifier








1 = Calling Party








2 = Called Party







2-11




Location Routing Number















Table 107 below provides a definition of element


49


. Element


49


defines a LRN Supporting Information element, which contains the source/system where the LRN was derived.




An example of this element follows: 1.












TABLE 107











Element 49-LRN Supporting Information












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1




LRN Source Indicator







1 = LNP Database (SCP)







2 = Derived from the SS







3 = Signaling Data














Table 108 below provides a definition of element


50


. Element


50


defines a Soft Switch Version element, which contains the current software version that is operating on the soft switch.




An example of this element follows: 0150.












TABLE 108











Element 50-Soft Switch Version












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




SS Version Number (Prefix)






2-4




SS Version Number (Suffix)














Table 109 below provides a definition of element


51


. Element


51


defines a Carrier Selection Information element, which contains the toll carrier selection method. This allows downstream systems, such as end-user billing and fraud, to parse records based on carrier selection methods (e.g., pre-subscription, dial-around/casual-calling.)




An example of this element follows: 01.












TABLE 109











Element 51-Carrier Selection Information












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Carrier Selection Method







01 = Pre-Subscribed







02 = SS Derived







03 = SCP Derived







04 = Carrier Designated by Caller at Time of Call







(casual-call/dial-around)














Table 110 below provides a definition of element


52


. Element


52


defines an Ingress Trunking Gateway element, which contains the TG identification number.




An example of this element follows: BOS003.












TABLE 110











Element 52-Ingress Trunking Gateway












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-3




Three Letter City ID






4-6




Trunking Gateway Number














Table 111 below provides a definition of element


53


. Element


53


defines an Egress Trunking Gateway element, which contains the TG identification number.




An example of this element follows: DEN003.












TABLE 111











Element 53-Egress Trunking Gateway












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-3




Three Letter City ID






4-6




Trunking Gateway Number














Table 112 below provides a definition of element


54


. Element


54


defines an Egress Routing Selection.




An example of this element follows: 02.












TABLE 112











Element 54-Egress Routing Selection












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Final Route Selection/Choice







01 = 1st route choice







02 = 2nd route choice







03 = 3rd route choice







04 = 4th route choice







05 = 5th route choice














Table 112 below provides a definition of element


55


. Element


55


defines an Egress Route Congestion Code element, which contains the reason for congestion on a trunk.




An example of this element follows: 01.












TABLE 113











Element 55-Egress Route Congestion Code












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Route Congestion Code







01 = Circuit Congestion







02 = Circuit Failure







03 = QoS Not Available














Table 114 below provides a definition of element


56


. Element


56


defines an Account Code Validation Flag element, which contains a flag that specifies whether or not the account code validation was successful.




An example of this element follows: 1.












TABLE 114











Element 56-Account Code Validation Flag












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1




Account Code Validation Flag







0 = AC Validation NOT Successful







1 = AC Validation Successful














Table 115 below provides a definition of element


57


. Element


57


defines a Routing Attempt Time element, which contains the time that an unsuccessful routing attempt was made on a trunk. This information can be useful to downstream Network Management and Traffic Engineering systems.




An example of this element follows: 102943005.












TABLE 115











Element 57-Routing Attempt Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 116 below provides a definition of element


58


. Element


58


defines a Routing Attempt Date element, which contains the date that an unsuccessful routing attempt was made on a trunk. This information can be useful to downstream Network Management and Traffic Engineering systems.




An example of this element follows: 19980430.












TABLE 116











Element 58-Routing Attempt Date element












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day














Table 117 below provides a definition of element


59


. Element


59


defines an Audio Packets Sent element, which contains the number of audio packets that were sent from an AG or TG during a session.




An example of this element follows: 000043917.












TABLE 117











Element 59-Audio Packets Sent












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-9




Audio Packets














Table 118 below provides a definition of element


60


. Element


60


defines an Audio Packets Received element, which contains the number of audio packets that were received by an AG or TG during a session.




An example of this element follows: 000043917.












TABLE 118











Element 60-Audio Packets Received












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-9




Audio Packets














Table 119 below provides a definition of element


61


. Element


61


defines an Audio Packets Lost element, which contains the number of audio packets that were lost during a session.




An example of this element follows: 000043917.












TABLE 119











Element 61-Audio Packets Lost












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-9




Audio Packets














Table 120 below provides a definition of element


62


. Element


62


defines an Audio Bytes Transferred element, which contains the total number of audio packets that were transferred sent from an AG or TG during a session.




An example of this element follows: 000023917.












TABLE 120











Element 62-Audio Bytes Transferred element














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-9




Audio Bytes















Table 121 below provides a definition of element


63


. Element


63


defines an Originating IP Address element, which contains the Internet Protocol (IP) address of the originator.




An example of this element follows: 205123245211.












TABLE 121











Element 63-Originating IP Address














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Class A Address







4-6




Class B Address







7-9




Class C Address







10-12




Class D Address















Table 122 below provides a definition of element


64


. Element


64


defines a Terminating IP Address element, which contains the Internet Protocol (IP) address of the termination.




An example of this element follows: 205123245211.












TABLE 122











Element 64-Terminating IP Address














ASCII Characters




Meaning











1-3




Class A Address







4-6




Class B Address







7-9




Class C Address







10-12




Class D Address















Table 123 below provides a definition of element


65


. Element


65


defines an Ingress Security Gateway IP Address element, which contains the Internet Protocol (IP) address of the security gateway on the ingress portion of a call/session.




An example of this, element follows: 205123245211.












TABLE 123











Element 65 - Ingress Security Gateway IP Address












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-3




Class A Address






4-6




Class B Address






7-9




Class C Address






10-12




Class D Address














Table 124 below provides a definition of element


66


. Element


66


defines an Egress Security Gateway IP Address element, which contains the Internet Protocol (IP) address of the security gateway on the egress portion of a call/session.




An example of this element follows: 205123245211.












TABLE 124











Element 66 - Egress Security Gateway IP Address












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-3




Class A Address






4-6




Class B Address






7-9




Class C Address






10-12




Class D Address














Table 125 below provides a definition of element


67


. Element


67


defines an Ingress Firewall IP Address element, which contains the Internet Protocol (IP) address of the security gateway on the ingress portion of a call/session.




An example of this element follows: 205123245211.












TABLE 125











Element 67 - Ingress Firewall IP Address












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-3




Class A Address






4-6




Class B Address






7-9




Class C Address






10-12




Class D Address














Table 126 below provides a definition of element


68


. Element


68


defines an Egress Firewall IP Address element, which contains the Internet Protocol (IP) address of the security gateway on the egress portion of a call/session.




An example of this element follows: 205123245211.












TABLE 126











Element 68 - Egress Firewall IP Address












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-3




Class A Address






4-6




Class B Address






7-9




Class C Address






10-12




Class D Address














Table 127 below provides a definition of element


69


. Element


69


defines an Operator Trunk Group Number element, which contains the trunk group number for the trunk selected to the Operator Services Platform (OSP).




An example of this element follows: 1234.












TABLE 127











Element 69 - Operator Trunk Group Number












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-4




Trunk Group Number














Table 128 below provides a definition of element


70


. Element


70


defines an Operator Circuit Identification Code (CIC) element, which contains the circuit number/id of the circuit used for an Operator service call.




An example of this element follows: 0312.












TABLE 128











Element 70 - Operator Circuit Identification Code












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-4




Circuit Identification Code/Trunk Member Number














Table 129 below provides a definition of element


71


. Element


71


defines an Account Code Type element, which contains a value associated with the type of account used in the call.




An example of this element follows: 1.












TABLE 129











Element 71 - Account Code Type












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1




Account Code Type







1 = Verified Forced







2 = Verified Unforced







3 = Unverified Forced







4 = Unverified Unforced














Table 130 below provides a definition of element


72


. Element


72


defines an Ingress Carrier Connect Date element, which contains the date when the ingress trunk/circuit was seized.




An example of this element follows: 19980513.












TABLE 130











Element 72 - Ingress Carrier Connect Date












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day






9




Delimiter














Table 131 below provides a definition of element


73


. Element


73


defines an Egress Carrier Connect Date element, which contains the date when the egress trunk/circuit was seized.




An example of this element follows: 19980513.












TABLE 131











Element 73 - Egress Carrier Connect Date












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day














Table 132 below provides a definition of element


74


. Element


74


defines a Terminating Number (International) element, which contains the overseas number that was dialed for domestic calls. The terminating number element should be populated for ALL calls that require a terminating number for billing. This field can be right-justified, padded with


0


s.




An example of this element follows: 34216273523482.












TABLE 132











Element 74 - Terminating Number (International)












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-14




Overseas Number














Table 133 below provides a definition of element


75


. Element


75


defines a DA Trunk Group Number element, which contains the trunk group number for the trunk selected to the directory assistance (DA) service provider.




An example of this element follows: 1234.












TABLE 133











Element 75 - DA Trunk Group Number












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-4




Trunk Group Number














Table 134 below provides a definition of element


76


. Element


76


defines a DA Circuit Identification Code element, which contains the circuit number/id. of the circuit used for a DA service call.




An example of this element follows: 0312.












TABLE 134











Element 76 - DA Circuit Identification Code












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-4




Circuit Identification Code/Trunk Member Number














Table 135 below provides a definition of element


77


. Element


77


defines a Directional Flag element, which contains a flag that specifies whether a call event block is an ingress or an egress generated block.




An example of this element follows: 1.












TABLE 135











Element 77 - Directional Flag












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1




0 = Ingress







1 = Egress














Table 136 below provides a definition of element


78


. Element


78


defines a Trunk Group Type element, which contains a type identification number, which maps to a type/use of a trunk. The element can be useful to downstream systems, such as mediation/billing, fraud, etc. This element can also be used in call processing.




An example of this element follows: 001.












TABLE 136











Element 78 - Trunk Group Type












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-3




Trunk Group Type














Table 137 below provides a definition of element


79


. Element


79


defines a Call Type Identification element, which contains a call type identification number, which maps to a type of a call. The element can be useful to downstream systems, such as, for example, mediation/billing, fraud. This element can also be used in call processing. This element can be derived during LSA analysis.




An example of this element follows: 001.












TABLE 137











Element 79 - Call Type Identification












ASClI Characters




Meaning









1-3




Call Type Identification














Table 138 below provides a definition of element


80


. Element


80


defines a Customer Identification element, which contains a customer account number.




An example of this element follows: 000000325436.












TABLE 138











Element 80 - Customer Identification












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-12




Customer Identification














Table 139 below provides a definition of element


81


. Element


81


defines a Customer Location Identification element, which contains a customer location identification number.




An example of this element follows: 000000000011.












TABLE 139











Element 81 - Customer Location Identification












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-12




Customer Location Identification














Table 140 below provides a definition of element


82


. Element


82


defines a Call Event Block Sequence Number element, which contains a sequence number for each event block created by the soft switch for a particular call.




An example of this element follows: 03.












TABLE 140











Element 82 - Call Event Block Sequence Number












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Call Event Block Sequence Number














Table 141 below provides a definition of element


83


. Element


83


defines a Long Duration Sequence Number element, which contains a sequence number for each long duration call (LDC) event block created by the soft switch for a particular call.




An example of this element follows: 03.












TABLE 141











Element 83 - Long Duration Sequence Number












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Long Duration Sequence Number














Table 142 below provides a definition of element


84


. Element


84


defines a Long Duration Event Time element, which contains the time when the soft switch generated the LDC Event Block.




An example of this element follows: 120000002.












TABLE 142











Element 84 - Long Duration Event Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-2




Hours






3-4




Minutes






5-6




Seconds






7-9




Milliseconds














Table 143 below provides a definition of element


85


. Element


85


defines a Long Duration Event Date element, which contains the date when the soft switch generated the LDC Event Block.




An example of this element follows: 19980430.












TABLE 143











Element 85 - Long Duration Event Time












ASCII Characters




Meaning









1-4




Year






5-6




Month






7-8




Day














7. Network management component




Telecommunications network


200


includes network management component


118


which can use a simple network management protocol (SNMP) to trap alarm conditions within and receive network alerts from hardware and software elements of the network.

FIG. 21A

illustrates in detail SNMP network management architecture


2100


. SNMP network management architecture


2100


is organized into a plurality of tiers and layers (not shown).




Tier 1 addresses hardware specific events that are generated on each respective hardware and software system. Generally, hardware vendors provide tier 1 functionality in the form of a management information base (MIB).




Tier 2 is designed to capture operating system specific events and is also available as a commercially sold product in the form of an MIB from a software vendor.




Tier 3 is related to events generated by customized software running on the platform.




In one embodiment of the invention, tiers 1 and 2 are provided by a hardware vendor, for example, from Sun Microsystems of Palo Alto, Calif. Tier 1 and 2 MIBs are designed to provision, update, and pass special event and performance parameters to a network operations center (NOC), pictured as NOC


2114


in FIG.


21


A.




Tier 3 can support alarm transmission from software applications and can be designed and implemented via a customized software solution from a third party vendor. Software applications can call a standardized alarm transport application programming interface (API) to signal events and alarms within the software code. The vendor supplied alarm API can redirect events to a local alarm manager application. There can be one instance of a local alarm manager application on each customized platform or computer in the network. The local alarm manager can log events to a disk-based database. The local alarm manager can also log events to a disk-based log file and can then forward the events from the database or log file to a specialized MIB component. The specialized MIB component can then divert this information to a regional SNMP agent at each geographical location, i.e., at each soft switch site


104


,


106


and


302


, or gateway site


108




a


,


108




b


,


108


C,


108


D,


108


E,


110




a


,


110




b


,


110




c


,


110


D and


110


E. Regional SNMP agents can then route all incoming network management events or alarms to master SNMP managers


2102


and


2104


at the NOC


2114


.




a. Network Operations Center (NOC)





FIG. 21A

includes Network Operations Center (NOC)


2114


in SNMP network management architecture


2100


. Soft switch sites


104


,


106


and


302


include a plurality of network components each having their own SNMP agents. For example, soft switch site


104


includes RNECP


224




a


and


224




b


having their own SNMP agents. Soft switch site


104


also includes configuration servers


206




a


and


206




b


, soft switches


204




a


,


204




b


and


204




c


, route servers


212




a


and


212




b


, SS7 GWs


208


and


210


, and ESs


332


and


334


, each having their own SNMP agents. Soft switch site


104


can also include one or more redundant SNMP servers


2110


and


2112


for collecting regional SNMP alerts. SNMP servers


2110


and


2112


can maintain log files of network management events. SNMP servers


2110


and


2112


can then send events and alarms upstream to NOC


2114


of network management component


118


. NOC


2114


can include one or more centralized SNMP manager servers


2102


and


2104


for centrally managing telecommunications network


200


.




Soft switch sites


106


and


302


can have similar SNMP agents in network components included in their sites.




Gateway sites


108




a


,


108




b


,


108




c


,


108




d


,


108




e


,


110




a


,


110




b


,


110




c


,


110




d


and


110




e


include multiple gateway site components which can each have their SNMP agents. For example, gateway site


108




a


can include TGs


232




a


and


232




b


which have SNMP agents


1002


. Gateway site


108




a


can also include AGs


238




a


and


238




b


having SNMP agents


1006


. Gateway sites


108




a


can also include ESs


1602


and


1604


and routers


1606


and


1608


having their own SNMP agents. Gateway site


108




a


can also have one or more SNMP servers


2106


and


2108


for gathering SNMP alerts, events and alarms at gateway site


108




a


, from SNMP agents such as, for example, SNMP agents


1002


and


1006


. SNMP servers


2106


and


2108


can then forward network management events and alarms to NOC


2114


for centralized network management processing.




b. Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP)




Simple network management protocol (SNMP) events generated by network elements can enable NOC


2114


to determine the health of the voice network components and the rest of telecommunications network


200


. Tier 1 and tier 2 MIBs can be purchased as commercially off the shelf (COTS) components, or are provided with computer hardware and operating systems. Events generated within the customized third tier can be prioritized according to multiple levels of severity. Prioritization can allow a programmer to determine the level of severity of each event generated and sent to NOC


2114


. Customized alarm managers resident in each computer system can serve as alarm logging components and transport mechanisms for transport to downstream SNMP agents. Personnel working at NOC


2114


can log into a computer system to analyze special alarm conditions and to focus on the cause of the SNMP alarms. Multiple alarm conditions can be registered at NOC


2114


. A local log file can store all events processed by a local alarm manager application. For example, local alarm manager applications can reside in SNMP servers


2106


and


2108


at gateway site


108




a


, and at SNMP servers


2110


and


2112


of soft switch site


104


. The local log files can serve as a trace mechanism to identify key network and system event conditions generated on the computer systems.




c. Network Outage Recovery Sceriarios





FIG. 21B

illustrates an example outage recovery scenario


2116


. Outage recovery scenario


2116


can be used in the event of, for example, a fiber cut, a period of unacceptable latency or a period of unacceptable packet loss failure in data network


112


.





FIG. 21B

includes a calling party


102


placing a call to called party


120


. Calling party


102


is connected to carrier facility


126


. Called party


120


is connected to carrier facility


130


. A call path from calling party


102


to called party


120


is illustrated between carrier facility


126


and carrier facility


130


over a normal call path route


2118


through DACS


242


and


244


and TGs


232


and


234


of gateway sites


108


and


110


, respectively. Normal call path route


2118


would go through, in succession, TG


232


, one of ESs


1602


and


1604


, one of routers


1606


and


1608


, data network


112


, one of routers


1614


and


1616


, one of ESs


1610


and


1612


, and TG


234


, before exiting DACs


244


to connect to carrier facility


130


.




Assuming a fiber cut occurs, or excessive latency or packet loss failure occurs in data network


112


, outage recovery scenario


2116


routes the call over backup call path


2117


of

FIG. 21

B. Backup call path


2117


takes a call which originated from carrier facility


126


through DACS


242


to TG


232


, and connects the call back out through DACS


242


to an off-network carrier


2115


which connects the call traffic for termination at carrier facility


130


. By using off-network routing via off-network carrier


2115


, service level agreements (SLA) can be maintained providing for a higher percentage of network uptime and a higher level of audio quality.




Outage recovery scenario


2116


would cover any failure or degradation in a network device which falls after TG


232


including IP media processes within TG


232


, in normal call path route


2116


, assuming that TG


232


can still be controlled so as to route the call out over DACS


242


over backup call path


2117


to off-network carrier


2115


.




(1) Complete Gateway Site Outage





FIG. 21C

depicts an example network outage recovery scenario


2120


. Outage recovery scenario


2120


envisions a complete gateway site outage. Specifically, gateway site


108


is illustrated as experiencing a complete gateway outage. In such a scenario, normal call path


2118


will never be received by the internal network telecommunications network


200


. In outage recovery scenario


2120


, the call is rerouted via carrier facility routing from carrier facility


126


over backup call path


2122


through off-network carrier


2115


to carrier facility


130


for termination to called party


120


. For calls placed from carrier facility


126


and other carrier facilities which are serviced from failed gateway site


108


, CIC overflow routing tables in carrier facility


126


will automatically reroute traffic through off-network carrier


2115


.





FIG. 21D

illustrates outage recovery scenario


2124


depicting another complete gateway site outage, different from that illustrated in FIG.


21


C. In

FIG. 21D

, it is gateway site


110


that has experienced a complete gateway site outage. In such a scenario, call path


2118


from calling party


102


does reach an on-network device TG


232


, but the call is placed to a called party on failed gateway site


110


. Backup call path


2126


, is rerouted via soft switch overflow routing from TG


232


over DACS


242


to off-network carrier


2115


for termination at carrier facility


130


of called party


120


. For calls placed from the area served by operating gateway site


108


, attempting to terminate at failed gateway site


110


, soft switch


204


overflow routing automatically reroutes call traffic through off-network carrier


2115


.




(2) Soft Switch Fail-Over




Anticipating the possibility of a failure of a soft switch


204


of soft switch site


104


it is important that existing calls (i.e. those placed through an associated gateway device, e.g., TGs


232


and


234


of gateway sites


108


and


110


, respectively) not be impacted by the failure. In one embodiment of the invention, it is possible that some calls that are in the process of being established might be lost, such that a calling party


102


might have to re-dial to connect. In order to preserve calls set up and managed by failed soft switch


204


, back-up soft switch


304


has access to the states of the stable calls managed by failed soft switch


204


. Once the back-up soft switch


304


initiates fail-over, it notifies the primary and secondary SS7 GWs


208


and


308


that the back-up soft switches


204


and


304


are now the contact points for signaling messages that had previously been targeted for failed soft switch


204


.




(3) Complete Soft Switch Site Outage Scenario





FIGS. 21E and 21F

illustrate outage recovery scenarios


2132


and


2140


involving a complete soft switch site outage.

FIG. 21E

depicts soft switch site coverage of various gateway sites. Specifically,

FIG. 21E

illustrates western soft switch site


104


, central soft switch site


106


and eastern soft switch site


302


. Western soft switch site


104


is responsible for controlling all access servers


254


and


256


in circle


2136


. Central soft switch site


106


is responsible for controlling all access servers


254


and


256


within circle


2134


. Similarly, eastern soft switch site


302


is responsible for controlling all access servers


254


and


256


within circle


2138


.




Western soft switch site


104


thus is responsible for controlling access servers


254


and


256


(not shown) in gateway sites


2135




a


,


2135




b


,


2135




c


,


2135




d


and


2135




e.






Central soft switch site


106


is responsible for controlling access servers


254


and


256


(not shown) in gateway sites


2133




a


,


2133




b


,


2133




c


,


2133




d


,


2133




e


and


2133




f.






Eastern soft switch site


302


is responsible for controlling access servers


254


and


256


(not shown) which are located in gateway sites


2139




a


,


2139




b


,


2139




c


,


2139




d


,


2139




e


and


2139




f.







FIG. 21F

illustrates outage recovery scenario


2140


depicting a complete soft switch site outage. Specifically, central soft switch site


106


has failed or been shut down for maintenance in outage recovery scenario


2140


. Failure of central soft switch site


106


means that central soft switch site


106


can no longer control access servers


254


and


256


(not shown) which lie within circle


2134


. Specifically, access servers


254


and


256


which lie within gateway sites


2133




a


-


2133




f


cannot be controlled by central soft switch site


106


.





FIG. 21F

illustrates how western soft switch site


104


and eastern soft switch site


302


can take over control of gateway sites


2133




a


-


2133




f


to overcome the outage of central soft switch site


106


. Specifically, western soft switch site


104


can take over control of gateway sites


2133




a


,


2133




d


,


2133




e


and


2133




f


. Similarly, eastern soft switch site


302


can take over control of gateway sites


2133


b and


2133


c. Thus, access servers


254


and


256


located in gateway sites


2133




a


,


2133




b


,


2133




c


,


2133




d


,


2133




e


and


2133




f


can seemlessly be controlled by soft switch sites


106


and


302


in other geographies. It would be apparent to persons having ordinary skill in the art that other outage scenarios could be similarly remedied via communication between soft switch sites


104


,


106


and


302


.





FIG. 21G

depicts a block diagram


2146


of interprocess communication including a NOC


2114


communicating with a soft switch


204


. NOC


2114


communicates


2148


to soft switch


418


to startup command and control. Soft switch


418


communicates


2150


in order to send alarms and network management alerts to NOC


2114


. NOC


2114


communicates


2152


in order to shut down soft switch


418


command and control. Soft switch


418


can also accept management instructions from NOC


2114


at startup


2154


or at shutdown


2156


.




8. Internet Protocol Device Control (IPDC) Protocol




a. IPDC Base Protocol




The IPDC base protocol described below, provides the basis for the IP device control family of protocols. The IPDC protocols include a protocol suite. The components of the IPDC protocol suite can be used individually or together to perform multiple functions. Functions which can be performed by the IPDC protocol suite include, for example, connection control, media control, and signaling transport for environments where the control logic is separated from the access server


254


and


256


. The IPDC protocol suite operates between the media gateway controller and the media gateway. The media gateway controller can be thought of as soft switch


204


. The media gateway can be thought of as access servers


254


and


256


, including, for example, TGs


232


and


234


, AGs


238


and


240


and NASs


228


and


230


. The corresponding entities of media gateway controller and the media gateway are the call control and media control portions of the H.323 gateway.




IPDC acts to fulfill a need for protocols to control gateway devices which sit at the boundary between the circuit-switched telephone network and the Internet and to terminate circuit-switched trunks. Examples of such devices include NASs


228


and


230


and voice-over-IP gateways, also known as access servers


254


and


256


, including TGs


232


and


234


and AGs


238


and


240


. This need for a control protocol separate from call signaling arises when the service control logic needed to process calls lies partly or wholly outside the gateway devices. The protocols implement the interface between soft switch


204


and access servers


254


,


256


. IPDC views access servers


254


and


256


, also known as media gateways, as applications which may control one or more physical devices. In addition to its primary mandate, IPDC can be used to control devices which do not meet the strict definition of a media gateway such as DACS


242


and


244


and ANSs


246


and


248


. IPDC builds on a base provided by DIAMETER. DIAMETER has a number of advantages as a starting point including, for example, built-in provision for control security, facilities for starting up the control relation, and ready extensibility both in modular increments and at the individual command and attribute level. DIAMETER is specifically written for authentication, authorization and accounting applications. Calhoun, Rubins, “DIAMETER based protocol”, July 1998. The DIAMETER based protocol specification was written by Pat Calhoun of Sun Microsystems, Inc. and Alan C. Rubins of Ascend Communications.




The IPDC protocol includes a message header followed by attribute-value-pairs (AVPs) an IPDC command is a specialized data object which indicates the purpose and structure of the message which contains the IPDC command. The command name can be used to denote the message format.




A DIAMETER device can be a client or server system that supports the DIAMETER based protocol. Alternatively, a DIAMETER device can support extensions in addition to the DIAMETER based protocol.




An IPDC entity can be any object, logical or physical, which is subject to control through IPDC or whose status IPDC must report. Every IPDC entity has a type. Types of IPDC entities include, for example, a media gateway_type, a physical_gateway_type, a station_type, an equipment_holder type, a transport_termination type, an access_termination type, a trunk_termination type, a signaling_termination type, a device_type, a modem type, a conference_port type, a fax_port type, a stream_source type, a stream_recorder type, an RTP_port type, an ATM_spec type, an H323_spec type, and a SIP_spec type.




An IPDC protocol endpoint can be used to refer to either of the two parties to an IPDC control session, i.e. the media gateway controller (e.g., soft switch


204


), or the media gateway (e.g., access servers


254


and


256


). To the extent that IPDC can be viewed as providing extensions to DIAMETER, an IPDC protocol endpoint can also be a DIAMETER device.




A transaction can be a sequence of messages pre-defined as part of the definition of IPDC commands which constitute that sequence. Every message in the sequence can carry the same identifier value in the header and the same transaction-originator value identifying the originator of the transaction.




DIAMETER packets or IPDC messages can be transmitted over UDP or TCP. Each DIAMETER service extensions draft can specify the transport layer. For UDP, when a reply is generated the source and destination ports are reversed. IPDC requires a reliable, order-preserving transport protocol with minimal latency so that IPDC control can be responsive to the demands of call processing. UDP combined with a protocol description satisfies these requirements, and is therefore the default transport protocol for IPDC. It would apparent to those skilled in the art that network operators can choose to implement transmission control program (TCP) instead for greater security, or for other reasons.




The IPDC base protocol is a publically available document published on the Internet. It is important to note, that the IPDC based protocol is a document in a so called, “Internet-draft,” as of the time of the writing of this publication. Internet-drafts are working documents of the internet engineering task force (IETF), its areas, and its working groups. Other groups can also distribute working documents as Internet-drafts. Internet-drafts can be updated, replaced or obsoleted by other documents at any time.




It would be apparent to someone skilled in the art that an alternative base protocol could be used.




Command AVPs include a plurality of DIAMETER based commands and additional IPDC commands. For example, DIAMETER base commands include, for example, command-unrecognized-IND, device-reboot-IND, device-watchdog-IND, device-feature-query, device-feature-reply, device-config-REQ, and device-config-answer. Additional IPDC commands include, for example, command-ACK and message-reject.




In addition to command AVPs, a plurality of other AVPs exist, including, for example, DIAMETER base AVPs, and additional IPDC AVPs. DIAMETER base AVPs include host-IP-address, host-name, version-number, extension-ID, integrity-check-vector, digital-signature, initialization-vector, time stamp, session-ID, X509-certificate, X509-certificate-URL, vendor-name, firmware-revision, result-code, error-code, unknown-command-code, reboot-type, reboot-timer, message-timer, message-in-progress-timer, message-retry-count, message-forward-count and receive-window. Additional IPDC AVPs include, for example, transaction-originator and failed-AVP-code.




Protection of data integrity is enabled using the integrity-check-vector, digital signatures and mixed data integrity AVPs.




AVP data encryption is supported including, for example, shared secrets, and public keys. Public key cryptography support includes, for example, X509-certificate, X509-certificate-URL, and static public key configuration.




b. IPDC Control Protocol




The IPDC is a control protocol that facilitates the delivery of voice and data services requiring interconnection with an IP network. The IPDC protocol permits a soft switch control server to control a media gateway or access server. IPDC includes signaling transport, connection control, media control and device management functionality. These control functions include creation, modification, and deletion of connections; detection and generation of media and bearer channel events; detection of resource availability state changes in media gateways; and signal transport.




Alternatively, other protocols can be used to provide this control. For example, the network access server messaging interface (NMI) protocol or the media gateway control protocol (MGCP). The MGCP protocol from the internet engineering task force (IETF) supports a subset of the functionality of the IPDC protocol plus the simple gateway control protocol(SGCP) from Bellcore and CISCO. SGCP includes connection control and media control (i.e. a subset of IPDC media control) functionality.




IPDC protocol allows a call control server, i.e. a soft switch


204


, to command a circuit network to packet network gateway (a media gateway), i.e. an access server


254


, provides the control mechanism to for setting up, tearing down and managing voice and data calls. The term packet network gateway is intended to allow support for multiple network types including, for example, an IP network and an ATM network, data network


112


. In addition, the IPDC protocol supports the management and configuration of the access server


254


. The following types of messages are described in this document, start-up messages describing access server start-up and shut-down, configuration messages describing access server, soft switch and telco interface query and configuration; maintenance messages describing status and test messages; and call control messages describing call set-up tear-down and query for data, TDM and packet-switched calls.




The architecture in which IPDC operates incorporates existing protocols wherever possible to achieve a full interconnection of IP-based networks with the global switched telephone network (GSTN). The architecture accommodates any GSTN signaling style, including, for example, SS7 signaling, ISDN signaling and in-band signaling. The architecture also accommodates an interface with H.323 voice-over-IP networks.




A modification to the H.323 architecture can allow H.323 networks to be seamlessly integrated with SS7 networks.




Until now, H.323 protocols have been defined assuming that an H.323 to GSTN gateway uses an access signaling technique such as ISDN or in-band access signaling for call set-up signaling on the GSTN. The H.323 architecture did not readily accommodate the use of SS7 signaling for call set-up via H.323 gateways, creating a gap in the standards. Until now, H.323 standards have distinguished between multi-point processor (MP) functions and multi-point controller (MC) functions only in the definition of multi-point control units (MCUs). Recent international telecommunications union (ITU) work on H.323 version III has considered extending the concept of MC/MP separation to H.323 gateways as well as MCUs. Separation of the MC function from the H.323 gateway can allow SS7 to be properly interconnected with an H.323 network. By separating the MC function from the MP function, a separate SS7 signaling gateway, such as, for example, SS7 GW


208


, can be created to interconnect the SS7 network with the H.323 network. Such an SS7 gateway can implement the H.323 gateway MC function as a signaling interface shared among multiple H.323 gateway MP functions.




At least five functions must be performed in order to interface an H.323 network to a GSTN network. The functions include, for example, a packet network interface, H.323 signal intelligence, GSTN signaling intelligence, a media processing function and a GSTN circuit interface.




In an H.323 gateway which interfaces with an in-band signaled or ISDN-signaled GSTN trunk, all of these five functions could be performed with a H.323 gateway. However, in a H.323 gateway which interfaces with a SS7 signaled trunk, the functionality could be more optimally partitioned to allow for a group of SS7 links to be shared among multiple H.323 gateway MP functions. For example, an H.323 gateway MC function could include, for example, a packet network interface, H.323 signaling intelligence, and GSTN SS7 signaling intelligence. In addition, an H.323 gateway MP function could include a packet network interface, a media processing function, and a GSTN circuit interface. Thus, the H.323 gateway functionality could be separated into the H.323 gateway MC function and the H.323 gateway MP function.




In another embodiment, the MC function could be further partitioned. For example, H.323 gateway MC function could include a packet network interface, H.323 signaling intelligence, and a packet network interface. An SS7 gateway could include additional MC functions, such as, for example, a packet network interface, and a GSTN SS7 signaling intelligence. The physical separation of the H.323 gateway MC function from the SS7 gateway provides several advantages, including, for example, more than one SS7 gateway can be interfaced to one or more MC functions, allowing highly reliable geographically redundant configurations; service logic implemented at the H.323 gateway MC function (or at an associated gatekeeper) can be provisioned at a smaller number of more centralized sites, reducing the amount of data replication needed for large-scale service implementation across an H.323 network; and SS7 gateway to H.323 gateway MC functional interface could be a model for other signaling gateways, such as, for example, an ISDN NFAS gateway, a channel-associated C7 signaling gateway, and a DPNSS gateway. In fact, once service providers have implemented service logic at the H.323 gateway MC function for their SS7 signaled trunks, the following anomalies become apparent, for example, service providers will likely want to exercise the same or similar service logic for their. ISDN and in-band signal trunks as well as their SS7 signaled trunks; and service providers will want to incorporate media processing events into the service logic implemented at the H.323 gateway MC function (or at an associated gatekeeper).




The IPDC protocol is intended to interface the MC function with the MP function in H.323 to GSTN gateways. Based upon events detected in the signaling stream, the H.323 gateway MC function must be able to create, delete, and modify connections in the H.323 gateway MP function. Also, the H.323 gateway MC function must be able to create or detect events in the media stream which only the H.323 gateway MP function has access to. A standardized protocol is needed to allow an H.323 gateway MC function to remotely control one or more H.323 gateway MP functions. Therefore, IPDC was created to allow H.323 gateway MC function to remotely control one or more H.323 gateway MP functions. Specifically, soft switch


204


can remotely control one or more access servers


254


.




The IPDC protocol uses the terminology of bay, module, line and channel. A bay is one unit, or set of modules and interfaces within an access server


254


. A stand-alone access server


254


or a multi-shelf access server


254


can constitute a single bay. A module is a sub-unit that sits within a bay. The module is typically a slot card that implements one or more network line interfaces, e.g., a dual span T


1


card. A line is a sub-unit that sits within a module. The line is typically a physical line interface that plugs into a line card, e.g., a T


1


. A channel is a sub-unit within a line. The channel is typically a channel within a channelized line interface, e.g., one of the 24 channels in a channelized T


1


.




All numbers in the IPDC protocol should be in binary, and coded in network byte order (big endian or motorola format). The format for date/time fields is a 4 bytes integer expressing the number of seconds elapsed since Jan. 1, 1990 at 0:00.




The soft switches


204


and


304


(e.g., primary/secondary/tertiary, etc.) are completely hot-swappable. Switching to a backup soft switch


204


does not require fall back in call processing states or other IPDC-level operation on access server


254


. Both soft switches


204


and


304


follow the operations of the other soft switch, precisely.




The message exchange as defined in IPDC can be implemented over any IP base protocol. Suggested protocols include, e.g., TCP and UDP.




Access server


254


can include the following configuration items: IP addresses and TCP or UDP ports of any number of soft switches


204


to which access server


254


should connect; bay number (8 bytes, in alpha numeric characters); system type (9 bytes, in alpha-numeric characters); and protocol version supported.




An IPDC packet can have the following components included in its format, for example, a protocol ID, a packet length, a data field tag, a data field length, data flags, an optional vendor ID, data and padding. For example, a protocol ID may exist in a first byte. Packet length can be a 2 byte field appearing second, a single byte reserved field can then occur followed by a 4 byte data field tag. Next a 2 byte data field length can be used, followed by a single byte data flag, and a single byte reserved field. Next, a 4 byte optional vendor ID can exist. Next, the data included in the body of the message can contain a variable number of 4 byte aligned tag, length, value combinations. Finally, a 3 byte data and single byte padding field can be placed in the IPDC packet. For all IPDC messages, the message type and transaction ID are required attribute value pairs.




The message code must be the first tag following the header. This tag is used in order to communicate the message type associated with the message. There must only be a single message code tag within a given message. The value of this tag for each message type may be found below.




The transaction ID is assigned by the originator of a transaction. The transaction ID must remain the same for all messages exchanged within a transaction. The transaction ID is a 12-byte value with the following tag, length, value format: the first 4 bytes can contain a data field tag; the next two bytes can include the data field length; the next byte can contain flags; the next byte is reserved; the next 4 bytes can contain an originator ID; the following 4 bytes can contain originator ID; and in the last 4 bytes there can exist in the first bit the originator, and in the remaining bytes the transaction correlator 31 bits.




c. IPDC Control Message Codes




Table 144 below provides a listing of the names and corresponding codes for control messages transmitted between Soft Switch


204


and Access Servers


254


and


256


. Also included are the source of each message and the description for each message. For example, the NSUP message is transmitted from Access Server


254


to Soft Switch


204


, informing Soft Switch


204


that Access Server


254


is coming up.












TABLE 144











Message Codes














Name




Code




Source




Description









NSUP




0x00000081




AS




Notify the soft switch that the access









server is coming up






ASUP




0x00000082




SS




Acknowledgment to NSUP






NSDN




0x00000083




AS




Notify the soft switch that the access









server is about to reboot






RST1




0x00000085




SS




Request system reset -









Drop all channels






ARST1




0x00000086




AS




Reset in progress -









awaiting Reboot command






RST2




0x00000087




SS




Request system reset









(Reboot command)






ARST2




0x00000088




AS




Reboot acknowledgment






MRJ




0x000000FF




SS or AS




Message reject.






RSI




0x00000091




SS




Request system information






NSI




0x00000092




AS




Response to RSI






RBN




0x00000093




SS




Request bay number






NBN




0x00000094




AS




Response to RBN






SBN




0x00000095




SS




Set bay number






ABN




0x00000096




AS




Acknowledgment to SBN






RMI




0x00000097




SS




Request module information






NMI




0x00000098




AS




Notify module information






RLI




0x00000099




SS




Request line information






NLI




0x0000009A




AS




Notify line information






RCI




0x0000009B




SS




Request channel information






NCI




0x0000009C




AS




Notify channel information






SLI




0x0000009D




SS




Set line information






ASLI




0x0000009E




AS




Acknowledgment to SLI






SDEF




0x0000009F




SS




Set Default Settings






ADEF




0x000000A0




AS




Accept Default Settings






RSSI




0x000000A1




SS




Request soft switch information






NSSI




0x000000A2




AS




Notify soft switch information






SSSI




0x000000A3




SS




Set soft switch information






ASSSI




0x000000A4




AS




Acknowledgment to SSSI






RSSS




0x000000A5




SS




Request soft switch status






NSSS




0x000000A6




AS




Notify soft switch status






RMS




0x00000041




SS




Request module status






RLS




0x00000043




SS




Request line status






RCS




0x00000045




SS




Request channel status






NMS




0x00000042




AS




Notify module status






NLS




0x00000044




AS




Notify line status






NCS




0x00000046




AS




Notify channel status






SMS




0x00000051




SS




Set a module to a given state






SLS




0x00000053




SS




Set a line to a given state






SCS




0x00000055




SS




Set a group of channels to a









given state






RSCS




0x00000056




AS




Response to SCS






PCT




0x00000061




SS




Prepare channel for continuity test






APCT




0x00000062




AS




Response to PCT






SCT




0x00000063




SS




Start continuity test procedure









with far end as loopback (Generate









tone and check for received tone)






ASCT




0x00000064




AS




Continuity test result






RTE




0x0000007D




SS or AS




Request test echo






ARTE




0x0000007E




AS or SS




Response to RTE






RTP




0x0000007B




SS




Request test ping to given IP address






ATP




0x0000007C




AS




Response to RTP






LTN




0x00000071




SS




Listen for tones






ALTN




0x00000072




AS




Response to listen for tones






STN




0x00000073




SS




Send tones






ASTN




0x00000074




AS




Completion result of STN command






RCSI




0x00000001




SS




Request inbound call setup






ACSI




0x00000002




AS




Accept inbound call setup






CONI




0x00000003




AS




Connect inbound call (answer)






RCSO




0x00000005




AS or SS




Request outbound call setup






ACSO




0x00000006




SS or AS




Accept outbound call setup






CONO




0x00000007




SS or AS




Outbound call connected






RCST




0x00000009




SS




Request pass-through call setup









(TDM connection between two









channels)






ACST




0x0000000A




AS




Accept pass-through call






RCON




0X00000013




SS




Request Connection






ACON




0X00000014




AS




Accept Connection






MCON




0X00000015




SS




Modify connection






AMCN




0X00000016




AS




Accept modify connection






RCR




0x00000011




SS or AS




Release channel request






ACR




0x00000012




AS or SS




Release channel complete






NOTI




0x00000017




AS, SS




Event notification to the soft switch






RNOT




0x00000018




SS, AS




Request event notification from









the access server














d. A Detailed View of the IPDC Protocol Control Messages




The following section provides a more detailed view of the control messages transmitted between Soft Switch


204


and Access Server


254


.




(1) Startup Messages




Table 145 below provides the Startup messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages) and the R/O status.












TABLE 145











Startup (registration and de-registration)














Message




Parameter Tag




Parameter Description




R/O









NSUP -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify Access






Server coming up




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x00000001




Protocol version implemented.




R







0x00000002




System ID




R







0x00000003




System type




R







0x00000004




Maximum number of modules




R








(cards) on the system








(whether present or not).







0x00000005




Bay number.




R






ASUP -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Acknowledgment




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






to NSUP




0x00000002




System ID




R






NSDN -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify Access






Server




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






coming down




0x00000002




System ID




R












(about to reboot)




This message will be sent by the access server







when it has been asked to reset (for







instance, from the console, etc.)














RST1 - Request




0x00C0




Message Code




R






system reset -




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






Drop all channels




0x00000002




System ID




R






ARST1 - Reset in




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






progress -




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






awaiting






Reboot command




0x00000002




System ID




R






RST2 - Request




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






system reset




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






(Reboot




0x00000002




System ID




R






command)






ARST2 - Reboot




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






acknowledgment




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x00000002




System ID




R







0x00000006




Result code




R














(2) Protocol Error Messages




Table 146 below provides the Protocol error messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages) and the R/O status.












TABLE 146











Protocol Error handling














Message




Parameter Tag




Parameter Description




R/O









MRJ - Message reject




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x000000FD




Cause Code Type




R







0x000000FE




Cause code




R













This message is generated by the access server or







soft switch when a message is received with an







error, such as an invalid message code, etc.







The cause code indicates the main reason







why the message was rejected.















(3) System Configuration Messages




Table 147 below provides the System configuration messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 147











System configuration

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes















RSI -




This message does not contain any fields, the






Request system




receiving access server returns an NSI message.






information














NSI -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify system




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






information




0x00000001




Protocol




R






(response





version






to RSI)





implemented








(initially,








set to 0).







0x00000002




System ID




R







0x00000003




System type




R







0x00000004




Maximum




R








number of








modules








(cards) on the








system








(whether








present or








not).







0x00000005




Bay number




R













This message is sent as a response to a RSI request.






RBN -




This message does not contain any fields, the






Request bay




receiving access server returns an NBN message.






number














NBN -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Response to




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






RBN




0x00000005




Bay number




R













This message is sent as a response to a RBN request.














SBN -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Set bay number




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x00000005




Bay number




R






ASBN -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Acknowledg-




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






ment to SBN




0x00000005




Bay number




R













This message is sent as a response to a SBN request.















SDEF -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Set Default




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






Settings




0x00000007




Module




O




If module








number





number is not










specified, all










changes apply










to all










modules/lines/










channels within










the bay.







0x0000000D




Line number




O




If line










number is










not specified,










all changes










apply to all










lines/channels










within the










specified










module. If line










number is










specified,










module number










must also be










specified.







0x00000015




Channel




O




If channel








number





number is not










specified, all










changes apply










to all channels










within the










specified line.










If channel










number is










specified,










module number










and line










number must










also be










specified.







0x00000070




Encoding Type




O




Required only








(1 byte)





when a change







0x00000071




Silence




O




to the setting








Suppression





is desired.








Activation








Timer







0x00000072




Comfort Noise




O








Generation







0x00000073




Packet Loading




O







0x00000074




Echo




O








Cancellation







0x00000075




Constant




O








DTMF Tone








Detection








on/off







0x00000076




Constant




O








MF Tone








Detection








on/off







0x00000077




Constant




O








Fax Tone








Detection








on/off







0x00000078




Constant




O








Modem Tone








Detection








on/off







0x00000079




Programmable




O








DSP








Algorithm








activation







0x0000007A




Programmable




O








DSP








Algorithm








deactivation







0x0000007B




Constant




O








Packet Loss








Detection








on/off







0x0000007C




Packet Loss




O








Threshold







0x0000007D




Constant




O








Latency








Threshold








Detection








on/off







0x0000007E




Latency




O








Threshold







0x00000084




Signaling




O








channel








QoS type







0x00000085




Signaling




O








channel QoS








value (variable








length)







0x0000006E




Forward




O








Signaling








Events to the








Soft Switch













This message is used to configure default settings within







the access server. If no module is specified, default







settings will apply to all modules/lines/channels in the







bay. If no line number is specified, default settings will







apply to all lines/channels within a module.







If no channel number is specified the default settings







will apply to all channels within a line.















ADEF - Accept




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Default




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






Settings







0x00000007




Module




O




The setting for








number





these fields are







0x0000000D




Line number




O




the same as







0x00000015




Channel




O




those passed








number





in on the







0x00000048




Set Channel




R




SDEF message.








Status Result













This message is sent from the access server to the soft







switch on response to a SDEF message.















(4) Telephone Company Interface Configuration Messages




Table 148 below provides the Telephone Company (Telco) interface configuration messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 148











Telco interface configuration

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









RMI - Request




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







module




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






information




0x00000007




Module




R








number






NMI - Notify




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






module




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






information




0x00000007




Module




R






(response





number






to RMI)




0x0000000A




Module type




R







0x0000000B




Module




R








capabilities







0x00000008




Number of




R








lines (or items,








depending on








card type).







0x0000003A




Number of




R








failed lines








(or items,








depending on








card type).







0x00000009




External name




R








(i.e.,








“8tl-card”,








etc.) in ASCII








format.






RLI -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Request line




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






information




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R






NLI -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify line




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






informiation




0x00000007




Module




R






(response





number






to RLI)




0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x0000000E




Number of




R








channels







0x0000000F




External name




R








in ASCII








format







0x00000010




Line coding




R







0x0000001l




Framing




R







0x00000012




Signaling type




R







0x00000013




In-band




R








signaling








details







0x00000041




T1 front-end




R








type







0x00000042




T1 CSU




R








build-out







0x00000043




T1 DSX-1




R








line length






RCI - Request




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






channel




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






information




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number






NCI -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify channel




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






information




0x00000007




Module




R






(response





number






to RCI)




0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number







0x00000016




Channel status




R







0x00000017




Bearer




R








Capability of








the Channel








(BCC) or type








of the active








call, when a








call is present







0x00000018




Calling




O




Required only








Party number





if the channel







0x00000019




Dialed Phone





has an








number





active call.







0x0000001A




Timestamp of




R








the last channel








status transition







0x00000040




Access Server




O




Required only








Call Identifier





if the channel










has an active










call.






SLI - Set line




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






information




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x6000000F




External name




O




Required only








in ASCII





if the value








format





is to be










changed in the










access server.







0x00000010




Line coding




O




Required only







0x00000011




Framing




O




if the value is







0x00000012




Signaling type





to be changed










in the










access server.







0x00000013




In-band




O




Valid for telco








signaling





interface cards








details





only.







0x00000041




T1 front-end




O








type







0x00000042




T1 CSU




O








build-out







0x00000043




T1 DSX-1




O








line length






ASLI -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






New line




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






information




0x00000007




Module




R








number






ACK




0x0000000D




Line number




R













This message is sent as a response to a SLI request.















(5) Soft Switch Configuration Messages




Table 149 below provides the Soft Switch configuration messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 149











Soft Switch Configuration

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









RSSI - Request










soft switch






information






NSSI -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify soft




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






switch




0x0000001B




IP address for




R






information





primary soft








switch







0x0000001C




TCP port for




R








primary soft








switch







0x0000001D




IP address for




O




Required only








secondary





if secondary








soft switch





soft







0x0000001E




TCP port for




O




switch has been








secondary





configured








soft switch







0x0000003B




IP address




O




Required only








for tertiary





if tertiary soft








soft switch





switch has been







0x0000003C




TCP port for




O




configured








tertiary








soft switch













This message is sent as a response to a RSSI request,







or when the local access server configuration is changed







by other means.















SSSI - Set




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







intormation




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x00000002




Serial number




R








of remote unit







0x0000001B




New IP address




R








of primary








soft switch






SSSI (cont.)




0x0000001C




TCP port for




R








primary








soft switch







0x0000001D




New IP address




O




Required only








of secondary





if secondary








soft switch





soft







0x0000001E




TCP port for




O




switch is being








secondary





set configured








soft switch







0x0000003B




IP address for




O




Required only








tertiary





if tertiary soft








soft switch





switch is being







0x0000003C




TCP port for




O




set cotifigured








tertiaty








soft switch












ASSSI -




This message is sent as a response to a SSSI request.






Acknowledge






to SSSI















RSSS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Request soft




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






switch status




0x00000002




Serial Number




R








of Remote Unit






NSSS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify soft




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






switch status




0x00000002




Serial Number




R








of Remote Unit







0x0000001B




New IP




R








Address of








Primary Host







0x0000001C




TCP port for




R








Primary







0x0000001D




New IP




O




Required only








Address of





if secondary








Secondary Host





soft switch is







0x0000001E




TCP port for





configured








Secondary








0x0000003B




IP Address for




O




Required only








tertiary





if tertiary








soft switch





soft switch is







0x0000003C




TCP port for




O




configured








tertiary soft








switch







0x0000001F




Soft Switch




R








in use








(Primary/








Secondary/








Tertiary)













This message is sent in response to a RSSS request.















(6) Maintenance-Status Messages




Table 150A below provides the Maintenance-Status messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 150A











Maintenance Status

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes

















RMS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Request for




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






module status




0x00000007




Module




R








number













This message will force an immediate NMS.














RLS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Request line




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






status




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R













This message will force an immediate NLS.














RCS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Request




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






channel status




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number













This message will force an immediate NCS.















NMS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Notify




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






module status




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000A




Module type




R








(see NMI








above)







0x0000000C




Module status




R







0x00000020




Number of




O




Valid for








lines





telco interface







0x00000021




Line status:




O




cards only.








one entry









per line













This message should be issued by the access server any







time that the module status changes or if a RMS







command was received.














NLS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Notify line




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






status




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000014




Line status




R







0x00000022




Number




R








of channels







0x00000023




Channel status:




R








one entry








per channel













This message should be issued by the access server any







time that the line status changes or if a RLS command







was received.














NCS - Notify




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






channel status




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number







0x00000023




Channel status




R













This message should be issued by the access server if an







RCS command was received














SMS - Set




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






a module to




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






a given status




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x00000024




Requested




R








module state













As the Module changes status, the access server will







notify the soft switch with NMS messages.







The transaction ID in those NMS messages will not be







the same as the transaction ID in the SMS message.














SLS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Set a line to a




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






given status




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000025




Requested




R








line state













As the lin changes status, the access server will notify







the soft switch with NLS messages. The transaction ID in







those NLS messages will not be the same as the







transaction ID in the SLS message.














SCS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Set a group




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






of channels to a




0x00000007




Module




R






given status





number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number







0x00000029




End Channel




R








number







0x00000026




Requested




R








Channel








Status








Action







0x00000027




Set Channel




R








Status Option






RSCS -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Response to




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






SCS




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000028




Start Channel




R








number







0x00000029




End Channel




R








number







0x0000002A




Set Channel




R








Status Result







0x00000022




Number of




R








channels







0x00000023




Channel status:




R








one entry








per channel














Table 150B below lists actions which can set the channels from an initial state to a final state.
















TABLE 150B











Action




Valid initial state




Final state













Reset to idle




maintenance, blocked,




idle








loopback, idle,








in use, connected







Reset to out




maintenance, blocked,




out of service







of service




loopback, idle,








in use, connected







Start loopback




idle




loopback







End loopback




loopback




idle







Block




idle




blocked







Unblock




blocked




idle















(7) Continuity Test Messages




Table 151 below provides the Continuity test messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 151











Continuity Test

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









PCT - Prepare




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







channel for




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






continuity test




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number






APCT -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Response to




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






PCT request




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number







0x0000002B




Prepare




R








for continuity








check result






SCT - Start




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






continuity test




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






procedure




0x00000007




Module




R






with far end





number






as loopback




0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number







0x0000002C




Timeout in




R




Default is 2








milliseconds.





milliseconds













The SCT command must be received less than 3 seconds







after the APCT was sent.







The continuity test performed by the access server







is as follows:














1.




Start tone detection







2.




Generate a check tone







3.




Start timer







4.




When tone is detected (minimum of 60 ms):














4.1.




Stop timer







4.2.




Stop generator














4.2.1




TEST SUCCESSFUL














5.




If timer expires:














5.1.




Stop generator







5.2.




TEST FAlLED













After continuity testing, a channel is always left in







the idle state.














ASCT -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Continuity




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






test result




0x00000007




Module




R








number







0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel




R








number







0x0000002D




Continuity




R








Test Result














(8) Keepalive Test Messages




Table 152 below provides the Keepalive test messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 152











Keepalive Test
















Parameter




Parameter








Message




Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









RTE -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Request




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






test echo




0x0000002E




Random characters




R






ARTE -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Response




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






to RTE




0x0000002E




Random characters




R




Same random










characters










from RTE














(9) LAN Test Messages




Table 153 below provides the LAN test messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status, and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 153











LAN test
















Parameter




Parameter








Message




Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









RTP -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Request




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






a test




0x00000002




System ID




R






ping




0x0000002F




IP Address to Ping




R







0x00000030




Number of pings




R




Number of










pings to send






ATP -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Response




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






to RTP




0x00000002




System ID




R







0x0000002F




IP Address to Ping




R







0x00000030




Number of pings




R




Number of










successful










pings














(10) Tone Function Messages




Table 154 below provides the Tone function messages, the parameter tags, the parameter descriptions (associated with these messages), the R/O status and any notes associated with the message.












TABLE 154











Tone functions















Message




Tag Value




Field Description




R/O




Notes









STN -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Send tones




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x00000007




Module number




R







0x0000002D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel number




R







0x00000049




Tone Type




R







0x0000004A




Apply or Cancel Tone




R







0x00000032




Number of tones to send




R







0x00000033




String of Tones to send




R






ASTN -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R






Completion




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






result of




0x00000007




Module number




R






STN command




0x0000000D




Line number




R







0x00000015




Channel number




R







0x00000036




Tone Send Completion




R








Status














(11) Example Source Port Types




Table 155 below provides a list of exemplary Source Port Types.












TABLE 155











Source Ports













Source Port Type




Parameter Tag




Parameter Description









GSTN




Tag 0x07




Source module number







Tag 0x0D




Source line number







Tag 0x15




Source channel number







Tag 0x48




Source jack ID (for DSL)






Packet ATM




Tag 0x59




Source ATM Address Type







Tag 0x5A




Source ATM Address






Packet H.323




Tag 0x5B




Source H.323 Network Address








(IP address)







Tag 0x9A




Source H.323 TSAP Identifier (Port)







  or







Tag 0x5C




Source H.323 alias







 with







Tag 0x63




Destination H.323 Network Address








(IP address)







Tag 0x9B




Destination H.323 TSAP Identifier







  or




(Port)







Tag 0x64




Destination H.323 alias






Packet RTP




Tag 0x5D




Destination listen IP address








0xFFFFFFFF tells soft switch to








allocate







Tag 0x5E




Destination listen RTP port number







Tag 0x5F




Destination send IP address








0xFFFFFFFF indicates unspecified








address







Tag 0x60




Destination send RTP port number














(12) Example Internal Resource Types




Table 156 below provides a list of exemplary Internal Resource Types.












TABLE 156











Resource Identifier for Internal Resources













Internal








Resource Type




Parameter Tag




Parameter Description









Modem Port




0x0000006B




Identifier for internal modem








resource - optional






Fax Port




0x00000068




Identifier for internal fax resource -








optional






Conference Port




0x00000067




Identifier for internal conference








resource - optional






Playback




0x00000069




Internal announcement resource ID -








optional







0x0000007F




Announcement identifier - optional







0x00000080




Announcement information - optional







0x00000086




Announcement treatment - optional






Recording




0x00000069




Internal recording resource ID -








optional














(13) Example Destination Port Types




Table 157 below provides a list of exemplary Destination Port Types.












TABLE 157











Destination Ports













Destination








Port Types




Parameter Tag




Parameter Description









GSTN




Tag 0x00000037




Destination module number







Tag 0x00000038




Destination line number







Tag 0x00000039




Destination channel number






Packet RTP




Tag 0x0000005D




Destination listen IP address








0xFFFFFFFF tells soft switch to








allocate







Tag 0x0000005E




Destination listen RTP port number







Tag 0x0000005F




Destination send IP address








0xFFFFFFFF indicates unspecified








address







Tag 0x00000060




Destination send RTP port number






Packet ATM




Tag 0x00000037




To module number







Tag 0x00000038




To line number







Tag 0x00000039




To channel number







Tag 0x00000061




To ATM Address Type







Tag 0x00000062




To ATM Address






Packet H.323




Tag 0x0000005B




Source H.323 Network Address








(IP address)







Tag 0x0000009A




Source H.323 TSAP Identifier








(UDP Port)







   or







Tag 0x0000005C




Source H.323 alias







   with







Tag 0x00000063




Destination H.323 Network Address








(IP address)







Tag 0x000009B




Destination H.323 TSAP Identifier








(UDP Port)







   or







Tag 0x00000064




Destination H.323 alias














(14) Call Control Messages




Table 158A below provides a list of exemplary Call Control Messages.












TABLE 158A











Call Control


















Parameter






Port






Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes




Types









RCON -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R





All






Request




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R





All






Connection




0x000000C2




Call ID




R





All







0x00000065




Source port type




R




See additional fields




All










necessary for each port










type







0x00000066




Destination port




R




See additional fields




All








type





necessary for each port










type







0x00000017




Bearer Capability




O





M








of the Channel










(BCC) required










for the call









0x00000019




Called Phone




O




Used only for




M








Number





authentication for







0x00000018




Calling Pary




O




modem transfer calls




M








Number









0x00000044




CPE lines to




O




Used only for GSTN




G, M








present the call





ports where an








on





outbound call is to be










made. This field can be










used for applications










when the same physical










channel can be










timeshared by several










CPE devices/ports







0x00000045




Date and time




O




Used only for GSTN




G








of the call





ports where an










associated outbound










call is to be made







0x00000047




Requested




O




Required only for




All








Priority





priority calls








(forced 911,









not forced)








0x00000070




Encoding Type




O




Required only when




R, H, A








(1 byte)





feature is desired







0x00000071




Silence




O








Suppression








Activation timer







0x00000072




Comfort Noise




O








Generation







0x00000073




Packet Loading




O







0x00000074




Echo Cancellation




O





All







0x00000075




Constant DTMF




O





All








Tone Detection








on/off







0x00000076




Constant MF tone




O





All








Detection on/off







0x00000077




Constant Fax tone




O





All








detection on/off







0x00000078




Constant Modem




O





All








tone detection








on/off







0x00000079




Programmable




O





All








DSP Algorithm








activation







0x0000007A




Programmable




O





All








DSP Algorithm








deactivation







0x0000007B




Constant Packet




O





R, H, A








Loss Detection








on/off







0x0000007C




Packet Loss




O





R, H, A








Threshold







0x0000007D




Constant Latency




O





R, H, A








Threshold








Detection on/off







0x0000007E




Latency




O





R, H, A








Threshold







0x00000081




QoS type




O





R, H, A







0x00000082




QoS value




O





R, H, A








(variable length)













This message is sent from the soft switch to the access server to request a







connection to be setup to the specified endpoint.
















ACON -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R





All






Accept




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R





All






Connection




0x000000C2




Call ID




R





All







0x00000065




Source port type




O




See additional fields




All










necessary for each port










type







0x00000066




Destination port




O




See additional fields




All








type





necessary for each port










type







0x00000040




Access Server




O





All








Caller Identifier













This message is sent from the access server to the soft switch indicating that







the connection has been accepted. This message is sent in response to an







RCON, if the access server allocates an endpoint on its own (if resource







management is done by the access server) the endpoint ID will be returned







in the ACON.
















MCON -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R





All






Modify




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R





All






Connection




0x000000C2




Call ID




R





All







0x00000065




Source port type




R




See additional fields




All










necessary for each port










type







0x00000066




Destination port




R




See additional fields




All








type





necessary for each port










type







0x00000070




Encoding Type




O




Required only when a




R, H, A







0x00000071




Silence




O




change to the field




R, H, A








Suppression





value is desired








Activation timer







0x00000072




Comfort Noise




O





R, H, A








Generation







0x00000073




Packet Loading




O





R, H, A







0x00000074




Echo Cancellation




O





All







0x00000075




Constant DTMF




O





All








Tone Detection








on/off







0x00000076




Constant MF




O





All








Tone Detection








on/off







0x00000077




Constant Fax tone




O





All








detection on/off







0x00000078




Constant Modem




O





All








tone detection








on/off







0x00000079




Programmable




O





All








DSP Algorithm








activation







0x0000007A




Programmable




O





All








DSP Algorithm








deactivation







0x0000007B




Constant Packet




O





R, H, A








Loss Detection








on/off







0x0000007C




Packet Loss




O





R, H, A








Threshold







0x0000007D




Constant Latency




O





R, H, A








Threshold








Detection on/off







0x0000007E




Latency




O





R, H, A








Threshold







0x00000081




QoS type




O





R, H, A







0x00000082




QoS (variable




O





R, H, A








length)













This message is sent from the soft switch to the access server







to query or request changes to the settings associated with a







connection. Except for the “from” and “to” port







fields, all other fields are optional. If a field is specified







the access server is requested to change to the specified setting.







In response to an MCON the access server responds with current







settings for all fields.
















AMCN -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R





All






Accept




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R





All






Modify




0x000000C2




Call ID




R





All






Connection




0x00000065




Source port type




R




See additional fields




All










necessary for each port










type







0x00000066




Destination port




R




See additional fields




All








type





necessary for each port










type







0x00000070




Encoding Type




R




All fields are required




R, H, A







0x00000071




Suppression




R




since the message is




R, H, A








Activation timer





also a query response







0x00000072




Comfort Noise




R





R, H, A








Generation







0x00000073




Packet Loading




R





R, H, A







0x00000074




Echo Cancellation




R





All







0x00000075




Constant DTMF




R





All








Tone Detection








on/off







0x00000076




Constant MF




R





All








Tone Detection








on/off







0x00000077




Constant Fax tone




R





All








detection on/off







0x00000078




Constant Modem




R





All








tone detection








on/off







0x00000079




Programmable




R





All








DSP Algorithm







0x0000007B




Constant Packet




R





All








Loss Detection








on/off







0x0000007C




Packet Loss




R





R, H, A








Threshold







0x0000007D




Constant Latency




R





R, H, A








Threshold








Detection on/off







0x0000007E




Latency




R





R, H, A








Threshold







0x00000040




Access Server




R





All








Call Identifier







0x00000081




QoS type




R





R, H, A







0x00000082




QoS (variable




R





R, H, A








length)













This message is sent from the access server to the soft







switch to acknowledge the modifications made in response to







the MCON. Only those tags sent in the modify request should be







returned in the modify accept.















(15) Example Port Definitions




Table 158B below provides a list of exemplary Port Definitions.












TABLE 158B











Port Definitions












Type




Description









All




The field applies to all port types






G




The field applies to GSTN port types






H




The field applies to H.323 port types






R




The field applies to RTP port types






A




The field applies to ATM port types






M




The field applies to internal modem port types






F




The filed applies to internal fax port types






C




The field applies to internal conference port types






P




The field applies to internal playback port types






Re




The field applies to internal recording port types














(16) Call Clearing Messages




Table 158B below provides a list of exemplary Call Clearing Messages.












TABLE 159











Call Clearing

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









RCR - Release




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







channel request




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R







0x000000C2




Call ID




R







0x00000065




Source Port type




R




See additional fields










necessary for each port










type







0x000000FD




Cause Code Type




R







0x000000FE




Cause Code




R













In case of a pass-through call (TDM or packet connection), the channel







identified should be the source side.















ACR - Release




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







channel




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






completed




0x000000C2




Call ID




R







0x00000065




Source Port type




R




See additional fields










necessary for each port










type







0x000000FD




Cause Code Type




R







0x000000FE




Cause Code




R







0x00000091




Number of packets sent




O




Required for packet








and received





pass through calls only







0x00000092




Number of packets




O








dropped







0x00000093




Number of bytes sent




O








and received







0x00000094




Number of bytes dropped




O







0x00000095




Number of signaling




O








packets sent and








received







0x00000096




Number of signaling




O








packets dropped







0x00000097




Number of signaling




O








bytes sent and received







0x00000098




Number of signaling




O








bytes dropped







0x00000099




Estimated average




O








latency







0x0000009D




Number of audio packets




O








received







0x0000009E




Number of audio bytes




O








received







0x0000009F




Number of signaling




O








packets received







0x000000A0




Number of signaling




O








bytes received














(17) Event Notification Messages




Table 158B below provides a list of exemplary Event Notification Messages.












TABLE 160











Event Notification

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









NOTI -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Event




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






Notification




0x000000C2




Call ID




R







0x00000065




Source Port type




R




See additional fields










necessary for each port type







0x00000083




Event type




O







0x00000019




Called phone




O




Required tags for event type








number





0x000000 - Inbound call







0x00000018




Calling party




O




notification








number







0x000000FD




Cause Code Type




O




Required tags for event type







0x000000FE




Cause Code




O




0x04 - Call termination










notification







0x0000007C




Packet Loss




O




Required tags for event type








Threshold





0x05 - Packet loss threshold










exceeded







0x00000070




Encoding Type




O




Required tags for event type










0x06 - Voice codec changed







0x00000073




Packet Loading




O




Required tags for event type










0x07 - Voice codec changed







0x000000A1




Pattern1 detected




O







0x000000B0




Pattern16 detected




O







0x000000B7




Input buffer




O




Detected Signals in










character string form













This message is sent from the access server to the soft switch to indicate the







occurrence of an event.















RNOT -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Request




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






Event




0x000000C2




Call ID




R






Notification




0x00000065




Source port type




R




See additional fields










necessary for each port type.










Note that a soft switch can










request notification for a set










of events on an entire bay,










or on an entire bay/module,










or on an entire










bay/module/line, without










specifying each individual










channel.







0x00000083




Event type




O




A soft switch can request










notification of a specific










event or set of events. The










event type field can be










repeated as many times as










needed.







0x000000A1




Pattern1




O




A soft switch can request










notification of a specific










pattern as described in the










pattern grammar above.







0x000000B0




Pattern16




O




A soft switch can request










notification of a specific










pattern as described in the










pattern grammar above.







0x000000B1




Initial Timeout




O




If parameter is not included,










then there is no timeout.










Initial Timeout is the










maximum time between










starting retrieve signals and










the first signal detected.







0x000000B2




Inter-signaling




O




If parameter is not included,








Timeout





then there is no timeout.










Inter-signaling Timeout is










the maximum time between










the detection of one signal










and the detection of another










signal.







0x00000046




Maximum time to




O




If parameter is not included,








wait for signal





then there is no timeout.








detection








0x000000B3




Enabled Event




O




Specifies an automated










response if a signal pattern










is detected, in the form










“[pattern#], [event










character]”. This tag may










be included multiple times










within a single message.







0x000000B4




Discard Oldest




O




When parameter is included










with any value, then as the










input buffer fills up, the










oldest received signal is










discarded.







0x000000B5




Buffer Size




O




If parameter is not










specified, default buffer size










is 35 characters.







0x000000B6




Filter




O




Filter Pattern allows certain










signals to be excluded from










the input buffer of detected










signals (ignored signals).













This event is sent from the soft switch to the access server to indicate that







the access server should notify the soft switch of the indicated events.















(18) Tunneled Signaling Messages




Table 158B below provides a list of Tunneled Signaling Messages.












TABLE 161











Tunneled Signaling

















Parameter








Message




Parameter Tag




Description




R/O




Notes









SIG -




0x000000C0




Message Code




R







Notify/









Initiate




0x000000C1




Transaction ID




R






Signaling




0x00000065




Source port type




R




Only port type of GSTN,






Events







H.323 and ATM are










allowable values for this










field. See the additional










fields necessary for these










ports types.







0x0000006C




Signaling Event Type




R




Identifies the signaling










event included in the










Signaling Data field.







0x0000006D




Signaling Event Data




R














e. Control Message Parameters




Table 162 below provides a listing of the control message parameters, and the control messages which use these message parameters. More specifically, Table 162 provides the tags associated with the parameters, the size (in bytes) of the parameters, the type of the parameters (e.g., ASCII), the parameter descriptions, the values and the control messages which use the parameters.

















TABLE 162









Parameter




Size





Parameter








Tag




(bytes)




Type




description




Values




Usage











0x00000000




4




BYTE




End marker




Always 0x00000000




All messages.

















0x00000001




4




UINT




Protocol version




0x00000000




Version 0




NSUP











(Xcom NMI 5.0)










0x00000001




IPDC Version 0.1






0x00000002




1 to 24




ASCII




System ID/






NSUP, ASUP,









Serial Number






NSDN, RST1,












ARST1, RST2,












ARST2, NSI,












SSSI, RSSS,












NSSS






0x00000003




9




ASCII




System type






NSUP, NSI






0x00000004




4




UINT




Max. number






NSUP, NSI









of modules









(slot cards)









supported






0x00000005




8




ASCII




Bay number






NSUP,












NSI, NBN






0x00000006




4




BYTE




Reboot




0x00000000




Request accepted.




ARST2









acknowledgment





Access server











will reboot now.










0x00000001




Request denied.











Access server











will not reboot.






0x00000007




4




UINT




Module number






RMI, NMI,












RLI, NLI,












RCI, NCI,












SLI, ASLI,












RMS, RLS,












RCS, NMS,












NLS, NCS,












SMS, SLS,












SCS, RSCS,












PCT, APCT,












SCT, ASCT,












STN, ASTN,












RCON, ACON,












MCON, AMCN,












RCR, ACR






0x00000008




4




UINT




Number of lines






NMI, NMS









on this module






0x00000009




16 




ASCII




Module name






NMI






0x0000000A




4




BYTE




Module type




0x00000000




not present




NMI










0x00000001




unknown




















Other values to be defined







0x0000000B




4




BYTE




Module




Logical OR of any of the




NMI










capabilities following flags





















0x00000001




Capable of












continuity testing










0x00000002




Network











interface module






0x0000000C




4




BYTE




Module status




0x00000000




not present (empty)




NMS










0x00000001




out of service (down)










0x00000002




up










0x00000003




error






0x0000000D




4




UINT




Line Number






RLI, NLI,












RCI, NCI,












SLI, ASLI,












RLS, RCS,












NLS, NCS,












SLS, SCS,












RSCS,












PCT,












APCT,












SCT,












ASCT,












STN,












ASTN,












MCON,












ACON,












RMCN,












AMCN,












RCR, ACR






0x0000000E




4




UINT




Number of






NLI, NLS









channels on









this line






0x0000000F




16




ASCII




Line name






NLI, SLI






0x00000010




4




BYTE




Line coding




0x00000000




Unknown




NLI, SLI










0x00000001




AMI










0x00000002




B8ZS






0x00000011




4




BYTE




Line framing




0x00000000




Unknown




NLI, SLI










0x00000001




D4










0x00000002




ESF






0x00000012




4




BYTE




Line siganling




0x00000000




Unknown




NLI, SLI









details




0x00000001




In-band










0x00000002




ISDN PRI










0x00000003




NFAS










0x00000004




SS7 gateway






0x00000013




4




BYTE




Line in-band




0x00000000




Unknown




NLI, SLI









signaling details




0x00000001




Wink start










0x00000002




Idle start










0x00000003




wink-wink with 200











msec wink










0x00000004




wink-wink with 400











msec wink










0x00000005




loop start CPE










0x00000006




ground start CPE






0x00000014




4




BYTE




Line status




0x00000000




not present




NLS










0x00000001




disabled










0x00000002




red alarm











(loss of sync)










0x00000003




yellow alarm










0x00000004




other alarms or errors










0x00000005




up










0x00000006




loopback






0x00000015




4




UINT




Channel number






RCI, NCI,












RCS, NCS,












SCS,












RSCS,












PCT,












APCT,












SCT,












ASCT,












STN,












ASTN,












MCON,












ACON,












RMCN,












AMCN,












RCR, ACR






0x00000016




4




BYTE




Channel status




0x00000000




not present




NCS










0x00000001




out of service










0x00000002




signaling channel











(i.e., D-channel











on an ISDN PRI line










0x00000003




maintenance











(continuity test











pending or in progress)










0x00000004




blocked










0x00000005




loopback










0x00000006




idle










0x00000007




in use (dialing,











ringing, etc.)










0x00000008




connected










0x00000009




in use/DSP output










0x0000000A




in use/DSP input










0x0000000B




in use/DSP











input + output










0x0000000E




off hook/idle
















0x00000017




4




BYTE




Bearer capability




A one byte value. The capability




NCI, RCON










encoding is the same as the octet










“Information Transfer Capability”










from the User Service Information










parameter from ANSI T1.113.3:





















0x00000000




Voice call











0x00000008




64K data call










0x00000009




56K data call










0x00000010




Modem call











(3.1K Audio call)










0x00000012




Fax call











(Reserved for future use,











not ANSI-compliant)






0x00000018




24 




ASCII




Calling party number






NCI, RCON






0x00000019




24 




ASCII




Dialed number






NCI, RCON






0x0000001A




4




TIME




Channel status change






NCI









timestamp
















0x0000001B




4




BYTE




Primary soft switch IP




1


st


byte: Class A octet




NSSI,










2


nd


byte: Class B octet




SSSI, NSSS










3


rd


byte: Class C octet










4


th


byte: Server octet






0x0000001C




4




UINT




Primary soft switch





NSSI,









TCP port





SSSI, NSSS






0x0000001D




4




BYTE




Secondary




1


st


byte: Class A octet




NSSI,









soft switch IP




2


nd


byte: Class B octet




SSSI, NSSS










3


rd


byte: Class C octet










4


th


byte: Server octet






0x0000001E




4




UINT




Secondary soft switch





NSSI,









TCP port





SSSI, NSSS

















0x0000001F




4




BYTE




Soft switch selector




0x00000001




Primary Soft Switch




NSSS










0x00000002




Secondary Soft Switch










0x00000003




Tertiary Soft Switch






0x00000020




4




UINT




Number of lines






NMS









in the Line









status array






0x00000021




Variable




BYTE




Line status array




0x00000000




not present




NMS










0x00000001




disabled










0x00000002




red alarm











(loss of sync)










0x00000003




yellow alarm










0x00000004




other alarms or errors










0x00000005




up










0x00000006




loopback






0x00000022




4




UINT




Number of channels






NLS









in the Channel









status array






0x00000023




Variable




BYTE




Channel status array




0x00000000




not present




NLS










0x00000001




out of service










0x00000002




signaling channel











(i.e., D-channel on an











ISDN PRI)










0x00000003




maintenance











(continuity test pending/











in progress)










0x00000004




blocked










0x00000005




loopback










0x00000006




idle










0x00000007




in use











(dialing, ringing, etc.)










0x00000008




connected










0x00000009




in use/DSP output










0x0000000A




in use/DSP input










0x0000000B




in use/DSP











input + output










0x0000000E




off hook/idle






0x00000024




4




BYTE




Requested




0x00000000




out of service




SMS









module state




0x00000001




initialize (bring up)






0x00000025




4





Requested line state




0x00000000




Disable




SLS










0x00000001




Enable










0x00000002




Start loopback










0x00000003




Terminate loopback






0x00000026




4




BYTE




Requested channel




0x00000000




Reset to idle




SCS









status action




0x00000001




Reset to out of service










0x00000002




Start loopback










0x00000003




Terminate loopback










0x00000004




Block










0x00000005




Unblock






0x00000027




4




BYTE




Set channel




0x00000000




Do not perform the




SCS









status option





indicated action if any of











the channels is not in the











valid initial state.










0x00000001




Perform the indicated











action on channels











which are on the valid











initial state. Other











channels are not affected.






0x00000028




4




UINT




Channel number first






SCS, RSCS









(for grouping)






0x00000029




4




UINT




Channel number last






SCS, RSCS









(for grouping)






0x0000002A




4




BYTE




“Set channel




0x00000000




action successfully




RSCS









status” result





performed in all channels










0x00000001




at least one channel











failed






0x0000002B




4




BYTE




“Prepare for continuity




0x00000000




Resources reserved




APCT









check” result





successfully










0x00000001




Resource not available
















0x0000002C




4




UINT




Continuity timeout




Time out in milliseconds, default is




SCT










2000 (2 seconds)

















0x0000002D




4




BYTE




Continuity test result




0x00000000




Test completed




ASCT











successfully










0x00000001




Test failed






0x0000002E




0 to 16





Test echo






RTE, ARTE
















0x0000002F




4




BYTE




Test ping address




1


st


byte: Class A octet




RTP, ATP










2


nd


byte: Class B octet










3


rd


byte: Class C octet










4


th


byte: Class Server octet






0x00000030




4




UINT




Number of pings





RTP, ATP






0x00000032




4




UINT




Number of tones





STN






0x00000033




Variable




ASCII




Tone string




ASCII characters




STN









′0′-′9′, ′A′-′D′, ′*′, ′#′)




′0′-′9′, ′*′, ′#′,










′d′ - contiguous dialtone,










′b′ - contiguous user busy










′n′ - contiguous network busy










′s′ - short pause










′r′ - contiguous ringback










′s′ - short pause










′r′ - ring back tone










′w′ - wink










′f′ - flash hook










′c′ - call waiting tone










′a′ - answer tone










′t′ - ringing










′p′ - prompt tone










′e′ - error tone










′i′ - distinctive ringing tone










′u′ - Stutter dialtone

















0x00000036




4




UINT




Tone send




0x00000000




Operation succeeded




STN









completion status










0x00000001




Operation failed










0x00000002




Operation was interrupted






0x00000037




4




UINT




TDM destination






RCST, ACST,









Module






RCSO (SS)






0x00000038




4




UINT




TDM destination






RCST, ACST,









Line






RCSO (SS)






0x00000039




4




UINT




TDM destination






RCST, ACST,









channel






RCSO (SS)






0x0000003A




4




UINT




Number of failed lines






NMI
















0x0000003B




4




BYTE




Tertiary soft switch IP




1


st


byte: Class A octet




NSSI, SSSI,










2


nd


byte: Class B octet




NSSS










3


rd


byte: Class C octet










4


th


byte: Class Server octet






0x0000003C




4




UINT




Tertiary soft switch





NSSI, SSSI,









TCP port





NSSS






0x00000040




4




UINT




Access Server





RCON, AMCN,









Call identifier





NCI

















0x00000041




4




BYTE




T1 front-end type




0x00000000




Unknown




SLI, NLI










0x00000001




CSU (T1 long haul)










0x00000002




DSX-1 (T1 short haul)






0x00000042




4




BYTE




T1 CSU build-out




0x000000000




dB




SLI, NLI










0x000000017.5




dB










0x0000000215




dB










0x0000000322.5




dB






0x00000043




4




BYTE




T1 DSX line length




0x000000001-133




ft




SLI, NLI










0x00000001134-266




ft










0x00000002267-399




ft










0x00000003400-533




ft










0x00000004534-655




ft






0x00000044




 1 to 255




BYTE




List of CPE line the






RCON









call is offered on









for inbound calls or









the port the call









was originated from









for outbound calls.






0x00000045




4




TIME




Timestamp of the call






RCON









setup (for caller ID









service). Number of









seconds since Jan. 1









00:00:00









1990.






0x00000046




4




UINT




Maximum total time




Time in milliseconds





RNOT









allowed for digit









recognition.






0x00000047




4




BYTE




Requested Priority




0x00000000




not forced




RCON










0x00000001




forced






0x00000048




4




UNT




Set Defaults




0x00000000




action successfully




ADEF









Settings result





performed in all











channels










0x00000001




at least one channel failed






0x00000049




4




BYTE




Tone Type




0x00000000




DTMF




STN










0x00000001




MF






0x0000004A




4




BYTE




Apply/Cancel Tone




0x00000000




Apply tone




STN










0x00000001




Cancel tone
















0x00000055




4




BYTE




Source listen




1


st


byte: Class A octet




RCON, ACON,









IP address




2


nd


byte: Class B octet




RMCN,










3


rd


byte: Class C octet




AMCN, RCR,










4


th


byle: Server octet




ACR






0x00000056




4




UINT




Source listen RTP





RCON, ACON,









port number





RMCN, AMCN,











RCR, ACR






0x00000057




4




BYTE




Source send IP address




1


st


byte: Class A octet




RCON, ACON,










2


nd


byte: Class B octet




RMCN, AMCN,










3


rd


byte: Class C octet




RCR, ACR










4


th


byle: Server octet







0x00000058




4




UINT




Source send RTP





RCON, ACON,









port number





RMCN, AMCN,











RCR, ACR

















0x00000059




4




UINT




Source ATM




0x00000001




E.164 format




RCON,









Address Type




0x00000002




ATM End System




ACON, RMCN,











Address format




AMCN, RCR,












ACR






0x0000005A




Variable




ASCII




Source ATM Address






RCON, ACON,












RMCN, AMCN,












RCR, ACR
















0x0000005B




4




BYTE




Source H.323 Network




1


st


byte: Class A octet




RCON, ACON,









Address (IP Address)




2


nd


byte: Class B octet




RMCN, AMCN,










3


rd


byte: Class C octet




RCR, ACR










4


th


byte: Server octet







0x0000005C




Variable




ASCII




Source H.323 alias





RCON, ACON,











RMCN, AMCN,











RCR, ACR






0x0000005D




4




BYTE




Destination listen




1


st


byte: Class A octet




RCON, ACON,









IP address




2


nd


byte: Class B octet




RMCN, AMCN,










3


rd


byte: Class C octet




RCR, ACR










4


th


byte: Server octet






0x0000005E




4




UINT




Destination listen RTP





RCON, ACON,









port number





RMCN, AMCN,











RCR, ACR






0x0000005F




4




BYTE




Destination send IP




1


st


byte: Class A octet




RCON, ACON,









address




2


nd


byte: Class B octet




RMCN, AMCN,










3


rd


byte: Class C octet




RCR, ACR










4


th


byte: Server octet






0x00000060




4




UINT




Destination send RTP





RCON, ACON,









port number





RMCN, AMCN,











RCR, ACR

















0x00000061




4




BYTE




Destination ATM




0x00000001




E.164 format




RCON, ACON,









Address Type




0x00000002




ATM End System




RMCN, AMCN,











Address format




RCR, ACR






0x00000062




Variable




ASCII




Destination ATM






RCON, ACON,









Address






RMCN, AMCN,












RCR, ACR
















0x00000063




4




BYTE




Destination H.323




1


st


byte: Class A octet




RCON, ACON,









Network Address




2


nd


byte: Class B octet




RMCN, AMCN,









(IP Address)




3


rd


byte: Class C octet




RCR, ACR










4


th


byte: Server octet






0x00000064




Variable




ASCII




Destination H.323 alias





RCON, ACON,











RMCN, AMCN,











RCR, ACR

















0x00000065




4




BYTE




Source port type




0x00000000




GSTN chanel




RCON, ACON,










0x00000001




RTP port




RMCN, AMCN,










0x00000002




ATM port




RCR, ACR










0x00000003




H.323 port










0x00000004




Internal Modem Resource










0x00000005




Internal Fax Resource










0x00000006




Internal Conference











Resource










0x00000007




Internal Recording











Resource










0x00000008




Internal Playback Resource






0x00000066




4




BYTE




Destination port type




0x00000000




GSTN channel




RCON, ACON,










0x00000001




RTP port




RMCN, AMCN,










0x00000002




ATM port




RCR, ACR










0x00000003




H.323 port










0x00000004




Internal Modem Resource










0x00000005




Internal Fax Resource










0x00000006




Internal Conference











Resource










0x00000007




Internal Recording











Resource










0x00000008




Internal Playback Resource






0x00000067




4




BYTE




Internal conference






RCON









resource ID






0x00000068




4




BYTE




Internal Fax resource D






RCON






0x00000069




4




BYTE




Internal playback






RCON









resource ID






0x0000006A




4




BYTE




Internal recording






RCON









resource ID






0x0000006B




4




BYTE




Internal modem






RCON









resource ID
















0x0000006C




4




BYTE




Signaling Event Type




For GSTN ports using Q.931 signaling




SIG














0x00000000




ALERTING







0x00000001




CALL PROCEEDING







0x00000002




CONNECT







0x00000003




CONNECT








ACKNOWLEDGE







0x00000004




DISCONNECT







0x00000005




USER INFORMATION







0x00000006




PROGRESS







0x00000007




RELEASE







0x00000008




RELEASE COMPLETE







0x00000009




RESUME







0x0000000A




RESUME








ACKNOWLEDGE







0x0000000B




RESUME REJECT







0x0000000C




SETUP







0x0000000D




SETUP








ACKNOWLEDGE







0x0000000E




STATUS







0x0000000F




STATUS INQUIRY







0x00000010




SUSPEND







0x00000011




SUSPEND








ACKNOWLEDGE







0x00000012




SUSPEND REJECT













For ATM polls using Q.2931 signaling














0x00000100




ALERTING







0x00000101




CALL PROCEEDING







0x00000102




CONNECT







0x00000103




CONNECT ACKNOWLEDGE







0x00000104




DISCONNECT







0x00000105




USER INFORMATION







0x00000106




PROGRESS







0x00000107




RELEASE







0x00000108




RELEASE COMPLETE







0x0000010C




SETUP







0x0000010D




SETUP ACKNOWLEDGE







0x0000010E




STATUS







0x0000010F




STATUS INQUIRY
















0x0000006D




Variable




BYTE




Signaling Event Data




Q.931 or Q.2931 signaling messages




SIG






0x0000006E




4




BYTE




Forward Signaling




Indicates whether the access server should




SDEF









Events to the




send signaling events to the soft switch









Soft Switch














0x00000000




Do not send signaling events







0x00000001




Send signaling events
















0x00000070




4




BYTE




Encoding type




These values are defined in




RCON,










ietf-avt-profile-new-02.txt,




RMCN,










dated Nov. 20, 1997.




AMCN














0x00000001




1016







0x00000002




DVI4







0x00000003




G722







0x00000004




G723







0x00000005




G726-16







0x00000006




G726-24







0x00000007




G726-32







0x00000008




G726-40







0x00000009




G727-16







0x0000000A




G727-24







0x0000000B




G727-32







0x0000000C




G727-40







0x0000000D




G728







0x0000000E




G729







0x0000000F




GSM







0x00000010




L8







0x00000011




L16







0x00000012




LPC







0x00000013




MPA







0x00000014




PCMA (G.711 A-law)







0x00000015




PCMU (G.711 mu-law)







0x00000016




RED







0x00000017




SX7300P







0x00000018




SX8300P







0x00000019




VDVI

















0x00000071




4




UINT




Silence Suppression




Time in milliseconds





RCON, RMCN,









Activation Timer






AMCN






0x00000072




4




BYTE




Comfort Noise




00x00




off




RCON, RMCN,









Generation




0x01




on (default)




AMCN
















0x00000073




4




UINT




Packet Loading




Numeric value expressed in milliseconds




RCON, RMCN,










per packet (frames per packet)




AMCN






0x00000074




4




BYTE




Echo Cancellation





















0x00000000




off




RCON, RMCN,










0x00000001




on, 16 ms tail




AMCN










0x00000002




on, 32 ms tail (default)






0x00000075




4




BYTE




Constant DTMF Tone




0x00000000




off




RCON, RMCN,









Detection on/off




0x00000001




on (default)




AMCN






0x00000076




4




BYTE




Constant MF Tone




0x00000000




off (default)




RCON, RMCN,









Detection on/off




0x00000001




on




AMCN






0x00000077




4




BYTE




Constant Fax tone




0x00000000




off




RCON, RMCN,









detection on/off




0x00000001




on (default)




AMCN






0x00000078




4




BYTE




Constant Modem tone




0x00000000




off




RCON, RMCN,









detection on/off




0x00000001




on (default)




AMCN
















0x00000079




4




UINT




Programmable DSP




Identifier of the DSP algorithm




RCON, RMCN,









Algorithm activation




Values to be assigned




AMCN






0x0000007A




4




UINT




Programmable DSP




Identifier of the DSP algorithm




RCON, RMCN,









Algorithm deactivation




Values to be assigned




AMCN

















0x0000007B




4




BYTE




Constant Packet Loss




0x00000000




off




RCON, RMCN,









Detection on/off




0x00000001




on (default)




AMCN
















0x0000007C




4




UINT




Packet Loss Threshold




Number of packets lost per second




RCON, RMCN,











AMCN

















0x0000007D




4




BYTE




Constant Latency




0x00000000




off




RCON, RMCN,









Threshold Detection




0x00000001




on (default)




AMCN









on/off
















0x0000007E




4




UINT




Latency Threshold




Max latency end to end measured in millisceonds




RCON, RMCN,











AMCN






0x0000007F




4




UINT




Announcement Identifier




Identifier of announcement (Values to be assigned)




RCON, RMCN,











AMCN






0x00000080




Variable




ASCII




Announcement





RCON









Information

















0x00000081




4




BYTE




QoS type




0x00000001




MPLS




RCCP, RMCP,










0x00000002




ToS bits




AMCP










0x00000003




ATM
















0x00000082




4




BYTE




QoS value




For MPLS 4 byte, network defined, MPLS tag




RCCP, RMCP,










For ToS 1 byte (4 bits used, big-Endian)




AMCP










as defined in RFC 1349





















0x00000008




Minimize delay











0x00000004




Maximize throughput










0x00000002




Maximize reliability










0x00000001




Minimize monetary cost










0x00000000




Normal service For ATM










0x00000001




Constant bit rate










0x00000002




Real-Time variable bit rate










0x00000003




Non-Real-Time variable











bit rate










0x00000004




Available bit rate










0x00000005




Unspecified bit rate






0x00000083




4




BYTE




Event type




0x00000000




Inbound call notification




NOTI










0x00000001




Ringing notification










0x00000002




Call Answer notification










0x00000003




On hook notification










0x00000004




Packet loss threshold











exceeded










0x00000005




Voice codec changed










0x00000006




Sampling rate changed










0x00000007




Flash hook










0x00000008




Off hook










0x00000009




Latency Threshold











exceeded










0x0000000A




Channel Blocked










0x0000000B




Busy notificaiton










0x0000000C




Fast Busy notificaiton










0x0000000D




Answering Machine











Detected










0x0000000E




Operation complete













Need to make sure that this lit is complete







with respect to handling MF and DTMF signaling.

















0x00000084




4




BYTE




Signaling Channel




0x00000001




MPLS




RCCP, RMPC,









QoS type




0x00000002




ToS bits




AMCP










0x00000003




ATM
















0x00000085




4




BYTE




Siganling Channel




For MPLS 4 byte, network defined, MPLS tag




RCCP, RMCP,









QoS type




For ToS 1 byte (4 bits used, big-Endian) as




AMCP










defined in RFC 1349





















0x00000008




Minimize delay











0x00000004




Maximize throughput










0x00000002




Maximize reliability










0x00000001




Minimize monetary cost










0x00000000




Normal service











For ATM










0x00000001




Constant bit rate










0x00000002




Real-Time variable bit











rate










0x00000003




Non-Real-Time variable











bit rate










0x00000004




Available bit rate










0x00000005




Unspecified bit rate






0x00000086




4




BYTE




Announcement




0x00




Continuous play




RCON









Treatment




0x01




Play once and terminate











the call










0x02




Play twice and terminate











the call






0x00000091




4




UINT




Number of audio






RCR, ACR









packets sent






0x00000092




4




UINT




Number of audio






RCR, ACR









packets dropped






0x00000093




4




UINT




Number of audio






RCR, ACR









bytes sent






0x00000094




4




UINT




Number of audio






RCR, ACR









bytes dropped






0x00000095




4




UINT




Number of signaling






RCR, ACR









packets sent






0x00000096




4




UINT




Number of signaling






RCR, ACR









packets dropped






0x00000097




4




UINT




Number of signaling






RCR, ACR









bytes sent






0x00000098




4




UINT




Number of signaling






RCR, ACR









bytes dropped






0x00000099




4




UINT




Estimated average




Time in milliseconds





RCR, ACR









latency






0x0000009A




4




UINT




Source H.323 TSAP






RCCP, ACCP,









Identifier (UDP Port)






RMCP, AMCP,












RCR, ACR






0x0000009B




4




UINT




Destination H.323






RCCP, ACCP,









TSAP Identifier






RMCP, AMCP,









(UDP Port)






RCR, ACR






0x0000009D




4




UINT




Number of audio






ACR









packets received






0x0000009E




4




UINT




Number of audio






ACR









bytes received






0x0000009F




4




UINT




Number of signaling






ACR









packets received






0x000000A0




4




UINT




Number of signaling






ACR









bytes received
















0x000000A1




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 1




Refer to the section describing the




NOTI, RNOT









(character string)




NOTI and RNOT messages for more






0x000000A2




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 2




information on the contents of these fields




NOTI, RNOT









(character string)







0x000000A3




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 3





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000A4




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 4





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000A5




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 5





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000A6




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 6





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000A7




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 7





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000A8




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 8





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000A9




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 9





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000AA




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 10





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000AB




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 11





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000AC




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 12





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000AD




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 13





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000AE




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 14





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000AF




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 15





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000B0




Variable




ASCII




Pattern 16





NOTI, RNOT









(character string)






0x000000B1




4




UINT




Initial Timeout





RNOT









(in ms)






0x000000B2




4




UINT




Inter-signaling Timeout





RNOT









(in ms)






0x000000B3




Variable




ASCII




Enabled Event





RNOT









(character string)






0x000000B4




4




ASCII




Discard Oldest Flag





RNOT






0x000000B5




4




UINT




Buffer Size





RNOT






0x000000B6




Variable




ASCII




Filter (pattern





RNOT









(character string)






0x000000B7




Variable




ASCII




Input Buffer





NOTI









(character string)















0x000000C0




4




UINT




Message Code




This tag is used in order to communicate










the message type associated with the message.










There MUST only be a single message code tag










within a given message.






0x000000C1




12 




BYTE




Transation ID




The transaction ID is assigned by the originator










of a transaction. It must remain the same for all










messages exchanged within the transaction.






0x000000C2




16 




BYTE




Call ID




The call ID is used for all call related messages










within IDPC. It must remain the same for all










messages exchanged for the same call. The data is










a 16 byte value that follows the GUID format










specified in H.225.0.

















0x000000FD




4




UINT




Cause code type




0x01




ISDN




MRJ, RCR,




















Other values reserved for future use




ACR, NOTI






0x000000FE





UINT




Cause code




A one byte value. For ISDN cause codes, the




MRJ, RCR,










encoding is defined in ANSI T1.113.3, using the




ACR, NOTI










CCITT coding standard. The following is a list of










ISDN cause codes values is for reference only:














1




Unassigned (unallocated)








number







2




No route to specified








transit network







3




No route to destination







6




Channel unacceptale







7




Call awarded and being








delivered in an








established channel







16




Normal call clearing







17




User busy







18




No user responding







19




No answer from user








(user alerted)







21




Call rejected







22




Number changed







26




Non-selected user clearing







27




Destination out of order







28




Invalid number format








(incomplete number)







29




Facility rejected







30




Response to status enquiry







31




Normal, unspecified







34




Nor circuit/channel available







38




Network out of order







41




Temporary failure







42




Switching system congestion








(Soft switch, Access








Server, IP network)







43




Access information discarded







44




Requested circuit/channel








not available







47




Resource unavailable,








unspecified







50




Requested facility not








subscribed







57




Bearer capability not








authorized







58




Bearer capability not








presently available







63




Service or option not








available







65




Bearer capability not








implemented







66




Channel type not implemented







69




Requested facility not








implemented







70




Only restricted digital








information bearer capability








is available







79




Service or option not








implemented, unspecified







81




Invalid call reference value







82




Identified channel does not








exist







83




A suspended call identity








exists but this call identity








does not







84




Call identity in use







85




No call suspended







86




Call having the requested call








identity has been cleared







88




Incompatible destination







91




Invalid transit network








selection







95




Invalid message, unspecified







96




Mandatory information








element is missing







97




Message type non-existent








or not implemented







98




Message not compatible








with call state or message








type non-existent or not








implemented







99




Inormation element








non-existent or not








implemented







100




Invalid information element








contents







101




Message not compatible








with call state







102




Recovery on time expiry







111




Protocol error, unspecified







127




Interworking, unspecified















f. A Detailed View of the Flow of Control Messages




The following section provides a detailed view of the flow of control messages between Soft Switch


204


and Access Server


254


. Included are the source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments describing the message flow.




(1) Startup Flow




Table 163 below provides the Startup flow, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments.















TABLE 163










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1





NSUP




Access Server coming up. The message









contains server information, including number









of modules in the system.






2




ASUP





Acknowledge that the Access Server is









coming up.














Note: At this time, the Soft Switch must wait for the Access Server to send notification when modules (cards) become available.




(2) Module Status Notification Flow




Table 164 below provides the Module status notification flow, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments.















TABLE 164










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1





NMS




Notify module status.











If the module is in the UP state:














2




RMI





Request module information






3





NMI




Notify module information









(including number of lines in this module).














Note: At this time, the Soft Switch must wait for the Access Server to send notification when lines become available.




(3) Line Status Notification Flow




Table 165 below provides the Line status notification flow, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments.















TABLE 165










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1





NLS




Notify line status











If the line is in the UP state:














2




RLI





Request line information






3





NLI




Notify line information









(including number of channels).














Note: Channels will remain in the out-of-service state until the line becomes available. At that time, the channels will be set to the idle state. The Soft Switch must then explicitly disable or block channels that should not be in the idle state.




(4) Blocking of Channels Flow




Table 166 below provides the Blocking of channels flow, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments.















TABLE 166










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1




SCS





Set a group of channels to be blocked state.






2





RSCS




Message indicates if the operation was success-









ful or if it failed.














(5) Unblocking of Channels Flow




Table 167 below provides the Unblocking of channels flow, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments.















TABLE 167










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1




SCS





Set a group of channels to be unblocked state.






2





RSCS




Message indicates if the operation was success-









ful or if it failed.














(6) Keepalive Test Flow




Tables 168A and 168B below provides the Keep-alive test flow, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. Table 168A shows the Access Server verifying that the Soft Switch is still operational. Table 168B shows the Soft Switch verifying that the Access Server is still operational.

















TABLE 168A












Soft




Access








Step




Switch




Server




Comments













1





RTE








2




ARTE




























TABLE 168B












Soft




Access








Step




Switch




Server




Comments













1




RTE









2





ARTE















(7) Reset Request Flow




Table 169 below provides the Reset request flow, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments.















TABLE 169










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1




RST1





First step.






2





ARST1






3




RST2





Second step. If the Access Server doesn't









receive this command within 5 seconds of









sending an ARST1, it will not reboot.






4





ARST2




The Access Server starts the reboot procedure.






5





NSDN




Access Server is now rebooting.














g. Call Flows




(1) Data Services




The Data Call Services Scenarios that follow can be used to deliver internet and intranet access services through NASs


228


and


230


. The scenarios assume that access servers


254


and


256


provide modem termination for inbound calls.




(a) Inbound Data Call via SS7 Signaling Flow




Table 170 below provides an Inbound data call flow via SS7 signaling, including the step, the control message source (Soft Switch


204


, SS7 signaling network


114


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. The reader is directed to the text below further detailing a data call on NASs


228


and


230


, described with reference to FIGS.


26


C and

FIGS. 46-61

. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 63

which depicts a flowchart state diagram of Access Servers


254


and


256


inbound call handling.
















TABLE 170










Soft




Access








Step




Switch




Server




SS7




Comments











1






IAM




Inbound request for new call






2




RCON






Request the soft switch to accept the










call






3





ACON





Accept inbound call






4





NOTI





Answer validated call






5




ANM






Request ANM message to be sent out to










outgoing network











SS7 network initiated termination from this side of the call















6






REL




Incoming release message form SS7










network






7




RCR






Release call on the Soft Switch






8





ACR





Release complete from Soft Switch











Soft Switch initiated or remote network side initiated call termination















6




REL






Send a release request to the SS7 Soft










Switch






7




RCR






Request release of the call on the Soft










Switch






8





ACR





Release call complete from the Soft










Switch














(b) Inbound Data Call via Access Server Signaling Flow




Table 171 below provides an Inbound data call flow via Access Serving signaling, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. The incoming data call could arrive at AGs


238


and


240


from a customer facility


128


via a DAL or ISDN PRI connection. The reader is directed to

FIG. 63

which depicts a flowchart state diagram of Access Servers


254


and


256


inbound call handling, The reader is also directed to

FIG. 25B

which depicts an exemplary call path flow.















TABLE 171










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1





NOTI




Notify the soft switch of an inbound call






2




RCON





Request the soft switch to accept the call






3





ACON




Accept inbound call






4





NOTI




Answer validated call











Network initiated call termination














5





NOTI




Notify the soft switch of hang up






6




RCR





Request release of the call on the soft switch






7





ACR




Release call complete from Soft Switch














(c) Inbound Data Call via SS7 Signaling (with Call-back)




Table 172 below provides an Inbound data call flow via SS7 signaling (with call-back), including the step, the control message source (Soft Switch


204


, SS7 signaling network


114


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. The reader is also directed t o

FIG. 24D

which depicts an exemplary call path flow.
















TABLE 172










Soft




Access








Step




Switch




Server




SS7




Comments



























1






IAM




Inbound request for new call






2




RCON






Request the soft switch to accept the










call






3





ACON





Accept inbound call






4




ANM






Request outgoing ANM for SS7










network






5





RCR





Release complete message with cause










code indicating call back






6




REL






Send a release request to the SS7 soft










switch






7




RCON






Request an outbound call with the same










transaction ID






8





ACON





Accept outbound call request






9




IAM






Send an IAM request to the SS7 soft










switch






10






ACM




Incoming address complete from SS7










network






11






ANM




Incoming answer message from










network






12





NOTI





Call passes RADIUS verification











SS7 network initiated termination from this side of the call















13






REL




Incoming release message form SS7










network






14




RCR






Release call on the soft switch






15





ACR





Release complete from soft switch











Soft switch initiated or remote network side initiated call termination















13




REL






Send a release request to the SS7 soft










switch






14




RCR






Request release of the call on the soft










switch






15





ACR





Release call complete from the soft










switch














The call scenario in Table 172 includes a call flow where the intranet provider does not want to accept direct inbound calls to the network. The service provider accepts inbound calls only for authentication of calling party


102


and then drops the line and dials-back to calling party


102


at the registered location of calling party


102


.




(d) Inbound Data Call (with Loopback Continuity Testing) Flow




Table 173 below provides an Inbound data call flow (with loopback continuity testing), including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments.















TABLE 173










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1




SCS





Set a channel to loopback state






2





RSCS




Message indicates if the operation was









successful or if it failed











If the soft switch determines that the test was successful:














3




RCON





Setup for inbound call on given









module/line/channel






4





ACON




Accept inbound call. At this time, the access









server may start any Radius lookup, etc.






5





NOTI




Connect (answer) inbound call











If the soft switch determines that the test was not successful:














3




SCS





Release a channel from the loopback state









(back to the idle state).






4





RSCS




Message indicates if the operation was









successful or if it failed.














Note: In this case, a continuity test is required before the call proceeds. Also note that different transaction IDs are used throughout this sequence, as follows:




the RSCS message uses the same transaction ID as the SCS command (steps


1


and


2


);




the ACSI and CONI messages use the same transaction ID as the RCSI command (steps


3


.


1


through


3


.


3


); and




the RSCS message uses the same transaction ID as the SCS command (steps


4


.


1


and


4


.


2


).




(e) Outbound Data Call Flow via SS7 Signaling




Table 174 below provides an Outbound data call flow via SS7 signaling, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


, SS7 signaling network


114


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 24D

which depicts an exemplary call path flow.
















TABLE 174










Soft




Access








Step




Switch




Server




SS7




Comments



























1




RCON





IAM




Request an outbound call






2





ACON





Accept outbound call request






3




IAM






Send an LAM request to the SS7 soft










switch






5






ACM




Incoming address complete from SS7










network






6






ANM




Incoming answer message from










network






7





NOTI





Call passes RADIUS verification











SS7 network initiated termination from this side of call















8






REL




Incoming release message from SS7










network






9




RCR






Release complete from soft switch






10





ACR





Release complete from soft switch











Soft switch initiated call termination















8




REL






Send a release request to the SS7 soft










switch






10




RCR






Request release of the call on the soft










switch






11





ACR





Release call complete from the soft










switch














(f) Outbound Data Call Flow via Access Server Signaling




Table 175 below provides an Outbound data call flow via Access Server signaling, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 69

which illustrates a flowchart depicting an Access Server outbound call handling initiated by Soft Switch state diagram. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 25D

which depicts an exemplary call path flow.















TABLE 175










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1




RCON





Request an outbound call






2





ACON




Accept outbound call request






3





NOTI




Notify the soft switch of ringing






4





NOTI




Notify the soft switch of answer






5





NOTI




Call passes RADIUS verification











Network initiated call termination














6





NOTI




Notify the soft switch of hang up






7




RCR





Request release of the call on the soft switch






8





ACR




Release call complete from the soft switch











Soft switch initiated call termination














6




RCR





Request release of the call on the soft switch






7





ACR




Release call complete from the soft switch














(g) Outbound Data Call Flow Initiated from the Access Server with Continuity Testing




Table 176 below provides an Outbound data call flow initiated from the Access Server with continuity testing, including the step, the control message source (either Soft Switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. The reader is also directed to

FIGS. 67A and 67B

which illustrate a flowchart depicting an Access Server continuity test handling state diagram, and to

FIGS. 68A and 68B

which illustrate a flowchart depicting an Access Server outbound call handling initiated by an Access Server state diagram.















TABLE 176










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1





RCON




Request outbound call. Note that the access









server doesn't know yet what









module/line/channel will be used for the call









and so, they are set to 0.






2




RPCT





Soft switch requests a continuity test






3





APCT




Accept continuity test






4




SCT





Start continuity test. If the access server









doesn't receive this command within 3 seconds









of sending an APCT, the continuity test will be









canceled and all reserved resources will









released.






5





ASCT




Continuity test result






6




ACON





Accept outbound call on module/line/channel.









This message is used by the soft switch to









notify the access server which module, line and









channel will be used for the call. If the access









server can't process the call on that channel, it









should issue a release command.






7





NOTI




Outbound call answered by called party














Note: In this case, the Soft Switch requests a continuity test when selecting the outbound channel. Also note that different transaction IDs are used in this sequence as follows:




the ACSO and CONO messages should use the same transaction ID as the RCSO command; and




the APCT, SCT and ASCT messages should use the same transaction ID as the RPCT command.




(2) TDM Switching Setup Connection Flow




The following call scenarios can be used to control a device that is used for TDM circuit switching. TDM circuit switching can be necessary in configurations where a single set of access trunks are used for calls that must terminate on different access server


254


,


256


devices. Soft switch


204


can make the determination of where to send the call based upon the information in the signaling message. TDM switching can be used to route voice traffic to one device and data to another. TDM switching can also be used to connect different inbound calls to different access servers connected to different intranets. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 66

which depicts a flowchart of a stated diagram of Access Server TDM connection handling.




(a) Basic TDM Interaction Sequence




Table 177 below provides a basic interaction sequence for establishing a connection within a TDM switching device including the step, the control message source (either soft switch


204


or Access Server


254


) and relevant comments. The sequence includes a RCST request from soft switch


204


and an ACST response from access servers


254


and


256


.















TABLE 177










Soft




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Comments











1




RCON





Soft Switch requests a given pair of module/









line/channel to be interconnected for inter-trunk









switching.






2





ACON




Accept inter-trunk switch connection.














(b) Routing of Calls to Appropriate Access Server using TDM Connections Flow




Table 178 below illustrates the routing of calls to the appropriate Access Server using TDM connections including the step, the control message source (including soft switch


204


, TDM switching device (e.g., DACs


242


and


244


), SS7 signaling network


114


and Data Access Server (e.g. NASs


228


and


230


). In this call flow, a data call can arrive via the SS7 signaling network


114


. Soft switch


204


must identify the call as a data call and make a TDM connection to connect the call to the appropriate data server. Soft switch


204


can look at information in the IAM message such as the dialed number to determine the type of call and therefore the destination of the TDM connection. This call flow can be used to separate data and voice calls as well as separate data calls destined for different data networks. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 23B

which depicts an exemplary call path flow.

















TABLE 178











TDM




Data









Soft




switching




Access








Step




Switch




device




Server




SS7




Comments




























1







IAM




Inbound request for new











call






2




ACM







Send ACM to originating











network






3




RCON







Identify the call as a data











call, and request a











connection to the correct











access server






4





ACON






Accept the TDM











connection






5




RCON







Request the data access











server to accept the call






6






ACON





Accept the call






7




ANM







Forward answer message to











the originating network











SS7 network initiated termination from this side of the call
















14







REL




Incoming release message











from SS7 network






15




REL







Forward release message to











the originating network






17




RCR







Release call on the TDM











device






18





ACR






Release complete from the











TDM device






19




RCR







Release call on the data











access server






20






ACR





Release complete from data











access server














(3) Voice Services




The following message flows show how to connect calls that originate and terminate on a Switched Circuit Network (SCN), but pass through a data network


112


.




(a) Voice over Packet Services Call Flow (Inbound SS7 Signaling, Outbound Access Server Signaling, Soft Switch Managed RTP Ports)




Table 179 below provides an illustration of a Voice over packet call flow having (Inbound SS7 signaling, Outbound access server signaling, Soft Switch managed RTP ports), including the step, the control message source (i.e., the soft switch


204


, originating access server


254


, SS7 signaling network


114


and terminating access server


256


), and relevant comments. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 63

depicting a flowchart illustrating an Access Server inbound call handling state diagram. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 23C

which depicts an exemplary call path flow.

















TABLE 179











Originating




Terminating









Soft




Access




Access








Step




Switch




Server




Server




SS7




Comments




























1







IAM




Inbound request for new call






2




IAM







Send IAM to terminating











switch






3




RCON







Request the originating











access server to accept the











call. Include port











information in request.






4





ACON






Accept the incoming call











and allocate DSP resources






5




RCON







Request the terminating











access server to accept the











call. Include port











information in request.






6






ACON





Accept the outbound call











and allocate DSP resources.






7






NOTI





Notification of ringing






8




ACM







Address complete to











originating network






9




STN







Apply ringing to inbound











circuit






10






NOTI





Notification of answer from











the termination






11




STN







Remove ringing from











inbound circuit






12




ANM







Forward answer message to











the originating network











SS7 network initiated termination from this side of the call
















13







REL




Incoming release message











from SS7 network






14




REL







Forward release message to











the originating network






15




RCR







Release call on the











originating access server






16





ACR






Release complete from











originating access server






17




RCR







Release call on the











terminating access server






18






ACR





Release complete form











terminating access server














(b) Voice over Packet Call Flow (Inbound Access Server Signaling, Outbound Access Server Signaling, Soft Switch Managed RTP Ports)




Table 180 below provides an illustration of a Voice over packet call services flow having (Inbound access server signaling, Outbound access server signaling, Soft switch managed RTP ports), including the step, the control message source (i.e., the soft switch


204


, originating access server


254


and terminating access server


256


), and relevant comments. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 63

illustrating a flowchart depicting an Access Server inbound call handling state diagram. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 25A

which depicts an exemplary call path flow.
















TABLE 180











Orig-










inating




Terminating








Soft




Access




Access







Step




Switch




Server




Server




Comments



























1




RNOT






Request event notification for










inbound calls, this is probably










done at port initialization.






2





NOTI





Notify the Soft Switch of an










inbound call






3




RCON






Request the originating access










server to accept the call. Include










packet port in the request.






4





ACON





Accept the incoming






5




RCON






Request the terminating access










server to accept the call. Include










packet port in the request






6






ACON




Accept the call






7






NOTI




Notification of ringing from










termination






8




NOTI






Notification of ringing to










origination






9




STN






Apply ringing to origination






10






NOTI




Notification of answer from the










termination






11




STN






Cancel ringing on origination






12




NOTI






Notification of answer from the










soft switch to the origination











Terminating network initiated call termination















13






NOTI




Notify the soft switch of hang up






14




RCR






Request release of the call on the










originating access server






15





ACR





Release call complete from the










originating access server






16




RCR






Request release of the call on the










terminating access server






17






ACR




Release call complete from the










terminating access server














(c) Voice over Packet Call Flow (Inbound SS7 Signaling, Outbound SS7 Signaling, IP Network with Access Server Managed RTP Ports)




Table 181 below provides an illustration of a Voice over packet call flow having (inbound SS7 signaling, outbound SS7 signaling, IP network with access server managed RTP ports), including the step, the control message source (i.e. soft switch


204


, originating access server


254


, SS7 signaling network


114


and terminating access server


256


), and relevant comments. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 63

depicting a flowchart illustrating an Access Server inbound call handling state diagram. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 23

A which depicts an exemplary call path flow.

















TABLE 181











Orig-




Ter-










inating




minating









Soft




Access




Access








Step




Switch




Server




Server




SS7




Comments




























1







IAM




Inbound request for new











call






2




IAM







Send IAM to terminating











switch






3




RCON







Request the originating











access server to accept the











call






4





ACON






Accept the incoming call











and allocate transmit RTP











port






5




RCON







Request the terminating











access server to accept the











call






6






ACON





Accept the call and allocate











a transmit RTP port






7




MCON







Modify the call on the











originating access server to











update the listen port






8





AMNC






Accept modification of











listen port






9







ACM




Inbound address complete











message from terminating











network






10







ANM




Inbound answer message











from terminating network






11




ANM







Forward answer message to











the originating network











SS7 network initiated termination from this side of the call
















12







REL




Incoming release message











from SS7 network






13




REL







Forward release message to











the originating network






14




RCR







Release call on the access











server






15





ACR






Release complete from











originating access server






16




RCR







Release call on the











terminating access server






17






ACR





Release complete from











terminating access server














(d) Unattended Call Transfers Call Flow




Table 183 below provides an unattended call transfer call flow including the step, the control message source (i.e. soft switch


204


, originating access server


254


, operator services access server (e.g. operator services platform


628


) SS7 signaling network


114


, and terminating access server


256


), and relevant comments.




The call flow in Table 183 shows the IPDC protocol can be used to transfer a call to another destination. The example call flow assumes that the person performing the transfer is at an operator services workstation that has the ability to signal soft switch


204


to perform the transfer. The operator services platform interaction is not shown since this would be covered in another protocol, but the resulting messages to access servers


254


and


256


are shown. The operator services platform


628


is connected with dedicated access trunks such as, for example, a DAL or ISDN PRI, or dedicated SS7 signaled trunk.




Note that throughout this call flow the same transaction ID can be used to indicate that the new RCCP commands to ports that are already in use indicates a re-connection, or a call transfer. In this example call flow, the originating caller, i.e. calling party


102


, is serviced by an SS7 signaled trunk, the operator services platform


628


is on a dedicated trunk and the termination is accessed via an access server


254


and


256


signaled trunk. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 63

illustrating a flowchart depicting an access server inbound call handling state diagram. The reader is also directed to

FIG. 6D

depicting an operator services platform


628


.


















TABLE 183












Operator











Originating




Services




Terminating







Soft




Access




Access




Access






Step




Switch




Server




Server




Server




SS7




Comment





























1








IAM




Inbound request for new call. The call is identified as an operator












services call and is routed to an operator services workstations.












The soft switch could perform ACD functions and select the actual












workstation, but that logic is not shown here.






2




RCON








Request the originating access server to accept the call.












And terminate to the operator services access server.






3





ACON







Accept the incoming call.






4




RCON








Request the operator services access server to accept the call.






5






ACON






Accept the call. It is assumed here that the soft switch has the












capability to signal the operator services platform to indicate that












the call has been terminated to one of their ports. Another option












would be to initiate an outbound call with RCSO.






6






NOTI






Notification of ringing.






7




ACM








Address complete message to terminating network






8






NOTI






Notification answer






9




ANM








Answer message to the originating SS7 network











Originator is connected to the operator services platform, the originator and operator interact and determine the actual termination.

















10




RCON








The operator services platform signals the call transfer to the soft switch












(not shown) and the soft switch uses the same transaction ID to send a












new RCCP command to the originating access server to connect












to a multicast port playing music on hold.






11





ACON







Originating access server accepts the new termination






12




RCON








Request the operator serves access server to be connected to the target












of the transfer






13






ACON






Accept connection to the target of the transfer






14




RCON








Request the new terminating access server to accept the call from the












operator services platform






15







ACON





Terminating access server accepts the call






16







NOTI





Notification of ringing






17




STN








Apply ringing to operator services access server






18







NOTI





Notification of answer






19




STN








Remove ringing from operator services access server











Operator Serices platform is connected to the called party, interacts briefly and connects to originator and termination.

















22




RCON








After the operator services platform decides to connect the two callers,












the soft switch is signaled and request the originating access server












to connect to the termination






23





ACON







Accept connection to the new termination






24




RCON








Request that the termination now connects to the originating access












server






25







ACON





Accept connection to originating access server






26




STN








Send a connect tone to origination indicating that the termination












is on the line






27




STN








Send a connect tone to termination indicating that the originator












is on the line






28




RCR








Release call on operator services access server






29






ACR






Accept call release.














(e) Attended Call Transfer Call Flow




Table 184 below provides an illustration of an Attended Call Transfer call flow including a step, a control message source (i.e. soft switch


204


, originating access server


254


, operator services access server, SS7 signaling network


114


and terminating access server


256


), and relevant comments.




The call flow of Table 184 is similar to the unattended call flow of Table 183, except that rather than blindly transferring the call, the original caller is placed on hold and the operator services workstations connected to the termination. Once the operator services workstation announces the caller, the two parties are connected. As with Table 183, the message interaction with the operator services platform is not shown.




Note that throughout this call flow the same transaction ID is used to indicate that the new RCCP commands to ports that are already in use indicates a re-connection, or a call transfer.




In the example call flow of Table 184, the originating caller is serviced by an SS7 signaled trunk, the operator services platform is on a dedicated trunk and the termination is accessed via an access server


254


signaled trunk.


















TABLE 184












Operator











Originating




Services




Terminating







Soft




Access




Access




Access






Step




Switch




Server




Server




Server




SS7




Comment





























1








IAM




Inbound request for new call. The call is identified as an operator












services call and is routed to an operator services workstations.












The soft switch could perform ACD functions and select the actual












workstation, but that logic is not shown here.






2




RCON








Request the originating access server to accept the call.












And terminate to the operator services access server.






3





ACON







Accept the incoming call.






4




RCON








Request the operator services access server to accept the call.






5






ACON






Accept the call. It is assumed here that the soft switch has the












capability to signal the operator services platform to indicate that












the call has been terminated to one of their ports. Another option












would be to initiate an outbound call with RCSO.






6






NOTI






Notification of ringing.






7






NOTI






Notification of answer.






8




ANM








Answer message to the originating SS7 network.






9




RCON








The operator services platform signals the call transfer to the soft switch












(not shown) and the soft switch uses the same transactoin ID to send a












new RCCP command to the originating access server to connect












to a different termination.






10





ACON







Originating access server accepts the new termination.






11




RCON








Request the new terminating access server to accept the call.






12







ACON





Terminating access server accepts the call.






13







NOTI





Notification of ringing






14




STN








Apply ringing to origination






15







NOTI





Notification of answer






16




STN








Remove ringing from origination






17




RCR








Release call on operator services access server






18






ACR






Accept call release.














(f) Call Termination with a Message Announcement Call Flow




Table 185 below provides an illustration of a Call termination with a message announcement, including a step, a control message source (i.e. soft switch


204


, originating access server


254


, SS7 signaling network


114


and one of announcement servers


246


and


248


), and relevant comments




The call flow of Table 185 shows the use of announcement servers (ANSs)


246


and


248


, to play call termination announcements as final treatment to a call.




The call flow assumes announcement server, (ANSs)


246


and


248


have pre-recorded announcements. Soft switch


204


signals ANSs


246


and


248


with the appropriate announcement ID using the fields in the RCCP command. One of ANSs


246


and


248


plays the announcement and notifies soft switch


204


that it has completed its task.




In the example call flow, the originating caller is connected via SS7 signaled trunks and one of ANSs


246


and


248


is connected to soft switch


204


via IP data network


114


.




The reader is directed to

FIG. 23D

depicting an exemplary call path flow.

















TABLE 185











Originating








Soft




Access




Announcement






Step




Switch




Server




Server




SS7




Comment




























1







IAM




Inbound request for new call. The call is identified as needing a disconnect











message and is sent to the announcement server.






2




ACM







Address complete to the originating SS7 network. (Note - may need to answer the











call depending upon originating network implementation)






3




RCON







Request the originating access server to accept the call, and terminate to the











announcement server.






4





ACON






Accept the incoming call






5




RCON







Request the announcement server to accept the call. The announcement ID is











included in this message and it is implied that the announcement server will











notify when complete.






6






ACON





Accept the call






7






NOTI





Notification of operation complete






8




REL







Release the call in the originating SS7 network






9




RCR







Release the call on the originating access server






10





ACR






Accept release






11




RCR







Release call on the announcement server






12






ACR





Accept release














(g) Wiretap




Table 186 below provides an illustration of a wiretap call for listening to a call, including the step, the control message source (i.e. soft switch


204


, originating access server


254


, wiretap server (a specialized access server


254


), SS7 signaling network


114


and a terminating access server


256


), and relevant comments.




The example call flow of Table 186 shows the use of a wiretap server to listen to a call. The wiretap server allows the originator and the intended terminator to participate in a normal call with a third party listening to the conversation, but not transmitting the third party's voice. The wiretap server can be an IPDC specialized access server, similar to a conference bridge, but that does not permit transmission of voice from a connected wiretap workstation.


















TABLE 186











Originating





Terminating









Soft




Access




Wiretap




Access






Step




Switch




Server




Server




Server




SS7




Comments





























1








IAM




Inbound request for new call. The call is identified as an operator services












call and is routed to operator services workstations. The soft switch could












perform ACD functions and select the actual workstation, but that logic












is not shown here.






2




RCON








Request the originating access server to accept the call. And terminate












to the wiretap server.






3





ACON







Accept the incoming call.






4




RCON








Using the same transaction ID, request the wiretap server to accept












the inbound call.






5






ACON






Accept the call.







RCON








Request the terminating gateway to connect to the wiretap server,












again using the same transaction ID. This is the key used by the












wiretap server to bridge calls.










ACON





Accept connection of the termination to the wiretap server.







RCON








Request the wiretap server to accept the connection from the termination,












again using the same transaction ID.









ACON






Accept the call.






6




ANM








Answer message to the originating SS7 network.














B. Operational Description




1. Voice Call originating and terminating via SS7 signaling on a Trunking Gateway





FIG. 23A

depicts a voice call originating and terminating via SS7 signaling on a trunking gateway. The reader is directed also to Table 181 shown above, which details control message flow for a voice over packet call flow having inbound SS7 signaling, outbound SS7 signaling, and an IP network with access server managed RTP ports.





FIG. 23A

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2300


. Call path


2300


is originated via a SS7 signaling message


2302


, sent from carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


through SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with TG


232


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2304


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


may require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message


2302


.




SCP


214




a


can then provide to soft switch


204


a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


120


.




Soft switch


204


can then query RS


212


to perform further processing. Route logic


294


of RS


212


can be processed to determine a termination using least cost routing. The termination can be through data network


112


.




Soft switch


204


, i.e., the originating soft switch, can then communicate with terminating soft switch


304


to set up the other half of the call.




Terminating soft switch


304


can then communicate with port status (PS)


298


of RS


314


to determine whether a DS


0


circuit is available for termination and in which TG.




Having determined a free circuit is available on TG


234


, soft switch


304


can allocate a connection


2308


between TG


234


and carrier facility


130


for termination to called party


120


.




Soft switch


304


can then communicate with soft switch


204


to establish connection


2312


, between TG


234


and TG


232


. Soft switch


304


can provide the IP address for TG


234


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


provides this address to TG


232


. TG


232


sets up a real-time transport protocol (RTP) connection


2312


with TG


234


to complete the call path.




a. Voice Call on a TG Sequence Diagrams of Component Intercommunication





FIG. 26A

depicts a detailed diagram of message flow for an exemplary voice call over a NAS, similar to FIG.


23


A.





FIGS. 27-39

depict detailed sequence diagrams demonstrating component intercommunication for a voice call using the interaction of two soft switch sites, i.e. an originating and a terminating soft switch site, similar to

FIG. 2B

, FIG.


23


A and Table 181.

FIGS. 40-45

depict call teardown for the voice call.





FIG. 27

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch accepting a signaling message from an SS7 gateway sequencing diagram


2700


, including message flows


2701


-


2706


.





FIG. 28

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch getting a call context message from an IAM signaling message sequencing diagram


2800


, including message flows


2801


-


2806


.





FIG. 29A

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch receiving and processing an IAM signaling message including sending a request to a route server sequencing diagram


2900


, including message flows


2901


-


2908


.





FIG. 29B

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch starting to process a route request sequencing diagram


2950


, including message flows


2908


, and


2952


-


2956


.





FIG. 30

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server determining a domestic route sequencing diagram


3000


, including message flows


2908


and


3002


-


3013


.





FIG. 31

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server checking availability of potential terminations sequencing diagram


3100


, including message flows


3008


and


3102


-


3103


.





FIG. 32

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server getting an originating route node sequencing diagram


3200


, including message flows


3009


and


3201


-


3207


.





FIGS. 33A and 33B

depict block diagrams of a call flow showing a route server calculating a domestic route for a voice call on a trunking gateway sequencing diagram


3300


, including message flows


3301


-


3312


and sequencing diagram


3320


, including message flows


3321


-


3345


, respectively.





FIG. 34

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch getting a call context from a route response from a route server sequencing diagram


3400


, including message flows


3401


-


3404


.





FIG. 35

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch processing an IAM message including sending an IAM to a terminating network sequencing diagram


3500


, including message flows


3501


-


3508


.





FIG. 36

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message including sending an ACM to an originating network sequencing diagram


3600


, including message flows


3601


-


3611


.





FIG. 37

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message including the setup of access servers sequencing diagram


3700


, including message flows


3701


-


3705


.





FIG. 38

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an example of how a soft switch can process an ACM message to send an RTP connection message to the originating access server sequencing diagram


3800


, including message flows


3801


-


3814


.





FIG. 39

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ANM message sending the ANM message to the originating SS7 GW sequencing diagram


3900


, including message flows


3901


-


3911


.





FIG. 40

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an REL message where the terminating end initiates call teardown sequencing diagram


4000


, including message flows


4001


-


4011


.





FIG. 41

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an REL message to tear down all nodes sequencing diagram


4100


, including message flows


4101


-


4107


.





FIG. 42

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an RLC message where the terminating end initiates teardown sequencing diagram


4200


, including message flows


4201


-


4211


.





FIG. 43

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch sending an unallocate message to route server for call teardown sequencing diagram


4300


, including message flows


4301


-


4305


.





FIG. 44

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch instructing a route server to unallocate route nodes sequencing diagram


4400


, including message flows


4305


,


4401


-


4410


.





FIG. 45

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing call teardown including deleting call context sequencing diagram


4500


, including message flows


4409


,


4502


and


4503


.




2. Data Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Trunking Gateway





FIG. 23B

illustrates termination of a data call arriving on TG


232


. The reader is also directed to Table 170 shown above, which depicts a voice over packet call flow having an inbound data call using SS7 signaling. Tables 177 and


178


are also relevant and describe TDM passthrough switching.





FIG. 23B

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2314


. Call path


2314


is originated via an SS7 signal from the carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


through SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with TG


232


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2316


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


may require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in the signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide to soft switch


204


a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


120


.




As part of the query performed on CS


206


, soft switch


204


can determine that the called party corresponds to a data modem, representing a data call.




Soft switch


204


can then communicate with network access server (NAS)


228


to determine whether a modem is available for termination in NAS


228


.




If soft switch


204


determines that a terminating modem is available, then soft switch


204


can set up connections


2318


and


2322


via TDM switching to terminate the data call in a modem included in NAS


228


. Connections


2316


and


2322


are DS


0


circuits. Connection


2318


represents a TDM bus. TDM pass-through switching is described further with respect to Tables 177 and 178, above.




If soft switch


204


determines that a terminating modem is available, then soft switch


204


terminates the call to that modem.




3. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Trunking Gateway and terminating via access server signaling on an Access Gateway





FIG. 23C

depicts a voice call originating on an SS7 trunk on a TG


232


and terminating via access server signaling on an AG


240


. The reader is directed to Table 179 above, which illustrates a voice over packet call flow having inbound SS7 signaling, outbound access server signaling, and soft switched managed RTP ports.





FIG. 23C

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2324


. Call path


2324


is originated via SS7 signaling IAM messages from carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


through SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with TG


232


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2326


from carrier facility


126


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


can require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide to soft switch


204


a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


124


.




Soft switch


204


can then query RS


212


to perform further processing. Route logic


294


of RS


212


can be processed to determine a least cost routing termination. The termination can be through data network


112


.




Soft switch


204


, i:e., the originating soft switch, can then communicate with terminating soft switch


304


to set up the other half of the call.




Terminating soft switch


304


can then communicate with port status (PS)


298


of RS


314


to determine whether a DS


0


or DS


1


circuit is available for termination and in which AG.




Having determined a free circuit is available on AG


240


, soft switch


304


can allocate a connection


2330


between AG


240


and customer facility


132


for termination to called party


124


.




Soft switch


304


can then communicate with soft switch


204


to establish connection


2334


, between TG


232


and AG


240


. Soft switch


304


can provide the IP address for TG


240


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


provides this address to TG


232


. TG


232


sets up a real-time transport protocol (RTP) connection


2334


with AG


240


(based upon the IP addresses provided by the soft switch) to complete the call path.




4. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Trunking Gateway and terminating on an Announcement Server





FIG. 23D

depicts a voice call originating on an SS7 trunk on a TG and terminating with a message announcement on an ANS. The reader is directed to Table 185 above which shows a call termination with a message announcement call flow.





FIG. 23D

includes a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2336


. Call path


2336


is originated via a signal from carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


, to soft switch,


204


through SS7 GW


208


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with TG


232


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2338


between customer facility


126


and TG


232


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


may require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message


2302


.




SCP


214




a


can then provide to soft switch


204


a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


120


.




Soft switch


204


can then query RS


212


to perform further processing. Route logic


294


of RS


212


can be processed to determine a least cost routing termination. RS


212


determines an optimal termination from data network


112


, or least cost routing with data network


112


terminations as exemplary choices. Off network routing can be considered as well. The termination can be through data network


112


.




If a route termination cannot be found, the call is “treated” by the announcement server


246


. Treating refers to processing done on a call.




For example, assuming a TG


232


to TG


234


call, the soft switches can communicate and soft switch


304


can check port status of RS


314


to determine whether a DS


0


circuit is available for termination on a TG and the IP address of the TG.




Assuming, for this call flow, that no DS


0


circuits are determined to be free on TG


234


, soft switch


204


communicates with TG


232


, including providing the IP address of ANS


246


to TG


232


. Soft switch


204


can also communicate with ANS


246


, via the IPDC protocol, to cause ANS


246


to perform functions. TG


232


can set up an RTP connection


2342


with ANS


246


to perform announcement processing, and to deliver an announcement to calling party


102


.




5. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a Network Access Server and terminating on a Trunking Gateway via SS7 signaling





FIG. 24A

depicts a voice call originating on a SS7 trunk on a NAS and terminating on a TG via SS7 signaling. The reader is directed to Tables 177 and 178 above, which show a TDM switching connection setup flow and the routing of calls to an appropriate access server using TDM connections. The reader is directed also to Table 181 shown above, which details control message flow for a voice over packet call flow having inbound SS7 signaling, outbound SS7 signaling, and an IP network with access server managed RTP ports.





FIG. 24A

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2400


. Call path


2400


is originated via a SS7 signaling message, sent from carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


through SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with NAS


228


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2402


between carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


and NAS


228


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


may require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message


2302


.




SCP


214




a


can then provide to soft switch


204


a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


120


.




In one embodiment, soft switch


204


determines from the dialed number in the IAM message, that the call is a voice or VPOP call and thus needs a trunking gateway to handle the voice call. Soft switch


204


sends an IPDC message to the NAS to TDM pass-through the call to the TG.




To determine the type of call, soft switch


204


can also perform further processing to determine, e.g., whether the call is to a destination known as a data modem termination dialed number. If the dialed number is not to a data number, then soft switch


204


determines that the call is a voice call.




Soft switch


204


can now determine whether a TG


232


has any ports available for termination by querying port status


292


of route server


212


, and if so, can allocate the available port and set up a TDM bus connection


2404


in the NAS via TDM switching, and DS


0


circuit


2406


to TG


232


. Soft switch


204


can also query routing logic


294


of RS


212


to determine a least cost route termination to the called destination.




Soft switch


204


, i.e., the originating soft switch, can then communicate with terminating soft switch


304


to set up the other half of the call.




Terminating soft switch


304


can then communicate with port status (PS)


298


of RS


314


to determine whether a port is available for termination and in which TG.




Having determined a free circuit is available on TG


234


, soft switch


304


can allocate a connection


2410


between TG


234


and carrier facility


130


for termination to called party


120


.




Soft switch


304


can then communicate with soft switch


204


to establish connection


2414


, between TG


234


and TG


232


. Soft switch


304


can provide the IP address for TG


234


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


provides this address to TG


232


. TG


232


sets up an real-time transport protocol (RTP) connection


2414


with TG


234


to complete the call path.




a. Voice Call on a NAS Sequence Diagrams of Component Intercommunication





FIG. 26B

depicts a detailed diagram of message flow for an exemplary voice call over a NAS, similar to FIG.


24


A.





FIGS. 27-39

and


46


-


48


depict detailed sequence diagrams demonstrating component intercommunication for a voice call using the interaction of two soft switch sites, i.e. an originating and a terminating soft switch site, similar to

FIG. 2B

, FIG.


24


A and Table 181.

FIGS. 40-45

depict call teardown for the voice call.





FIG. 27

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch accepting a signaling message from an SS7 gateway sequencing diagram


2700


, including message flows


2701


-


2706


.





FIG. 28

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch getting a call context message from an IAM signaling message sequencing diagram


2800


, including message flows


2801


-


2806


.





FIG. 29A

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch receiving and processing an IAM signaling message including sending a request to a route server sequencing diagram


2900


, including message flows


2901


-


2908


.





FIG. 29B

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch starting to process a route request sequencing diagram


2950


, including message flows


2908


, and


2952


-


2956


.





FIG. 30

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server determining a domestic route sequencing diagram


3000


, including message flows


2908


and


3002


-


3013


.





FIG. 31

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server checking availability of potential terminations sequencing diagram


3100


, including message flows


3008


and


3102


-


3103


.





FIG. 32

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server getting an originating route node sequencing diagram


3200


, including message flows


3009


and


3201


-


3207


.





FIGS. 33A and 33B

depict block diagrams of a call flow showing a route server calculating a domestic route for a voice call on a trunking gateway sequencing diagram


3300


, including message flows


3301


-


3312


and sequencing diagram


3320


, including message flows


3321


-


3345


, respectively.





FIG. 34

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch getting a call context from a route response from a route server sequencing diagram


3400


, including message flows


3401


-


3404


.





FIG. 35

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch processing an IAM message including sending an IAM to a terminating network sequencing diagram


3500


, including message flows


3501


-


3508


.





FIG. 36

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message including sending an ACM to an originating network sequencing diagram


3600


, including message flows


3601


-


3611


.





FIG. 37

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message including the setup of access servers sequencing diagram


3700


, including message flows


3701


-


3705


.





FIG. 38

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an example of how a soft switch can process an ACM message to send an RTP connection message to the originating access server sequencing diagram


3800


, including message flows


3801


-


3814


.





FIG. 39

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ANM message sending the ANM message to the originating SS7 GW sequencing diagram


3900


, including message flows


3901


-


3911


.





FIG. 46

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an exemplary calculation of a route termination sequencing diagram


4600


, including message flows


4601


-


4625


.





FIG. 47

depicts a block diagram of a soft switch getting call context from route response sequenced diagram


4700


, including message flows


4701


-


4704


.





FIG. 48

includes a soft switch processing an IAM sending the IAM to the terminating network sequencing diagram


4800


, including message flows


4801


-


4808


.





FIG. 40

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an REL message where the terminating end initiates call teardown sequencing diagram


4000


, including message flows


4001


-


4011


.





FIG. 41

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an REL message to tear down all nodes sequencing diagram


4100


, including message flows


4101


-


4107


.





FIG. 42

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an RLC message where the terminating end initiates teardown sequencing diagram


4200


, including message flows


4201


-


4211


.





FIG. 43

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch sending an unallocate message to route server for call teardown sequencing diagram


4300


, including message flows


4301


-


4305


.





FIG. 44

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch instructing a route server to unallocate route nodes sequencing diagram


4400


, including message flows


4305


,


4401


-


4410


.





FIG. 45

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing call teardown including deleting call context sequencing diagram


4500


, including message flows


4409


,


4502


and


4503


.




6. Voice Call originating on an SS7 trunk on a NAS and terminating via Access Server Signaling on an Access Gateway





FIG. 24C

depicts a voice call originating on an SS7 trunk on a NAS


228


and terminating via access server signaling on an AG


240


. The reader is directed to Table 179 above, which illustrates a voice over packet call flow having inbound SS7 signaling, outbound access server signaling, and soft switched managed RTP ports. The reader is also directed to Tables 177 and 178 which show TDM switching connections.





FIG. 24C

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2422


. Call path


2422


is initiated via SS7 signaling IAM messages from carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


through SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with NAS


228


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2424


from carrier facility


126


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


can require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide to soft switch


204


a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


124


to soft switch


204


.




In one embodiment, soft switch


204


determines from the dialed number in the IAM message, that the call is a voice or virtual point of presence (VPOP) call and in this scenario needs an access gateway to handle the voice call. Soft switch


204


sends an IPDC message to the NAS to TDM pass-through the call to the AG.




To determine the type of call, soft switch


204


can also perform further processing to determine, e.g., whether the call is to a destination known as a data modem termination dialed number. If the dialed number is not to a data number, then soft switch


204


determines that the call is a voice call.




Soft switch


204


can now determine whether an AG


238


has any circuits available for termination by querying port status


292


of route server


212


, and if so, can allocate the available port and set up a TDM bus connection


2426


in the NAS via TDM switching, and DS


0


circuit


2428


to AG


238


. Soft switch


204


can also query routing logic


294


of RS


212


to determine a least cost route termination.




Soft switch


204


, i.e., the originating soft switch, can then communicate with terminating soft switch


304


to set up the other half of the call.




Terminating soft switch


304


can then communicate with port status (PS)


298


of RS


314


to determine whether a port is available for termination and in which AG.




Having determined a free circuit is available on AG


240


, soft switch


304


can allocate a connection


2432


between AG


240


and customer facility


132


for termination to called party


124


.




Soft switch


304


can then communicate with soft switch


204


to establish connection


2436


, between AG


238


and AG


240


. Soft switch


304


can provide the IP address for AG


240


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


provides this address to AG


238


. AG


238


sets up a real-time transport protocol (RTP) connection


2436


with AG


240


to complete the call path.




7. Data Call originating on an SS7 trunk and terminating on a NAS





FIG. 24B

illustrates termination of a data call arriving on NAS


228


. The reader is also directed to Table 170 shown above, which depicts an inbound data call using SS7 signaling.





FIG. 24B

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2416


. Call path


2416


is originated via an SS7 signal from the carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


through SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with NAS, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2418


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer—trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


may require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in the signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


120


to soft switch


204


.




As part of the query performed on CS


206


, or based on a query to RS


212


, soft switch


204


can determine that the called party corresponds to a data modem, representing a data call.




Soft switch


204


can then communicate with network access server (NAS)


228


to determine whether a modem is available for termination in NAS


228


.




If soft switch


204


determines that a terminating modem is available, then soft switch


204


terminates the call to that modem.




a. Data Call on a NAS Sequence Diagrams of Component Intercommunication





FIG. 26C

depicts a more detailed diagram of message flow for an exemplary data call over a NAS, similar to FIG.


24


B.





FIGS. 27-32

and


49


-


53


depict detailed sequence diagrams demonstrating component intercommunication during a data call received and terminated on a NAS.

FIGS. 43-45

, and


54


-


57


.





FIG. 27

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch accepting a signaling message from an SS7 gateway sequencing diagram


2700


, including message flows


2701


-


2706


.





FIG. 28

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch getting a call context message from an IAM signaling message sequencing diagram


2800


, including message flows


2801


-


2806


.





FIG. 29A

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing an originating soft switch receiving and processing an IAM signaling message including sending a request to a route server sequencing diagram


2900


, including message flows


2901


-


2908


.





FIG. 29B

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch starting to process a route request sequencing diagram


2950


, including message flows


2908


, and


2952


-


2956


.





FIG. 30

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server determining a domestic route sequencing diagram


3000


, including message flows


2908


and


3002


-


3013


.





FIG. 31

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server checking availability of potential terminations sequencing diagram


3100


, including message flows


3008


and


3102


-


3103


.





FIG. 32

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a route server getting an originating route node sequencing diagram


3200


, including message flows


3009


and


3201


-


3207


.





FIG. 49

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing calculation of a domestic route including a modem pool route node sequencing diagram


4900


, including message flows


4901


-


4904


.





FIG. 50

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch getting call context from route response sequencing diagram


5000


, including message flows


5001


-


5004


.





FIG. 51

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an IAM message, connecting a data call sequencing diagram


5100


, including message flows


5101


-


5114


.





FIG. 52

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message, sending an ACM to originating LEC sequencing diagram


5200


, including message flows


5201


-


5210


.





FIG. 53

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ANM message, sending an ANM to the originating LEC sequencing diagram


5300


, including message flows


5301


-


5310


.





FIG. 43

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch sending an unallocate message to route server for call teardown sequencing diagram


4300


, including message flows


4301


-


4305


.





FIG. 44

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch instructing a route server to unallocate route nodes sequencing diagram


4400


, including message flows


4305


,


4401


-


4410


.





FIG. 45

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing call teardown including deleting call context sequencing diagram


4500


, including message flows


4409


,


4502


and


4503


.





FIG. 54

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an RCR message where teardown is initiated by the terminating modem sequencing diagram


5400


, including message flows


5401


-


5412


.





FIG. 55

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an RLC message sequencing diagram


4100


, including message flows


5501


-


5506


.





FIG. 56

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an ACM message sending the ACM to the originating network sequencing diagram


5600


, including message flows


5601


-


5611


.





FIG. 57

depicts a block diagram of a call flow showing a soft switch processing an IAM message setting up access servers sequencing diagram


5700


, including message flows


5701


-


5705


.




8. Data Call on NAS with Callback Authentication





FIG. 24D

illustrates termination of an alternate authentication data call arriving on NAS


228


incorporating call back. The reader is also directed to Table


172


shown above, which depicts an inbound data call using SS7 signaling with call-back, and to Table 174 which depicts an outbound data call flow via SS7 signaling.





FIG. 24D

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2438


. Call path


2438


is originated via an SS7 signal from the carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


through SS7 GW


208


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with NAS


228


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2440


for the purpose of authenticating calling party


102


.




Soft switch


204


can then perform a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


102


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


may require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in the signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


120


to soft switch


204


.




As part of the query performed on CS


206


, soft switch


204


can determine that the called party corresponds to a data modem, representing a data call, and that calling party


102


gains access to network resources via an outbound call-back following authentication.




Soft switch


204


can then request that authenticating information from calling party


102


be entered at NAS


228


. Upon verification of the authentication information, soft switch


204


can release the call and reoriginate an outbound callback from NAS


228


.




Soft switch


204


communicates with network access server (NAS)


228


to determine whether a modem is available for termination of a data call on NAS


228


.




If soft switch


204


determines that a terminating modem is available, then soft switch


204


can call calling party


102


via signaling through SS7 GW


208


to carrier facility


126


of calling party


102


, to set up connection


2442


between carrier facility


126


and NAS


228


. Soft switch


204


terminates the call to a modem in NAS


228


.




9. Voice Call originating on Access Server dedicated line on an Access Gateway and terminating on an Access Server dedicated line on an Access Gateway





FIG. 25A

depicts a voice call originating on an access server dedicated line (such as a DAL or an ISDN PRI) on an AG


238


and terminating via access server signaling on an AG


240


. The reader is directed to Table 180 above, which illustrates a voice over packet call flow having inbound access server signaling, outbound access server signaling, and soft switched managed RTP ports.





FIG. 25A

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2500


. Call path


2500


is originated via a call setup message, such as, for example through data D-channel signaling on an ISDN PRI line, from customer facility


128


of calling party


122


to AG


238


. AG


238


encapsulates call control messages, such as Q.931 messages, into IPDC messages that AG


238


sends to soft switch


204


over data network


112


. In-band MF DALs are handled similarly.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with AG


238


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2502


from carrier facility


128


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


122


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


can require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


124


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can then query RS


212


to perform further processing. Route logic


294


of RS


212


can be processed to determine least cost routing. The termination can be through data network


112


.




Soft switch


204


, i.e., the originating soft switch, can then communicate with terminating soft switch


304


to set up the other half of the call.




Terminating soft switch


304


can then communicate with port status (PS)


298


of RS


314


to determine whether a DS


0


circuit is available for termination and in which AG.




Having determined a free circuit is available on AG


240


, soft switch


304


can allocate a connection


2506


between AG


240


and customer facility


132


for termination to called party


124


.




AG


238


and AG


340


establish an RTP connection based on IP addresses provided by soft switches


204


and


304


. Soft switch


304


can then communicate with soft switch


204


to establish connection


25




10


, between AG


238


and AG


240


. Soft switch


304


provides the IP address for AG


240


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


provides this address to AG


238


. AG


238


can set up a real-time transport protocol RTP connection


2510


with AG


240


, to complete the call path.




10. Voice Call originating on Access Server signaled private line on an Access Gateway and terminating on SS7 signaled trunks on a Trunking Gateway





FIG. 25C

depicts a voice call originating on an access server dedicated line (such as a DAL or an ISDN PRI) on an AG


238


and terminating via SS7 signaling on a TG


234


.





FIG. 25C

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2522


. Call path


2522


is originated via a call setup message, such as, for example through data D-channel signaling on an ISDN PRI line, from customer facility


128


of calling party


122


to AG


238


. AG


238


encapsulates call control messages, such as Q.931 messages, into IPDC messages that AG


238


sends to soft switch


204


over data network


112


. In-band MF DALs are handled similarly.




Soft switch


2




04


can communicate with AG


238


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2524


from carrier facility


128


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


122


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


can require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


120


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can then query RS


212


to perform further processing. Route logic


294


of RS


212


can be processed to determine least cost routing. The termination can be through data network


112


.




Soft switch


204


, i.e., the originating soft switch, can then communicate with terminating soft switch


304


to set up the other half of the call.




Terminating soft switch


304


can then communicate with port status (PS)


298


of RS


314


to determine whether a DS


0


circuit is available for termination and in which TG.




Having determined a free circuit is available on TG


2340


, soft switch


304


can allocate a connection


2528


between TG


234


and customer facility


130


for termination to called party


120


.




Soft switch


304


can then communicate with soft switch


204


to have AG


238


establish connection


2532


, between AG


238


and TG


234


. Soft switch


304


can provide the IP address for TG


234


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


provides this address to AG


238


. AG


238


can set up a real-time transport protocol RTP connection


2532


with TG


234


, to complete the call path.




11. Data Call on an Access Gateway





FIG. 25B

depicts a data call originating on an access server dedicated line (such as a DAL or an ISDN PRI) on an AG


238


and terminating at a data modem in a NAS


228


. The reader is directed to Table 171 above, which illustrates an inbound data call flow via access server signaling.





FIG. 25B

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2512


. Call path


2512


is originated via an access server signaling message, such as, for example through data D-channel signaling on an ISDN PRI line, from customer facility


128


of calling party


122


to AG


238


and through signaling packets sent over data network


112


to soft switch


204


.




Soft switch


204


can communicate with AG


238


, via the IPDC protocol, to determine if an incoming DS


0


circuit (on a DS


1


port on a telephone PSTN interface) is free, and if so, to allocate that circuit to set up a connection


2514


from customer facility


128


.




Soft switch


204


then performs a query to CS


206


to access a customer trigger plan


290


of calling party


122


.




Depending on the contents of customer trigger plan


290


, soft switch


204


can require other call processing, such as, for example, an


800


call translation table lookup from SCP


214




a


based on information in signaling message.




SCP


214




a


can then provide a translated destination number, i.e. the number of called party


124


to soft switch


204


.




As part of the query performed on CS


206


or to RS


212


, soft switch


204


can determine that the called party corresponds to a data modem, representing a data call.




If the incoming call is determined to be a data call, then the incoming circuit


2514


is connected to TDM bus


2516


which is in turn connected to circuit


2518


which terminates the data call to a modem in NAS


228


.




Soft switch


204


can then communicate with network access server (NAS)


228


to determine whether a modem is available for termination in NAS


228


.




If soft switch


204


determines that a terminating modem is available, then soft switch


204


can terminate the call to the modem.




12. Outbound Data Call from a NAS via Access Server signaling from an Access Gateway





FIG. 25D

depicts an outbound data call originating from a data modem in NAS


228


via access server signaling from an Access Gateway on an access server dedicated line (such as a DAL or an ISDN PRI) between AG


238


and carrier facility


128


of calling party


122


. The reader is directed to Table 175 above, which illustrates an outbound data call flow via access server signaling.





FIG. 25D

depicts a block diagram of an exemplary call path


2534


. Call path


2534


is originated by soft switch


204


communicating with NAS


228


to determine whether a data modem is available.




If a data modem is available in NAS


228


, the call is terminated at one end to the modem.




Soft switch can then determine whether via communication with AG


238


, via IPDC protocol communication, whether a circuit is available for the outbound data call. If AG


238


has an available circuit, then soft switch


204


can use TDM bus


2540


to connect circuit


2542


to circuit


2538


(which is in turn terminated to a modem in NAS


228


).




TDM bus


2540


can then be connected to circuit


2542


, i.e., an access server signaled dedicated access line to carrier facility


128


, using, for example D-channel signaling of an ISDN PRI line. TDM pass-through switching is described further with respect to Tables 177 and 178, above.




13. Voice Services




Telecommunications voice network services supported by the present invention include, for example, origination and termination of intralata, interlata and international calls seamlessly between the PSTN and Telecommunications network


200


. Access can be achieved by switched or dedicated access lines. Call origination can be provided via Feature Group D (FGD) and direct access line (DAL) (T-


1


/PRI) access to access servers


254


,


256


. Local access can be provisioned via the PSTN with FGD and co-carrier termination to trunking gateways


232


,


234


. Dedicated DS


0


s, T-


1


s and T-


3


s can connect an end user's CPE directly to AGs


238


,


240


. In one embodiment, a standard unit of measurement for usage charges can be a rate per minute (RPM). Where telecommunications network


200


provides the DS


0


s, T-


1


s, and T-


3


s, there can be an additional monthly recurring charge (MRC) for access.




In one embodiment, ingress and egress can be via the PSTN. In another embodiment, native IP devices can originate and terminate calls over data network


112


over the IP protocol. In such an environment, flat rated calling plans are possible.




a. Private Voice Network (PVN) Services




Private voice network (PVN) services can be a customer-defined calling network that allows companies to communicate “on-net” at discounted prices. The backbone of the product can be dedicated access connectivity, such as, for example, using a DAL or ISDN PRI for access to telecommunications network


200


. Using a capability called dedicated termination service (DTS), calls that originate either by PIC or a dedicated access method can terminate on dedicated facilities when possible. For example, assume a customer with five locations across the country (e.g., in on-net cities) has T-


1


s deployed at each site. Calls between those five sites can be significantly discounted due to the fact that the carrier owning telecommunications network


200


originates and terminates the calls on dedicated facilities at little cost. Additionally, customers will be able to add others to their PVN, such as, for example, business partners, vendors, and customers, enabling the customer (as well as the others) to further reduce their communications costs.




In one embodiment, service can be provided to customers for a MRC, with no additional charge for on-net calls, and with a charge on a rate per minute basis for all other types of calls. In another embodiment, no MRC can be required, and all calls can be charged on a RPM basis. In another embodiment, the RPM may vary according to the type of call placed.




Network requirements can include use of dedicated termination service (DTS). DTS can allow long distance calls that originate from a FGD or DAL to terminate on a DAL. Traditionally, these calls are routed to POTS lines. This functionality can enable the network to determine if the call can be terminated over its own facilities and, if so, rate it appropriately. DTS is the backbone functionality of PVN. A routing table can allow the network to identify calls that originate from either an ANI or Trunk Group that has been assigned an associated terminating Trunk Group. In one embodiment,


700


,


800


, and


900


type calls can not originate over DALs.




Customer premises equipment (CPE) requirements can include a CSU/DSU with a router for Multiple Service T-


1


with dedicated access, and a customer can have an option to lease or buy them.




b. Long Distance or 1+ Services




Long distance(1+) service can allow a customer to place long distance calls to anywhere in the U.S., Canada, USVI, and Puerto Rico by dialing


1


plus an area code (NPA), plus a 7-digit phone number. International calls can be placed by dialing


011


plus a country code (CC), plus a city code, plus a number. Both switched and dedicated access can be available from on-net cities or from off-net cities (i.e., through a designated off-net carrier).




(1) Project Account Codes (PAC)




Project Access Codes (PACs) can be, for example, two to twelve digits. PACs, can be end user defined or predefined codes that are assigned to, for example, employees, projects, teams, and departments. PACs can be used, for example, by a customer to track such things as intralata, interlata, and international calls.




An example benefit to a customer of using PACs is that PACs can allow businesses to allocate and track costs of specific projects. Additionally, they can be used to track employee or department calls and expenditures. PACs can also be used to prevent unauthorized long distance calling. In one embodiment, an invoice can track account codes individually and can then group the codes in a hierarchical fashion as well.




Operationally, PACS can be entered by a calling party after dialing, e.g., a local, long distance, or international phone number. The calling party can hear a network-generated tone prompting the calling party to enter the PAC code. Once the PAC code has been entered and authorized, the call can be connected as usual.




All types of PACs can be translated on the invoice from code to text, i.e., PAC number “1234” could be translated to a “Marketing Department” and PAC number “4567” could be translated to “John Doe.” An example invoice could show call detail records (CDR) and total expenditures for each PAC.




If an invalid code is entered, a voice prompt can immediately respond with a message such as, for example, “Invalid code, please try again.” A second invalid entry can prompt the same message. A third can prompt another message, such as, e.g., “Goodbye.” PAC Translation would not occur in this instance.




If a user fails to enter any account code, the same prompting for receipt of an incorrect account code entry, can take place. A time out can occur after, for example, 3.5 seconds of no activity. PAC Translation would not occur in this instance.




Customers with PIC access can be required to wait for a tone before entering a PAC. Customers with dedicated access can complete the entire dialing sequence (phone number and PAC) without waiting for the tone and be connected without even hearing the tone. If, however, the customer (using dedicated access) pauses after dialing the phone number, the network can still generate a tone prompting the user for the PAC.




Business customers can have the ability to modify their PAC tables via a world wide web Internet interface. The modification functions can include, for example, additions, deletions, changes, and modifications of verbal translations. These changes can take effect within e.g., 60 minutes or less.




Customers that choose PAC Translation can have the translation, not the actual account code, presented on an invoice. Customers that do not use PAC Translation can have the account code presented on the invoice.




PAC tables can be associated to any type of resource (e.g., Master Account, ANI, Trunk Group, Location Account, and/or Authcode). Multiple PAC tables, in one embodiment, cannot be associated with a single resource.




(a) PAC Variations




Verified Forced PACs enable a customer to assign PACs to, e.g., employees, teams and departments, that force the end-user to enter the PAC prior to completing a long distance call.




Unverified Forced PACs can require that a PAC (of the chosen digit length, e.g., four digits) be entered to complete a call, however the digits are not pre-determined and the customer can have the ability to use all PACs in a given digit length. For example, with four-digit PACs, the customer could use any code from


0001


-


9999


.




Unverified Unforced PACs are the same as Unverified Forced PACs, but do not require a caller to enter the PAC to complete the long distance call. Unforced PACs can have, for example, a # override feature allowing calls to be connected quickly without relying on a network timeout to connect the call. If after, e.g., 3.5 seconds a PAC is not entered, the call can connect as usual. If a user enters a lower number of digits than the PAC table indicates, a prompt “Invalid code, please try again” can be announced. At this point, the pound override feature can be used or the user can try again. A second wrong entry can produce the same prompt and a third can prompt “Goodbye.” If a user enters more digits than has been setup on the PAC table, the first digits that comprise the correct PAC length can be used and the remaining digits ignored. Translation can occur (if activated) for the digits that correspond to the PAC table only. Billing presentation can also show the correct digit length.




Partially Verified Forced PACs can range from, for example, 4 to 12 digits. A portion of the PAC can be verified while the remaining portion is not; however, the entire digit stream can be forced. The customer can choose the digit length for user authentication as well as determine the digit length project accounting portion. A minimum of, e.g., 2 digits can be verified and can occur before the unverified portion of the digit stream. For example, a customer can choose a 5-digit PAC and the first two digits would authenticate the user and the remaining digits would be used for accounting purposes. Additionally, each portion of the PAC can have the option to be translated by the customer for invoice and web presentation, i.e., PAC “12345” could be translated to “12”=John Doe and “345” could translate to “Project X.”




Department summary by PAC group enables a customer to choose any given set of PACs associated with a single table and group them under a customer chosen heading. For example, the header “Marketing” can contain codes


123


,


234


and


456


, and the header “Customer Care” can contain codes


789


,


987


and


678


. The invoice can present summaries under each header.




(2) Class of Service Restrictions (COSR)




Class of Service Restrictions (COSR) can allow a customer to restrict outbound calling by certain jurisdictions. Restrictions can be set at, e.g., the account, ANI, Trunk Group, Authcode, or PAC level. The customer can be able to modify the COSR through, e.g., a web interface. Alternatively, some destinations, such as, e.g., international destinations, could not be modified by a customer directly and the customer could be required to contact customer care for approval.




Exemplary COSRs include, for example, interlata COSRs restricting calls to a customer's LATA only; intrastate calls restricting calls to the customer's originating state; interstate calls, allowing end-users to place domestic calls only anywhere in the U.S. whether local, intralata, intrastate, or interstate; domestic and dedicated international destinations allowing domestic calling as well as international calling to selected countries (based on country code) as determined by the customer; and domestic and selected international (i.e., can exclude high-risk countries) that allows callers to place all types of domestic and international calls.




Domestic and international can be the default, unless otherwise specified by the customer. A list of high risk countries can be unavailable unless otherwise requested by the customer. These high risk countries can have an increased probability of fraud and can require proper credit and sales approval.




In an example embodiment, PACs can be the first service restriction look-up followed by restrictions set up at the account level. High risk countries can always be blocked unless otherwise requested by the customer.




(3) Origination and Termination




A plurality of forms of access can be provided including, for example, primary interexchange carrier (PIC), dedicated (T-1/T-3/PRI), and 101-XXXX.




Customers pre-subscribed to the telecommunications carrier owning telecommunications network


200


can have PIC access to the network via FGD trunks from an LEC. This access method can allow for, e.g., intralata, intrastate, interstate, and international calling.




Dedicated customers can originate calls using local facilities such as T-1/T-3 on telecommunications network


200


.




101-XXXX customers with an established account and ANIs loaded into the billing system can access telecommunications network


200


. In this instance, customers do not have to have PIC access. If an end-user dials 101-XXXX without first establishing an account with the respective ANIs, calls can be blocked at the network level and the end-user can hear a recording explaining the call cannot be completed and to contact the operator for further assistance.




The order entry (OE) portion of the order management system (OSS) supports non-PICd ANIs. This system can load the ANIs into a soft switch, e.g., as subscribed “non-PICd” ANIs which allows calls to be placed via 101-XXXX. These ANIs can stay non-PICd until the customer has requested a change to the PIC. Regular system maintenance does not PIC these designated ANIs to telecommunications network


200


carrier and identifies these ANIs as Subscribed Non-PICd. Because 101-XXXX can only allowed for customers of telecommunications network


200


, LEC billing (CABS) will not be necessary for direct customers.




Casual calling can be allowed through resale and wholesale customers, if requested. The customer can be required to have its own CIC code to do so. Call treatment discrimination can be necessary for Resale and Wholesale customers in this instance. The network can identify the customer type by the CIC and allow or disallow casual access. In this instance, LEC billing arrangements can be necessary. CIC code billing can be available as an option for wholesale and resale customers.




(4) Call Rating




For domestic calls, example call ratings of 1-second increments with, for example, 18-second minimums per call, can be supported.




For international calls, example call ratings of 1-second increments with 1-minute minimums per call, can be supported.




Example times of day(TOD) and days of week(DOW), etc., can be rated differently. For example, 8 am-5 pm Monday through Friday can be rated differently than 5:01 pm—7:59 am Monday through Friday and all day Saturday and Sunday.




Term discounts can be provided for long-term service contract commitments.




(5) Multiple-Service T-


1






1+ toll-free, internet access, private line and dedicated access lines can be provisioned over the same multiple service T-


1


. Multiple service T-


1


can support two-way trunks.




(6) Monthly Recurring Charges (MRCs)




MRCs can be charged for any combination of enhanced or basic services either as a group or stand-alone.




(7) PVN Private Dialing Plan




PVN Private dialing plan services can also be offered on a customized basis.




(8) Three-Way Conferencing




A 3-way conferencing bridge can be created by the end-user by choosing the conferencing feature from the enhanced services menu. The end-user enters up to, e.g., two additional phone numbers and is then connected by a bridge.




(9) Network Hold with Message Delivery




A service which places the caller on hold while playing an announcement message can be offered as a service to customers.




c. 8XX Toll Free Services




Toll-free service can allow calling parties to dial an 8XX number and terminate the call to either a POTS line or DAL. The person or company receiving the call is responsible for the cost of the transaction.




Termination can be available to both on-net and off-net areas in the U.S. Off-net can be handled CB. Calls can originate anywhere in the U.S. plus, e.g., Canada, USVI, and Puerto Rico.




Real-time ANM network-based feature can pass the originating ANI to the customer answering the call. The number is viewed by the operator of the answering end using CPE. This can be used by call centers wishing to pull customer records based on the customer's phone number. This can be a DAL-only service. Default delivery can provide an entire ANI. Customers can add up to 2 delimiters.




Dialed Number Identification Service (DNIS) is a network-based feature that can provide the answering party with the toll-free (or customer delivered) number dialed. Customer-owned computer telephony equipment can provide the display. DNIS allows multiple toll-free numbers to be used on a single trunk group in a call-center setting because of its ability to display which number has been dialed enabling the calls to be handled uniquely. This can be a DAL-only service. Customers can order DNIS in a variety of numbering format schemes from, for example, 4-10 digits. DNIS can be the entire toll-free number. DNIS can be any portion of the toll-free number. DNIS can be any customer defined number from, for example, 4-10 digits. Default delivery can include the entire toll-free number. Customer can define the number with up to two delimiters.




(1) Enhanced Routing Features




Time of Day (TOD) routing routes toll-free calls to alternate, customer-defined destinations based on the time of day. Routing can be determined by the customer in one-minute increments. The time of day can be determined by the terminating location's time zone. A day can be equal to 12:00 am to 11:59 pm.




Day of Week (DOW) routing routes toll-free calls to alternate, customer-defined destinations based on the day of week. The time of day is determined by the terminating location's time zone. A day can be equal to 12:00 am to 11:59 pm.




Area Code ((NPA) routing routes toll-free calls to alternate, customer-defined destinations based on the area code the originating phone call came from.




NPA-NXX routing routes toll-free calls to alternate, customer-defined destinations based on the area code and prefix of the originating ANI.




Geographic routing routes toll-free calls to alternate, customer-defined destinations based on the state the originating phone call came from.




Multi-carrier routing routes pre-determined percentages of toll-free calls over a single toll-free number to alternate carriers defined by the customer. This is a function of the SMS database.




Percentage Allocation routing routes toll-free calls to alternate, customer-defined destinations based on call distribution percentages. Percentages can be defined down to the nearest 1%.




Day of Year (DOY) routing routes callsed based on days of the year that are determined by the customer.




Extension routing routes calls based on end-user DTMF input. These extensions are pre-defined by the customer and can range from 2 to 12 digits. A table can be built that associates a terminating point, e.g., an ANI or Trunk Group, with an extension. A network prompt such as, for example, a “bong tone,” can be used. A time out of, for example, 3.5 seconds can be used. An invalid entry prompt, such as “Invalid Code, Please Try Again,” can be used. A two “invalid entry” maximum and then a “Goodbye” and a network disconnect can be used. A no entry warning, such as “Invalid Code, Please Try Again,” can be used. A two “no entry” maximum and then a “Goodbye” and a network disconnect, can be used. An Invoice Presentation, including a summary of # calls, # minutes, taxes, and total cost, can be the standard when customer utilizes Extension Routing. An extension translation can be used such that each extension can be translated to text with a maximum character length of, for example,


35


.




Call blocking does not allow toll-free calls to originate from a state, an area code (including Canada, USVI, Puerto Rico), NPA NXX, and/or an ANI, as defined by the customer. Blocked calls by default can hear a network busy signal. In another embodiment, a call blocking announcement can be used. This is a customer option that enables blocked calls to hear either a network-generated or a custom, customer-defined prompt. The network prompt can read, “Your call cannot be completed from your calling area.” The customer can define its own prompt to last no more than, for example, 10 seconds. Additional charges can apply to this service.




Calls can also be blocked by time of day, day of week, and day of year.




Direct Termination Overflow (DTO) allows a customer to pre-define termination points for calls that exceed the capacity of the customer's network. Terminating points can include ANIs and/or Trunk Groups. Overflow traffic can be sent to any customer site whether or out of a serving area. The customer can assign up to five terminating points that can hunt in a sequence as defined by the customer.




Routing Feature Combination allows the customer to route calls based on any grouping of routing features listed above.




(2) Info-Digit Blocking




Info-Digit Blocking selectively blocks calls based on the info-digit that is passed through. Examples of info-digits that include 07, 27, 29 and 70 calls can be blocked at a customer's request. The default can permit calls to pass regardless of info-digit. Payphone Blocking can be an option to a customer. In one embodiment, calls that originate from payphones can be blocked. Payphone-originated calls that are not blocked can incur a per-call surcharge that can be marked up and passed to the customer.




(3) Toll-Free Number Portability (TFNP)




Toll-Free Number Portability (TFNP) allows customers to change RespOrg on their toll-free number and “port” the number to a different carrier. Toll-Free Reservation allows reservation of vanity or customer-requested toll-free numbers for later use. This is a function of the national SMS database.




(4) Multiple-Server T-


1






Toll-free, 1+, internet access, private line and dedicated access line services can be able to be provisioned over the same T-


1


. The service also supports two-way trunks.




(5) Call Rating




Different call rates can be charged to a customer based upon criteria such as, for example, the type of call placed, i.e., the type of origination and termination.




Time of day and day of week pricing can permit calls placed 8 am-5 pm, Monday through Friday and all day Saturday and Sunday.




Cross-contribution permits volume from other services to contribute to monthly commitment levels for toll-free and vice-versa.




A customer can commit to monthly revenue levels based upon volume thresholds. Rates can be set according to the thresholds.




Term discounts can permit customers committing to service contracts such as, for example, 1-, 2- and 3-year terms, to achieve higher discounts than those customers which are scheduled on monthly terms. Term discounts can effect net rates after all other discounts are applied.




Monthly recurring charges (MRCs) can be charged for any individual or combination of enhanced or basic services either as a group or stand-alone.




(6) Project Account Codes




Project Account Codes (PACs) (forced versions) can be available on toll-free service.




(7) Toll-Free Directory Listings




A directory listing in the toll-free information service provided by AT&T can be provided at a customer's request. This service may or may not require a one-time or monthly service charge.




(8) Menu Routing




Interactive voice response (IVR) routing services can be offered to customers over telecommunications network


200


.




(9) Network ACD




Automatic call distribution (ACD) services can be offered to customers over telecommunications network


200


.




(10) Network Transfer (TBX)




Network transfer services can be provided by telecommunications network


200


.




(11) Quota Routing




Quota Routing can allow the customer to define a minimum and maximum number of calls that are routed to a particular termination point. The call thresholds can be based on, e.g., 15 minute, half-hour, one hour, and 24-hour increments.




(12) Toll-Free Valet (Call Park)




Toll-free valet call parking services can hold calls in network queue until the customer has an open Trunk for the call to terminate to. This benefits a customer in that it does not have to over-trunk for busy periods. Music on-hold can be available as a standard feature of toll-free valet.




A custom greeting or announcement is an enhanced feature of Toll-Free Valet allowing callers to hear a customized greeting developed by the customer. Additional charges can apply for a custom greeting.




d. Operator Services




Operator Services are services which can handle a customer request for, for example, collect calls, third-party billed calls, directory assistance (DA), and person-to-person calls.




Operator Services can be available to any customer using, for example, 1+ long distance service, calling card service, and prepaid calling card service of the carrier of telecommunications network


200


.




An operator can be accessed by dialing “00” or 101-XXXX-0. Access to an operator can be accomplished through switched or dedicated access.





FIG. 6B

illustrates an operator services call


622


. A call coming in from LEC


624


or from IXC


626


into gateway site


110


has signaling come in through STP


250


through SS7 gateway


208


to soft switch


204


. Soft switch


204


is in communication with gateway site


110


via data network


112


using H.323 protocol or IPDC


602


protocol. H.323 is a gatekeeper protocol from the international telecommunications union (ITU) discussed further in the IPDC portion of the disclosure. Soft switch


204


can analyze the dialed number and determine that it is an operator call, i.e., if the call begins with a “0” or a “00,” upon determining that a call requires operator services, soft switch


204


can then route the call to off-switch operator services service bureau


628


. Operator services


628


can handle the call at that time. Operator services


628


can also perform whatever additional call routing is required in order to terminate the call.




(1) Domestic Operator Services Features




A plurality of operator services are supported, including, for example, collect calling service by this the caller requests that the called party be billed for the call; third party billing service allowing the caller to bill calls to another number other than the originating phone number; directory assistance (DA) service allowing customer to retrieve phone number outside of its area code by 1+ Area Code+555-1212 and making the requests through an operator; person to person calling service allowing a customer to contact an operator and request that the operator call a specific number and complete the call for the user (i.e. an operator connects the call by creating a bridge, ensuring a connection, and then bowing out of the connection); credit for call service by which, in instances where line quality is poor or a connection is lost, an operator can give an appropriate credit; branded service by which reseal and wholesale customer s can opt to use carrier-owned Operator Services and have the services branded to their preference; and service performance levels can be promised and enforced by which operators answer a call within a given number of rings such as, for example, four.




Non-Published Numbers service allows customers to keep their ANI(s) and toll-free numbers non-published.




Non-Listed Numbers allows a customer to have its ANI(s) and toll-free numbers non-listed.




Listed Number allows customers to list their ANI(s) and toll-free numbers.




Published Numbers allows customers to publish their ANI(s) and toll-free numbers.




Billed Number Screening allows a customer to establish who and who cannot charge calls to their phone number.




Charge Quotation Service permits an operator to quote the customer the cost of service being provided before the service is complete.




Line Status Verification service permits an operator to check the status of a line (idle, busy, off-hook) per customer request.




Busy Line Interrupt service permits an operator to interrupt the called party's call in progress and request an emergency connection with the calling party.




Telephone Relay Service (TRS) is a service provided for the hearing impaired. An operator assists the caller by typing the message and sends the message to the terminating party via TTD.




(2) International Operator Services




International operator services can be provided which provide similar features to domestic operator services with the addition of multiple language support. Internation operator services can be reached by dialing “00.”




e. Calling Card




Calling card service can include a credit card issued by a carrier that can allow a customer to place, for example, local, long distance, and international calls. The calling card can act as a stand-alone service or as part of the PVN product.




Calling card service can be available anywhere in the US, Puerto Rico, USVI, and Canada via toll free origination. Additionally, access can be from foreign countries via ITFS service through an off-net provider. A customer can have a domestic physical address and billing location to obtain a calling card.




Operationally, a customer can dial a toll-free access number, or and ITFS access number, that prompts the user to enter an authorization and pin number. The customer can then be prompted to enter a ten-digit phone number the customer is attempting to call. The call is then connected.




Calling cards can allow customers to make long distance, international, and local calls while away from their home or office. These calls are billed monthly on the same invoice with other telecommunications services.




(1) Calling Card Features




Calling card services can include a plurality of features such as, for example, universal toll-free access number (UAN); UAN authorization code; class of service (COS) restrictions; reorigination; usage cap; authorization code (authcode) translation; invoice presentation; project account codes (PACs); dial correction; 3-way conferencing; and dedicated termination service.




Universal Toll-Free Access Number (UAN) is the toll-free number that accesses the calling card platform from anywhere in the US, Puerto Rico, USVI, and Canada. The UAN serves all customers that choose the UAN.




UAN Authorization Code authenticates the end user. For UAN customers, the code consist, for example, of 10 digits followed by a PIN number, totaling 14 digits in length. The 10 digist can either be randomly generated or can be requested by the customer as the customers Billing Telephone Number (or any other phone or number sequence). The PIN can also either be randomly generated or can be requested by the customer. The default can be random generation for both Authcode and PIN numbers. No more than 10 PIN numbers can be assigned to a single Authcode. An additional 6-digit international PIN can be generated for customer use when originating calls from an international destination. This PIN can be entered in lieu of the 4-digit domestic PIN.




The customer can limit calling card use based on Class of Service Restrictions (COS) restrictions. Cards can as a default have domestic (all 50 states, Canada, USVI, PR) origination and termination only. International origination and termination can be made available upon request by the customer.




Re-Origination will allow customers to place multiple calling card calls without having to hang up, dial the access number, and enter the authorization code again. The feature can be initiated by depressing for 2 full seconds.




Usage Cap limits any given authcode to a customer determined usage limit. Once the maximum dollar limit is hit the card ceases working and prompts the customer to contact customer service. Usage limits can be set in $10 increments and at daily, weekly, or monthly thresholds. When a customer is approaching its maximum, a prompt can be announced stating “your usage limit is near its maximum, you have Xminutes remaining, please contact customer service.” The prompt can begin when the user reaches 90% of its allowance based on dollars. In the even the customer is in the middle of a connection, only the card owner will hear the prompt. If a new call is placed and the en-user is already within the 90% threshold, a prompt will notify the customer of the number of minutes that are available after the terminating number is entered. The number of minutes will be based on the termination point and the rating associated with it.




Authcode translation allows a customer to translate authorization codes to, for example, a user name or department name up to a 25 character maximum.




An invoice can by default show 10 digist of the 14 digits and associate each authcode with expenditures. If the customer chooses Authcode Translation, the invoice can automatically present the translation and not the authcode.




A customer can associate a PAC Table with the customer's Authcodes. PAC table rules apply. An end-user can be prompted as usual after entering in the authcode and terminating ANI. The prompts apply to PACs on calling card as an long distance service.




If a phone number is mis-dialed, dial correction allows the user to hit the * key to delete the current entry and being to re-enter the phone number in its entirety.




Personal Toll-Free Access Number (PAN) service provides a toll-free number that accesses the calling card platform from anywhere in the US, Puerto Rico, USVI, and Canada. A PAN can be unique to individual users.




PAN Authorization Code authenticates the end user. For PAN customers, the code can consist of, e.g., 4 digits either defined by the customer or randomly generated.




Corporate Toll-Free Access Number (CAN) service provides a toll-free number that accesses the calling card platform from anywhere in the US, Puerto Rico, USVI, and Canada. This number can be unique to a corporate customer and can only be used by those end-users with the corporate customer.




CAN Authorization Code authenticates the end user. For CAN customers, the code can consist of, e.g., 7 digits either defined by the customer or randomly generated.




Customized Greeting service allows a customer to customize the network-generated greeting at the time of provisioning. This service can be available to CAN customers only.




Call Transfer service allows the calling card customer to connect two parties and attend the conference or drop the bridge and establish the connection between the two called parties.




(2) Call Rating




Domestic Calls can be priced using, for example, 1-second increments with for example, an 18-second minimum per call.




International Calls can be priced using, for example, 1-second increments with, for example, a 1-minute minimum per call. The first minute can be rated differently than additional minutes.




PVN Gold and Platinum Calls can be rated based on discounts associated with the PVN product group. Rating can be based on originating and terminating points. On-PVN Calls can be identified and rated appropriately.




A connection surcharge can be charged per call. The charge can differ based on the originating and terminating point of the call. These combinations include Domestic to Domestic, Domestic to International, and International to International.




Time of Day and Day of Week pricing can permit calls placed 8 am-5 pm Monday through Friday to be rated differently than those placed 5:01 pm-7:59 am Monday through Friday and all day Saturday and Sunday.




Cross-Contribution permits volume from other services to contribute to volume discounts for calling card and vice versa.




A customer can commit to monthly revenue levels based upon Volume Thresholds. Rates can be set according to the thresholds.




Term Discounts can permit customers comitting to service contracts such as, for example,


1


,


2


, and 3-year terms, to achieve higher discounts than those customers who have subscribed on monthly terms. Term discounts can effect net rates after all other discounts are applied.




Monthly Recurring Charges (MRCs) can be charged for any combination of enhanced or basic services either as a group or stand-alone.




Pre-Paid Calling Card services can be offered.




f. One-Number Services




One Number service is an enhanced call forwarding service that uses the intelligence of telecommunications network


200


network to re-route calls from a customers POTS/DID to an alternate termination point. One Number allows customers to receive calls regardless of where they are located. A simple WEB interface enables customers to define which phone number they want to receive clals on and for which days and what periods of time.




One Number can be available to any customer telecommunications network


200


local and long distance voice services. The service allows the customer to choose termination points anywhere in the world. Security can be necessary to prevent fraud and authenticate users. Calls or faces can terminate to multiple services including, e.g., POTS lines, fax machines, voice mail, pagers, e-mail (fax), and cellular phones.




Forwarded calls can be filtered, e.g., by soft switch


204


and can be forwarded to the appropriate terminating number. Multiple termination points can be specified by the customer enabling calls to “follow” them.




When a call is forwarded to the next number a network prompt could inform the caller that their call is being forwarded. The caller could hear, e.g., “Please hold while we attempt to locate John Doe (Subscriber's Name). If you would like to leave a voice message please press the pound sign now.”




Selective Forward allows the customer to forward only selected calls by originating ANI. All other calls could terminate normally.




(1) One-Number Features




# Override service allows a caller to # out to the subscriber's main number which can have voice messaging capability.




Fax Detect allows the customer to have all calls including fax calls come in to a single number only to be forwarded to an actual fax machine ANI. The network could be required to detect T.30 protocol and respond appropriately.




Fax to E-mail allows faxes to be forwarded to an e-mail address.




Call Statistics allows a customer to enter a WEB interface and look at all calls that have terminated to their ANI and which have been forwarded to corresponding termination points.




Termination Preferences Lists allow a customer to define up to three terminating numbers. If the first is busy, for example, the call would be sent to the next number in the list. If the call reached the end of the list, the call could disconnect or terminate into whatever type of messaging service that might be available. These lists can be toggled on or off via a web or IVR interface. Up to 5 lists can be created.




Busy Detection re-routes busy calls to an alternate destination. In the case of fax, the web interface shows when and where the fax was delivered.




IVR Interface permits a customer to change termination points and toggle on or off Termination preference lists via DTMF tones. A customer could be prompted for a pass-code for security purposes.




Dedicated Termination Service (DTS) allows forwarded calls to terminate On-PVN over dedicated facilities.




User Authentication ensures that a user authorized routing modifications by, e.g., entry of a code or PIN.




g. Debit Card/Credit Card Call Services




Debit card and credit card calls are permitted and are similar to calling card services calls with the addition of third-party credit check processing.




Customers have access to a web interface that manages, e.g., names, phone numbers, e-mail addresses, company names, addresses, and scheduling. Customers can enter and maintain their own contacts. By selecting names and a meeting time, customers can easily administer their own conference from the desktop. Additionally, the moderator can view the participants that have and have not connected.




Participants can be notified of, e.g., the conference time, dial-in number (if applicable), subject, and participants by, e.g., e-mail, pager, fax, or voice message.




Network Dial-Out service allows the conference moderator to direct-dial each participant at the phone number of choice. When a participant answers the phone a bridge is created. The moderator is always bridged to the call by being dialed directly.




800 Dial-In allows the conference moderator, to offer a means for participants unable to be dialed directly to participate via a toll-free number.




Point & Talk service creates a bridge between two parties by simply clicking on a phone number.




Music On-Hold permits a selection of music to be available for the moderator to choose while participants join the bridge. Once all participants have joined, the music can automatically turn off.




Cancel Music On-Hold can disengage music on-hold.




Selective Caller Dis-Connect allows a moderator to disconnect any participant at any time.




Selective Caller Mute allows a moderator to mute any participant at any time. Other attendees could, e.g., not be able to hear the muted person, nor, e.g., could the muted person be able to hear other participants in the conference.




Customized Greeting permits customers to generate and load their own greeting that a caller will hear before being connected to the bridge.




Code Access permits a participant to hear a prompt asking for a code (determined by moderator) that could allow access to the conference. The code can be entered, e.g., via dual tone multiple frequencies (DTMF) tones.




h. Local




Local Voice can comprise two separate elements. The first element of Local Voice, which is also the foundation of the service, is commonly referred to as “Dial Tone”. The other element is referred to as Local Calling/Traffic, which is the usage that is generated on the Dial Tone. Each element is addressed separately below.




(1) Local Voice/Dial Tone (LV/DT)




Local Services deliver services comparable to what incumbent ILECs provide. LV/DT provides, in its basic form, 10 digits phone numbers and/or services that can access the Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN). LV/DT provides the customer the ability to place and receive calls on their LV/DT, whether the calls are local, long distance, international, toll-free or service (611, 411, 911, 0, 00) types of calls. Call types can be from an on network customer or from an off network caller.




Two types of digital/trunking protocols currently in use today are PBX Digital Trunking and ISDN/PRI. Analog services can be provided as well. Digital trunks interface with Hybrid and PBX CPE equipment.




LD/VT adheres to the tariffs and regulations that govern Local Service providers in each market that the service is launched. For example, federal, state and local taxes can apply where applicable.




Local access can be available in those cities where the owner of telecommunications network


200


has co-carrier status and a POP within the serving wire center.




The two prevalent protocols that LD/VT emulates are Digital PBX Trunking and ISDN/PRI. Only one Rate Center that is generic to the customers physical address is allowed with each delivery. Foreign Exchange service is another option but not in combination with a customer's designated Rate Center.




Digital PBX Trunking (Digital PBX) or (DPbx) trunking uses a DS-1 4-wire (1.544 Mbit) for the underlying transmission facility. Line Code options of AMI or B


8


ZS, and framing options of Super-Frame (SF) or Extended SuperFrame (ESF) can be offered. Service provides 24 digital channels at 56K per DSO. Fractional DS-1s can also be available with a minimum of 12 DSOs ordered. Each DSO channel carries the signaling overhead. DPbx can be channelized as one-way inbound, one-way outbound or two-way trunk groups. Incoming calls hunt to an idle channel within a trunk group, low to high, while the customer hunts high to low. Customer must yield to a carrier under “glare” conditions. Calls are initiated with trunk seizure and confirmed by a receiving end via “wink” signaling. Addressing can be selected as, e.g., Dual Tone Multi-Frequency (DTMF) or Multi-Frequency (typically used for interoffice communications). Answer Supervision is provided on outbound calls.




ISDN also can use a DS-1 4-wire transmission facility. Configurations of PRI can be 23B+D or 24B channels. Each B (bearer) channel transmission is at 64 kpbs “clear channel” since the signaling is handled on the “D” or data channel for the circuit. In order for a customer to order a


24


B circuit, they must have at a minimum one


23


B+D configuration. In a preferred embodiment, customers can have a back up D channel when ordering multiple PRIs with a


24


B configuration. Customers can also preferably order PRI with a line coding of B


8


ZS and framing of ESF. ANI delivery can be standard with PRI service.




When customers order either a DPBX or ISDN/PRI service, each inbound only or two-way trunk group can automatically be provisioned with one phone number. If more than one phone number is needed per trunk group, DID services can be ordered.




Direct Inward Dial (DID) service can be delivered to a customer's CPE equipment via inbound only or two-way trunks. The switch can deliver the dialed telephone number (up to 7 digits), sometimes referred to as DNIS, to the premise switch. Number blocks are ordered in blocks of 20 consecutive numbers i.e. 555-1230 thru 555-1249.




(2) Call Handling Features




(a) Line Hunting




There are several different forms of line hunting. There is no additional charge, regardless of which hunting method is utilized. The form a customer selects will depend on their business application.




Series completion hunting allows calls made to a busy directory number to be routed to another specified directory number. Series completion hunting begins with the originally dialed member of the series completion group, and searches sequential for an idle directory number from the list of directory numbers. A telephone number is assigned to each member of the series completion hunt. When hunting reaches the last number in the group without finding an idle station, a busy signal can occur.




Multi-line hunting provides a sequential hunt over the members in the multi-line hunt group. A phone number is assigned to the main number, but each line in the hunt group can have a phone number or a “Ter” (Terminal) identifier assigned to it.




Circular hunting allows all lines in a multi-line hunt group to be tested for busy, regardless of the point of entry into the group. When a call is made to a line in a multi-line hunt group, a regular hunt is performed starting at the station associated with the dialed number. The hunt continues to the last station in the group, then proceeds to the first station in the group and continues sequentially through the remaining lines in the group. Busy tone can be returned if hunting returns to the called station without finding an alternative station that is idle. Usually in this situation, all members of the multi-line hunt group can be identified with a phone number.




Uniform Call Distribution (UCD) hunting, an enhanced form, has specific uses for customers. (UCD is not to be confused with Automatic Call Distribution (ACD), which is an enhanced version of UCD.) The UCD feature is a hunting arrangement that provides uniform distribution of terminated calls to members of a multi-line hunt group. UCD does a pre-hunt for the next call, searches for the next idle member and can set the member as the start hunt position for the next call. If no idle member is found, the start hunt position can be the last called member plus 1.




(b) Call Forward Busy




Call Forwarding Busy Line can automatically redirect incoming calls to a pre-designated telephone number when the line is busy. This service can establish a fixed forward-to telephone number. In one embodiment, it is not a customer changeable number. An order is issued by a carrier to change the forward-to number. When Call Forward Busy line is activated, the customer can pay for the local and/or toll usage charges. This feature can carry a flat monthly rate.




(c) Call Forwarding Don't Answer




Call Forwarding Don't Answer can automatically redirect all calls to another telephone number when a telephone is not answered within a specified amount of time. This service can establish a fixed forward-to telephone number. In one embodiment, it is not a customer changeable number. An order can be issued to change the forward-to number. The customer can choose the number of rings before the line forwards the call. When Call Forwarding Don't Answer is activated, the customer can pay for the local and/or toll usage charges. This feature can carry a flat monthly rate.




(d) Call Forward Variable




Call Forwarding Variable allows the user to redirect all incoming calls to another telephone number. This service can use a courtesy call that allows the customer to notify a party at the “forward-to-number” that the customer's calls will be forwarded to the second party's number. Activating the service also returns a confirmation tone to the originator. Call Forwarding Variable can take precedence over other features and services such as Call Forwarding Busy/Don't Answer, Call Waiting and Hunting. When this feature is activated, the customer can pay for any local and/or toll usage charges. This feature can carry a flat monthly rate.




(e) Call Hold




Call Hold can enable a user to put any in-progress call on hold by flashing the switchhook and dialing a code. This frees the line to originate another call. Only one call per line can be held at a time. The held call cannot be added to the originated call. This feature is not to be confused with the hold button on a telephone set. The party placed on hold will not hear anything (unless customer subscribes to Music-On Hold service). This feature carries a flat monthly rate.




(f) Three-Way Calling




Three-way Calling service can allow a line in the talking state to add a third party to the call without operator assistance. To add a third party, the user flashes the switchhook once to place the first party on hold, receives recall dial tone, dials the second party's telephone number, then flashes the switchhook again to establish the three-way connection. The second switchhook flash can occur any time after the completion of dialing, i.e., when the second party answers, a two-way conversation can be held before adding the original party for a three-way conference.




(g) Call Transfer




Call Transfer can conference and transfer an established inbound call to another number. When this feature is used to transfer a call to a local or toll number, the customer initiating the feature can pay for the resulting call charges. Call Transfer can be used in conjunction with Three-way calling.




(h) Call Waiting/Cancel Call Waiting




Call Waiting Terminating service can alert the user to an incoming call while the phone is already in use. The service signals the customer with two separate tones or tone patterns. The calling party can hear ringing or a tone/ring combination. Call Waiting Terminating can take precedence over Call Forwarding Busy Line. Call Waiting Terminating service can be canceled on a per call basis. This can be done by entering a code prior to placing a call or during a call.




Call Waiting Originating service can allow a customer to send, to another line within a group, a Call Waiting tone if the other line is busy.




(i) Extension or Station-to-Station Calling




Station-to-Station (or “abbreviated”) dialing can allow one station line to call another staation line without having to go through the public network. Calls of this nature are usually classified as an intercom call. Intercom calls do not carry any type of local or toll charges because they occur within a common group of numbers. A station-to-station call can be dialed by using 2-6 digits. An example would be placing a call to an internal station having the phone number 667-2345. If the dialing sequence is set at 4 digits, the call could be completed simply by dialing 2-3-4-5. If the common group is set for 3-digit station-to-station dialing, all other station lines can also then set to 3-digit dialing.




(j) Direct Connect Hotline/Ring Down Line




Direct Connect service automatically dials a pre-selected number. Simply taking the receiver off-hook can activate this service. No access codes or telephone numbers need to be dialed. The Direct Connect number can be selected when service is ordered and can be changed by placement of an order, such as, for example, via a web interface. The Direct Connect number can be, e.g., an internal line number, a local number or a long distance number. If the call is sent to another local or long distance number, the customer can pay for the usage charges.




(k) Message Waiting Indicator




Message Waiting Indication can come in two forms and is used primarily with Voice Mail. A first form of this feature can provide the station line user with an audible indication that Voice Mail has been activated. The stutter tone can be heard when the user goes off-hook, alerting the user that a message has been left in the voice mailbox. When the message has been retrieved, the stutter tone can disappear.




A second form of message waiting indication can be a visual prompt. The visual prompt can operate the same way as the stutter dial tone except that it can use a signal to light a lamp on the customer's phone.




(l) Distinctive Ringing




This feature can enable a user to determine the source of an incoming call from a distinctive ring. The pattern can be based on whether the call (1) originates from within a group, (2) originates external to the group, (3) is forwarded from the attendant position, or (4) originates from a line with a Call Waiting Originating feature.




Distinctive Ringing can comprise two call processing components: Party Filtering and Calling Party Filtering. The distinctive ringing components can provide for distinctive ringing patterns to be applied to a terminating line based on the originating line. Each component can have a list of multiple options that can be chosen from to customize the distinctive ringing. When Distinctive Ringing is assigned to a line, it can be immediately active. The station user cannot deactivate the feature in one embodiment. An order can be placed to have Distinctive Ringing deactivated.




(m) Six-Way Conference Calling




Six-way conference calling can allow a non-attendant station to sequentially call up to five (5) other parties after dialing the access code. The non-attendant station can add parties together to make an, e.g., six-way call. The originator of the six-way call can be billed for the usage charges. There are no limitations on the number of stations that can be assigned a Six-way Conference calling group.




(n) Speed Calling




Speed calling can allow a user to dial selected numbers using fewer digits than are normally required. One- and two-digit abbreviated dialing codes can be offered. Speed calling can be, e.g., available as an eight-number list (Speed Calling


8


), and a thirty-number list (Speed Calling


30


). Speed Calling


8


can use codes


2


through


9


. Speed Calling


30


can use codes


20


through


49


. Customers can order both options on one station line for a total of 38 speed calling codes. Any combination of local and long distance numbers, service access codes and 3-digit numbers (such a 9-1-1) can be entered into the Speed Calling list. The number of digits stored within each code can be limited to, e.g., 16.




(o) Selective Call Rejection




Call Rejection can allow a customer to pre-select up to a set number of phone numbers to reject any incoming calls from those numbers. If the number is not known, this feature can also be activated via a code after the call has been completed. A code can be entered to cancel Call Rejection at any time.




(p) Remote Activation of Call Forward Variable




This feature can enable a customer to activate or deactivate Call Forwarding Variable from a remote site. To activate or deactivate the feature from a remote site, a Touch Tone service and a Pin Code can be used, for example. The Pin Code can be required for security reasons.




(3) Enhanced Services




(a) Remote Call Forward (RCF)




Remote Call Forward (RCF) service can allow a business to establish a local presence in other areas without having to invest in a hardwired solution. RCF can create a virtual inbound only service, e.g., via software programming. A customer can make a request from the local service provider for a phone number that can be with a rate center that is not associated with the address to where the calls are to terminate. The RCF can be provisioned to forward all incoming calls to a customer specific phone number. This can in one embodiment, be a non-customer changeable number except via an order. Depending upon the locality of the service, the forwarding of calls can generate a local call, a local toll call or a long distance call, which can be invoiced to the RCF customer. Calls can be forwarded to a toll free service and in one embodiment do not carry a per call charge. RCF can carry a flat MRC.




When a customer requests multiple calls to be terminated at one time, RCF paths can be ordered. Depending upon the number of paths ordered, the number of calls that can be terminated simultaneously can be determined. Each path can carry a flat MRC.




(b) Voice Messaging Services




Voice Messaging services can provide a customer the control of determining how communications are to be handled at their business. Voice messaging combined with local service can create a total business solution. Voice messaging can provide the customer with flexibility and total call coverage.




The foundation of voice messaging can be the voice mailbox, which can provide for the repository of messages. These messages can be, for example, voice or fax. The voice mailbox can be configured according to the customer's needs with various levels or grades of service. Retrieval of messages can be performed through various methods that can range, e.g., from a local, to a remote and toll free access.




Voice messaging components take a basic voice mailbox and enhances it. Enhancements can include such features as, for example: broadcast services; one number location services; pseudo auto attendant; dial out capabilities; revert to operator; fax on demand; and informational services.




Voice messaging services can be broken down into three categories. The categories of voice messaging services can include, integrated voice messaging, stand-alone voice messaging, and enhanced voice messaging.




(c) Integrated Voice Messaging




Integrated voice messaging can tie the customer's phone number with the voice messaging platform. The customer's caller needs to dial only one number in order to contact the customer. The integration can be accomplished via call handling features to the voice-messaging platform such as call forwarding busy, call forwarding no answer, call forwarding variable and message waiting indication. Basic applications for this type of service can include private/individual lines and multi-lines and multi-line hunt arrangements that can require call coverage. By using an integrated version of voice messaging, the customer can also receive a “revert to operator” feature as part of the package.




This type of service can be application specific. A customer gives out only one number to its customers for them to reach it.If a customer does not what to answer the phone, when a call is transferred, it can still ring according to parameters set up by the call handling features, in one embodiment.




(d) Stand-alone Voice Messaging




Stand-alone voice messaging can provide customers with individual voice mailboxes. These mailboxes can be set up with their own phone numbers and need not be tied to a customer's phone number. Therefore, in one embodiment, they do not have “revert to operator” services and message waiting indication. These mailboxes can be useful to, e.g., a sales organization which has employees which do not have an office with phone services.




Depending upon the application, a pseudo-integration type of service can be set up. By using call-handling features, calls can be forwarded to the phone number assigned to a voice mailbox.




(4) Class Services




A name and number display can be provided.




An automatic call back/ring again service can allow automatic return of the last incoming call (i.e., whether answered or missed). If the number called back is busy, automatic call back service can alert the user with a special ring when the user's line and the line the user is calling back are both idle. This feature can be assigned on an individual line basis. The ringback alerting interval can be varied from, e.g., 24 to 48 seconds, inclusive in, e.g., 6-second increments. Automatic callback service can be activated before receiving another incoming call. Outgoing calls can be placed before activating automatic callback on the last incoming call. This service can work well with call waiting.




(5) Class of Service Restrictions




A local only COS restriction restricts all calls to locally terminated ones.




(6) Local Voice/Local Calling (LV/LC)




This second segment of Local voice is referred to as local calling. Local calling is the traffic that is within a LATA but does not constitute a long distance call. Depending upon the market that the service is being provided in, local calling can be a for fee or free service.




i. Conferencing Services




(1) Audio Conferencing




A 3-way conferencing bridge can be created by the end-user by choosing the conferencing feature from the enhanced services menu. The end-user enters up to, e.g., two additional phone numbers and is then connected by the bridge.




Dedicated Termination Service (DTS) allows long distance calls from the calling card to terminate to a Dedicated PVN site if applicable. Non-PVN calls could terminate regularly over FGD trunks. The network can determine if the call can be terminated over its own facilities and if so, rate it appropriately. DTS calls can be priced less than calls that terminate over FGD. A routing table allows the network to identify calls that originate from a calling card that has been assigned an associated terminating Trunk Group.




(a) Audio conferencing features




Audio conferencing can allow a customer to setup a call with two or more participants. The customer, through an easy to use web interface, can create a conferencing bridge.




This service can be available to all customers who sign up for the service. Because the call is being setup through a web interface, conferences can be setup anywhere access to the Internet is available.




(2) Video Conferencing




Video conferencing can be provided over telecommunications network


200


.




14. Data Services




a. Internet Hosting




Internet hosting services can be provided over the network of the claimed invention. An Internet Services Provider (ISP) can use server and communications services including Internet access from the telecommunications network and can be billed for the usage. High speed connectivity can be provided as well as World Wide Web, File Transfer Protocol (FTP), Gopher and other Internet hosting services.




b. Managed Modem Services




Managed modem service is a service provided to users of communications services, such as an ISP. Managed modem services provide modem services to subscribers of the ISP. As an ISP signs up new subscribers, access can be provided to the subscriber over modems provided by a networking services provider (NSP). Modems can be shared by a plurality of ISPs and economies of scale can be obtained by requiring a lower overall number of modems and associated communications network hardware. Other dialing services can be made available over the data network of the invention.




c. Collocation Services




Network services can be provided co-located with a customer. For example, the telecommunications network carrier can provide TG, AG, and NAS access at the customer premises for such purposes as high speed modem access. By placing telecommunications network components on site at a customer location, various advantages can be gained by the telecommunications provider and subscriber.




d. IP network Services




Other Internet access services can be made available for a client, such as intranet and PVN services.




e. Legacy Protocol Services—Systems Network Architecture (SNA)




Access to IBM Systems Network Architecture (SNA) services can be made available over data network


112


of the invention.




f. Permanent Virtual Circuits




Permanent Virtual Circuit services can be supported. For example, separate SNA PVCs can be provided.




15. Additional Products and Services




Telecommunications network


200


can be used to deliver a plurality of new product and service offerings. For example, new services include, services can be configured via Internet worldwide web connection to telecommunications network


200


. Additional service offerings include that billing options can be announced at the beginning of a call. Another new service enables the announcement of the cost of a call to be read at the conclusion of a telephone call. Telecommunications network


200


also supports connectivity of native IP devices, such as, for example, a SELSIUS phone. Additional new products and services include integration of native IP and unified PBX/file server devices into telecommunications network


200


. See for example customer net


658


shown in FIG.


6


D. Attached to network


658


are a variety or native IP devices


662


. For example, IP Client


660


can be a personal computer capable of VOIP telephony communication, including voice digitizing, network interface card and transmission hardware and software. PBX/File Server


664


is a native IP device with hybrid data/voice functionality, such as, for example, PBX


666


functionality with optionally collocated access gateway (AG)


670


functionality for telephony access by phones


672


, and data services functionality such as, for example, file server


668


functionality. Another new service enables messaging joined with find-me type services.




In addition to the new services just described enabled by telecommunications network


200


, it should be noted that telephone calls over telecommunications network


200


deliver call quality which is better than the standard PSTN. Telecommunications network


200


also permits read reporting of call statistics and call volumes and billing information to commercial clients, for example. Telecommunications network


200


also permits dynamic modification over the route traversed by traffic via worldwide web access.




IV. Definitions
















Term




Defintition











access tandem (AT)




An AT is a class 3 or 3/4 switch used to switch calls between EOs in a LATA.







An AT provides subscribers access to the IXCs, to provide long distance calling







services. An access tandem is a network node. Other network nodes include,







for example, a CLEC, or other enhanced service provider (ESP), and international







gateway or global point-of-presence (GPOP), or an intelligent peripheral (IP).






American National Standards Institute




This organization develops and publishes voluntary standards for a wide range






(ANSI)




of industries for companies based in the U.S.






Asynchronous Transfer Mode




Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) is a high speed cell-based packet switching






(ATM)




transmission technology.






Automatic Call Distributor




A specialized phone system that can handle volumes of incoming calls or make






(ACD)




outgoing calls. An ACD can recognize and answer an incoming call, look in its







database for instructions on what to do with that call, send a recorded message to the caller







(based on instructions from the database), and send the caller to a live operator as soon







as the operator is free or as soon as the caller has heard the recorded message.






bearer (B) channels




Bearer (B) channels are digital channels used to carry both digital voice and digital







data information. An ISDN bearer channel is 64,000 bits per second, which can carry







PCM-digitized voice or data.






Bellcore




Bell Communications Research, formed at divestiture to provide centralized services to







the seven regional Bell holding companies and their operating company subsidiaries.







Also serves as a coordinating point for national security and emergency preparedness







and communications matters of the U.S. federal govemment.






called party




The called party is the caller receiving a call sent over a network at the destination or







termination end.






calling party




The calling party, is the caller placing a call over any kind of network from the







origination end.






central office (CO)




A CO is a facility that houses an EO homed. EOs are often called COs.






centum call seconds




Telephone call traffic is measured in terms of centum call seconds (CCS)






(CCS)




(i.e., one hundred call seconds of telephone conversations).







{fraction (1/36)} of an Erlang.






class 5 switch




A class 5 switching office is an end office (EO) or the lowest level of local and long distance







switching, a local central office. The switch closest to the end subscriber.






class 4 switch




A class 4 switching office was a Toll Center (TC) if operators were present or else a







Toll Point (TP); an access tandem (AT) has class 4 functionality.






class 3 switch




A class 3 switching office was a Primary Center (PC); an access tandem (AT) has class







3 functionality.






class 1 switch




A class 1 switching office, the Regional Center (RC), is the highest level of local and long







distance switching, or “office of last resort” to complete a call.






CODEC




Coder/Decoder. Compression/decompression. An overall term used for the technology used in







digital video and digital audio.






competitive LEC




CLECs are telecommunications services providers capable of providing local services that






(CLEC)




compete with ILECS. A CLEC may or may not handle IXC services as well.






Computer Telephony




Adding computer intelligence to the making, receiving, and managing of telephone calls.






(CT) or






Computer Telephony Integration






(CTI)






customer premises equipment




CPE refers to devices residing on the premises of a customer and used to connect to a






(CPE)




telephone network, including ordinary telephones, key telephone systems, PBXs, video







conferencing devices and modems.






DHCP




Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol






digital access and cross-connect system




A DACS is a device providing digital routing and switching functions for T1 lines,






(DACS)




as well as DS0 portions of lines, for a multiple of T1 ports.






digitized data




Digitized data refers to analog data that has been sampled into a binary representation






(or digital data)




(i.e., comprising sequences of 0's and 1's). Digitized data is less susceptible to noise and







attenuation distortions because it is more easily regenerated to reconstruct the original signal






DTMF




Dual Tone Multi Frequency






Dual-Tone Multifrequency




A way of signaling consisting of a push-button or touchtone dial that sends out a sound






(DTMF)




consisting of two discrete tones that are picked up and interpreted by







telephone switches (either PBXs or central offices).






egress EO




The egress EO is the node or destination EO with a direct connection to the called







party, the termination point. The called party is “homed” to the egress EO.






egress




Egress refers to the connection from a called party or termination at the destination end of a







network, to the serving wire center (SWC).






end office (EO)




An EO is a class 5 switch used to switch local calls within a LATA. Subscribers of the LEC







are connected (“homed”) to EOs, meaning that EOs are the last switches to which the







subscribers are connected.






Enhanced Service Provider




A network services provider.






(ESP)






equal access




1+ dialing as used in U.S. domestic calling for access to any long distance carrier as required







under the terms of the modified final judgment (MFJ) requiring divestiture of the







Regional Bell Operating Companies (RBOCs) from their parent company, AT&T.






Erlang




An Erlang (named after a queuing theory engineer) is one hour of calling traffic,







i.e. it is equal to 36 CCS (i.e., the product of 60 minutes per hour and 60 seconds







per minute divided by 100). An Erlang is used to forecast trunking and TDM switching







matrix capacity.







A “non-blocking” matrix (i.e., the same number of lines and trunks) can theoretically switch 36







CCS of traffic.







Numerically, traffic on a trunk group, when measured in Erlangs, is equal to the average number







of trunks in use during the hour in question. Thus, if a group of trunks carries 20.25 Erlangs







during an hour, a little more than 20 trunks were busy.






Federal Communications Commission




The U.S. federal agency responsible for regulating interstate and international






(FCC)




communications by radio, television, wire, satellite, and cable.






G.711




ITU-T Recommendation G.711 (1988) - Pulse code modulation (PCM) of voice frequencies






G.723.1




ITU-T Recommendation G.723.1 (03/96) - Dual rate speech coder for multimedia







communications transmitting at 5.3 and 6.3 kbit/s






G.729




Coding of speech at 8 kbit/s using conjugate structure algebraic-code-excited linear-prediction







(CS-ACELP) - Annex A: Reduced complexity 8 kbit/s CS-ACELP speech codec






G.729A




ITU-T Annex A (11/96) to Recommendation






Gateway




An entrance into and out of a communications network.







Technically, a gateway is an electronic repeater device







that intercepts and steers electrical signals from one network to another.






global point of presence




A GPOP refers to the location where international telecommunications facilities and






(GPOP)




domestic facilities interface, an international gateway POP.






GSM




Global System for Mobile Conimunications






H.245




ITU-T Recommendation H.245 (03/96) - Control protocol for multimedia communication






H.261




ITU-T Recommendation H.261 (03/93) - Video codec for audiovisual services at p x 64 kbit/s






H.263




ITU-T Recommendation H.263 (03/96) - Video coding for low bit rate communication






H.323




ITU-T Recommendation H.323 (11/96) - Visual telephone systems and equipment for local area







networks which provide a non-guaranteed quality of service. The specification that







defines packet standards for terminals, equipment, and services for multimedia







communications over LANs. Adopted by the IP telephony community as standard for







communicating over any packet network, including the Internet.






IETF




Internet Engineering Task Force






incumbent LEC




ILECs are the traditional LECs, which include the Regional Bell Operating Companies






(ILEC)




(RBOCs).






ingress EO




The ingress EO is the node or serving wire center (SVC) with a direct connection to the







calling party, the origination point. The calling party is “homed” to the ingress EO.






ingress




Ingress refers to the connection from a calling party or origination.






integrated services digital network




ISDN is a network that provides a standard for communications (voice, data and signaling),






(ISDN)




end-to-end digital transmission circuits, out-of-band signaling, and







a features significant amount of bandwidth. A network designed to improve the world's







telecommunications services by providing an internationally accepted standard for voice,







data, and signaling; by making all transmission circuits end-to-end digital; by adopting a







standard out-of-band signaling system; and by bringing more bandwidth to the desktop.






integrated service digital network




An ISDN Basic Rate Interface (BRI) line provides 2






(ISDN)




bearer B channels and 1 data D line (known as “2B + D” over one or two pairs) to a subscriber.






basic rate interface






(BRI) line






intelligent peripheral




An intelligent peripheral is a network system (e.g. a general purpose computer running






(IP)




application logic) in the Advanced Intelligent Network Release 1 (AIN) architecture.







It contains a resource control execution environment (RCEE) functional group that enables







flexible information interactions between a user and a network. An intelligent peripheral







provides resource management of devices such as voice response units, voice announcers,







and dual tone multiple frequency (DTMF) sensors for caller-activated services. The







intelligent peripheral is accessed by the service control point (SCP) when services demand







its interaction.







Intelligent peripherals provide an intelligent network with the functionality to allow







customers to define their network needs themselves, without the use of telephone







company personnel. An intelligent peripheral can provide a routing decision that it







can terminate, but perhaps cannot regenerate.






inter machine trunk




An inter-machine trunk (IMT) is a circuit between two commonly-connected switches.






(IMT)






inter-exchange carrier




IXCs are providers of U.S. domestic long distance telecommunications services.






(IXC)




AT&T, Sprint and MCI are example IXCs.






International Multimedia




A non-profit organization dedicated to developing and promoting standards for audiographics






Teleconferencing Consortium




and video conferencing.






(IMTC)






International




An organization established by the United Nations to set telecommunications standards,






Telecommunications Union




allocate frequencies to various uses, and hold trade shows every four years.






(ITU)






internet protocol (IP)




IP is part of thc TCP/IP protocols. It is used to recognize incoming messages, route outgoing







messages, and keep track of Internet node addresses (using a number to specify a TCP/IP host







on the Internet). IP corresponds to network layer of OSI. A unique, 32-bit number for a







specific TCP/IP host on the Internet, normally printed in decimal form







(for example, 128.122.40.227). Part of the TCP/IP family of protocols, it describes software







that takes the Internet address of nodes, routes outgoing messages, and







recognizes incoming messages.






Internet service provider




An ISP is a company that provides Internet access to subscribers. A vendor who provides






(ISP)




direct access to the Internet, the worldwide network of networks.






Internet Engineering Task Force




One of two technical working bodies of the Internet Activities Board.






(IETF)




It meets three times a year to set the technical standards that run the Internet.






Internet Fax Routing Forum




Has published a specification letting companies interconnect their Internet fax servers






(IFRF)




to let service providers deliver fax traffic from other companies.






IP




See Internet Protocol or Intelligent Peripheral






IP Telephony




Technology that lets you make voice phone calls over the Internet or other packet networks







using your PC, via gateways and standard telephones.






IPv6




Internet Protocol - version 6






IPX




Internet Package eXchange






ISDN




An ISDN Primary Rate Interface (PRI) line provides the ISDN equivalent of a T1 circuit.






primary rate interface




The PRI delivered to a customer's premises can provide 23B + D (in North America)






(PRI)




or 30B + D (in Europe) channels running at 1.544 megabits per second and







2.048 megabits per second, respectively.






ISO Ethernet




An extension of the Ethernet LAN standard proposed by IBM and National Semiconductor.







Has the potential to carry both live voice or video calls together with LAN







packet data on the same cable.






ISP




See Internet Service Provider






ITU




See International Telecommunication Union






local exchange carrier




LECs are providers of local telecommunications services. Can include subclasses






(LEC)




including, for example, incumbent LECs (e.g. RBOCs), independent LECs (e.g. GTE),







competitive LECs (e.g. Level 3 Commnunications, Inc.).






local access and transport area




A LATA is a region in which a LEC offers services.






(LATA)




There are 161 LATAs of these local geographical areas within the United States.






local area network




A LAN is a communications network providing connections between computers and peripheral






(LAN)




devices (e.g., printers and modems) over a relatively short distance (e.g., within a building)







under standardized control.






Local Exchange Carrier




A company that provides local telephone service.






(LEC)






modified final judgment




Modified final judgment (MFJ) was the decision requiring divestiture of the Regional Bell






(MFJ)




Operating Companies (RBOCs) from their parent company, AT&T.






NAT




Network Address Translation






network node




A network node is a generic term for the resources in a telecomnunications network,







including switches, DACS, regenerators, etc. Network nodes essentially include all non-circuit







(transport) devices. Other network nodes can include, for example, equipment of a CLEC, or







other enhanced service provider (ESP), a point-of-presence (POP), an international gateway or







global point-of-presence (GPOP).






number planning area




NPA is an area code. NXX is an exchange, identifying the EO homed to the subscriber.






(NPA); NXX




(The homed EO is typically called a central office (CO).)






packetized voice or voice




One example of packetized voice is voice over internet protocol (VOIP). Voice over packet






over a backbone




refers to the carrying of telephony or voice traffic over a data







network, e.g. voice over frame, voice over ATM, voice over Internet Protocol (IP),







over virtual private networks (VPNs), voice over a backbone, etc.






PIN




Personal Identification Number






Pipe or dedicated




A pipe or dedicatcd communications facility connects an ISP to the internet.






comnunications facility






plain old telephone system




The plain old telephone system (POTS) line provides basic service supplying standard






(POTS)




single line telephones, telephone lines and access to the public switched







telephone network (PSTN). All POTS lines work on loop start signaling.







One “starts” (seizes) a phone line or trunk by giving a supervisory







signal (e.g. taking the phone off hook). Loop start signaling involves seizing a line







by bridging through a resistance the tip and ring (both wires) of a telephone line.






point of presence




A POP refers to the location within a LATA where the IXC and LEC facilities interface.






(POP)






point-to-point (PPP) protocol




PPP is a protocol permitting a computer to establish a connection with the Internet using a







modem. PPP supports high-quality graphical front ends, like Netscape.






point-to-point tunneling protocol




A virtual private networking protocol, point-to-point tunneling protocol (PPTP), can be






(PPTP)




used to create a “tunnel” between a remote user and a data network. A tunnel permits a







network administrator to extend a virtual private network (VPN) from a server (e.g., a







Windows NT server) to a data network (e.g., the Internet).






PPP




See Point-to-Point Protocol






private branch exchange




A PBX is a private switch located on the premises of a user. The user is typically a






(PBX)




private company which desires to provide switching locally.






Private Line with a dial tone




A private line is a direct channel specifically dedicated to a customer's use between two







specified points. A private line with a dial tone can connect a PBX or an ISP's access







concentrator to an end office (e.g. a channelized T1 or PRI).







A private line can also be known as a leased line.






Private Branch Exchange




A small phone company central office that you (instead of the phone company) own.






(PBX)






public switched telephone network




The PSTN is the worldwide switched voice network.






(PSTN)






Q.931




ITU-T Recommendation Q.931 (03/93) - Digital Subscriber Signaling System No. 1







(DSS 1) - ISDN user-network interface layer 3 specification for basic call control






RADIUS




Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service, an example of a proxy server which maintains







a pool of IP addresses.






RAS




Registration/Admission/Status






regional Bell operating companies




RBOCs are the Bell operating companies providing LEC services after being






(RBOCs)




divested from AT&T.






RSVP




Resource Reservation Protocol






RTCP




Real-time Transport Control Protocol






RTP




Real-time Transport Protocol






SCbus ™




The standard bus for communicating within a







SIGNAL COMPUTING SYSTEM ARCHITECTURE ™ (SCSA ™) node.







Its hybrid architecture consists of a serial message bus for control and signaling and a 16-wire







TDM data bus.






signaling system 7




SS7 is a type of common channel interoffice signaling (CCIS) used widely throughout the world.






(SS7)




The SS7 network provides the signaling functions of indicating the arrival of calls,







transmitting routing and destination signals, and monitoring line and circuit status.






SNMP




Simple Network Management Protocol.







SNMP is a standard protocol used for managing a network.







SNMP agents can send network alerts or alarms to an SNMP manager.






switching hierarchy or




An office class is a functional ranking of a telephone central office switch depending






office classification




on transmission requirements and hierarchical relationship to other switching centers.







Prior to divestiture, an office classification was the number assigned to offices







according to their hierarchical function in the U.S. public switched network (PSTN).







The following class numbers are used:







class 1 - Regional Center (RC),







class 2 - Sectional Center (SC),







class 3 - Primary Center (PC),







class 4 - Toll Center (TC) if operators are present or else Toll Point (TP),







class 5 - End Office (EO) a local central office. Any one center handles traffic from one to two







or more centers lower in the hierarchy. Since divestiture and with more intelligent software in







switching offices, these designations have become less firm. The class 5 switch was the closest







to the end subscriber. Technology has distributed technology closer to the end user,







diffusing traditional definitions of network switching hierarchies and the class of switches.






T.120




ITU-T Recommendation T.120 (07/96) - Data protocols for multimedia conferencing






TAPI




Telephony Application Programming Interface






TCP




Transport Control Protocol






telecommunications carrier




A LEC, a CLEC, an LXC, an Enhanced Service Provider (ESP), an intelligent peripheral (IP),







an international/global point-of-presence (GPOP), i.e., any provider of telecommnications







services.






transmission control




TCP/IP is a protocol that provides communications between interconnected networks.






protocol/internet protocol




The TCP/IP protocol is widely used on the Internet, which is a network comprising several






(TCP/IP)




large networks connected by high-speed connections.






transmission control protocol




TCP is an end-to-end protocol that operates at the transport and sessions layers of OSI,






(TCP)




providing delivery of data bytes between processes running in host







computers via separation and sequencing of IP packets






trunk




A trunk connects an access tandem (AT) to an end office (EO).






UDP




User Datagram Protocol






Voice over Internet Protocol




Founded in 1996 by Cisco, Dialogic, Microsoft, U.S. Robotics, VocalTec, and several other






(VoIP)




leading firms, VoIP is working to develop and promote standards for IP telephony.







The VoIP efforts consist primarily of building on and complementing existing standards,







like H.323.






wide area network




A WAN is a data network that extends a LAN over the circuits of a telecommunications carrier.






(WAN)




The carrier is typically a common carrier. A bridging switch or a router is used to connect







the LAN to the WAN.














V. Conclusion




While various embodiments of the present invention have been described above, it should be understood that they have been presented by way of example only, and not limitation. Thus, the breadth and scope of the present invention should not be limited by any of the above-described exemplary embodiments, but should be defined only in accordance with the following claims and their equivalents.



Claims
  • 1. A method for transmitting voice information over a packet-switched data network, the method comprising:receiving a signaling message associated with a telecommunications call requested between a caller at an origination location to a callee at a termination location, wherein the caller requests connection of the telecommunications call by dialing a termination call number associated with the termination location; querying a customer profile database using a customer look-up key contained in the signaling message; extracting from the customer profile database a plan for servicing telecommunications calls requested by the caller, wherein the plan specifies at least one process to be performed in response to reception of the signaling message; implementing the plan; analyzing the termination call number to determine a termination gateway servicing the termination location; and connecting the requested telecommunications call between an origination gateway servicing the origination location and the termination gateway.
  • 2. A method as defined in claim 1, wherein the plan specifies verification of an account code in order for the caller to participate in the requested telecommunications call, the implementing act comprising:prompting the caller to input the account code; receiving a response from the caller; and performing the analyzing act and the connecting act if the response matches the account code.
  • 3. A method as defined in claim 1, wherein the plan specifies input of one of a plurality of project account codes associated with a billing account set up for the caller, the implementing act comprising:prompting the caller to input one of a plurality of project account codes; receiving a response from the caller, the response being a specific project account code; and marking the telecommunications call as associated with a specific billing account identified by the specific project account code.
  • 4. A method as defined in claim 1, wherein the analyzing act comprises:determining a least-cost route through the packet-switched network between the origination gateway and the destination gateway.
  • 5. A method as defined in claim 4, wherein the connecting act comprises:allocating an ingress port at an origination access server located at the origination gateway; and allocating an egress port at a termination access server located at the termination gateway, wherein the least-cost route is determined between the ingress port and the egress port.
  • 6. A method as defined in claim 1, wherein the signaling message comprises an out of band signaling format.
  • 7. A method as defined in claim 1, wherein the telecommunications call comprises media traffic, the connecting act further comprising:transmitting the media traffic between the origination gateway and the termination gateway.
  • 8. A method as defined in claim 7, further comprising:converting the media traffic from a first media format to a second media format operable for transmission of the media traffic over the packet-switched data network.
  • 9. A method as defined in claim 8, wherein each of the first and the second media formats are selected from the group consisting of: a circuit switched format and a packet switched format.
  • 10. A method as defined in 9, wherein the media traffic comprises content selected from the group consisting of voice information and data information, wherein the analyzing act comprises:determining whether the media traffic comprises voice information or data information; and wherein the connecting act comprises: terminating the telecommunications call at the the termination gateway via a modem if the media traffic comprises data information; and terminating the telecommunications call at the termination gateway via an RTP connection if the media traffic comprises voice information.
CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATION

The following application of common assignee contains a related disclosure to the present application: U.S. patent application Ser. No. (to be assigned), filed on even date herewith, entitled “System and Method for Bypassing Data from Egress Facilities,” application Ser. No. 09/196,756, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.

US Referenced Citations (181)
Number Name Date Kind
4100377 Flanagan Jul 1978 A
4238851 Takahashi et al. Dec 1980 A
4569041 Takeuchi et al. Feb 1986 A
4608685 Jain et al. Aug 1986 A
4630260 Toy et al. Dec 1986 A
4630262 Callens et al. Dec 1986 A
4661947 Lea et al. Apr 1987 A
4674082 Flanagin et al. Jun 1987 A
4679190 Dias et al. Jul 1987 A
4679191 Nelson et al. Jul 1987 A
4707831 Weir, deceased et al. Nov 1987 A
4715026 Eberspaecher Dec 1987 A
4723238 Isreal et al. Feb 1988 A
4757497 Beierle et al. Jul 1988 A
4761779 Nara et al. Aug 1988 A
4771425 Baran et al. Sep 1988 A
4815071 Shimizu Mar 1989 A
4819228 Baran et al. Apr 1989 A
4862451 Closs et al. Aug 1989 A
4866704 Bergman Sep 1989 A
4872159 Hemmady et al. Oct 1989 A
4872160 Hemmady et al. Oct 1989 A
4885739 Read et al. Dec 1989 A
4903261 Baran et al. Feb 1990 A
4926416 Weik May 1990 A
4932022 Keeney et al. Jun 1990 A
4933931 Kokubo Jun 1990 A
4953158 Schreur Aug 1990 A
4958341 Hemmady et al. Sep 1990 A
4962497 Ferenc et al. Oct 1990 A
4969184 Gordon et al. Nov 1990 A
4970721 Aczel et al. Nov 1990 A
4975695 Almond et al. Dec 1990 A
4996685 Farese et al. Feb 1991 A
5008929 Olsen et al. Apr 1991 A
5014266 Bales et al. May 1991 A
5018136 Gollub May 1991 A
5020058 Holden et al. May 1991 A
5022071 Mozer et al. Jun 1991 A
5048081 Gavaras et al. Sep 1991 A
5051983 Kammerl Sep 1991 A
5093827 Franklin et al. Mar 1992 A
5115431 Williams et al. May 1992 A
5150357 Hopner et al. Sep 1992 A
5157662 Tadamura et al. Oct 1992 A
5197067 Fujimoto et al. Mar 1993 A
5208806 Hasegawa May 1993 A
5218602 Grant et al. Jun 1993 A
5231633 Hluchyj et al. Jul 1993 A
5241588 Babson, III et al. Aug 1993 A
5247571 Kay et al. Sep 1993 A
5268900 Hluchyj et al. Dec 1993 A
5274635 Rahman et al. Dec 1993 A
5291489 Morgan et al. Mar 1994 A
5301189 Schmidt et al. Apr 1994 A
5305308 English et al. Apr 1994 A
5327428 Van As et al. Jul 1994 A
5341374 Lewen et al. Aug 1994 A
5351276 Doll, Jr. et al. Sep 1994 A
5351286 Nici Sep 1994 A
5353283 Tsuchiya Oct 1994 A
5359598 Steagall et al. Oct 1994 A
5365521 Ohnishi et al. Nov 1994 A
5379293 Kanno et al. Jan 1995 A
5381405 Daugherty et al. Jan 1995 A
5381466 Shibayama et al. Jan 1995 A
5383183 Yoshida Jan 1995 A
5384840 Blatchford et al. Jan 1995 A
5390184 Morris Feb 1995 A
5396491 Newman Mar 1995 A
5420858 Marshall et al. May 1995 A
5422882 Hiller et al. Jun 1995 A
5423003 Berteau Jun 1995 A
5426636 Hiller et al. Jun 1995 A
5428607 Hiller et al. Jun 1995 A
5428616 Field et al. Jun 1995 A
5430719 Weisser, Jr. Jul 1995 A
5434913 Tung et al. Jul 1995 A
5436898 Bowen et al. Jul 1995 A
5438614 Rozman et al. Aug 1995 A
5444709 Riddle Aug 1995 A
5452289 Sharma et al. Sep 1995 A
5453986 Davis et al. Sep 1995 A
5457684 Bharucha et al. Oct 1995 A
5471470 Sharma et al. Nov 1995 A
5479411 Klein Dec 1995 A
5485457 Aramaki Jan 1996 A
5521914 Mavraganis et al. May 1996 A
5526353 Henley et al. Jun 1996 A
5537403 Cloonan et al. Jul 1996 A
5541917 Farris Jul 1996 A
5544161 Bigham et al. Aug 1996 A
5544163 Madonna Aug 1996 A
5544164 Baran Aug 1996 A
5544168 Jeffrey et al. Aug 1996 A
5553063 Dickson Sep 1996 A
5568475 Doshi et al. Oct 1996 A
5570355 Dail et al. Oct 1996 A
5572583 Wheeler, Jr. et al. Nov 1996 A
5577038 Miyahara Nov 1996 A
5577041 Sharma et al. Nov 1996 A
5579308 Humpleman Nov 1996 A
5590181 Hogan et al. Dec 1996 A
5592477 Farris et al. Jan 1997 A
5592538 Kosowsky et al. Jan 1997 A
5594732 Bell et al. Jan 1997 A
5600643 Robrock, II Feb 1997 A
5600649 Sharma et al. Feb 1997 A
5602991 Berteau Feb 1997 A
5604737 Iwami et al. Feb 1997 A
5608786 Gordon Mar 1997 A
5613069 Walker Mar 1997 A
H1641 Sharman Apr 1997 H
5621727 Vaudreuil Apr 1997 A
5625677 Feiertag et al. Apr 1997 A
5631897 Pacheco et al. May 1997 A
5640446 Everett et al. Jun 1997 A
5650999 Dickson Jul 1997 A
5654957 Koyama Aug 1997 A
5659541 Chan Aug 1997 A
5659542 Bell et al. Aug 1997 A
5680437 Segal Oct 1997 A
5684799 Bigham et al. Nov 1997 A
5689553 Ahuja et al. Nov 1997 A
5692126 Templeton et al. Nov 1997 A
5701301 Weisser, Jr. Dec 1997 A
5706286 Reiman et al. Jan 1998 A
5710769 Anderson et al. Jan 1998 A
5712903 Bartholomew et al. Jan 1998 A
5712908 Brinkman et al. Jan 1998 A
5724412 Srinivasan Mar 1998 A
5729544 Lev et al. Mar 1998 A
5732078 Arango Mar 1998 A
5737320 Madonna Apr 1998 A
5737331 Hoppal et al. Apr 1998 A
5737333 Civanlar et al. Apr 1998 A
5740164 Liron Apr 1998 A
5740231 Cohn et al. Apr 1998 A
5742596 Baratz et al. Apr 1998 A
5751706 Land et al. May 1998 A
5751968 Cohen May 1998 A
5754641 Voit et al. May 1998 A
5764628 Davis et al. Jun 1998 A
5764736 Shachar et al. Jun 1998 A
5764750 Chau et al. Jun 1998 A
5764756 Onweller Jun 1998 A
5777991 Adachi et al. Jul 1998 A
5790538 Sugar Aug 1998 A
5793762 Penners et al. Aug 1998 A
5793771 Darland et al. Aug 1998 A
5799154 Kuriyan Aug 1998 A
5805587 Norris et al. Sep 1998 A
5805588 Petersen Sep 1998 A
5809022 Byers et al. Sep 1998 A
5809128 McMullin Sep 1998 A
5812534 Davis et al. Sep 1998 A
5815505 Mills Sep 1998 A
5818912 Hammond Oct 1998 A
5825771 Cohen et al. Oct 1998 A
5828666 Focsaneanu et al. Oct 1998 A
5838665 Kahn et al. Nov 1998 A
5867494 Krishnaswamy et al. Feb 1999 A
5867495 Elliott et al. Feb 1999 A
5881060 Morrow et al. Mar 1999 A
5881131 Farris et al. Mar 1999 A
5889774 Mirashrafi et al. Mar 1999 A
5915008 Dulman Jun 1999 A
5922047 Newlin et al. Jul 1999 A
5933490 White et al. Aug 1999 A
5954799 Goheen et al. Sep 1999 A
5963551 Minko Oct 1999 A
5991291 Asai et al. Nov 1999 A
5999525 Krishnaswamy et al. Dec 1999 A
6009469 Mattaway et al. Dec 1999 A
6026083 Albrow et al. Feb 2000 A
6069890 White et al. May 2000 A
6134235 Goldman et al. Oct 2000 A
6278707 MacMillan et al. Aug 2001 B1
6324183 Miller et al. Nov 2001 B1
6327258 Deschaine et al. Dec 2001 B1
6339594 Civanlar et al. Jan 2002 B1
Foreign Referenced Citations (62)
Number Date Country
0 789 470 Aug 1997 EP
0 794 650 Sep 1997 EP
0 797 373 Sep 1997 EP
0 824 298 Feb 1998 EP
0 829 995 Mar 1998 EP
0 841 831 May 1998 EP
0 847 176 Jun 1998 EP
0 866 596 Sep 1998 EP
0 872 998 Oct 1998 EP
2 315 190 Jan 1998 GB
10-23067 Jan 1998 JP
10-51453 Feb 1998 JP
10-164135 Jun 1998 JP
10-164257 Jun 1998 JP
WO 9608935 Mar 1996 WO
WO 9615598 May 1996 WO
WO 9714238 Apr 1997 WO
WO 9714234 A2 Apr 1997 WO
WO 9716007 May 1997 WO
WO 9722216 Jun 1997 WO
WO 9723078 Jun 1997 WO
WO 9727692 Jul 1997 WO
WO 9728628 Aug 1997 WO
WO 9729581 Aug 1997 WO
WO 9731492 Aug 1997 WO
WO 9733412 Sep 1997 WO
WO 9738551 Oct 1997 WO
WO 9739560 Oct 1997 WO
WO 9738511 A2 Oct 1997 WO
WO 9747118 Dec 1997 WO
WO 9750217 Dec 1997 WO
WO 9750271 Dec 1997 WO
WO 9746073 A2 Dec 1997 WO
WO 9750277 A2 Dec 1997 WO
WO 9804989 Feb 1998 WO
WO 9811704 Mar 1998 WO
WO 9812860 Mar 1998 WO
WO 9813974 Apr 1998 WO
WO 9818238 Apr 1998 WO
WO 9818289 Apr 1998 WO
WO 9819425 May 1998 WO
WO 9819445 May 1998 WO
WO 9820701 May 1998 WO
WO 9823067 May 1998 WO
WO 9823080 May 1998 WO
WO 9826543 Jun 1998 WO
0 851 653 Jul 1998 WO
0 853 411 A2 Jul 1998 WO
WO 9828885 Jul 1998 WO
WO 9830007 Jul 1998 WO
WO 9830008 Jul 1998 WO
WO 9834391 Aug 1998 WO
WO 9834399 Aug 1998 WO
WO 9836543 Aug 1998 WO
WO 9837665 Aug 1998 WO
WO 9837688 A2 Aug 1998 WO
WO 9839897 Sep 1998 WO
WO 9842104 Sep 1998 WO
WO 9842107 Sep 1998 WO
WO 9842146 Sep 1998 WO
WO 9847256 A2 Oct 1998 WO
WO 9851063 Nov 1998 WO
Non-Patent Literature Citations (71)
Entry
Yang, C.; INETPhone: Telephone Services and Servers on Internet; Apr. 1995; pp. 1-6; Network Working Group, RFC#1789.
“VocalTec Introduces Full Duplex in Revolutionary Internet Phone,” PR Newswire, Jun. 5, 1995, 2 pages.
“New Vendor Alliance Targets Frame Relay Over ISDN,” ISDN News, vol. 8, Issue 6, Mar. 14, 1995, 3 pages.
“Cascade sweeps the Internet market, creating a new Internet infrastructure core for the world's largest commercial Internet providers; PSINet, UUNET and NETCOM select Cascade B-STDX 9000 switches to overcome the scalability, capacity, Quality of Service and management concerns of exploding Internet growth,” Business Wire, Oct. 30, 1995, 5 pages.
“Internet Telephone Companies Racing to Market,” Voice Technology & Services News, Oct. 3, 1995, 4 pages.
“Company Develops Telephone/Internet Gateway for International Callers,” Advanced Intelligent Network News, Oct. 18, 1995, 2 pages.
“IDT Connects Internet Phone Calls to the PSTN,” Network Briefing, Nov. 3, 1995, 2 pages.
Voice Over IP (VOIP) (Copyright 1998) <http://www.netrix.com/whatsnew/voip.htm>, 2 pages.
VocalTec Ensemble Architect—VocalTec Telephony Gateway Series 120 (visited Oct. 26, 1998) <http://www.vocaltec.com/products/vtg/vtg_overview.htm<, 1 page.
VocalTec Ensemble Architect—VocalTec Network Manager (visited Oct. 26, 1998) <http://www.vocaltec.com/products/vnm/vnm_overview.htm>, 2 pages.
VocalTec Ensemble Architect—VocalTec Gatekeeper (visited Oct. 26, 1998) <http://www.vocaltec.com/products/vgk/vgk13 overview.htm>, 2 pages.
VocalTec Ensemble Architect—VocalTec Internet Phone Lite (visited Oct. 26, 1998) <http://www.vocaltec.com/products/veaiplite/iplite_overview.htm>, 2 pages.
NextGen Telcos—By pulver.com (Copyright 1997) <http://www.pulver.com/nextgen/>, 4 pages.
Global Carrier Services—Overview (Copyright 1996, 1997) <http://www.alphanet.net/combine.cgi?content=gcs/gcs>, 4 pages.
Press Release—AlphaNet telecom Achieves a New Traffic Milestone and Provides a Status Update on its Telecommunications Business (Oct. 23, 1998) <http://www.alphanet.net/combine.cgi?content=pr/981023>, 2 pages.
The Global Gateway Group Press (Copyright 1997) <http://www.gcubed.com/g3press.htm>, 7 pages.
AT&T Products and Services (Copyright 1998) <http://www.attjens.co.jp/products/phone/phone_e.html>, 2 pages.
About Delta Three (visited Oct. 29, 1998) <http://www.deltathree.com/company/company_body1.asp>, 2 pages.
Internet Telephony (visited Oct. 29, 1998) <http://www.deltathree.com/company/company_body7.asp>, 3 pages.
TeleMatrix (Copyright 1997) <http://www.telematrix.co.jp/iphone.html>, 2 pages.
How VIP Calling Works (visited Oct. 29, 1998) <http://www.vipcalling.com/how.html>, 1 page.
About VIP Calling (visited Oct. 29, 1998) <http://www.vipcalling.com/about.html>, 1 page.
VIP Calling First Internet Telephony Company to Deploy DS-3 (Mar. 30, 1998) <http://www.vipcalling.com/PR_VIP-DS30330.html>, 2 pages.
Gareiss, R., Voice Over IP Services: The Sound Decision (Copyright 1998) <http://www.poptel.com/newpop/eng/pages/press/data.html>, 7 pages.
Phone Via Internet—and Forget the Computer (visited Oct. 29 1998) <http://www.poptel.com/newpop/eng/pages/press/heraldtrib.html>, 4 pages.
Interline Telephone Services (Copyright 1998) <http://www.interline.aust.com/prodserv.htm>, 2 pages.
What is IP Telephony? (Copyright 1998) <http://www.networkstelephony.com/whatistelephony.html>, 2 pages.
Products (EXICOM) (Copyright 1998) <http://www.exicom.com/products.html>, 2 pages.
Voice/Fax Over IP: Internet, Intranet, and Extranet: Technology Overview, MICOM Communications Corporation, 52 pages (white paper downloaded from www.micom.com).
Voice Over Packet (VOP) White Paper (Copyright 1997) <http://www.telogy.com/our_products?golden_gateway/VOPwhite.html>,12 pages.
Net2Phone Product Information (Copyright 1998) <http://www.net2phone.com/2/english/geninfo.html>, 2 pages.
Lucent Technologies and VocalTec Demonstrate Industry's First Interoperable Internet Telephony Gateways over ITXC Network (Sep. 14, 1998) <http://www.vocaltec.com/about/press/pr_lucent091498.htm>, 3 pages.
Gates, D., Voice Phone Over the Internet (Copyright 1998) <http://www.pretext.com/mar98/shorts/short1.htm>, 4 pages.
Aras, C.M. et al., “Real-Time Communication in Packet-Switched Networks,” Proceedings of the IEEE, vol. 82, No. 1, Jan. 1994, pp. 122-139.
Weinstein, C.J. and Forgie, J.W., “Experience with Speech Communication in Packet Networks,” IEEE Journal on Selected Areas in Communication, vol. SAC-1, No. 6, Dec. 1983, pp. 963-980.
A Fundamental Shift in Telephony Networks, Selsius Systems, Inc., Mar., 1998, Version 1.0, 28 pages.
MicroLegend Internet Telephony Tutorial (last updated May 16, 1998) <http://www.microlegend.com/what-it.htm>, 2 pages.
Ascend Product Overview: MultiVoice for the MAX—Release 1.0, Copyright 1998, Ascend Communications, Inc., 18 pages.
Electronic mail message from ‘srctran’ to ‘prd’ regarding “Internet and telephones review document”, 1995, 10 pages.
Schmit, J., “Talk is cheap in high tech's fledgling market,” USA Today, Jan. 19, 1996, pp. 1B-2B.
Gordon, J., “Overview of Internet Congestion on the Public Switched Telephone Network,” GR-303 Integrated Access Symposium, Jul. 30, 1998, 13 pages.
Gracanin, D., “Implementation of the Voice Transfer Over TCP/IP,” ITA, 1993, pp. 543-549.
Atai, A., Gordon, J., “Architectural Solutions to Internet Congestion Based on SS7 and Intelligent Network Capabilities,” Copyright 1997, Bellcore, 18 pages.
DIALOG File 347 (JAPIO) English Language Patent Abstract for JP 10-51453, published Feb. 20, 1998, 1 page.
DIALOG File 347 (JAPIO) English Language Patent Abstract for JP 10-164135, published Jun. 19, 1998, 1 page.
DIALOG File 347 (JAPIO) English Language Patent Abstract for JP 10-164257, published Jun. 19, 1998, 1 page.
DIALOG File 347 (JAPIO) English Language Patent Abstract for JP 10-23067, published Jan. 23, 1998, 1 page.
The Adax Advanced Protocol Controllers APC-VMEX—VMEbus (visited Mar. 7, 1997) <html document under http://www.adax.coj/products/>.
The Adax Advanced Protocol Controllers APC-PCX—PC bus (visited Mar. 7, 1997) <html document under http://www.adax.com/products/>.
Adax Advanced Protocol Controllers APC-EIX—EISAbus (visited Mar. 7, 1997) <http://www.adax.com/products/apc/eix.htm>.
The Adax Sbus Advanced Protocol Controllers APC-SBX—SBus (visited Mar. 7, 1997) <http://www.adax.com/products/apc/sbx.htm>.
Kristi An and David Powers, XCOM Technologies Creates Carrier-Class Data Network with Ascend Products (Nov. 18, 1997) <http://www.ascend.com/2495.html>.
Ascend DSLTNT Product Information (Ascend Communications, Inc., 1997).
Ascend IDSL Product Information (Ascend Communications, Inc. 1996).
Ascend RADSL Product Information (Ascend Communications, Inc. 1997).
Ascend SDSL Product Information (Ascend Communications, Inc. 1997).
DSC Signs Agreement With Unisys For Intelligent Network Measurement And Monitoring Systems (Jul. 15, 1997) <http:/www.dsccc.com/pr071597.htm>.
GeoProbe: The Service Provider's Competitive Advantage (Inet, Inc. 1997).
Tim Greene, XCOM Marks The Spot, Network World (Nov. 3, 1997) <http://www.engbooks.com/news/press11-3.html>.
MicroLegend MS7 SS7 Mediation System (Hewlett-Packard Company 1995).
New Telecommunications Protocols Published (Aug. 5, 1998) <http://www.l3.com/press_releases>.
Oliver L. Picher, Harnessing The Untapped Information Resources Within The Telephone Network (visited Nov. 25, 1998) <http://corp2.unisys.com/AboutUnisys/PressReleases/1996/jan/01085957.html>.
David Powers et al., XCOM Technologies, Inc., “The Data Phone Company,” Receives First Round Funding From Battery Ventures & Matrix Partners, (XCOM News Release, Sep. 8, 1997).
Salvatore Salamone, CLEC Seeks ISP Alliances To Expand Coverage, InternetWeek, Nov. 17, 1997, at 18.
Richard Sekar, DSL Modems Fail To Deliver Data Privacy, Electronic Engineering Times, Jun. 23, 1997, at 1.
Selsius System—Home of the IP PBX (last modified Jul. 16, 1998) <http://www.selsius.com/>.
Spectra: The Multi-Protocol Analyzer (Inet, Inc. 1997).
Too Much Of A Good Thing? (1996) <http://www.bellcore.com/BC.dynjava?GoodThingEAGeneral-ExchangeArticle>.
Trillium™ SS7 Product Group ISDN User Part (ISUP) Portable Software 1000029 (visited Mar. 14, 1997) <http://www.trillium.com/1078029.html>.
Trillium™ SS7 Product Group Telephone User Part (TUP) Portable Software 1000042 (visited Mar. 14, 1997) <http://www.trillium.com/1078042.html>.
Trillium™SS7 Product Group Signaling Connection Control Part (SCCP) Portable Software 1000030 (visited Mar. 14, 1997) <http://www.trillium.com/1078030.html>.